Economics Disha 4in1

You might also like

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 43

The

Economics
Compendium

Scanned by CamScanner

• Head Office : B-32, Shivalik Main Road, Malviya Nagar, New Delhi-110017



Sales Office : B-48, Shivalik Main Road, Malviya Nagar, New Delhi-110017
Tel. : 011-26691021 / 26691713
CONTENTS
1. Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India E-1-E-18
Introduction; Salient Features; National Income Of India; Population

2. Planning, Unemployment and Poverty in India E-19-E-44


Introduction; Planning Commission; NITI Aayog; Five Year Plans; Unemployment; Poverty;
Millennium Development Goals; Sustainable Development Goals

3. Agriculture E-45-E-70
Introduction; Features of Indian Agriculture; Growth and Productivity; Agriculture in Five
Typeset by Disha DTP Team Year Plans; National Agricultural Policy; Major Agriculture Programmes & Revolutions; Land
Reforms; Co-operative Farming; Rural Credit and Extension Services; Agricultural Insurance,
Marketing & Price Policy; Public Distribution System

4. Fiscal and Monetary Policy E-71-E-90


Introduction; Fiscal policy; Expenditure; Deficit & Taxes; Indian Tax Structure; Black Money;
Finance Commission; Monetary Policy

5. Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-91-E-120


Introduction; Money Market; Capital Market; Money Supply; Inflation; Indian Banking System;
Insurance Sector; Micro Finance

6. Foreign Trade and Investment in India E-121-E-140


Introduction; Foreign Exchange Reserves; India’s Foreign Trade; Balance Of Payments; India’s
Balance of Payment

7. Industry and Infrastructure E-141-E-164


DISHA PUBLICATION
Introduction; Status of Indian Industries; Acts and Regulations; Micro, Small and Medium
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
Enterprise; Major Industries; Public Sector Units
© Copyright Publisher

No part of this publication may be reproduced in any form without prior permission of the publisher. The author and the
publisher do not take any legal responsibility for any errors or misrepresentations that might have crept in. We have
tried and made our best efforts to provide accurate up-to-date information in this book.

For further information about the books from DISHA,


Log on to www.dishapublication.com or email to info@dishapublication.com
ECONOMY

STRUCTURE OF ECONOMY AND


1
HUMAN RESOURCE IN INDIA

Introduction
The word ‘Economics’ originates from the Greek word ‘Oikonomikos’; Oikos (means ‘Home’) + Nomos (means ‘Management’)’
means ‘Home management. Economics is the study of how people and society end up choosing, with or without the use of
money, to employ scarce productive resources that could have alternative uses to produce various commodities over time and
distributing them for consumption, now or in the future, among various persons or groups in society. It analyses costs and
benefits of improving patterns of resource allocation. The term Economy means the state of country or region in terms of the
production and consumption of goods and services and the supply of money.

Types of Economy Indian Economy


Salient Features of Indian Economy
Socialist Mixed Capitalist The salient features of Indian Economy include the followings:

Social ownership (1) Mixed Economy


Private ownership
of means of means of production India is a mixed economy. In a mixed economy,
of Production public sector (government-owned) business enterprises
exist alongside the private sector to achieve a welfare
USSR, China USA, UK, France, etc
state with socialistic pattern of society. Ever since
independence, India’s economic development has been
Public- Private Market-based Free-markets guided by the twin objectives of developing:
ownership + allocation + with state (a) a rapidly and technologically progressive economy
of Industry with Economic interventionism by democratic means; and
Planning
(b) a social order based on justice, offering equal
India opportunity to every citizen of the country.
(2) Low per Capita Income
Sells
Buys/ ebentures According to IMF GDP per capital of India in 2014 at
s, d to
Share ds from / s current prices is $1,627. India is the 9th largest economy
n
& bo n countrie Borrows of the world. But, due to its huge population of more
foreig & Lends
Free than 1.26 billion, India is at 145th position in term of
Closed Economy Open movement GDP Per capita. Per capita income of India is 6.69 times
of people lower than world’s average around of $10,880. This
figure is 68.66 times lower than richest country of world
ow
e fl
No economic M Fre oods & and 6.5 times greater than poorest country of the world.
relation with rest bilatera aintain of g rvices India is at 34th position in the list of Asian countries.
l/multi s e
of the world relation lateral On the basis of PPP, GDP, per capita of India stands
ships
at 5,855 International Dollar in 2014. GDP (PPP) per
capita of world is 15,189 Int. $.

E-2 Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India E-3

2014-15 India suffers from inadequacy of financial institutions Percentage Share of Sectors in GVA at factor cost at current Prices -
in rural areas. Similarly, India being a country of a
Per capita Net national Income at current prices - `88533 large number of small farmers, the development of Sector 2004-05 Series 2011-12 Series
Per capita Income constant prices ( 2011-12 prices) - `74193 certain agencies of credit for granting loans to farmers
GDP Per Capita at current - `98,983 2011-12 2012-13 2013-14 2011-12 2012-13 2013-14 2014-15
on easy terms is needed. Likewise, to provide medium
GDP Per Capita at 2011-12 price - `84, 009. 1. Agriculture & Allied Activities 17.9 17.5 18.2 18.9 18.7 18.6 17.6
and long-term loans to industries for the development of
industrial finance corporation is quite necessary. There 2. Industry 27.2 26.2 24.8 32.9 31.7 30.5 29.7
(3) Dominance of Agriculture and Heavy Population
Pressure on Agriculture is a great scarcity of skilled and efficient administrators and 3. Service 54.9 56.3 57.0 48.2 49.6 50.9 52.7
managers. Source : CSO’s press Releases of 30 january 2015 & 9 February 2015 on New Series Estimates of National Income.
In India, almost 60-70% of the total population still
resides in rural areas and hence they depend on State of the Economy 2014-15
The Central Statistics Office (CSO), Ministry of Statistics In equation form:
agriculture for their livelihood. An Overview and Programme Implementation have released the advance GNP = GDP + X – M,
(4) Over-Population 1. GDP Growth Rate - 7.4 % estimates of GDP growth rates for 2015-16 and Q1, Q2, Q3 where,
2. Export growth - 2.4 % (US$265 billion) of 2015-16 at constant (2011-12) and current prices are given X = Income earned and received by nationals within
India is over populated. In every decade Indian
(April-Jan.) below: the boundaries of foreign countries.
population gets increased by about 20%. During 2001-
11, population increased by 17.6%. With this high 3. Import growth - 2.2% (US$ 383.4 billion) Growth Rates of GDP M = Income received by foreign nationals within the
growth rate of population about 1.7 crore new persons (April-Jan.) country.
Constant Current
are added to Indian population every year. According If X = M, then GNP = GDP.
4. Fiscal Deficit - 4.0% Prices (2011-12) Prices
to 2011 census, the total Indian population stands at a Similarly, in a closed economy
5. Inflation (WPI) - 3.4% (April-Dec.) Annual 2015-16 (Advance) 7.6 8.6 X=M=0
high level of 121.02 crore which is 17.5% of the world’s
total population which is second largest population of the 6. Foreign Exchange - US $ 330.2 billion Q1 2015-16 (April-June) 7.6 8.7 then also GNP = GDP
world. To maintain this 17.5% of world population India Reserves (6 Feb. 2015) In equation form :
Q2 2015-16 (July-Sep) 7.7 6.4
holds only 2.42% of total land area of the world. * New Base year of National Accounts is 2011-12 GNP = GDP + NFIA
Q3 2015-16 (Oct-Dec) 7.3 9.2
(5) Unbalanced Economic Development Where NFIA = Net Factor Income from abroad
Structure Composition of Indian Economy also NFIA = Factor incomes received from abroad —
India has not yet achieved the goal of balanced economic There are 3 major sectors of Indian economy- the primary sector, National Income Of India Factor income paid to abroad.
development. According to latest data available about the secondary and the tertiary sector. It is to be noted here that in a closed economy which
National income measures the net value of goods and services
64% of total labour force is dependent on agriculture, Manufactured goods used as Inputs does not deal with outside world, has no NFIA, i.e. its
produced in a country during a year and it also includes net NFIA is equal to Zero. Hence, for such countries, GDP
16% on industries and the rest about 20% on trade,
earned foreign income. In other words, a total of national = GNP
transport and other services.
income measures the flow of goods and services in an Gross Domestic Product (GDP)
Primary Provide Secondary Provide Tertiary
(6) Low rate of capital formation Sector Natural Products Sector
economy. National income is a flow not a stock. As contrasted It is the total money value of all final goods and services
Infrastructure Sector
Another basic characteristic of the Indian economy is the with national wealth which measures the stock of commodities produced within the geographical boundaries of the
held by the nationals of a country at a point of time, national country during a given period of time. So, domestic
existence of capital deficiency which is reflected in two Services that help in production
income measures the productive power of an economy in a given product emphasis the total output which is raised within
ways - firstly, the amount of capital per head available is the geographical boundaries of the country, national
low; and secondly, the current rate of capital formation period to turn out goods and services for final consumption.
Sector Activity product focuses not only on the domestic product but also
is also low. Gross Fixed Capital Formation in India on goods and services produced outside the boundaries of
Agriculture and Allied Sector Concepts of National Income a nation.
increased to 4975.22 INR billion in the third quarter of
2014 from 4957.25 INR billion in the second quarter of The various concepts of national income are as follows: 3. Net National Product (NNP)
Primary Forestry
2014. Gross Fixed Capital Formation in India averaged 1. Per Capita Income NNP is obtained by subtracting depreciation value (i.e.
Sector Fishing It is a measure of the amount of money that is being capital stock consumption) from GNP.
3595.81 INR billion from 2001 until 2014, reaching an
Mining &Quarrying earned per person in a certain area. In equation form :
all time high of 5356.22 INR billion in the first quarter
of 2014 and a record low of 2021.90 INR billion in the National Income NNP = GNP – Depreciation.
Secondary Manufacturing PCI =
first quarter of 2002. Population 4. National Income
Sector Electricity, Gas
(7) Lack of Infrastructure Facility or and Water Supply 2. Gross National Product (GNP) GNP is based on market prices of produced goods
Gross National Product refers to the money value of total which includes indirect taxes and subsidies. NNP can be
There is a lack of physical infrastructure (i.e. Industrial sector Construction calculated in two ways-
road,electricity, banking, transportation, insurance, energy) output or production of final goods and services produced (i) at market prices of goods and services
and social infrastructure(i.e. education, health, housing, Trade, Hotels and Restaurants by the nationals of a country during a given period of (ii) at factor cost
drinking water, sanitation) that hinders the development Transport time, generally a year. When NNP is obtained at factor cost, it is known
process of a country. In the calculation of GNP, we include the money value as National Income. National Income is calculated by
Storage of goods and services produced by nationals outside
(8) Poor Economic Organisation Tertiary subtracting net indirect taxes (i.e. total indirect tax-
Communication the country. Hence, income produced and received by subsidy) from NNP at market prices. The obtained value
Another important feature of the Indian economy Sector or Service nationals of a country within the boundaries of foreign
Sector Financing, (Banking Insurance) is known as NNP at factor cost or National income. So,
is poor economic organisation. Certain institutions countries should be added in Gross Domestic Product NNP at factor cost or National Income
necessary for economic development are not adequately Real Estate and Business Services (GDP) of the country. Similarly, income received by
developed. For instance, to mobilise savings and more = NNP at market price – (Indirect Taxes – Subsidy)
Community, Social, Personal and foreign nationals within the boundary of the country
especially the savings of the rural sector, the creation = NNP(mp) – Indirect Tax + Subsidy.
other Services should be excluded from GDP.
and development of financial institutions is essential.
E-4 Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India E-5

5. Personal Income In India a combination of production method and income (iv) Human Development Index (HDI) : It is one of the actual decline in population in that Census, brought about by an
Personal income is that income which is actually obtained method is used for estimating national income. most recent and significant indicator of economic influenza epidemic. The most spectacular growth in population
by nationals. Symbolically : N.I = C + I + G + (X – M) development of a country. It is a composite of three was witnessed after Independence, as is clear from the table
Personal income is obtained by subtracting corporate indicators, i.e. Life Expectancy Index (LEI); Education below.
Where,
taxes and payments made for social securities provision C= Total consumption expenditure
Attainment Index (EAI) and Standard of Living Index. Population Growth
(HDI) ranks countries in relations to each other. It can
from national income and adding to it government I = Total Investment Expenditure Year Population Growth Average
be computed by using following formula :
transfer payments, business transfer payments and net G = Total Govt. Expentiture. (in millions) rate during annual growth
interest paid by the government. So,
HDI : 3
LEI× EAI×SLI decade (%) rate (%)
X = Export
Personal Income = National income – undistributed M = Import 1921 251.3 – 0.31 – 0.03
profits of corporation – payments for social security Population 1931 278.9 11 1.04
provisions – corporate tax + government transfer Estimates of National Income in India
payments + Business transfer payments + Net interest In 1868, the first attempt was made by Dada Bhai
Theory of Demographic Transitions 1941 318.6 14.22 1.33
paid by government. Naoroji. He, in his book ‘Poverty and Un-British Rule in Demography is the scientific study of human population. 1951 361 13.31 1.25
It should always be kept in mind that personal income India’. estimated Indian per capita annual income at a level The relationship between population growth and economic 1961 439.2 21.51 1.96
is a flow concept. of Rs. 20. development can be explained by the Theory of Demographic 1971 548.1 24.8 2.2
Transition for contemporary developed nations. There are 1981 683.3 24.66 2.22
6. Personal Disposable Income Some Other economists followed it and gave various estimates
three stages of population growth.
of Indian national income, some of these estimates are as 1991 846.3 23.85 2.14
When personal direct taxes are subtracted from personal follows : (i) First stage of stable or slow population growth
income, the obtained value is called disposable personal 2001 1027 21.34 1.9
Findlay Shirras ( 1911) -   `49 Due to the high death rate which nullified the high birth
income (DPI). So, rate. In this stage, these economies were primitive 2011 1.21 –17.64 1.41
Wadia & Joshi ( 1913-14) -  `44.30
Disposable personal income and primarily agrarian, with widespread illiteracy, Due to the high rate population growth, it has not been possible
Dr. V.K.R.V. Rao (1925-29) -  `76 to make a significant change in the poverty levels in India. The
DPI = [Personal income] – [Direct Taxes] poor sanitation and health care conditions, negligible
After independence, the Government of India appointed knowledge of family planning and large family sizes higher population growth, the lower is the rate of growth of per
A Graphical Representation of relationship between the National Income Committee in August 1949 under the which contributed to factors such as high fertility rate capita income. The rapid growth in population, which is one
various measures. chairmanship of Prof. P.C. Mahalanobis, to compile and high death rate. In the period between the first and of the highest in the world and making up one-fifth of the total
GNPMP authoritative estimates of national income. For further the second stages, the death rates start reducing and world population, is eroding India’s considerable development
estimation of national income, the government established birth rates remain stable which brings an imbalance in gains and steadily diminishing its ability to provide a decent
NNPMP = GNPMP – Depreciation Central Statistical Organisation (CSO) which now regularly
× × × × × ×
× ×× × × × × × × the economy. Measures like diseases control, improving quality of life for a large number of its people. However,
× ×
× ×
× × × × ×× × × ××× ××
× × × ×
NNPFC = NNPMP – Indirect taxes publishes national income data. nutrition levels, and sanitation improvement are several economists and demographers are of the opinion that
× × × × ×× × × × ×× × ×× × ×
× × ××××× ×
× ×
× ××
× ×
× × ×× × × ×××
× ×
+ Subsidier CSO & NSSO to be Merged : implemented to reduce death rates, but the measures India’s growing population is not hindering rapid development.
× ×× ×
× × × ×× × × ×
×× × × ×× × × × × ×× ×
The government is planning to merge Central Statistical for controlling birth rates are not implemented, which According to them a rise in income will automatically bring
× × ×× × × ×
× × × × ×
× ××
× × ×× results in population explosion. This required a period of down the rate of population growth as in developed nations.
Organisation (CSO) and National Sample Survey
× ×
× × × × ××
× ×
× × Personal Income = NNPFc
× × × × × ×× ×
×× × transition for adjustment, thus bringing the second stage However, rapid population growth is a development problem.
× ×
× × ××××
× ×
+Net transfer payment Organisation (NSSO) for promoting statistical network of transition. Continuing rapid population growth in the long run is likely
Disposable income in the country. The newly merged unit will be named as to mean a lower quality of life for millions of people. In the
(ii) Second stage of population explosions
= Personal Income – Direct Taxes National Statistical Organisation (NSO). The head of the developing countries the main economic class that suffers are
In this stage rise in income levels contributed to
organisation will be designated as ‘Chief of Statistician of the poor. It is also the poor, with little education, low and
Methods of Measuring National Income improvement in health-care, education, disease control
India’ and will be having the rank of Chief Secretary. insecure income, poor health and large families, who lose
National Income of a country is calculated by following three and so on which in turn contributed to reducing the
death rates. This accelerated the growth population. The out as rapid population growth hampers development. This
methods :
Indicators of Economic Development family size reduced and improved trade and economic points to the need for a comprehensive public policy aimed at
1. Product Method reducing population growth.
The major indicators to increase the levels of development are : conditions resulted in more food and better food habits
In this method net value of final goods and services
which further helped the population to grow at a much India : Demographics (2013 Estimates)
produced in a country during a year is obtained and the (i) Net National Product (NNP)
higher rate than in the first stage. The demographic
total obtained value is called total final product. This It is defined as the total output produced by a country 1. Population growth rate - 1.25%
changes brought imbalances in the economy, creating
represents Gross Domestic Product (GDP). Net income in one financial year. It can be computed by subtracting 2. Birth rate - 20.22 (Per 1000)
conditions for further transition of society.
earned in foreign boundaries by nationals is added and depreciation from GNP. NNP is also called as National 3. Death Rate - 7.4 (Per 1000)
depreciation is subtracted from GDP. (iii) Third stage of low birth rates and low death rates
Income. 4. Infant Mortality rate - 40 ( Per 1000)
2. Income Method Modernization and industrilization changed the living
(ii) Per Capita Income 5. Total fertility rate - 2.3
In this method, a total of net incomes earned by working pattern in such nations, the rural population shifted
A high per capital income indicates a better standard of to cities and family sizes reduced to become nuclear
people in different sectors and commercial enterprises is living and thus, economic development on the whole. Birth Rate and Death Rate in India
obtained. families. The standard of living increased which further
Further, a rise in per capita income will always mean a brought down mortality rates and birth rates. As a result, (Per Thousand Population)
Symbolically : National Income = total Rent + Total rise in aggregate real output. the growth of population declined. Year Birth Rate Death Rate
Wages + total Interest + Total Profit. (iii) Quality of Life Index (QLI) : The Index of Quality of 1950-51 39.9 27.4
3. Consumption Method life depends upon mainly three factors, i.e. life expected, Population and development in Indian
1960-61 41.7 22.8
It is also called expenditure method. Income is either Basic Literacy ad Infant Morality Rate. Most of the perspective
spent on consumption or saved. Hence national income countries with low per capita GNP tends to have to QLI 1970-71 36.9 14.9
India’s population grew slowly till the 1920s. The year 1921
is the addition of total consumption and total savings. and vice-a-versa. is known as the year of the Great Divide, since there was an 1980-81 33.9 12.5

E-6 Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India E-7

1990-91 29.5 9.8 (i) The immediate objective is to address the unmet needs • Standard of Living Index (SLI): It is represented here by Human Development Report 2015
for contraception, health care infrastructure and basic the concept of Purchasing Power Parity (PPP). Per capita
2000-01 25.4 8.4 reproductive and child health care. The HDR is an annual milestone published by the United Nations
income is converted into Purchasing Power Parity in terms
2007-08 23.5 7.4 Development Programme (UNDP). The title of 2015 edition of
(ii) The medium-term objective is to bring the Total Fertility of US dollar.
HDR is ‘ Rethinking work for Human Development’. The
2008-09 22.8 7.4 Rate (TFR) to replacement levels of 2.1 by 2010.
Thus, HDI = 1 (FLET + EAI + SLI) top three nations in the 2015 HDI are Norway (1st) Australia
2009-10 22.5 7.3 (iii) The long-term objective is to achieve a stable population 3 ( 2nd) & Suitzerland (3rd). In 2015, India has been placed
by 2045, at a level consistent with the requirement of
2010-11 22.1 7.2 at 130th position with 0.609 score in the medium human
sustainable economic growth, social development and • Categories of Countries based on HDI
India is the first country in the world which has officially environmental protection. development category.
sponsored family planning programmes to control population A National Commission on Population, with the Prime Minister HDI has categorised countries into Gender Inequality Index 2015
in order to accelerate the overall development of the country. as the President and state chief ministers, Union ministers, – very high human development (USA, UK, etc.) India’s rank – 130th (Out 155 countries)
The programme was officially launched in 1962. The first two NGOs, demographers and public health professionals as
– high human development
family planning clinics were opened in Karnataka in 1930 members has been set up. This Commission of more than 100
members will oversee and review the implementation of the (Sri lanka, China and India) Global Hunger Index 2015
which were supposed to be the first such in the world.
policy. – low human development India’s Score – 29 (Serious hunger situation)
National Commission on Population The policy emphasises the pivotal role of urban and rural (Pakistan, Bangladesh and Nepal)
local bodies in implementing it. Promotional and motivational Occupational Distribution of Population
The National Commission on Population was constituted on
May 11, 2000 under the Chairmanship of the Prime Minister measures in the policy include rewarding the local bodies Meaning of HDI Value Occupational structure refers to distribution of work force in
to provide overall guidance for population stabilisation by for exemplary performance, cash incentives to mothers and Different levels of development in terms of HDI score the different occupations of the country. As economy grows,
promoting synergy between demographic, educational, couples who undergo sterilisation, etc. • Very high human development = 0.791 and labour force shifts from primary sector to secondary and
environmental and development programmes. The NPP has accepted the recommendation of the Swaminathan                     above tertiary sector.
Committee regarding extension of the freezing of seats in
On May 19, 2005 the National Commission on Population • High human development = 0.699 to Occupation 1951 1971 1991 2001
legislatures and Parliament on the basis of 1971 Census. The
was reconstituted. This Commission has now been transferred                    0.790
Parliament has passed the necessary legislation approving the Primary sector 72.1 72.1 62.7 89.3
from Planning Commission to Ministry of Health. The Prime freezing of seats up to 2026, instead of 2011 as suggested by • Medium human development = 0.541 to
Minister will remain the chairman of NCP while Deputy- Secondary sector 10.6 11.2 14.9 18.2
the Committee.                    0.698
Chairman of Planning Commission and Union Minister of • Low human development = 0.337 to Tertiary sector 17.3 16.7 22.14 22.5
The present approach National Commission on Population
Health and Family Welfare will work as Deputy Chairman of is based on evolving appropriate strategies to improve the                        0.540 Total 100 100 100 100
NCP. The membership of NCP has also been reduced from performance of demographically weak states, drawing lessons
131 to 44. from the southern states. The weaker states are : Bihar, Growth of Population and Workforce – All India Category
The National Commission on Population has undertaken Jharkhand, Madhya Pradesh, Chhattisgarh, Rajasthan, Uttar
various initiatives for implementing the National Population Pradesh and Odisha. Category Person Male Female
Policy such as review of the implementation of National 1981-91 1991-01 2001-11 1981-91 1991-01 2001-11 1981-91 1991-01 2001-11
Family Welfare Programme especially in the high fertility Human Development Index (HDI) Total Population 2.1 2.0 1.6 2.2 1.9 1.6 2.1 2.0 1.7
States, identification of high fertility districts and preparation HDI is a broad-based index that assesses the development of
of District Action Plans, selection of Social Economic and Total Workers 2.5 2.5 1.8 2.2 2.1 1.9 3.5 3.5 1.7
an economy, on the basis of the performance of the economy
Demographic Indicators for monitoring purpose, promotion of in various indicators. The need to create such an index was Main workers 2.5 0.9 1.5 2.2 0.8 1.3 3.6 1.2 2.1
policy-oriented relevant research for population stabilisation felt as the concept of GDP and per capita income could not Marginal workers 2.5 12.3 2.8 2.6 29.5 5.1 3.2 7.9 1.1
and promotion of public private partnership in meeting the demonstrate the various aspects of human development. The
unmet needs of family planning services. concept of HDI was evolved by economist Mahbub-ul-Haq. Sex Ratio in Population and Workforce – All India
The HDI calcualtes the development of an economy in terms
National Population Policy 2000 of three major indicators. Year Population Total Workers Main Workers Marginal Workers
The problem of over population can be solved by two ways 1981 933 351 253 5245
Indicators of HDI 1991 927 400 290 9425
• An effective employment policy, which can absorb the
growing number of workers and promote economic The HDI is an equi-weighted average of- 2001 933 461 303 1520
growth. • Life Expectancy Index (LEI): Infant mortality is not 2011 940 452 327 1032
• An imaginative family planning programme to encourage considered as a separate indicator in this index. Thus, life
expectancy refers to life expectancy at birth, not at age one. Note: 1. Rural and urban combined.
families to adopt the small family norm.
Source: Census of India.
Unfortunately, the official policy has relied heavily on the latter • Educational Attainment Index (EAI) It is a combination
without any linkage with the employment policy. The official of adult literacy rate and combined enrolment ratio. Work Participation Rate:
family planning programme started in 1952 was the first by 2 Percentage of workers (main + marginal) to total population.
The weight assigned to Adult Literacy Rate (ALR) is
any country. Initially, it was a purely birth control programme. 3 Main Workers :
It became evident during the course of time that such a narrow 1 A person who has worked for major part of the reference period (i.e.6 months or more during the last one year preceding the
approach will not pay. False reporting of the achievements of while that for combined Enrolment Ratio (CER) is .
3 date of enumeration) in any economically productive activity is termed as ‘main Worker.’
targets by the executing agency and wasteful expenditure were Therefore,
Marginal Workers :
some of the serious drawbacks of the target approach. Educational Attainment Index may be given as
A person who has worked for 3 months or less but for less than 6 months of the reference period in any economic activity is
The Government in February 2000, announced the National 2 1 termed as marginal worker.
EAI = ALR + CER
Population Policy (NPP) with the following objectives: 3 3
E-8 Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India E-9

17. Who wrote a book describing the theory of economic (b) signs of economic recovery during an economy
drain of India during British rule? downturn.
(a) Lala Lajpat Rai (b) Mahatma Gandhi (c) signs of growth of agriculture sector in a declining
(c) J.L. Nehru (d) Dadabhai Naoroji economy
1. Population experts refer to the possible ‘demographic 8. If it will be true to classify India as 18. The most appropriate measure of a country’s economic (d) signs of economic decline in a developed economy.
bonus’ that may accrue to India around 2016 A.D. They (a) a food-deficit economy growth is its 24. GDP deflator is used to :
are referring to the phenomenon of (b) a labour-surplus economy (a) Gross Domestic Product (a) measure the relative reduction in GDP growth rate
(a) a sharp drop in the total population (c) a trade-surplus economy (b) Net Domestic Product of a country.
(b) a surge in the population in the productive age (d) a capital-surplus economy (c) Net National Product (b) measure the inflation in a country.
group; (d) Per capita Real Income (c) compare the GDP of a country vis a vis other
9. The Indian Economy is characterised by
(c) a decline in both birth and death rates; 19. Which one among the following countries has the lowest countries of the world.
(a) pre-dominance of agriculture
(d) a well-balanced sex ratio GDP per capita? (d) estimate the purchasing power of the citizen of a
(b) low per capita income country.
2. The most significant economic consequence of the (a) China (b) India
(c) massive unemployment 25. Human Development Index comprises literacy rates, life
‘greying’ of the Indian population in the decades to (c) Indonesia (d) Sri Lanka
(d) all of the above expectancy at birth and
come, will be: 20. Which among the following sector of Indian Economy
10. In India, planned economy is based on is maximum dependent on economic developments in (a) GDP per head in the US dollars.
(a) a fall in the growth of population
(a) Gandhian system (b) Socialist system advanced rations? (b) GDP per head at real purchasing power.
(b) a reverse flow of wealth from children to parents
(c) Capitalist system (d) Mixed economy system (a) Manufacturing sector (c) GNP in US dollars
(c) a decline in the demand for maternity facilities
11. Who coined the term ‘Hindu rate of growth’ for Indian (b) Agricultural sector (d) National Income per head in US dollars.
(d) the need for redesigning apartment buildings 26. National income ignores
Economy? (c) Mining sector
3. According to 2011 census urban-rural population ratio (a) sales of a firm
(a) A.K. Sen (d) Services sector
was about- (b) salary of employees
(b) Kirit S. Parich 21. Which among the following is a most suitable example
(a) 35 : 65 (b) 32 : 68 (c) exports of the IT sector
(c) Raj Krishna of double counting in national income ?
(c) 28 : 72 (d) 31 : 69 (a) Wages of bus and train drivers. (d) sale of land
(d) Montek Singh Ahluwalia
4. One of the reasons for India’s occupational structure (b) Cotton output and cotton cloth output. 27. The value of all final goods and services produced by
12. Which one of the following is not a method of
remaining more or less the same over the years has been (c) Electricity output and water output. the normal residents of a country and their property,
measurement of National Income?
that whether operating within the domestic territory of the
(a) Value Added Method (d)  Tax receipts and earnings of inland revenue
(a) investment pattern has been directed towards capital country or outside in a year is termed as
(b) Income Method officials.
intensive industries
22. Which among the following is considered to be the
(b) productivity in agriculture has been high enough to (c) Expenditure Method (a) Gross National Income (b) Net National
best measure of an increase in a country’s economic
induce people to stay with agriculture (d) Investment Method Income
efficiency?
(c) Ceiling on land holdings have enabled more people 13. Which of the following is definitely a major indication of (c) Gross Domestic Product (d) Net Domestic
(a) Increase in annual private investment.
to own land and hence their preference to stay with the state of the economy of a country? Product
(b) Increase in real national income.
agriculture (a) Rate of GDP growth 28. National product at factor cost is equal to
(c) Increase in real per capita income.
(d) People are largely unaware of the significance of (b) Rate of inflation (a) Domestic product + Net factor income from abroad
(d) Increase in net annual investment.
transition from agriculture to industry for economic (c) Number of Banks in a country (b) National product at market prices - indirect taxes +
23. What does term ‘Green shoots’ represent in an Economy?
development subsidies
(d) None of these (a) signs of growth of agriculture sector in a growing
5. Which indicators are used to calculate the Human (c) Gross domestic-product - depreciation
14. In terms of economics, the total value of the output economy
Development Index (HDI)? (d) National product at market prices + Indirect taxes
(goods and services) produced and income received in a + subsidies
(a) Population growth, per capita GDP, life expectancy year by a domestic resident of a country put together is
(b) Population growth, infant rate, malnutrition called
(c) Life expectancy, educational attainment, per capita (a) Net National Product
GDP
(b) Gross National Product
(d) Current account balance, infant mortality rate,
(c) Gross National Income
educational attainment.
(d) National Income
6. Which of the following could assist economic growth in
15. Which sector of the Indian Economy contributes largest
developing countries?
to the GNP?
(a) An increase in the rate of taxation
(a) Primary sector (b) Secondary sector
(b) Decrease in foreign investment
(c) Tertiary sector (d) Public sector
(c) Decrease in the terms of trade
16. Per capita Income of a country derived from
(d) An increase in the level of education
7. Which sector of Indian Economy has shown remarkable (a) National Income
expansion during the last decade? (b) Population
(a) Primary sector (b) Secondary sector (c) National Income and Population both
(c) Tertiary sector (d) Mining sector (d) None of these

E-10 Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India E-11

12. Which is the correct definition of National Income ? 18. With reference to ‘Economics’ which statement is correct?
1. National Income means the total amount of money 1. Economics is an area where people, society and
Govt. earns through direct tax collection. government prioritize their choices in the process of
2. It is the total value of stocks held by a country at a using the infrequent reserves to satisfy the various
6. Consider the following specific stages of demographic particular point of time. needs and wants of life.
Statement Based MCQ transition associated with economic development : 3. This is the measure of goods and services produced 2. Economics is considered an exercise in the space-
1. Low birth rate with low death rate during an accounting year without double counting. time continuum.
1. Consider the following statements: 2. High birth rate with high death rate (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 3. Economics is considered an exercise in the time
1. The Central Statistical Organisation (CSO) is 3. High birth rate with low death rate continuum.
(c) 3 only (d) All 1, 2 and 3
responsible for calculating the consumer price indices (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
Select the correct order of the above stages using the codes 13. A dual economy means:
for urban non-manual employees. (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3
given below : 1. The existence of black money and white money
2. National Sample Survey Organisation (NSSO) 19. Which of the following is/are economic activity?
(a) 1, 2, 3 (b) 2, 1, 3 2. The existence of agriculture and industry
collects data for estimating national income. 1. Profit and Loss 2. Salary
(c) 2, 3, 1 (d) 3, 2, 1 3. The existence of commercial agriculture with 3. Employment 4. occupation
3. NSSO collects rural retail price on monthly basis for
7. Indian economy is a developing economy as there is? subsistence farming (a) 1 and 2 (b) 1, 2 and 3
calculating Consumer Price Index.
1. Dominance of agriculture. 4. Modern industry and commercial agriculture co- (c) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (d) 4 only
4. CSO conducts periodic economic census to collect 2. Huge unemployment existing with subsistence farming and traditional 20. Among the following, which is the reason for different
data on unorganised enterprises.
3. Low quality of human capital handicrafts types of economic system?
Which of the following statement/s is/are correct? 4. Low per capita consumption. (a) 1 only (b) 1, 2 and 4 1. Time requirement
(a) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (b) 2 and 4 (a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1 and 4 2. Money requirement
(c) 2, 3 and 4 (d) All of these
(c) 1, 3 and 4 (d) 3 and 4 (c) 2 and 3 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (a) 1 Only (b) 2 Only
14. Consider the following statements :
2. Among the socio-economic factors responsible for the high 8. Estimation of national income in India are not accurate as (c) 1 and 2 (d) None of the Above
(1) Higher growth in GDP and population can occur
birth rate in India we may include there is: 21. National Income is defined as:
together.
1. large scale poverty 1. illiteracy 1. It is the total amount of money government earns
(2) Per capita income always decreases with high
2. high mortality rate of children of poor parents 2. non-monetised consumption through direct tax collection.
population growth.
3. prevalence of child marriage 2. It measures the flow of goods and services in an
3. inflation Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
4. adverse sex ratio economy
4. people holding multiple jobs (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 3. It is the total value of stocks held by a country at a
Choose your answer from the following: (a) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (b) 2 and 3 (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 particular point of time
Codes: (c) 1 and 4 (d) 1, 2 and 4 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
15. In India, rural incomes are generally lower than the urban
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 1, 2 and 4 9. Which of the following gives a correct picture of the share incomes. Which of the following reasons account for this? (c) 1 and 2 (d) 3 only
(c) 2, 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2 and 3 of various sectors in economic growth in India over the (1) A large number of farmers are illiterate and know 22. Consider the following statements in regard to Gross
3. Which of the following are the main causes of slow rate years? little about scientific-agriculture. National product (GNP):
of growth of per capita income in India? 1. Primary sector-stagnant 1. Gross National Product refers to the money value of
(2) Prices of primary products are lower than those of
1. High capital output ratio 2. Secondary sector-increasing manufactured products. total output or production of final goods and services
2. High rate of growth of population 3. Tertiary sector-decreasing (3) Investment in agriculture has been lower when produced by the nationals of a country during a given
3. High rate of capital formation (a) 1 and 2 (b) 2 and 3 compared to investment in industry : period of time.
4. High level of fiscal, deficits (c) 2 only (d) 1 only 2. In the calculation of GNP, we include the money
(a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1 and 2
10. Consider the following statements: value of goods and services produced by nationals
codes: (c) 1 and 3 (d) 2 and 3
1. Human Development Report is an authoritative outside the country
(a) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (b) 2, 3 and 4 16. Consider the following statements (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
annual publication brought out by the World Bank.
(c) 1, 3 and 4 (d) 1 and 2 1. The current Economic Census is the seventh in the (c) Neither 1 nor 2 (d) Both1 and 2
2. It measures longevity by life expectancy at birth.
4. Consider the following statements: series so far conducted in India. 23. Which among the following is the full form of GDP?
3. Knowledge is measured by adult literacy rate.
1. Infant mortality rate takes into account the death of 2. The Economic Census in India is undertaken by the 1. Gross Data Product
4. Standard of living is measured by GDP per capita
infants within a month after birth. Department of Economic Affairs (Union Ministry of 2. Gross Domestic Product
(US $ PPP)
2. Infant mortality rate is the number of infant deaths in Finance). 3. Group Domestic Product
Which of the following statements is not correct?
a particular year per 100 live births during that year. Which of the statements given above is/are correct? 4. Group Data Product
(a) 1 (b) 2 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
Which of the above statements is/are correct? (a) Only 1 (b) Only 2
(c) 3 (d) 4 (c) 3 only (d) 4 only
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only (c) Both l and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
11. In the context of Indian economy, consider the following 24. Consider the following statements
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 17. Which of the following occupations are included under
statements 1. National income measures the net value of goods and
5. Consider the following statements about the megacities of 1. The growth rate of GDP has steadily increased in the secondary sector as per the national income accounts ?
services produced in a country during a year.
India: last five years. 1. Manufacturing
2. India is the first country in the world which has
1. Population of each megacity is more than 5 million. 2. The growth rate in per capita income has steadily 2. Construction officially sponsored family planning programmes
2. All the megacities are important sea ports. increased in the last five years. 3. Gas and water supply 3. The National Commission on Population was
3. Megacities are either national or state capitals. 3. The growth rate of GDP has steadily increased. 4. Mining and quarrying constituted on May 11, 2010
Which of these statements are correct ? Which of the statements given above is/are correct ? Select the correct answer using the codes given below Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
(a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1 and 2 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (a) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (b) 1, 2 and 4 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(c) 2 and 3 (d) 1 and 3 (c) Both 1 and 3 (d) None of these (c) 1, 2 and 3 (d) 3 and 4 (c) 3 only (d) 1 and 2
E-12 Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India E-13

25. Consider the following statements about the population of 30. Consider the following: 37. Which of the following are the roles of government in the 2. To review the working of the national economic plan
India: 1. Mehbub ul Haq economy: from time to time.
1. Due to the high rate population growth, it has not 2. Inge Kaul 1. Provision of public goods 3. To consider important questions of social and
been possible to make a significant change in the 3. David Hilton 2. Provision of merit goods economic policy affecting national development
poverty levels in India. The team which developed HDI was led which of the above 3. Poverty reduction Select the correct answer using the codes given below?
2. The higher population growth, the higher is the rate (a) 1 and 2 (b) 2 and 3 Select the correct answer using the codes given below: (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
of growth of per capita income. (c) 1 and 3 (d) 1, 2, 3 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3
3. The rapid growth in population is eroding India’s 31. Match the following in regards to labour force vs sector (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 44. Consider the following systems was/were provided by the
considerable development gains and steadily where 38. Consider the following statement related to population Government of India, Act 1935:
diminishing its ability to provide a decent quality of Column A Column B 1. An effective employment policy, which can absorb 1. Separation of provincial budgets from the central
life for a large number of its people. I. Primary Sector 17.3 the growing number of workers and promote budget for the first time.
4. Continuing rapid population growth in the long run II. Secondary Sector 72.1 economic growth. 2. Introduction of portfolio system in the Executive.
is likely to mean a lower quality of life for millions III. Tertiary Sector 10.6 2. An imaginative family planning programme to 3. Establishment of a Federal public service commission.
of people. (a) 2, 3, 1 (b) 1, 2, 3 encourage families to adopt the small family norm.
Which of the systems given above is correct:
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 1 and 3 (c) 3, 2, 1 (d) 3, 1, 2 Which among the above statements is / are not correct?
(a) 3 only (b) 2 only
(c) 1 and 4 (d) 3 and 4 32. Which among the following is the full form of CAGR. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(c) 1 only (d) 1, 2 and 3
26. The problem of overpopulation can be solved by 1. Compound Annual Growth Rate (c) 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
45. Which of the following are correct
1. An effective employment policy, which can absorb 2. Country Annual Growth Rate 39. Which among the following statement characterize Indian
the growing number of workers and promote 3. Country Annual Growth Region Economy: 1. These measures include a reduction in spending.
economic growth. 4. Compound Annual Growth Region 1. pre-dominance of agriculture 2. These measures include an increase in tax
2. An imaginative family planning programme to Choose the correct answer using the codes given below: 2. low per capita income 3. These measures include reduction in budget deficit.
encourage families to adopt the small family norm. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 3. massive unemployment Select the correct answer using the codes given below in
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only (c) 3 only (d) 4 only Select the correct answer using the codes given below regards to the austerity measures taken by a country
(c) 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 33. Consider the following statements: (a) 1 only (b) 1, 2 and 3 going through adverse economy conditions:
27. The objective of the National Population Policy (NPP) is 1. GDP is the total money value of all final goods and (c) 2 only (d) 1 and 2 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
1. The immediate objective is to address the unmet services produced within the geographical boundaries 40. Which among the following states have the first family (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3
needs for contraception, health care infrastructure of the country during a given period of time. planning clinic? 46. Consider the following statement
and basic reproductive and child health care. 2. GNP refers to the money value of total output or 1. New Delhi 2. Uttar Pradesh 1. The immediate objective is to address the unmet
2. The medium-term objective is to bring the Total production of final goods and services produced by 3. Karnataka 4. Maharashtra needs for contraception, health care infrastructure
Fertility Rate (TFR) to replacement levels of 2.1 by the nationals of a country during a given period of Select the correct answer using the codes given below and basic reproductive and child health care.
2010. time (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 2. The medium-term objective is to bring the Total
3. The short-term objective is to achieve a stable Which among the above statements is / are correct? (c) 3 only (d) 4 only Fertility Rate (TFR) to replacement levels of 2.1 by
population by 2045, at a level consistent with the (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 41. Consider the following statement: 2010.
requirement of sustainable economic growth, social (c) 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 1. High degree of disparity in income/wealth distribution 3. The long-term objective is to achieve a stable
development and environmental protection. 34. Arrange the following stages of population growth in is prevailed in India which is a characteristics feature population by 2045, at a level consistent with the
Which of the following statements is not correct? chronological order of developing economy. requirement of sustainable economic growth, social
(a) 1 (b) 2 1. population explosions 2. In India, almost 60-70% of the total population still development and environmental protection.
(c) 3 (d) All are correct 2. low birth rates and low death rates resides in rural areas and hence they depend on Which of the following statement is true for NPP objective?
28. The following objective helps in the development of India’s 3. stable or slow population growth agriculture for their livelihood. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
economic development since independence. Select the correct answer using the codes given below. 3. India’s per capita income level is much high as (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3
1. A rapidly and technologically progressive economy (a) 1, 2, 3 (b) 3, 1, 2 compared with other developed countries 47. Consider the following Statement
by democratic means (c) 3, 2, 1 (d) 1, 3, 2 Which among the following statement is not correct:
1. The relationship between population growth and
2. A social order based on justice, offering equal 35. Which among the following equation is correct (a) 3 only (b) 1 and 2
economic development can be explained by the
opportunity to every citizen of the country. 1. GDP=GNP+X-M (c) 1 and 3 (d) 1 only
2. GNP = GDP + X – M Theory of Demographic Transition for contemporary
3. Increasing population of the country 42. Consider the following statement in regards to Unbalanced
3. GNP = GDP + NFIA developed nations.
Which among the following is/are the objective? Economic Development
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 4. NNP = GNP – Depreciation. 1. India has not yet achieved the goal of balanced 2. The three stages of population growth are stable or
(c) 1 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3 Select the correct answer using the codes given below. economic development. slow population growth, population explosions, low
29. Consider the following statement in regards to Low per (a) 1 and 2 (b) 1, 2 and 3 2. Balanced Growth mentions to a definite type of birth rates and low death rates.
capita Income: (c) 2, 3 and 4 (e) 1, 3 and 4 economic growth that is maintainable in the long Select the correct statement using the code given below:
1. India is developing economy 36. Consider the following statements about personal Income: term. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
1. Personal income is that income which is actually (c) 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
2. India’s per capita income level is higher as compared 3. Balanced growth is contrasting to the high and low
obtained by nationals. 48. Consider the following statements:
with other developed countries nature of economic cycles.
2. Personal Income = National income – undistributed
3. According to World Development Report (2011) Which among the following statement is correct: 1. The basic objective of the Viability Gap Funding
profits of corporation – payments for social security
India’s per capita income was US $ 1499 in 2014 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only Scheme is to promote PPP investment in Infrastructure
provisions – corporate tax + government transfer
4. India’s per capita income falls in category of Lower payments + Business transfer payments + Net (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 2. The Infrastructure Projects are funded up to 20% by
Middle Income Countries(LMC) interest paid by government. 43. Which of the following is/are the functions of the National the Central Government
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? Select the correct answer using the codes given below: Development Council of India? Which among the above code is / are correct?
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 1, 2 and 3 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 1. To prescribe guidelines for preparation of the national (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(c) 1, 2 and 4 (d) 1, 3 and 4 (c) 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 economic plan. (c) 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2

E-14 Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India E-15

49. Which among the following sector of Indian Economy 54. With reference to Indian economy, consider the following
is maximum dependent on economic developments in statements:
advanced nations? 1. The rate of growth of Real Gross Domestic Product
1. Manufacturing Sector has steadily increased in the last decade.
2. Agricultural Sector 2. The Gross Domestic Product at market prices (in
EXERCISE-1 residents located in that country. GNP measures
3. Mining Sector rupees) has steadily increased in the last decade.
1. (b) 2. (b) 3. (d) 4. (a) 5. (a) 6. (d) the value of goods and services that the country’s
4. Services Sector Which of the statements given above is/are correct? citizens produced regardless of their location.
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 7. (c) During last decade tertiary sector has shown
Which statement is/are correct 15. (c) Tertiary sector of the Indian Economy contributes
remarkable expansion. The economy is divided
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) None of these largest to the GNP. During last decade tertiary
into three sector on the basis of activities–primary,
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only secondary and tertiary. Primary sector is involved sector has shown remarkable expansion. The
50. Consider the following statement: (d) Neither 1 nor 2 into agriculture, Secondary sector is involved economy is divided into three sectors on the basis of
Matching Based MCQ
1. Increase in annual private investment. into manufacturing, mining, construction while activities-Primary, Secondary and tertiary. Primary
2. Increase in real national income. tertiary sector is involved into trade, transport, sector is involved into agriculture, Secondary sector
55. Matching Based MCQ is involved into manufacturing, mining, construction
3. Increase in real per capita income. communication, banking & other services. In the last
Match columns A and B decade India has expanded maximum in providing while tertiary sector is involved into trade, transport,
4. Increase in net annual investment.
Column A Column B services like IT, Telecommunication, Healthcare, communication, banking & other services. In the last
Which among the following is considered to be the best
I. Mixed economy a. India has strong powers Tourism which is contributing around 60% to GDP. decade, India has expanded maximum in providing
measure of an increase in a country’s economic efficiency?
invested in the Centre with 8. (b) India is a labour-surplus economy because in India services like IT, Telecommunication, Healthcare,
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only
financial independence there is disguised unemployment along with under- Tourism which is contributing around 60% to GDP.
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only 16. (c) Per capita income of a country derived from
and adequacy employment which means that qualified, skilled
51. Role of the government in the economy is II. Fedral economy b. Public sector business National Income and population both. Per Capita
workforce willing to work is available but there are
1. Provision of public goods enterprise exist with Income is obtained by dividing National Income by
not enough employment opportunities.
2. Provision of merit goods Private sector 9. (d) total population of the country. Per capita income,
3. Poverty reduction III. Over population c. In each decade Indian 10. (b) In India, planned economy is based on socialist also known as income per person, is the mean
Which among the following code is/are correct population is increased By system in which all have equal opportunities to income of the people in a country . It is calculated
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 20% education, healthcare, non exploitation, equality of by taking a measure of all sources of income in the
(c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 IV. Disparities in d. India’s per capita income wealth etc. The concept was borrowed from Russia aggregate (such as GDP or Gross national income)
52. Human Development Index comprises literacy rates, life Income Distribution is about 1/40 of US level and is based on achieving directive principles and dividing it by the total population.
expectancy at birth and Of per capita mentioned in our constitution. 17. (d) Dadabhai, known as the Grand Old Man, wrote
1. GDP per head in the US dollars. 11. (c) The term was coined by Indian economist Raj the book ‘Poverty and Un-British Rule in India’
(a) I-b, II-a, III-d, IV-c
2. GDP per head at real purchasing power. Krishna. The Hindu rate of growth is a derogatory describing the theory of economic drain of India
(b) I-a, II-b, III-c, IV-d
3. GNP in US dollars term referring to the low annual growth rate of during British rule.
(c) I-a, II-d, III-b, IV-c
the socialist economy of India before 1991, which 18. (d) The most appropriate measure of a country’s
4. National Income per head in US dollars. (d) I-c, II-a, III-b, IV-d
stagnated around 3.5% from 1950s to 1980s. The economic growth is its per capita real income. Per
Which of the statement is correct 56. Match the following
word “Hindu” implies that the Hindu outlook of capita income is average income, a measure of the
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only Column A Column B wealth of the population of a nation. It is used to
fatalism and contentedness was responsible for the
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only I. 1962 a. The objective of NPP slow growth. measure a country’s standard of living thus a better
53. The national income of a country for a given period is equal was announced by govn 12. (d) Investment method is not a method of measurement indicator of economic growth.
to II. 1990 b. First HDR report was of National Income. There are three methods of 19. (b) India, among the countries has the lowest GDP
1. total value of goods and services produced by the published measurement; income method, product or value per capita. GDP per capita is as follows- India
nationals III. 2000 c. Family planning programme added method and the expenditure method. In the 1489 USD,China 6091USD, Sri Lanka 2923 USD,
2. sum of total consumption and investment expenditure was launched initial phase, production of goods and services takes Indonesia 3556 USD.
3. sum of personal income of all individuals (a) I-c, II-b, III-a place. During the course of production payment 20. (d) 21. (b) 22. (c)
4. money value of final goods and services produced (b) I-a, II-b, III-c is made to all factors of production like wages to 23. (b) Green shoots is a term used colloquially and
Which of the following code is/are correct (c) I-b, II-a, III-c labour etc. Once the production completes the output propagandistically to indicate signs of economic
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only (d) I-c, II-a, III-b is distributed for different uses like consumption etc. recovery during an economic downturn. It was first
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only 13. (a) Rate of GDP growth is a major indication of the state used in this sense by Norman Lamont, the then
of the economy of a country. Economic growth is Chancellor of the Exchequer of the United Kingdom,
the increase in the market value of the goods and during the 1991 recession.
services produced by an economy over time. It 24. (b) GDP deflator is an economic metric that accounts for
is conventionally measured as the percent rate of inflation by converting output measured at current
increase in gross domestic product. Gross domestic prices into constant-collar GDP. The GDP deflator
product (GDP) is the market value of all officially shows how much a change in the base year’s GDP
recognized final goods and services produced within relies upon changes in the price level.
a country in a year, or other given period of time. 25. (d) Human Development Report the HDI combines
14. (b) GNP is the total value of all final goods and services three dimensions: A long and healthy life: Life
produced within a country in a particular year, plus expectancy at birth, Education index: Mean years of
income earned by its citizens (including income schooling and Expected years of schooling and A
of those located abroad), minus income of non- decent standard of living: GNI per capita (PPP US$).
E-16 Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India E-17

26. (d) National Income ignores sale of land. 19. (c) 31. (a) Occupational structure refers to distribution of work business transfer payments and net interest paid by
27. (a) The sum of a nation’s gross domestic product 20. (c) Different types of economy are dependent on time force in the different occupations of the country. As the government.
(GDP) plus net income received from overseas. which helps in providing several ways to structure economy grows, labour force shifts from primary 37. (d) Provision of public goods like defence which no
Gross national income (GNI) is defined as the sum an economy. sector to secondary and tertiary sector. private agency can be entrusted with. Provision of
of value added by all producers who are residents in 21. (b) National income measures the net value of goods 32. (a) merit goods - goods like education and housing -
a nation, plus any product taxes (minus subsidies) and services produced in a country during a year and 33. (c) In the calculation of GNP, we include the money value through policies which encourage the consumption
not included in output, plus income received from it also includes net earned foreign income. of goods and services produced by nationals outside of such goods and discourage the use of non-merit
abroad such as employee compensation and property 22. (d) Gross National Product refers to the money value of the country. Hence, income produced and received goods like cigarettes. Poverty reduction is considered
income. total output or production of final goods and services by nationals of a country within the boundaries of a prime responsibility of all modern governments, as
28. (a) National product at factor cost is equal to net produced by the nationals of a country during a given foreign countries should be added in Gross Domestic the market caters to the needs of only those who can
domestic product at factor cost + Net factor Income period of time, generally a year. In the calculation Product (GDP) of the country. Similarly, income afford to pay, not of the poor.
from Abroad. of GNP, we include the money value of goods and received by foreign nationals within the boundary of 38. (d) The problem of over population can be solved by
EXERCISE-2 services produced by nationals outside the country. the country should be excluded from GDP. two ways
34. (b) First stage of stable or slow population growth: • An effective employment policy, which can absorb
1. (a) 2. (a) 3. (d) 23. (b)
The growth of population was slow due to the high the growing number of workers and promote
4. (d) Infant mortality rate indicates the number of infant 24. (d) The total of national income measures the flow of
death rate which nullified the high birth rate. In this economic growth.
death under one years of age per 1000 live birth goods and services in an economy.
stage, these economies were primitive and primarily • An imaginative family planning programme to
under one year of age. The increasing population of India hinders the
agrarian, with widespread illiteracy, poor sanitation encourage families to adopt the small family norm.
5. (d) Megacities of India have more than 5 million growth and progress of country.
and health care conditions, negligible knowledge 39. (b) The Indian economy constitute of predominance
population. But not all the major megacities are The National Commission on Population was of family planning and large family sizes which of agriculture, low per capita income, massive
located on the sea coast or are sea ports. Delhi, constituted on May 11, 2000 under the Chairmanship contributed to factors such as high fertility rate and unemployment.
which is the national capital is not a sea port. of the Prime Minister Shri Atal Bihari Vajpayee to high death rate. In the period between the first and 40. (c) The family planning programme was officially
6. (c) 2, 3, 1, i.e. High birth rate with high death rate, provide overall guidance for population stabilisation the second stages, the death rates start reducing launched in 1962. The first two family planning
High birth rate with low death rate, Low birth rate by promoting synergy between demographic, and birth rates remain stable which brings an clinics were opened in Karnataka in 1930 which
with low death rate. educational, environmental and development imbalance in the economy. Measures like diseases were supposed to be the first such in the world
7. (d) 8. (d) 9. (c) 10. (a) programmes. control, improving nutrition levels, and sanitation 41. (a) India is a developing country. Its per capita income
11. (d) 12. (c) 13. (c) 25. (b) The increasing population of India hinders the improvement are implemented to reduce death rates, level is much low as compared with other developed
14. (c) Higher growth in GDP and population can occur economic growth of the country. It is important to but the measures for controlling birth rates are not countries. Predominance of Agriculture : In India,
together. Per capita income always decreases with control the population growth. implemented, which results in population explosion. almost 60-70% of the total population still resides in
high population growth as income per person 26. (c) Over population of India can be controlled by This required a period of transition for adjustment, rural areas and hence they depend on agriculture for
decreases with rise in population. providing maximum employment and giving proper thus bringing the second stage of transition. their livelihood.
15. (a) In India a large number of farmers are illiterate education how to control population. Second stage of population explosions: In this stage 42. (d) India has not yet achieved the goal of balanced
and know little about scientific-agriculture, prices 27. (c) The long-term objective of NPP is to achieve a stable rise in income levels contributed to improvement economic development. Balanced Growth mentions
of primary products are lower than those of in health-care, education, disease control and so to a definite type of economic growth that is
population by 2045, at a level consistent with the
manufactured products and Investment in agriculture on which in turn contributed to reducing the death maintainable in the long term. Balanced growth is
requirement of sustainable economic growth, social
has been lower when compared to investment in rates. This accelerated the growth of population. contrasting to the high and low nature of economic
development and environmental protection.
industry .All these reasons are responsible for lower The family size reduced and improved trade and cycles. According to latest data available about 64%
28. (b) Since independence, India’s economic development
rural income. economic conditions resulted in more food and better of total labour force is dependent on agriculture,
has been guided by the twin objectives (1) a rapidly
16. (d) In 1976, Government of India launched a plan food habits which further helped the population to 16% on industries and the rest about 20% on trade,
and technologically progressive economy by
scheme called “Economic Census and Surveys”. grow at a much higher rate than in the first stage. transport and other services.
democratic means; and (2) a social order based on
In 1977 Central Statistical Organisation conducted The demographic changes brought imbalances in the 43. (d) The National Development Council (NDC) or the
First economic census in collaboration with the justice, offering equal opportunity to every citizen of
the country. economy, creating conditions for further transition Rashtriya Vikas Parishad is the apex body for decision
Directorate of Economics & Statistics (DES) in the of society. making and deliberations on development matters
States/Union Territories. Current Economic Census 29. (d) India is developing economy. Its per capita income
level is much low as compared with other developed Third stage of low birth rates and low death rates: in India, presided over by the Prime Minister. The
is Sixth Economic Census held in 2013. Modernization and industrialization changed the functions of the Council are to prescribe guidelines
The Central Statistics Office (CSO) in the Ministry of countries. According to World Development Report
living pattern in such nations, the rural population for the formulation of the National Plan; to consider
Statistics and Programme Implementation (MOSPI) (2011) India’s per capita income was US $ 1499
shifted to cities and family sizes reduced to become the National Plan as formulated by the Planning
conducted the Sixth Economic Census during in 2014. The per capita income in United States is
nuclear families. The standard of living increased Commission; to consider important questions
January, 2013 to April, 2014 in collaboration with US $ 47240 and hence India’s per capita income
which further brought down mortality rates and birth of social and economic policy affecting national
Directorates of Economics and Statistics in all the is about 1/40 of US level of per capita. The per rates. As a result, the growth of population declined. development; and to review the working of the
States and Union Territories. capita income of 2015 has increased by 10.1%, (as 35. ( c) X =Income from Abroad (income earned and Plan from time to time and to recommend such
17. (c) Primary sector-Agriculture, fishing, mining and compared to 2014) as stated by Minister of State for received by nationals within the boundaries of measures as are necessary for achieving the aims
quarrying Statistics and Programme Implementation Gen. V K foreign countries.)M = Income received by and targets set out in the National Plan.
Secondary sector- Manufacturing and construction, Singh. The national income in 2014-15 stood at Rs. foreign nationals within the country. 44. (a) The limited advisory function accorded to the Public
Gas and water supply 11,217,079 crore. With the mentioned per capita 36. (c) Personal income is a flow concept. It is the income that Service Commission and the continued stress on this
Tertiary sector- trade, transport etc, finance & real income India falls in category of Lower Middle is obtained by nationals. Personal income is obtained aspect by the leaders of our freedom movement
estate, community and personnel services Income Countries(LMC) by subtracting corporate taxes and payments made resulted in the setting up of a Federal Public Service
18. (b) Economics takes care of various needs and wants of 30. (b) The team which developed HDI was led by Mehbub for social securities provision from national income Commission under the Government of India Act,
life. ul Haq and Inge Kaul. and adding to it government transfer payments, 1935. The Federal Public Service Commission

E-18 Structure of Economy and Human Resource in India

became the Union Public Service Commission after economic conditions resulted in more food and better
Independence. The portfolio system in the Executive food habits which further helped the population to
was introduced by the Indian constitution council act, grow at a much higher rate than in the first stage.
1861. The separation of provincial budgets from the The demographic changes brought imbalances in the
central budget was introduced by the Indian councils economy, creating conditions for further transition
Act, 1919. of society.

2
45. (d) Austerity describes policies used by governments Third stage of low birth rates and low death rates:
to reduce budget deficits during adverse economic Modernization and industrialization changed the
conditions. These policies may include spending living pattern in such nations, the rural population
cuts, tax increases. This is done in economic crisis shifted to cities and family sizes reduced to become

PLANNING, UNEMPLOYMENT
situation to improve the credit rating of the countries nuclear families. The standard of living increased
going through adverse economic condition. which further brought down mortality rates and birth

& POVERTY IN INDIA


46. (d) The Government of India in February 2000, rates. As a result, the growth of population declined.
announced the National Population Policy (NPP) 48. (c)
with the objectives The immediate objective is to 49. (b) Indian Economy is highly dependent on agriculture
address the unmet needs for contraception, health because still the maximum population stays in rural
care infrastructure and basic reproductive and area.
child health care. (ii) The medium-term objective 50. (c) Indian economy is increased by real per capita
is to bring the Total Fertility Rate (TFR) to
replacement levels of 2.1 by 2010. (iii) The long-
income
51. (d) Provision of public goods like defence which no
Introduction
term objective is to achieve a stable population by private agency can be entrusted with. Economic planning is the making of major economic decisions what and how much is to be produced, how, when and
2045, at a level consistent with the requirement of Provision of merit goods - goods like education where it is to be produced, and to whom it is to be allocated by the comprehensive survey of the economic system as whole.
sustainable economic growth, social development and housing - through policies which encourage the (H.D.Dickinsom)
and environmental protection. consumption of such goods and discourage the use
47. (c) Population growth directly impacts on Indian of non-merit goods like cigarettes.
economy. The three stages of population growth are: Poverty reduction is considered a prime responsibility
First stage of stable or slow population growth: of all modern governments, as the market caters to
The growth of population was slow due to the high the needs of only those who can afford to pay, not
death rate which nullified the high birth rate. In this of the poor.
stage, these economies were primitive and primarily 52. (d) Human Development Report the HDI combines
agrarian, with widespread illiteracy, poor sanitation three dimensions: A long and healthy life: Life
and health care conditions, negligible knowledge expectancy at birth, Education index: Mean years
of family planning and large family sizes which of schooling and Expected years of schooling and
contributed to factors such as high fertility rate and A decent standard of living: GNI per capita (PPP
high death rate. In the period between the first and US$).
Composition Functions
the second stages, the death rates start reducing 53. (d) National Income is the money value of all the final
and birth rates remain stable which brings an goods and services produced by a country during a
imbalance in the economy. Measures like diseases period of one year. National Income consists of a
control, improving nutrition levels, and sanitation collection of different types of goods and services of
improvement are implemented to reduce death rates, different types.
but the measures for controlling birth rates are not 54. (c) Both statements are correct.
implemented, which results in population explosion. 55. (a) There are different types of economic types. The
This required a period of transition for adjustment, benefit of mixed economy is to achieve a welfare
thus bringing the second stage of transition. state with socialistic pattern of society. India is a
Second stage of population explosions: In this stage federal economy. India is developing economy.
rise in income levels contributed to improvement India’s population is getting increased in each
in health-care, education, disease control and so decade.
on which in turn contributed to reducing the death 56. (a) Family planning programme was launched in 1962.
rates. This accelerated the growth of population. First HDR report was published in 1990. The
The family size reduced and improved trade and objective of NPP was announced by govn in 2000.
Planning in India Four decades of planning show that India’s economy, a mix
of public and private enterprise, is too large and diverse to be
Planning in India starts in 1930s. Even before independence, wholly predictable or responsive to directions of the planning
the colonial government had established a planning board authorities.
that lasted from 1944 to 1946. Before independence private
industrialists and economists published three development Important Dates
plans in 1944. India’s leaders adopted the principle of formal • 1934: M. Visvesvaryya, in his book ‘Planned Economy of
India’, advocates the necessity of planning in the country
economic planning soon after independence as an effective
much before Independence.
way to intervene in the economy of faster growth and social • 1944: Bombay Plan, published in January 1944, prepared
justice. by eight leading industrialist of Bombay.
E-20 Planning, Unemployment and Poverty in India Planning, Unemployment and Poverty in India E-21

• Gandhian Plan put forward by S.N. Agrawal (1944). Composition: NITI Aayog will have Prime Minister as its Holiday Plan (1966-69) • Actual growth of national income was higher at 5.3%
• 1944: Planning Development Council was set up under chairman, one Vice-Chairman cum chief-executive officer, After the disastrous experience of the Third Plan, a plan (against a target of 5.2%).
the chairmanship of A. Dalal. 5 fulltime members and 2 part time members, apart from 4 • Increase of 16% per annum in real investment in fixed
holiday was declared for three years. All available resources
• Peoples Plan drafted by M.N. Roy (1945). central government ministers. asset by private sector.
• 1946: Interim Government sets up the Planning Advisory were mobilised for building a buffer stock and for stepping up
food production learning from the experience of near-famine • Poverty declined from 48.3% in 1977-78 to 37.4% in
Board. Five Year Plans
• 1947: Economic Programme Committee was set up under years (1965-66). 1983-84.
the chairmanship of Jawaharlal Nehru. The development plans drawn up by the Planning Commission Favourable monsoons and technological break-through in
• 1950: Planning Commission was set up.
Seventh Plan (1985-90)
to establish India’s economy in five-year phases are called wheat popularly known as ‘green revolution’ reduced the
• 2015: Formation of NITI Aayog. Five-Year Plans. A five-year plan is an indicative plan of inflationary pressure. Nationalisation of banks was another Major objective: Growth, modernisation, Self-reliance
action reflecting largely the intent of the government for that major step during this period. and Social justice.
Planning Commission period at the national, regional, and sectorial level. • Strong emphasis on creation of productive employment
Fourth Plan (1969-74) on farm as well as rural subsidiary occupations.
The Planning Commission was established in 1950, in accordance First Plan (1951-56) • Stress on increasing the production of food grains,
with Article 39 of the Directive Principles of the Constitution of Major objective: Growth with stability and progress towards
Major Objective: Agriculture, Price Stability, Power & oilseeds, sugar, textiles, domestic fuel and housing.
India headed by Prime Minister. The Commission is independent self-reliance.
Transport. • Outward-looking strategy with exports receiving high
of the Cabinet. A staff drafts plans under the guidance of the • Emphasis on growth with distributive justice. priority.
Commission; the draft plans are presented for approval to the The first five year plan focused on to stimulate balanced • A substantial increase in the outlay for family planning
economic development while correcting imbalances caused by • Tempo of domestic and external liberalisation hastened.
National Development Council, which consists of members of (` 278 crores from ` 25 crores in third plan).
World War II and partition various objectives were. • The Plan also had a 15-year perspective (1985-2000) for
the Planning Commission, the Chief Ministers of the States and • Goal of attaining self-sufficiency in agriculture and indus-
• It was based on Harrod Domar Model. trial production. (In agriculture, growth rate of 5% per removal of poverty, providing for basic needs, achieving
Administrators of UTs and All Union Ministers. The Council
• Its Highest priority on agriculture, irrigation and power annum and in industrial production growth rate of 8% to universal elementary education and total access to health
can make changes in the draft plan. After Council approval, the
projects. 10% per annum were targeted.) facilities.
draft is presented to the Cabinet and subsequently to Parliament,
• Rate of investment was targetted at 7% of national income. • Poor achievement of targets – national income grew by • Average annual growth rate during the plan period was
whose approval makes the plan an operating document for
• National income grew by 18% and per capita income by 3.3% per annum; per capita income by 1.2% per annum; 5.6% (target 5%).
Central and State governments.
11%. agricultural production by 2.8%; industrial production • Agriculture grew at 4.1% against a target of 4%.
Jawaharlal Nehru was the first chairman of the Planning • Food production increased by 20%. Under the first five
Commission by virtue of his being the Prime Minister of India. by 3.9%. • Manufacturing industries achieved a growth rate of 8.8%
year plan provision was made to spend a total of ` 2,378 (target 8%).
Functions crore during the plan period. But the actual expenditure Fifth Plan (1974-79) • There was a severe short fall in mining sector (5.6%
outcome to ` 1960 crore only. against a target of 13%).
(i) Assessment of the material, capital and human resources of Major objective: Poverty eradication and attainment of self
the country, including technical personnel and formulation Second Plan (1956-61) reliance. • Social sector performance fell far short of targets–
of proposals for the augmentation of such resources; especially in housing for the landless, elementary
Major objective: Rapid Industralisation. • Twin objectives of poverty eradication and attainment of
education and general poverty alleviation.
(ii) Formulation of plans for effective and balanced self-reliance.
• It was based on Mahalnobis Model.
utilization of resources;
• It targetted a 25% increase in national income through
• A National Programme for Minimum Needs including Eighth Plan (1992-97)
(iii) Defining stages in which the plan should be carried out; elementary education, safe drinking water, health care,
rapid industrialisation. Actual achievement was only 20%. and shelter for landless.
Major objective: Human development.
(iv) Determination of the resources necessary for implemen- • Goal of establishing the socialistic pattern of society. • The plan was launched in 1992 after the plan holiday
tation of the plans; • Adequate collection and distribution system in order to
• Rate of investment planned to be raised from seven per provide the commodities of necessary consumption to the during the economically and politically difficult days of
(v) Appraisal from time to time of the progress achieved; cent to 11% of national income. 1990-91 and 91-92.
poor people on reasonable and stable prices.
(vi) Public co-operation in national development; • Per capita income rose by eight per cent. • It was Manmohan-Rao (F.M- P.M.) Era of economic
• Stress on Export Promotion and Import Substitution.
(vii) Perspective planning; • Rapid industrialization with particular emphasis on liberalization.
• A growth rate of 5.2% (against a target of 4.4%)
National Planning Council: Is an advisory body attached development of basic and heavy industries. Large achieved. • Modernisation of industries was focussed.
to the Planning Commission It was established in 1965. It industries including steel plants (Durgapur, Bhilai • Agricultural production increased by 4.2% – the highest • India became member of WTO to pace with world
includes experts representing a cross-section of the Indian and Rourkela) were set up. The locomotive factory at so far. economics.
economy. Chittaranjan and Coach factory at Perambur were other • Moderate inflation of 2.1% per annum during the The economic paradigm had also considerably shifted with
major projects of this period. Emergency years (1975-1977). the acceptance of liberalisation and the need for market
NITI Aayog Third Plan (1961-66) • The Janata Government terminated the Plan in 1978. forces to play a greater role.
• Employment generation to be speeded up to achieve full
The government of India has replaced Planning Commission Major Objective : Self sustaining growth. Sixth Plan (1980-85) employment by 2000.
with a new institution named NITI Aayog (National Institution • Emphasis on basic industries continued but agriculture • Total literacy to be achieved in the 15-35 age group by
for Transforming India). and allied sectors (irrigation and power) were allocated Major objective : Poverty Alleviation. covering an additional 110 million people.
The institution will serve as ‘Think Tank’ of the Government 35% of the outlay. • Janata Government had adopted a Sixth Plan (1978-83), • Restructuring the systems of economic management
- a directional and policy dynamo. • A series of crises - China war (1962), Nehru’s death which was conceived as a rolling plan. Mrs. Gandhi’s through public sector reforms, including selective
NITI Aayog will provide Governments at the Central and State (1964), Pakistan war (1965) and Shastri’s death Government in 1980 abandoned this and a new sixth plan disinvestment.
Levels with relevant strategic and technical advice across the (1966), major drought (1965-66) - marred the smooth was drafted. • The Eighth Plan was to walk on ‘two legs’ - one leg
spectrum of key elements of policy, this includes matters of implementation of the plan. • Poverty alleviation gives the top priority. of alleviating poverty and removing unemployment; and
national and international importance on the economic front, • Growth rate of only 2.2% achieved as against a target of • Qualitative improvement in the living standards of people the other ‘leg’ providing a ‘safety net’ for those who
dissemination of best practices from within the country as well 5% per annum. by means of Minimum Need Programme (MNP). will be affected by the structural adjustment programme.
as from other nations, the infusion of new policy ideas and • Inflation (36%) ate up much of the achievement; Rupee • Schemes for transferring skills (TRYSEM) and assets The plan had thus built in the ‘human face’ element of
specific issue-based support. devaluation (1966). (IRDP) and providing slack season employment (NREP). adjustment.

E-22 Planning, Unemployment and Poverty in India Planning, Unemployment and Poverty in India E-23

• To strengthen the basic infrastructure (energy, transport, the per capita income in the next ten years, to reduce the The 27 National Targets under 11th Plan • Achieving Growth rate of 9.0 to 9.5% needs strong
communication, irrigation) in order to support the decadal population growth from 21.3% (1991-2001) to policy action. Major sectoral challenges are Energy,
The Plan has adopted 27 targets at the national level to
development process on a sustainable basis. 16.2% by 2010-11 and to ensure that the growth in gainful Water and Environment, which need to be addressed
ensure inclusive growth. These are related to: (i) income and
• The plan was explicitly indicative with a long-term employment kept pace with the addition to the labour force. without sacrificing growth. To find resources to create a
poverty, (ii) education, (iii) health, (iv) women and children
policy approach replacing the target approach. • Against the ambitious target of 8%, the economy grew at (v) infrastructure and (vi) environment. world class infrastructure in the country.
• Per capita national output grew by 3.9% per annum. the rate of 7.7% on an average during the 10th Plan period. • Require better performance in agriculture, for growth to
But, this growth masked considerable distortion in the However, an evaluation by the Planning Commission (i) Targeted growth of GDP at 9% per year.
be more inclusive. Faster creation of jobs, especially in
distribution front. From data regarding inflation and noticed that while the rate of growth was impressive, it was (ii) To raise industrial growth rate from 9.2% in 10th Plan to
manufacturing, and stronger effort at health, education
price indices, there is evidence that the poor became lop-sided and did not benefit all people alike. For too 10% in 11th Plan.
and skill development are given importance.
poorer despite ‘the safety net’. many people still lacked the basic requirements for a (iii) To reduce unemployment among educated youth to less
decent living in terms of nutritional standards, access to • Also, need to improve effectiveness of programmes
• Actual employment growth was only two percent against than 5%.
education and basic health, and also many other public directly aimed at the poor, special programmes for
a target of 2.6%. (iv) To reduce Infant Moraling Rate (IMR) to 28 and Material
services such as water supply and sewage. The benefits socially vulnerable groups, and special plans for
• Annual growth rate achieved in the Plan period is 6.8% Morality Rate (MMR) to 1 per 1000 on live births by the
did not reach fully some disadvantages sections like the disadvantaged/backward regions.
against the target of 5.6 %. end of plan.
Scheduled Castes and Tribes and minorities. Regional (v) To increase sex-ratio to 935 by 2011-12 and 950 by Sectorial Growth Rate in Different Five Years Plans
Ninth Plan (1997-2002) imbalances - both across states and even within states - 2016-17.
Major objective: Growth with Equity and Distributive were also noticed. (vi) To ensure that all children enjoy a safe childhood, Plan Growth Agri- Industry Services Actual
Justice. without any compulsion to work. Rate culture Growth
Eleventh Plan (2007-12) Rate
• This objective was sought to be achieved through a policy (vii) To ensure electricity connection to all villages and BPL
of concentrating on agriculture and rural development to Major objective: Faster and more Inclusive Growth household by 2009 and 24-hour power supply by the end Frist Plan 2.1 2.71 5.54 4.17 3.6
provide more employment; ensuring food and nutritional • The Eleventh Plan targets to resolve the regional of this plan.
imbalance still prevailing in the country. The Plan Second Plan 4.5 3.15 5.59 4.94 4.21
security to all, especially the vulnerable; providing (viii) To achive standards of air quality in all cities.
basic minimum needs in a time-bound manner; curbing document, sub-titled Inclusive Growth, outlines a (ix) To treat all urban waste water by 2011-12. Third Plan 5.6 –0.73 6.28 5.26 2.72
population growth; environmental sustainability of strategy for making growth both faster and more (x) To increase forest and tree cover by 5%. Plan Holiday 4.16 1.42 4.1 3.69
development; empowerment of women; promotion of inclusive. Encouraged by the achievement of a rate of
7.7% on an average during the 10th Plan, itself a target Twelfth Five Year Plan (2012-2017) Fourth Plan 5.7 2.57 4.91 3.22 2.01
Panchayati Raj institutions and strengthening efforts to
build self reliance. of 9% growth during the Plan period, with acceleration Major objective: Faster, Sustainable and More Indusive Fifth Plan 4.4 3.28 6.55 5.66 4.83
during the period to reach 10% by the end of the Plan. Sixth Plan 5.2 2.25 5.32 5.41 5.4
• The development strategy emphasised the role of markets Growth.
and the need for government to intervene to promote • The target of 9% growth requires the average rate of
Planning Commission in its meeting held on April 2011, the Seventh Plan 5 3.47 6.77 7.19 6
a degree of competition through suitable legislation. investment to rise from 32% (during 10th Plan) to 37%
Prime Minister, Dr. Manmohan Singh, addressed the Planning
in the current plan, reaching 39% at the end of the plan Eighth Plan 5.6 4.68 7.58 7.54 6.68
Licence Raj was to be ended. The Plan emphasised co- Commission concerning the twelth Five Year Plan of India.
period. Private investment which has contributed 78% Ninth Plan 6.5 2.06 4.51 7.78 5.4
operative federalism. It also stressed the importance of The main point of the Twelfth Plan are:
of the investment during the 10th Plan is expected to
infrastructural development. Tenth Plan 8 2.34 8.9 9.4 7.5
• The Plan was indicative in nature, focusing on policies. It
maintain its share. Public investment is expected to be Resource Allocation Priorities in 12th plan
maintained at the same level of 22% as in the 10th Plan. Eleventh Plan 9 (8.1) 4 10.5 9.9 8
also provided a 15-year perspective. It aimed to achieve a • Health and Education received less than projected in
Planning Commission has framed a plan for achieving Twelth Plan 8 04 10.9 10 –
growth rate of 8% per annum in the medium term and a Eleventh Plan. Allocations for these sectors will have to
faster growth with greater inclusiveness which involves
rate of 6.5% during the plan period (’97-’02). be increased in 12th plan.
the following interrelated components:
• The plan envisaged the creation of 52 million jobs as
(i) a continuation of the policy of economic reform
• Health, Education and Skill Development together in the Unemployment
against the demand for job opportunities for 60.5 million Centre’s Plan will have to be increased by at least 1.2%
which has created a competitive private sector
persons. The backlog of unemployment, which was 7.5 point of GDP. Nature of Unemployment in India
capable of benefiting from the opportunities
million at the close of the eighth Plan, was expected to be • Infrastructure, including irrigation and watershed Employment refers to a situation when a labour does not
provided by greater integration with the world;
6.6 million at the end of the Ninth Plan. management and urban infrastructure, will need obtain employment opportunity despite his willingness to work
(ii) more emphasis on agriculture,
• The GDP grew only by 5.35% per annum during the plan additional 0.7 percentage point of GDP over the next 5 on existing wage rate. India is a developing economy where
(iii) improved access to essential services in health and years.
period against the target of 6.5%. The shortfall was due the nature of unemployment is entirely different from that of
education (including skill development);
to poor performance by agricultural and industrial sectors, • Since Centre’s GBS will rise by only 1.3 percentage
(iv) special thrust on infrastructural development; developed nations. In India, the unemployment rate measures
as explained in the table below. points over 5 years, all other sectors will have a slower
(v) special attention to the needs of disadvantaged the number of people actively looking for a job as a percentage
Performance of Agricultural and Industrial Sectors growth in allocations.
groups, and • Decrease the number of Centrally Sponsored Schemes of the Labour force. As per the ministry of Labour and
Sector 8th Plan 9th Plan (vi) good governance at all level, central, state and Employment, the unemployment rate for the year 2014 is
(CSS) to a few major schemes. For the rest, create new
Agriculture 4.69 2.06 local. flexi-fund which allow Ministries to experiment in other 4.90%.
Manufacturing 7.58 4.51 • The broad targets fixed by the 11th Plan include a 4% CSS areas.
per cent growth in Agriculture sector, 10% growth in Different types of Unemployment in India
• PPP model must be encouraged, including in the social
Services 7.54 7.78 Industries and Minerals, and investment in infrastructure (1) Structural Unemployment
sector, i.e. health and education. Efforts on this front
Total 6.68 5.35 to grow from 5.43% of GDP in 06-07 to 9.43% by the need to be intensified. In this type of unemployment demand for labour falls
Source: Planning Commission end of the 11th Plan. • Distinction between plan and non-plan being reviewed short to the supply of labour due to rapidly growing
• The total public sector outlay in the Eleventh Plan (both by Rangarajan Committee. population and their immobility.
Tenth Plan (2002-07) Central and States and including the PSEs) is estimated at (2) Disguised Unemployment
Major objective: 8% annual growth rate. ` 36,44,718 crore. Of this total, the share of the Centre Objectives from the initial white paper It refers to a state of unemployment in which more
• The Tenth Plan laid down an ambitious target of 8% (including the plans of Public Sector Enterprises (PSEs) presented on April 21, 2011 people are engeged in work than are really needed. In
annual growth rate for the economy, against the will amount to ` 21,56,571 crore, while that of the States • Basic objective is faster, more inclusive, and sustainable the late 1950 s, about one-third of workers in India were
prevailing rate of 5.5%. Its long term vision was to double and union territories (UTs) will be ` 14,88,147 crore. growth. disguisedly unemployed.
E-24 Planning, Unemployment and Poverty in India Planning, Unemployment and Poverty in India E-25

(3) Seasonal Unemployment 2011-12 (Planning Commission), the percentage of persons Number & Percentage of Poor*
It refers to an unemployment that occurs at certain below the poverty line in India for the year 2011-12 has
seasons of the years. The period of such unemployment been figured out as 25.7% in rural areas, 13.7% is urban Poverty line (in `) Number or Poor (million) Poverty Ratio (%)
Year
varies from state to state, depending upon the methods of areas and 21.9% for the country as a whole. Rural Urban Rural Urban Total Rural Urban Total
farming, the condition of soil, the type and numbers of Poverty, is defined in human development report as denial 2004-05 446.8 578.80 326.3 80.8 407.1 41.8 25.7 37.2
crops grown, etc. of opportunities “to lead a long, healthy, creative life and 2011-12 816.00 1000.00 216.5 52.8 269.3 25.7 13.7 21.9
(4) Open Unemployment to enjoy a decent standard of living, freedom, dignity, self-
It refers to that economic phenomenon in which persons Source : Economic Survey 2014-15,* Estimated by Tendulkar Method.
respect and the respect of others”.
are able and willing to work at the prevailing wage rate, (i) Absolute Poverty 23. Swarna Jayanti Gram Swarojgar Yojana.
According to the World Bank (2014), the national poverty
but fail to get work. It is called open unemployment Absolute Poverty is when a person cannot obtain certain 24. Sampurna Gramin Rojgar Yojana.
line for 2011-12, after adjusting it to Indian currency using
because such unemployment can be seen and corrected absolute standards of minimum requirements, usually 25. Indira Awaas Yojana.
in terms of the number of unemployed people. PPP (Purchasing Power Parity) Conversion factor is $1.94
measured in terms of income. It refers to the total a day. India with 17.5 % of total world’s population, had 26. Samagra Awaas Yojana.
(5) Industrial Unemployment number of people living below Poverty line. As per this Government Efforts for Eliminating Urban Poverty
20.6% share of world’s poorest in 2011 (World Bank, 2014).
It refers to the unemployment among the illiterates, who measure, around 30% of India’s population is below 1. Emphasis on vocational education.
wish to work in industrial establishments. The slow Poverty : (Rural And Urban)
poverty line. 2. Nehru Rozgar Yojana (NRY).
pace of industralisation is unable to generate sufficient
(ii) Relative Poverty Main Reasons for Rural Poverty 3. Self-Employment Programme for the Urban Poor
employment opportunities. As a result, there is a huge
Relative Poverty is when a person falls behind others. 1. Rapid population growth. (SEPUP).
industrial unemployment in the country.
It is thus a measure of inequality of income. It refers 2. Lack of capital. 4. Financial assistance for constricting houses.
(6) Frictional Unemployment
to Poverty of people, in comparison to other people, 3. Lack of alternate employment opportunities other than 5. Self-Employment to the Educated Urban Youth (SEEUY)
It refers to temporary unemployment which exists during
regions or nations. agriculture. programme.
the period, wherein workers leave one job and join some
other. There are many approaches to measure poverty . Income is 4. Excessive employment pressure on agriculture. 6. Prime Minister’s Rozgar Yojana (PMRY).
(7) Cyclical Unemployment one approach. Another approach is the basic needs approach, 5. Illiteracy. 7. National social Assistance Programme.
It is associated with the down-swing and depression according to which poverty should not be looked at merely 6. Regional disparities. 8. Urban Basic Services for the Poor programme (UBSP).
phases of business cycle. It is the most common type of in terms of private income but should include access to basic 7. Orthodox society. 9. Prime Ministers Integrated Urban Poverty Eradication
unemployment in the developed capitalist economies. needs like health, education, employment and other essential 8. Child marriage tradition. Programme (PMIUPEP).
services which the community usually provides to its citizens. 9. Indifferent attitude towards investment. 10. Swarna Jayanti Shahri Rozgar Yojana.
Magnitude of Unemployment There are important limitations in measuring poverty in terms 10. Lack of proper implementation of public distribution
There is great diversity in the forms of unemployment. of either income or consumption levels. These approaches system. Important Programmes in Brief
It has been found that no single measure can adequately do not pay attention to the assets on which most poor people
11. Lack of vocational education/training. 1. Swarnajayanti Gram Swarojgar Yojana (SGSY)
capture the magnitude of unemployment in India. In addition rely for their livelihood. These assets can include their access
Government Efforts for Eliminating Rural Poverty Swarnajayanti Gram Swarojgar Yojana launched by the
to the decadal census figures, the National Sample Survey to natural and financial resources, their health and capacity
1. Antyodaya plan. Union Ministry of Rural Development was a poverty alleviation
Organisation (NSSO) conducts more detailed sample surveys to work. Another drawback of the traditional approaches
is that these do not focus on the social relations which lead 2. Small Farmer Development Programme (SFDP). programme, came into effect from April 1, 1999 which has
every five years on employment and unemployment. It uses
to the process of impoverishment. For instance, the lack of 3. Drought Area Development Programme (DADP). replaced IRDP and its allied schemes, viz. Training of Rural
three different tests for measuring:
political influence of the poor and their being subjected to 4. Minimum Needs Programme (MNP). Youth for Self Employment (TRYSEM), Development of
• The Usual Status (US) concept which has a reference
discrimination are issues which are relevant while studying the 5. Food for work programme. Women and Children in Rural Areas (DWCRA), Supply of
period of one year and classifies a person as unemployed
nature and causes of their poverty. 6. National Rural Employment Programme (NREP). Improved Toolkits to Rural Artisans (SITRA), Ganga Kalyan
if she was not working but was available for work for
7. Integrated Rural Development Programme (IRDP). Yojana (GKY) and Million Wells Scheme (MWS).
most or all of the period of one year. The ‘Sustainable livelihoods’ is the new approach. This
8. Jawahar Gram Samriddhi Yojana (JGSY) (Formerly The main objectives of SGSY are :
• The Current Weekly Status (CWS) includes a person if addresses issues such as the capabilities, assets and labour
known as Jawahar Rojgar Yojana). (i) focussed approach to poverty;
she has not worked even for one hour during the week, required for a means of living. A livelihood is stated to be
though available for work. 9. Rural Labour Employment Guarantee Programme (ii) capitalising advantages of group lending; and
sustainable if it can cope with and recover from stresses and
• The Current Daily Status (CDS) measures the (RLEGP). (iii) overcoming the problems associated with multiplicity of
shocks and maintain or enhance its assets both now and in the
employment status during the seven days preceding the 10. TRYSEM scheme. programmes.
future.
survey and adds up all the hours of work undertaken The SGSY is conceived as a holistic programme of micro
11. Family planning/welfare programme for population
during this reference period to decide the un/ Measurement of Poverty control.
enterprises covering all aspects of self-employment which
underemployment status of the person. includes organising rural poor into Self-Help Groups (SHGs).
The overall estimation of poverty is based on the data available 12. Scheme for Rural artisans / craftsmen. It integrates various agencies – District Rural Development
Chronic unemployment can be measured by the US and from NSSO, all-India sample survey of household consumption 13. Mahila Samriddhi Yojana.
CWS data. However, the policy formulation regarding Agencies, banks, departments, Panchayati Raj Institutions,
expenditure, where poverty is defined with reference to a poverty 14. Rural Housing Programme. Non-government organisations (NGO) and other semi-
supplementary employment all the three sets of data are used line which is the level of monthly per capita consumption 15. DWCRA programme. government organisations. It is only self-employment
in conjuction. The Planning Commission and NSSO have expenditure considered to be a minimum necessary for living. 16. National Social Assistance Programme (NSAP). programme currently being implemented for the rural poor.
been using the CDS data recently as this gives a more realistic
17. Employment Assurance Scheme. The scheme aims of establishing a large number of micro
estimate. Committees constituted for measurement of Poverty
18. Group Life Insurance Scheme for Rural Areas. enterprises in rural areas of the country. The objective of
• Dr. Y.K. Alagh (1977) SGSY is to bring the assisted poor family above the poverty
Poverty • D.T. Lakdawala (1989) 19. Pradhan Mantri Rojgar Yojana.
line in three years by providing them income generating
• Suresh D.Tendulkar (2005) 20. Agriculture Income Insurance Scheme. assets through a mix of bank credit and government
Poverty refers to a state in which an individual is unable to
fulfil even the basic necessities of life. The minimum basic • N.C. Saxena (2008) 21. Mahatma Gandhi National Rural Employment Guarantee subsidy. The monthly income from the activity to be
requirement include food, clothing, housing, education and • S.R. Hashim (2010) Scheme (MGNREGS). undertaken should not be less than ` 2000, net of repayment
health facilities. According to the survey conducted in • Dr. C. Rangarajan (2012) 22. Pradhan Mantri Gramodaya Yojana (PMGY). to the Bank, at least in the third year.

E-26 Planning, Unemployment and Poverty in India Planning, Unemployment and Poverty in India E-27

Subsidy under SGSY is uniform at 30% of the project cost The programme was implemented by all the three-tiers of MGNREGA is the first ever law of the world, that guarantees poverty like drought, deforestation and soil erosion and so
subject to a maximum of ` 7500. In respect of Scheduled Panchayats. Each level of Panchayat was an independent unit wage employment at an unprecedented scale. The primary encourage sustainable development. The process outcomes
Castes and Scheduled Tribes, it is 50% subject to a maximum for formulation of Action Plan and executing the scheme. objective of the Act is augmenting wage employment. include strengthening grassroot processes of democracy and
of ` 10,000. For groups, the subsidy is 50% subject to a The resources were distributed among District Panchayat, Its auxiliary objective is strengthening natural resource infusing transparency and account ability in governance.
ceiling of ` 1.25 lakh. The scheme is being implemented on a Intermediate Panchayats and the Gram Panchayats in the ratio management through works that address causes of chronic
cost-sharing basis between the centre and states of 75 : 25 for of 20 : 30 : 50.
Various Poverty and Unemployment Elimation Programmes initiated by Govt. In Five-Year Plans.
non-north eastern states and 90 : 10 for north-eastern states. 4. Mahatma Gandhi National Rural Employment
Below the poverty line families in rural areas constitute the Guarantee Scheme (MGNREGS) S. No. Name of the Programme Year of Main Objectives
target group of the SGSY. Within the target group social After the notification of ambitious step of UPA Starting
safeguards have been provided to vulnerable sections, by way government of the National Rural Employment Guarantee 1. Crash Scheme for Rural Employment 1971-72 Generation of new employment rural development.
of reserving 50% benefits for SC/ST, 40% for women and 3% Act on September 7, 2005, a new scheme named “National
Rural Employment Guarantee Scheme (NREGS)” (It was 2. Pilot Intensive Rural Employment 72-73 Construction work in Villages.
for disabled persons.
later changed with the name Mahatma Gandhi National
The scheme of SGSY covers all aspects of self-employment Rural Employment Guarantee Act) has been launched on 3. Drought Prone Areas Programme 73-74 To develop natural resources in drought prove rural areas.
such as organisation of the poor into self-help groups, training, February 2, 2006. The ongoing programmes of Sampoorna
credit, technology, infrastructure and marketing. Grameen Rozgar Yojana (SGRY) and National Food for Work 4. Food for work Programme 77-78 To provide food for work in development process.
2. National Food for Work Programme Programme (NFFWP) were integrated within the NREGS in
the 200 districts identified in the initial stage. Implemented 5. Antyodaya Yojana 77-78 To give economic assistance to families BPL.
National food for work programme was Launched on
November 14, 2004. by the Ministry of Rural Development, National Rural 6. National Rural Employment Pro- 80-81 Helping that segment of Population which largely depends
It is started in 150 most backward districts of the country Employment Guarantee Act (NREGA) is a flagship programme
gramme (NREP) on wage employment by providing gainful employment.
identified by the Planning Commission in consultation with the of the government that directly touches lives of the poor and
Ministry of Rural Development and State Government. promotes inclusive growth. NREGS has been launched with 7. Rural landless Employment Gurantee 1983-84 To expand Employment.
following guidelines: Programme (RLEGP)
The objective of the programme was to provide additional
• To enhance livelihood security of households in rural
resources apart from the resources available under Sampoorna areas of the country by providing at least 100 days of 8. Million Wells Scheme (MWS) 1988-89 To provide open irrigation wells, free of cost, to poor small
Grameen Rozgar Yojana (SGRY) to 150 most backward guaranteed wage employment in every financial year to and Marginal farmers belonging to Sc/ST.
districts of the country so that the generation of supplementary every household whose adult members volunteer to do
employment and providing of food security through creation unskilled manual work. 9. Jawahar Rojgar Yojana (JRY) 1989-90 Generation of gainful employment to unemployed in rural
of need based economic, social and community assets in these • Until such time as a wage rate is fixed by the Central areas.
districts is further intensified. The scheme was 100% central Government, the minimum wage for agricultural
sponsored. The programme has been subsumed in National labourers shall be applicable for the scheme. 10. Employment Assurance Scheme 1993-94 Providing assured employment of days unskilled manual
Rural Employment Guarantee Act initiated since February • An applicant not provided employment within fifteen (EAS) work to rural.
2, 2006, which has now come in force in all districts of the days, to be entitled to a daily unemployment allowance
as specified by the State Government. 11. Prime Minister Rojgar Yojana 1994-95 To provide self-employment to educated unemployed by
country.
• Central Employment Guarantee Council to be constituted (PMRY) setting up of sever lakh micro-enterprises.
3. Sampoorna Grameen Rojgar Yojana (SGRY)
This Scheme has been subsumed under ‘National to discharge various functions and duties assigned to the
12. Jawahar Gram Samridhi Yojana 1999-2000 To create employment and durable assets in rural areas.
Council. Every State Government is to constitute a State
Rural Employment Guarantee Programme (NREGP)’ (JGSY)
Council for this purpose.
which has been started since February 2, 2006.
• Panchayat at the district level is to constitute a Standing 13. Swarnjayanti Gram Swarozgar Yo- 1999-2000 To promote micro-enterprises and helping the rural poor
The ongoing schemes - the Employment Assurance Scheme Committee of its members to supervise, monitor and
(EAS) and the Jawahar Gram Samridhi Yojana (JGSY) were gana (SG SY) into self-help group.
oversee the implementation of the Scheme within the
merged into the Sampoorna Grameen Rojgar Yojana (SGRY) district. 14. Pradhan Mantri Gramodaya Yojana 2000-01 Improving the quality of life of people in rural areas.
on September 25, 2001. The thrust area of the programme • For every Block, State Governments is to appoint a
was to provide additional wage employment in rural areas and Programme Officer for implementing the Scheme. 15. Jai Prakash Rojgar Guarantee Yojana 2002-03 To provide employment guarantee to the unemployed in the
also to provide food security, alongside creation of durable • Gram Panchayat is to be responsible for identification (JPRGY) most distressed districts of the country.
community, social and economic assets and infrastructure of the projects as per the recommendations of the Gram
development in these areas. Preference was given to BPL Sabha and for executing and supervising such works. 16. National food for work Programme 2004-05 To intensify the generation of supplementary wage
families for providing wage employment under SGRY, poor • Central Government is to establish a National (NFWP) employment.
families above the poverty line were also offered employment Employment Guarantee Fund. State Governments
17. National Rural Employment Guaran- 2006 To entitle the rural poor to guaranted employment for 100
under SGRY. The annual outlay was ` 10,000 crore which to establish State Employment Guarantee Funds for
tee Act (NREGA) days. w.e.f April 2008 expanded from 200 to all 614 rural
includes 50 lakh tonnes of foodgrains. The fund was shared implementation to the Scheme.
districts of India.
between the Centre and the States in the ratio of 75 : 25. • The Scheme is to be self-selecting in the sense that those
Foodgrains are provided free of cost to the States/UTs. The among the poor who need work at the minimum wage 18. Swavalamban Scheme 2010 New Pension Scheme for poorer section in which Govt. will
payment of foodgrains was made directly to FCI at economic would report for work under the scheme. contribute a sum of ` 1000 along with the subscriber upto `
cost by the Centre. However, the cost of the transportation of The Act was implemented in a phased manner. In phase one 12000. This scheme will cover 10 lakh subscribers each in
foodgrains from the FCI godown to the work-site/ PDS and it was introduced in 200 of the most backward districts of the four years beginning 2010-11 bringing the total number to 40
its distribution are the responsibility of the State Government. country. It was expanded to 330 districts during 2007-08. The lakh by March, 2014.
Minimum wages are paid to the workers through a mix of Act has been notified throughout the country with effect from
minimum five kg. of foodgrains and at least 25% of wages in April 1, 2008. During the year 2010-11, 5.48 crore households 19 Pradhan Mantri Jan Dhan Yojana 2014 Start by current PM Narendra Modi to eradicate poverty at
cash. were provided employment under the scheme. grass root level.
E-28 Planning, Unemployment and Poverty in India Planning, Unemployment and Poverty in India E-29

5. Indira Awas Yojana (IAY) rural road network. It is estimated that an investment of about 9. Rashtriya Mahila Kosh (National Women Fund) 12. Innovative and Special Employment Scheme (The
The Indira Awas Yojana was launched in 1985-86 to ` 48,000 crore would be required for achieving the targets The objective of this institution set-up on March 30, 1993 Third Stream of JRY)
provide dwellings. In 1989-90, after merging the RLEGP under Bharat Nirman. is to facilitate credit support to poor women for their socio- The third phase of Jawahar Rozgar Yojana which is
with Jawahar Rozgar Yojana, this plan also became a part During the first two years of 11th Five Year Plan, an economic upliftment. The support is extended through NGOs, known as the Innovative and Special Employment Scheme is
of Jawahar Rozgar Yojana (JRY). Since January 1, 1996, expenditure of ` 25780.7 crore has been incurred on rural Women Development Corporations. Suitable state government being implemented since the year 1993-94. In this scheme,
it was again separated from JRY. At present, IAY is one agencies like DRDAs, Dairy Federations, Municipal Councils, special and modern projects are included whose objective
roads under PMGSY in which 93636 km long road work has
of the six components of the Bharat Nirman Programme. is to stop the migration of labour, to encourage the female
been completed in rural areas. etc. RMK extends loan to the above organisations at 8% and employment and to develop the productivity in the desert
The objective of IAY is to provide financial assistance for the above. Organisation can lend to the women Self Help
7. Swarna Jayanti Shahari Rozgar Yojana (SJSRY) areas. Following are some of the main points of this scheme-
construction upgradation of houses to BPL rural households Groups/ ultimate women beneficiaries at an interest ranging
Swarna Jayanti Shahari Rozgar Yojana (SJSRY) became 1. Under this plan, the schemes like Operation Black Board
belonging to Scheduled Castes and Scheduled Tribes, freed from 8% to 18%. The financial assistance given by RMK is
operational Since December 1, 1997. The Government has were also given place which fulfil the main objectives of
bonded labourers, non -SC/ST rural households, widows and
recently revamped the SJSRY with effect from April 1, 2009. totally security free and RMK does not insist for any sort of Jawahar Rozgar Yojana. The construction of the school
physically handicapped persons living in the rural areas. At
Its objective is community impowerment through promoting collateral from the organisations availing loan from it. building and of class rooms has been given priority.
present, it is the flagship programme for rural housing. Operation Black Board scheme was started in 1987.
The main points of this scheme are as follows: community organisation like Neighbourhood Groups (NHGs) 10. National Rural Health Mission (NRHM)
The National Rural Health Mission (NRHM) was 2. All the projects coming under the third stream are
1. Since 1993-94, the benefit of Indira Awas Yojana is Neighbourhood Committees (NHCs) and Community
launched on 12th April, 2005, to provide accessible, affordable given acceptance by a Screening Committee which is
being provided even to those rural poor of non-schedule Development Societies (CDSs). CDS will be the nodal agency constituted under the chairmanship of the Secretaries of
caste/schedule tribe who are living below the poverty for project identification and co-ordination. It is founded on a and accountable quality health services to rural areas. The
Rural Employment and Poverty Eradicating Departments
line. 75:25 proportion between the Centre and states. The scheme difficult areas with unsatisfactory health indicators were of the Central Government.
2. A minimum of 60% of funds are to be utilized for provides gainful employment to the urban unemployed and classified as special focus States to ensure greatest attention
13. CAPART
construction of houses for the SC/ST people. underemployed poor, by encouraging the setting up of self- where needed. The thrust of the Mission was on establishing
To promote rural development the Council for
3. From 1995-96, IAY benefits have been extended to employment ventures by the urban poor and also by providing a fully functional, community owned, decentralized health Advancement of People’s Action and Rural Technology
widows or next to kin of defence personnel killed in wage employment and utilizing their labour for construction of delivery system with inter-sectoral convergence at all levels, (CAPART) was constituted on September 1, 1986. CAPART
action. socially and economically useful public assets. This is urban to ensure simultaneous action on a wide range of determinants is a registered body under the Ministry of Rural Development.
4. Benefits have also been extended to ex-servicemen and counterpart of SGSY. The SJSRY has five targets: of health like water, sanitation, education, nutrition, social and The head office of CAPART is at New Delhi. CAPART has
retired members of para military forces as long as they (a) The Urban Self-Employment Programme (USEP) which gender equality. Institutional integration within the fragmented nine Regional Committees / Centres at Jaipur, Lucknow,
fulfil the normal eligibility conditions of IAY. targets individual urban poor for setting up of micro health sector was expected to provide a focus on outcomes, Ahmedabad, Bhubaneswar, Patna, Chandigarh, Hyderabad,
5. 3% of funds are reserved for the disabled persons living enterprises; measured against Indian Public Health Standards for all health Guwahati and Dhanbad. The Regional Committees are
below the poverty line in rural areas. (b) The Urban Women Self-help Programme (UWSP) which facilities. From narrowly defined schemes, the NRHM shifted empowered to sanction projects proposals to voluntary agencies
6. Under the plan, the allocation of the house is done in the targets urban poor women self-help groups for setting upto an outlay of ` 25 lakhs in their respective regions. Its
focus to a functional health system at all levels, from the
name of the female member of the benefited family or in up of group enterprises and providing them assistance main objective is to encourage and assist the voluntary
village to the district. activities for implementing projects for rural prosperity. Some
the joint names of husband and wife. through a fund for credit activities; NRHM is being operationalized throughout the country with important features related to it are as under-
7. The ceiling on assistance for construction of new houses (c) Skill Training for Employment Promotion amongst special focus on 18 states which includes 8 Empowered (i) CAPART extends assistance to Jawahar Rojgar Yojana,
has been increased from ` 25,000 to ` 35000 per unit Urban Poor (STEP-UP) which targets the urban poor Action Group States (Bihar, Jharkhand, Madhya Pradesh, Organisation of the Beneficiaries of Poverty Eradicating
for the plain areas and from ` 27,500 to ` 38,500 per for imparting quality training so as to enhance their Chhattisgarh, Uttar Pradesh, Uttarakhand, Odisha and Programme, Integrated Rural Development Programme,
unit for the hilly/difficult areas with effect from April 1, employability for self-employment or better salaried Development of Women and Children in Rural Areas
Rajasthan), 8 NE states, Himachal Pradesh, Jammu &
2008. employment; and other related organisations.
Kashmir.
8. Under the scheme, financial resources are shared (d) The Urban Wage Employment Programme (UWEP) (ii) The Rural Development Department of the Indian
Among major innovations of the NRHM are creation of a cadre
between the Centre and State on a 75 : 25 basis. In which seeks to assist the urban poor by utilizing their Government provides the required funds to CAPART.
case of NE states, the funding pattern has recently been of Accredited Social Health Activists (ASHA) and improved
labour for the construction of socially and economically hospital care, decentralisation at district level to improve intra 14. Bharat Nirman
revised to 90 : 10. useful public assets, in towns having population less than and inter-sectoral convergence and effective utilisation of This programme, launched in 2005-06, for building
6. Pradhan Mantri Gram Sadak Yojana (PMGSY) 5 lakhs as per the 1991 census; and infrastructure and basic amenities in rural areas, has six
Pradhan Mantri Gram Sadak Yojana (PMGSY), a 100% resources through NGOs and community in general.
(e) The Urban Community Development Network (UCDN) components, namely rural housing, irrigation potential,
centrally sponsored scheme was launched on December 25, which seeks to assist the urban poor in organizing 11. Intensified Jawahar Rozgar Yojana (The Second drinking water, rural roads, electrification and rural telephony.
2000. The prime objective of the PMGSY was, to provide themselves into self-managed community structures so as Stream of JRY) A goal has been set to provide connectivity to all villages
connectivity to all unconnected habitations in the rural areas to gain collective strength to address the issues of poverty Second phase of Jawahar Rozgar Yojana is being with a population of 1000 (500 in hilly or tribal areas) with
having population of more than 500 persons, by the end of facing them and participate in effective implementation implemented in 120 backward districts of 12 states of the all-weather roads. New connectivity is proposed to a total of
Tenth Plan Period (2007). In respect of the Hill States (North- of urban poverty-alleviation programmes. country which are badly affected with unemployment and 63940 habitations under Bharat Nirman. As per Economic
East, Sikkim, Himachal Pradesh, Jammu and Kashmir and under-unemployment problems. These states are Andhra Survey 2011-12, under the rural roads component of bharat
8. Antyodaya Anna Yojana (AAY)
Uttarakhand), Desert Areas and Tribal (Schedule - V) Areas, Pradesh, Bihar, Gujarat, Jammu & Kashmir, Karnataka, Nirman, 42249 habitations have been provided all weather road
In order to make TPDS more focused and targeted connectivity up to December, 2011 and projects for connecting
the objective is to connect habitations with a population of 250 Madhya Pradesh, Maharashtra, Odisha, Rajasthan, Tamil
towards the poorest section of population, the ‘Antyodaya 16126 habitations are at different stages of implementation.
persons and above. Nadu, Uttar Pradesh and West Bengal. Since January 1, 1996
Anna Yojana’ (AAY) was launched in December 2000 for one
Under Bharat Nirman, goal has been set to provide connectivity this plan was merged with Employment Assurance Scheme 15. Pradhan Mantri Jan Dhan Yojna (PMJDY)
crore poor families. Initially AAY contemplated identification
to all the habitations with population of more than 1000 in the (EAS). The main points of this plan were as under - PMJDY was introduced on the 15th August, 2014 by
of one crore poorest of the poor families from amongst the
plain areas and habitations with a population of 500 or more 1. Under this programme, those works are given priority Prime Minister Narendra Modi. It is a part of the drive of
BPL families covered under TPDS within the States and
in hilly and tribal areas in a time bound manner by 2009. The which provide ample employment opportunities, like national inclusion. The scheme entails a ‘no-frills account’
providing them foodgrains at a highly subsidised rate of ` 2
systematic upgradation of the existing rural road networks is creating small irrigation facility on barren lands, foresty, with an overdraft facility of `5000 and a Rupay Debit Card.
per kg for wheat and ` 3 per kg for rice. The States/UTs
also an integral component of the scheme. Accordingly, an etc. Other attractions of the scheme include accidental insurance
are required to bear the distribution, cost, including margin to
Action Plan has been prepared for connecting 66,802 habitations 2. This plan also includes various activities which create cover of `1 lakh and a life insurance coverage of `30000.
dealers and retailers as well as the transportation cost. Thus
with 1,46,185 km of all-weather roads. This action plan also rural infrastructure including primary education An unprecedented number of 1.5 crore bank accounts were
the entire food subsidy is being passed on to the consumers
envisages upgradation/renewal of 1,94,130 km of the existing under the scheme. institutions. opened under the scheme on the first day of its launch.

E-30 Planning, Unemployment and Poverty in India Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India E-31

16. Rural Electrification in India Millennium Development Goals (MDGs)


Rural electrification involves supply of energy for two
MDGs were eventuated at the UNs Millennium Summit, 2000,
types of programmes:
where the world leaders agreed on a set of quantifiable and
(a) production-oriented activities like minor irrigation, rural
monitorable goals for development and poverty eradication to 1. The rationale given in the first plan for state intervention 11. The phenomenon known as green revolution began to
industries, etc. and,
be achieved by 2015. These MDGs were based on the assump- in the industrial sector was that: manifest during:
(b) electrification of villages. Rural Electrification tion that, “progress that world has made over the past 30 years
Corporation (REC) (a) private sector was inefficient (a) 2nd Plan
shows that these goals are attainable”. (b) state alone can ensure decentralization of wealth (b) 3rd Plan
It was established in July 1969 to finance various projects of
MDGs (c) private sector was neither willing nor capable of (c) Annual Plans (1966-69)
rural electrification. REC is a Public Financial Institution under
section 4A of the Companies Act 1956. REC is also registered
The main MDGs, as per UN are – investing in certain sectors (d) 4th Plan
• Eradicate extreme hunger and poverty. (d) the commanding heights of the economy should be 12. Relative poverty refers to a situation where:
as a Non-Banking Financial Company (NBFC) under section
• Achieve universal primary education. in the public sector (a) a person falls behind others
451A of RBI Act, 1934. At present REC is a ‘Navratna’
• Promote gender equality and empower women. 2. Which of the following is not one of the International (b) a person is unable to obtain the necessaries for life
Company. The current mission of REC is to facilitate
• Reduce child mortality. Development Targets of the Millennium Development (c) a person is below poverty line
availability of electricity for accelerated growth and for
• Improve maternal health. Goals? (d) a person is poorer than another in the developed
enrichment of quality of life of rural and semi-urban population
• Combat HIV/AIDS, malaria and other diseases. (a) Reducing the number of persons living in extreme world
and to act as a competitive, client-friendly and development
• Ensure environmental sustain ability. poverty by one half of 2015 13. Use of energy requirements (calorie) as a measure of
oriented organisation for financing and promoting projects • Develop a global partnership for development.
covering power generation, power conservation, power (b) Universal primary education by 2015 poverty in India was made for the first time by:
transmission and power distribution network in the country. (c) Reduction of infant and child mortality by 2/3rd by (a) Amartya Sen
To give impetus to rural electrification, the Government has
Sustainable Development Goals (SDGs) 2015 (b) Dandekar and Rath
given special attention for creation and augmentation of Rural At the United Nations Sustainable Development Summit on 25 (d) Reducing the total population by 1/3rd (c) Planning Commission
Electricity Distribution Backbone and Village Electricity September 2015, World Leaders adopted the 2030 Agenda for 3. Structural unemployment arises due to: (d) T. N. Srinivasan
Infrastructure so as to cover all unelectrified villages and rural sustainable Development, which includes a set of 17 sustain- (a) deflationary conditions 14. Human Poverty Index (HPI) measures the deprivation as
households within a span of five years. able Development Goals to end poverty, fight inequality and (b) heavy industry bias a composite index of:
injustice and tackle climate change by 2030. (c) shortage of raw materials (a) longevity, nutrition and knowledge
Rural Electricity Supply Technological Mission (REST) has
17 SDGs are– (d) inadequate productive capacity (b) knowledge, basic needs and standard of living
been set up to oversee the implementation of schemes under
1. End poverty in all its forms everywhere. 4. ‘Disguised unemployment’ refers to: (c) longevity, standard of living and sanitation
Accelerated Rural Electrification Programme. 2. End hunger, achieve food security and imporve nutrition
(a) persons with no jobs (d) longevity, knowledge, and standard of living
Rural Electrification Policy and promote sustainable agriculture.
3. Ensure healthy lives and promote well-being for all at all (b) more persons employed for a job which a few can 15. After the launch of New Economic Policy:
On August 23, 2006, Government notified Rural Electrification ages. accomplish (a) both urban and rural poverty increased
Policy under section 4 & 5 of the Electricity Act, 2003. 4. Ensure inclusive and equitable Quality Education and por- (c) unemployment among women (b) rural poverty increased initially but declined in
The policy aims at provision of access to electricity to all mote life long learning opportunities for all. (d) unemployment of people above 60 years of age 1993-94
households by year 2009, quality and reliable power supply at 5. Achieve gender equality and empower all women and girls. 5. This type of unemployment can occur even in a situation (c) both rural & urban poverty decreased
reasonable rates and minimum lifeline consumption of 1 unit 6. Ensure availability and sustainable management of water of full employment. (d) rural poverty increased but urban poverty declined
per household per day as a merit by year 2012. and sanitation for all. (a) Structural unemployment 16. Aam Admi Bima Yojana provides social security to-
7. Ensure access to affordable, reliable, sustainable and mod- (b) Functional unemployment (a) All labours in rural areas
Important Programmes introduced ern energy for all. (c) Cyclical unemployment (b) All landless labours living below poverty line in
8. Promote sustained, inclusive and sustainable economic
in Union Budget growth, full and productive employment and decent work
(d) Disguised unemployment rural areas
6. Usual status (US) unemployment is calculated with (c) All labours in urban areas
for all.
2014-15 9. Build resilient infrastructure, promote inclusive and Sustain- reference to a period of: (d) All labours in both rural as well as urban areas
• Housing for all - 2 crore houses in urban areas & 4 crore able industrialization and foster innovation. (a) one year (b) indefinite 17. CAPART is related with-
houses in Rural areas 10. Reduce inequality within and among countries. (c) one month (d) one week (a) Assisting and evaluating rural welfare programmes
• Micro units Development Refinance Agency (MUDRA) 11. Make cities and human settlements inclusive, safe, resilient 7. Chronic unemployment is measured using: (b) Computer hardware
Bank, with a corpus of ` 20,000 crores, and credit and sustainable. (a) US data (b) CWS data (c) Consultant service of export promotion
guarantee corpus of ` 3,000 crores to be created. 12. Ensure sustainable consumption and production patterns. (c) None of the two (d) Both (a) and (b) (d) Controlling pollution in big industries
• A new sheme for providing physical Aids and Assisted 13. Take urgent action To combat climate change and its im- 8. The Planning Commission was set up in accordance with 18. Which day has been declared as ‘Balika Diwas’ (Girl Day)
Living Devices for Senior Citizens, living below the pacts. the directive principles in: by the Ministry of Woman and Children Development?
poverty line. 14. Conserve and sustainably use the oceans, seas and marine (a) Article 38 (b) Article 39 (a) April 5, every year
resources for sustainable development. (c) Article 42 (d) 51 A (b) July 9, every year
• SETU (Self-Employment and Talent Utilization) to
15. Protect, restore and promote sustainable use of terrestrial
establish as Techno-financial, incubation and facilitation 9. Structural Planning refers to: (c) October 9, every year
ecosystems, sustainable manage forests, combat deserti-
programme to support all aspects of start-up business. (a) laying down broad goals and strategies (d) December 9, every year
fication, and halt and reverse land degradation and halt
• A national skill mission to consolidate skill initiatives biodiversity loss. (b) centralised planning 19. Sector wise, maximum employment in the public sector
spread across several ministeries to be Launched. 16. Promote peaceful and inclusive societies for sustainable (c) fixing flexible targets in
• Deen Dayal Upadhyay Gramin Kaushal Yojana to enhance development, provide access to justice for all and build (d) changing existing institutions or creating new ones (a) electricity, gas, and water
the employability of rural youth. effective, accountable and inclusive institutions at all levels. 10. First Plan adopted (b) community, social, and personal services
• Job creation through revival of growth and investment and 17. Strengthen the means of implementation and revitalize the (a) Lewis-Fei model (b) Mahalanobis model (c) finance, insurance, and real estate
promotion of domestic manufacturing - “Make in India” global partnership for Sustainable development. (c) Harrod Domar model (d) Keynesian model (d) transport, storage, and communication
E-32 Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India E-33

20. Which plan was suspended one year before the time (d) The nation’s priorities have shifted away from 39. National Development Council is concerned with 47. In which one the following Five Year Plans the actual
schedule? industrial development to rural development (a) implementing state plans growth performance in India in respect of GDP(at factor
(a) First Plan (1951-56) (b) Third Plan (1966-71) 29. Various employment programmes have been launched in (b) approving and assessing major development projects cost) was less than the target set ?
(c) Sixth Plan (1980-85) (d) Fifth Plan (1974-79) India, namely, IRDP, NREP, RLEQP, FWP. They are in India (a) Sixth Five Year Plan
21. Rajeev Gandhi Scheme for Empowerment of Adolescent meant to improve (c) approval of five-year plans (b) Seventh Five Year Plan
Girls named to ‘Sabla’ includes the girls of the age (a) rural employment (d) implementing community development programmes (c) Eighth Five Year Plan
group– (b) urban employment 40. Which of the following is not a millennium development (d) Ninth Five Year Plan
(a) 9 to 12 years (b) 10 to 15 years (c) rural and urban employment goal? 48. How would the size of the labour force and the rate of
(c) 11 to 18 years (d) 15 to 18 years (d) educated employment (a) The eradication of extreme poverty and hunger. unemployment be affected if people retrenched from
22. Which Indian plan ensured high growth rate as compared their jobs did not actively seek employment?
30. Among the following who are eligible to benefit from (b) Universal primary and secondary education.
with targeted growth rate ? (a) The labour force would be smaller and the
the “Mahatma Gandhi National Rural Employment (c) Gender equality and empowerment of women.
(a) Fifth Plan (b) Fourth Plan unemployment rate would be lower.
Guarantee Act”? (d) Reducing the child mortality rate.
(c) Second Plan (d) Eighth Plan (b) The labour force would be smaller and the
(a) Adult members of only the scheduled caste and 41. Which plan emphasised optimum utilisation of capacities, unemployment rate would be higher.
23. What was the aim of Antyodaya Programme? scheduled tribe households improvement in productivity and establishment of sunrise (c) There would be no change in the labour force and
(a) Elimination of Urban Poverty (b) Adult members of below poverty line (BPL) industries”? the unemployment rate would be higher.
(b) Improving the standards of scheduled castes households (a) Fifth Plan (b) Sixth Plan (d) The labour force would be smaller and there would
(c) Uplifting minorities (c) Adult members of households of all backward (c) Second Plan (d) Seventh plan be no change in the unemployment rate.
(d) Helping the poorest among poor communities 42. Which of the following programmes is specially directed 49. The natural rate of unemployment is likely to fall if:
24. Economic survey in India is published officially, every (d) Adult members of any household towards helping women in difficult circumstances or in (a) unemployment benefits increase
year by the 31. Inclusive growth as enunciated in the Eleventh Five Year distress? (b) income tax increases
(a) Reserve Bank of India Plan does not include one, of the following: (a) Swadhar (c) more training is available for the unemployed
(b) Planning Commission of India (a) Reduction of poverty (b) Swayamsiddha (d) geographical immobility increases
(c) Ministry of Finance, Government of India (b) Extension of employment opportunities (c) Mahila Samriddhi Yojana 50. To reduce cyclical unemployment the government might:
(d) Ministry of Industries, Government of India (c) Strengthening of capital market (d) Rashtriya Mahila Kosh (a) increase the budget surplus
25. The schemes of Urban Micro-Enterprises, Urban Wage (d) Reduction of gender inequality 43. PEARL is a programme related to (b) increase the balance of payments deficit
Employment and Housing, and Shelter Upgradation are 32. In the context of India’s Five Year Plans, a shift in the (c) increase the budget deficit
(a) improvement of gems and jewellery export
part of (d) reduce government expenditure
pattern of industrialization, with lower emphasis on (b) pet awareness and rescue
(a) Integrated Rural Development Programme 51. The Economic Planning Committee was established in
heavy industries and more on infrastructure begins in (c) knowledge sharing on urban reforms and city
(b) Nehru Rozgar Yojana the chairmanship of
(a) Fourth Plan (b) Sixth Plan governance
(c) Jawahar Rozgar Yojana (a) J.L. Nehru
(c) Eighth Plan (d) Tenth Plan (d) quality enhancement of processed food for export
(d) Prime Minister’s Rozgar Yojana (b) Dr. Rajendra Prasad
33. Deputy chairman of the Planning Commission is the: 44. Indicative planning
26. The Employment Assurance Scheme envisages financial (c) Ramkrishna Mudaliyar
(a) Prime Minister (a) replaces the market system (d) K.C. Niyogi
assistance to rural areas for guaranteeing employment to
(b) Planning Minister (b) is a method of controlling the 52. The second five year plan was based on
at least
(c) Holds the rank of a cabinet minister (c) economy by setting short term goals (a) P.C. Mahalnobis Model
(a) 50 per cent of the men and women seeking jobs in
(d) Economist of repute (d) can work only when capital account convertibility (b) Nehruvian Model
rural areas
34. Overall aim of Indian plans is operates works through the market (c) Harro-Domar Model
(b) 50 per cent of the men seeking jobs in the rural areas
(c) one man and one women in a rural family living (a) industrial development 45. Which one of the following statements is not correct? (d) None of these
below the poverty line (b) economic growth with social justice (a) Under the Targeted Public Distribution System, the 53. What was the main objective of the Third Five year Plan?
(d) one person in a rural landless house hold living (c) socialist pattern of society. families below Poverty Line are provided 50 kg (a) To make economy self dependent
below the poverty line (d) regional prosperity of food grains per month per family at subsidized (b) To ensure social development
27. The growth rate of which one of the following sectors has 35. Ninth Plan put emphasis on price. (c) For abolition of poverty
(a) universal education (b) Under Annapurna Scheme, indigent senior citizens (d) To establish heavy industries
very low employment elasticity?
(b) growth with social justice and equity of 65 years of age or above eligible for National Old 54. Which five year plan was focused on poverty and
(a) manufacturing (b) construction
(c) removal of rural unemployment Age Pension but not getting pension can get 10 kg unemployment for the first time?
(c) financial services (d) mixed farming
(d) decentralization of food grains per person per month free of cost. (a) Third Five Year Plan
28. The planning process in the industrial sector in India
36. _____ sector was the largest contributor to GDP during (c) Ministry of social justice and empowerment has a (b) Fourth Five Year Plan
has assumed a relatively less important position in the (c) Fifth Five Year Plan
nineties as compared to that in the earlier period. Which the Ninth Plan? scheme in which indigent people living in welfare
(d) Sixth Five Year Plan
one of the following is not true in this regard? (a) Manufacturing institutions like orphanages are given 15 kg of
55. Who among the following has written the book named
(a) With the advent of liberalization, industrial (b) Trade foodgrains per person per month of BPL rates.
‘Indian Economy: Gandhian Blue print”?
investments/development have largely been placed (c) Information technology (d) Ministry of Human Resource Development gives
(a) Acharya Vinoba Bhave
within the domain of private and multinational (d) Financial services financial support to mid-day meal scheme for the (b) Morarji Desai
sectors. 37. Durgapur, Bhilai and Rourkela steel plants were benefit of Class I to V students in government or (c) Jai Prakash Narayan
(b) With markets assuming a central place, the role of established during _____ Plan. government aided school. (d) Charan Singh
central planning in many sectors has been rendered (a) Second (b) Third 46. Which Five- Year Plan had an objective of “Rapid 56. A shift in pattern of Industrialisation with lower emphasis
redundant (c) Fourth (d) First industrialization with particular emphasis on development of the heavy industry and move on infrastructure begins
(c) The focus of planning has shifted to sectors like 38. ____ Plan had the fastest growth rate. of basic and heavy industries” ? in which five year plan?
human resource development, infrastructure, (a) First (b) Fifth (a) First (b) Second (a) Fifth plan (b) Sixth plan
population control and welfare. (c) Sixth (d) None (c) Third (d) Fourth (c) Seventh plan (d) Eight plan

E-34 Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India E-35

57. The government introduced an agricultural strategy which (a) Sixth Five Year Plan
gave rise to green revolution in India under the plan (b) Seventh Five Year Plan
(a) Third Five Year Plan (b) Fourth Five Year Plan (c) Eighth Five Year Plan
(c) Fifth Five Year Plan (d) Sixth Five Year Plan (d) Ninth Five Year Plan
58. Agriculture, Irrigation and Power Projects were given 70. The ‘Bombay Plan’ drafted by GD Birla and JRD Tata Select the correct answer using the codes given below:
highest priority in which among the following plans? emphasized: Statement Based MCQ (a) 1 only (b) 2 and 3
(a) First Five Year Plan (b) Second Five Year Plan (a) that the economy should be left to the dynamic (c) 1 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3
(c) Third Five Year Plan (d) Fourth Five Year Plan investments by the private sector in heavy industries, 1. Which of the two employment programmes are being 7. With reference to “Aam Admi Bima Yojana’’, consider the
59. Who among the following works as Ex-officio secretary etc. merged in newly introduced Prime Minister’s Employment following statements
of National Development Council? (b) the public sector investment in infrastructure and Generation Programme? 1. The member insured under the scheme must be the
(a) Secretary of Finance Ministry 1. PMRY 2. NREP head of the family or an earning member of the family
heavy industries
(b) Vice Chairman of Planning Commission 3. REGP 4. RLEGP in a rural landless house-hold.
(c) annual planning
(c) Secretary of Planning Commission Choose the right option 2. The member insured must be in the age group of 30 to
(d) that the private sector should foot the Bill for (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
(d) Secretary of Planning & Implementation Ministry 65 years.
intensive and low return investments in the industrial (c) 1 and 3 (d) 2 and 4 3. There is a provision for free scholarship for upto two
Secretary of Planning Commission
sector. 2. Which of the following is/are correct? children of the insured who are studying between
60. Socio-economic planning is a part of ____?
71. Which one among the following statements regarding the 1. Bulk of unemployment in India is in rural areas. classes 9 and 12.
(a) Union List (b) State List
Eighth five year plan in India is not correct? 2. The disguised unemployment in agricultural sector is Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
(c) Concurrent List (d) Reserved List
61. In which five year plan self reliance as an object of (a) The plan was postponed by two years because of perennial. (a) 1 only (b) 2 and 3
planning was emphasized? political upheavals at the centre 3. Industrialization has rendered several people jobless in (c) 1 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3
(b) It aimed at high growth of both agriculture and India. 8. Consider the following statements regarding Indian Planning:
(a) First Five Year Plan
manufacturing sectors (a) 1 and 2 (b) 1, 2 and 3 1. The Second Five-Year Plan emphasized on the
(b) Second Five Year Plan
(c) Its emphasis was on growth in export and import, (c) 1 only (d) 2 and 3 establishment of heavy industries.
(c) Third Five Year Plan
improvement in trade and current account deficit 3. Which of the following were the priority objectives of the 2. The Third Five-Year Plan introduced the concept of
(d) Fourth Five Year Plan Eighth plan?
(d) It set before itself the two principal objectives of import substitution as a strategy for industrialization.
62. Who among the following is NOT a part of National 1. Universalization of elementary education. Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
Development Council? ‘growth with stability’ and ‘growth with justice’
2. Growth and diversification of agriculture. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(a) Finance Commission of India Chairman 72. By which one of the following years does the 11th Five
3. Containment of population growth. (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
(b) Vice Chairman of Planning Commission Year Plan aim at achieving 10% rural tele-density in 4. Gradual privatization of most public sector undertakings. 9. Planning Commission of India
(c) Secretary of Planning Commission India from the present 1.9%? Choose your answer from the following codes 1. was set up in 1950
(d) Secretary of Planning & Implementation Ministry (a) 2009 (b) 2010 (a) 1, 2 and 4 (b) 2, 3 and 4 2. is a constitutional body.
63. Which five year plan Infrastructure as an object of (c) 2011 (d) 2012 (c) 1, 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2 and 3 3. is an advisory body
planning was emphasized? 73. When the productive capacity of the economic systems of 4. With reference to the government’s welfare schemes, 4. is a government department
(a) First Five Year Plan (b) Second Five Year Plan a state is inadequate to create sufficient number of jobs, it consider the following statements. (a) 1 and 2 (b) 2 and 3
(c) Third Five Year Plan (d) Sixth Five Year Plan is called 1. Under the Antyodaya Anna Yojana, the foodgrains are (c) 1 and 3 (d) 3 only
64. Which five year plan is also known as Mahalanobis (a) seasonal unemployment available to the poorest of the poor families at ` 2 kg 10. _____ is/are not matched correctly?
model plan? (b) structural unemployment for wheat and ` 3 kg of rice. 1. First Plan 1950-55
(a) First Five Year Plan (b) Second Five Year Plan (c) disguised unemployment 2. Under the National Old Age Pension Scheme, the 2. Third Plan 1961-66
(c) Third Five Year Plan (d) Sixth Five Year Plan (d) cyclical unemployment old and destitute are provided ` 75 month as Central 3. Fourth Plan 1966-71
65. Disguised unemployment generally means Pension, in addition to the amount provided by most 4. Seventh Plan 1985-90
74. The main objective of the 12th Five-Year Plan is
(a) Large number of people remain unemployed State Governments. (a) 1 and 2 (b) 3 only
[CSAT-2014-I] (c) 1 only (d) 1 and 3
(b) Alternative employment is not available 3. Government of India has allocated 25 kg foodgrains
(a) inclusive growth and poverty reduction 11. Basic objectives of Indian plans are
(c) Marginal productivity of labour is zero per below poverty line family per month, at less than
(b) inclusive and sustainable growth half the economic cost. 1. economic growth
(d) Productivity of worker is low (c) sustainable and inclusive growth to reduce Which of these statements are correct? 2. self-reliance
66. Which Five-Year Plan had an objective of “Rapid
unemployment (a) 1 and 2 (b) 1 and 3 3. employment generation
industrialization with particular emphasis on development
(d) faster, sustainable and more inclusive growth (c) 2 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3 4. population growth
of basic and heavy industries” ?
75. ‘Pradhan Mantri Jan-Dhan Yojana’ has been launched 5. Which of the following can aid in furthering the Government’s (a) 1, 2 and 4 (b) 1, 2 and 3
(a) First (b) Second (c) 2 and 3 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4
for [CSAT-2015-I] objective of inclusive growth ?
(c) Third (d) Fourth 12. ____ is an achievement of Indian planning.
67. In which of the following years was the planning (a) providing housing loan to poor people at cheaper 1. Promoting Self-Help Groups.
interest rates 2. Promoting Micro Small and Medium Enterprises. 1. development of infrastructure
commission set up in India ? 2. diversification of industry and exports
(b) promoting women’s Self-Help Groups in backward 3. Implementing the Right to Education Act.
(a) 1947 (b) 1948 3. high growth in national in-come
areas Select the correct answer using the codes given below:
(c) 1949 (d) 1950 (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 4. control over prices
68. Who is the ex-officio Chairman of the Planning (c) promoting financial inclusion in the country (a) 1 and 2 (b) 1, 2 and 3
(d) providing financial help to the marginalized (c) 2 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3
Commission of India ? 6. The Multi-dimensional Poverty Index developed by Oxford (c) 1, 2 and 4 (d) 2 and 3
(a) Vice-President of India communities 13. Which plans and features are wrongly matched?
Poverty and Human Development Initiative with UNDP
(b) The Prime Minister of India 76. The Government of India has established NITI Aayog to 1. First Plan - Community development projects
support covers which of the following?
(c) The Finance Minister of India replace the [CSAT-2015-I] 1. Deprivation of education, health, assets and services at 2. Second - Heavy industries
(d) The Law Minister of India (a) Human Rights Commission household level. 3. Third - Green Revolution
69. In which one the following Five Year Plans the actual (b) Finance Commission 2. Purchasing power parity at national level. 4. Fourth Plan
growth performance in India in respect of GDP(at factor (c) Law Commission 3. Extent of budget deficit and GDP growth rate at (a) 1 and 4 (b) 3 and 4
cost) was less than the target set ? (d) Planning Commission national level. (c) 3 only (d) 1 and 3
E-36 Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India E-37

14. Fourth Plan failed due to (2) The third five year plan aimed to achieve self- 28. Consider the following statements about the LPG model 33. In context of ‘Indira Awaas Yojana’, consider the
1. Indo-China conflict sufficiency in foodgrains and increase agricultural of economic development process in India? following statements:
2. Bangladesh refugee influx production to meet the requirements of industry and (1) Disinvestment of profit making public sector (1) Indira Awaas Yojana seeks to provide shelter to
3. bad monsoons exports. Enterprises. rural BPL households.
4. bad prices situation Which of the statements given above is/are correct? (2) Permitting private sectors to establish Industrial (2) Allotment under this housing scheme is made only
(a) 1, 3 and 4 (b) 1, 2 and 3 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only Units without taking a licence. in the name of the female member of the household.
(c) 2, 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (3) Chronically sick industries were referred to BIFR Which of the following is/are correct?
15. National Rural Employment Guarantee Act ensures that the 22. Consider the following statements about Indian Economy? for the formulation of revival or rehabilitation plan. (a) Only1 (b) Only 2
1. Centre bears 75% of the cost of wages of unskilled (1) During 11th Five Year Plan, the foodgrain Which of the processes given above is/are taken after (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
manual workers. production steadily increased. adoption of LPG model? 34. A person qualifies for insurance under the Aam Aadmi
2. State government provides 100 days of work to every (2) During 11th Five Year Plan, the average inflation
member of a household in a financial year. (a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1 and 3 Bima Yojana only if he ______
on the wholesale price Index is above 10%. (c) 2 and 3 (d) only 2
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only Which of the statements given above is/are correct? 1. Is earning member of rural household
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 29. Consider the following two statements and answer the 2. Is Landless
(a) only 1 (b) only 2
16. Consider the following statements : (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 question– 3. Belongs to BPL category
1. The period of the 10th Five Year Plan is 2003-2008. 23. Consider the following statements : I. The rural poverty alleviation programme will 4. Between 15- 59 years of age which among the above
2. The 10th Five year Plan approach towards tourism signifies (1) MNREGA was launched in the 11th five year plan. henceforth run on mission mode. statements is / are correct?
a distinct shift from that adopted in previous plans. (2) Indira Awas Yojana was launched in the 9th Five II. National Rural Livelihood Mission is centrally (a) Only 1 (b) 1 & 2
Year Plan. sponsored programme implemented by the states. (c) 1, 2 , 3 & 4 (d) 1 , 3 & 4
Which of the statements given above is/are correct ?
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? (a) Only I is correct 35. Consider the following:
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (a) only 1 (b) only 2 (b) Only II is correct 1. Low per capita income
17. Which among the following is not correct with regard to
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (c) Both I and II are correct 2. Low rate of capital formation
24. Consider the following statements : (d) None is correct 3. Working force largely in the tertiary sector
Sampoorna Garmeena Rozgar Yojana?
(1) The Ninth Five Year Plan was launched in the 50th 30. Which of the statement[s] is true regarding the NDC Which among the above is/ are the characters of an
1. The cash component of the programme is borne
year of India’s independence. 1. to prescribe guidelines for the formulation of the underdeveloped economy?
exclusively by the Central Government.
(2) For the first time in the Indian economy the GDP National Plan, including the assessment of resources (a) 1 & 2 (b) 2 & 3
2. Foodgrains are provided free of costs to the States/Union
growth rate of the Ninth Five Year Plan was set at for the Plan;
Territories. (c) 1 & 3 (d) 1, 2 & 3
7%. 2. to consider the National Plan as formulated by the
Select the answer using the code given below: 36. Consider the following statements:
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? Planning Commission;
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 1. Indira Gandhi Matritva Sahyog Yojana (IGMSY) has
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 3. to consider important questions of social and
(c) Both1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 Nor 2 been launched to improve the health and nutrition
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 economic policy affecting national development;
18. _____ was the priority objectives of the 10th Plan? 25. Consider the following statements : status of pregnant, lactating women and infants.
1. 7.92% growth of CPP and 2. The scheme envisages Cash Incentives for the above
(1) In the 11th Five Year Plan, the growth rate of the 4. to review the working of the Plan from time to time
2. Increasing literacy rate to 75 per cent export was always positive. beneficiaries
3. Five years of schooling to all children by 2007 and to recommend such measures as are necessary 3. All Government Women Employees are beneficiaries
(2) In the middle of the 11th Five Year Plan, the import
4. Creating 100 million jobs in 5 years for achieving the aims and targets set out in the of the IGMSY
growth was negative due to external factors.
(a) 1, 2 and 4 (b) 2, 3 and 4 National Plan.
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? Which among the above statements is / are correct?
(c) 1, 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2 and 3 (a) Only 1, 2,and 3 (b) Only 2, 3
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only (a) Only 1 & 2 are correct
19. The National Development Council (NDC) : (c) Only 1 and 2 (d) All of them
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (b) Only 2 & 3 are correct
(1) discusses progress of the National plan. 31. Who among the following constitute the National
26. Consider the following statements : (c) Only 1 is correct
(2) suggests the ways to achieve goals of the national Development Councils?
(1) Indo-china war had hampered the proper progress (d) All are correct
plan. 1. The Prime Minister of India
and implementation of Fourth Five Year Plan in 37. Which among the following is not correct with regard to
(3) gives guidelines to formulate the National plan. 2. The Leader of Opposition
India. Sampoorna Garmeena Rozgar Yojana?
(4) suggests plan allocation. 3. Minister of Union Cabinet
(2) In the Indian Economy, the plan Holiday took place 1. The cash component of the programme is borne
Consider the above statements, select the correct answer 4. Chief Minister of the States
during 1966 to 1969 exclusively by the Central Government.
from the codes given below : Which of the statements given above is/are correct? Select the correct answer using the given code below.
Codes : (a) 1 and 2 only 2. Foodgrains are provided free of costs to the States/
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only Union Territories.
(a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 2, 3 and 4 (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (b) 1, 2, 3 and 4
(c) 1, 2 and 4 (d) All of the above (c) 1, 3 and 4 only Select the answer unsing the code given below:
27. Consider the following statements :
20. Inclusive growth would necessitate : (d) 1, 2 and 3 only (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(1) The state sets broad parameters and goals for the
(a) Development of infrastructural facilities 32. Consider the following statements: (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 Nor
economy.
(b) Revival of agriculture 1. Bulk of employment in India is in rural areas. 38. Consider the following statements
(2) The targets to be achieved are broadly set by the
(c) Increase availability of social services such as state. 2. The disguised unemployment in agricultural sector 1. Food for Work Programme was launched in India
education and health. (3) The plan is made for the specific time period of is perennial. during the 10th Five Year Plan.
(d) All the above. about 15 years. 3. Industrialization has rendered several people jobless 2. The Planning commission in India is a constitutional
21. Consider the following statements regarding Indian Which of the statements given above is/are correct in India. Which of the statement(s) given above is/ body.
planning. about the Indicative planning? are correct? Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
(1) The second five year plan emphasized on the (a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1 and 2 (a) 1 and 2 (b) 1 and 3 (a) Only 1 (b) Only 2
establishment of heavy industries. (c) 1 and 3 (d) only 1 (c) 2 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3 (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2

E-38 Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India E-39

39. The 11th Five Year Plan strategy to raise agricultural 3. The major objective of third plan is continued 50. Which among the following is the objective of Prime 56. Which of the following were the priority objectives of the
output envisages which of the following? emphasis on basic industries together with an Minister RojgarYojana (PMRY) Eighth plan?
1. Greater attention to land reforms. increased outlay of 35% in agriculture and applied 1. To provide self-employment to educated unemployed 1. Universalization of elementary education.
2. Double the rate of growth of irrigated area. sectors. by setting up of sever lakh micro-enterprises 2. Growth and diversification of agriculture.
3. Promote animal husbandry and fishery. Which among the following statement is correct: 2. To promote micro-enterprises and helping the rural 3. Containment of population growth.
4. Interest free credit to the farmers. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only poor into self-help group. 4. Gradual privatization of most public sector
Select the correct answer using the codes given below (c) 3 only (d) 3 and 2 3. To create employment and durable assets in rural undertakings.
(a) 1 and 3 (b) 2 and 3 45. Consider the following statement areas. Choose your answer from the following codes
(c) 1, 2 and 3 (d) 2 and 4 1. The plan holiday was declared for three years as 4. Improving the quality of life of people in rural areas. (a) 1, 2 and 4 (b) 2, 3 and 4
40. ‘Inclusive growth’ is a phrase used in India’s there was discontinuity in the planning process. Choose the correct code (c) 1, 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2 and 3
1. 9th Plan 2. 10th Plan 2. Plan period was from 1965-1968 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only Matching Based MCQ
3. 11th Plan 4. 12th Plan Which among the following Statement is correct:
Select the correct answer using the codes given below. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 51. Consider the following statements
1. Since 1993-94, the benefit of Indira AwasYojana DIRECTIONS (Qs. 57-66) : Match List-I with List-II and
(a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 2 and 4 (c) 1 and 2 (d) 1 and 3
is being provided even to those rural poor of non- select the correct answer using the codes given below the lists.
(c) 3 and 4 (d) Only 4 46. In _____ demand for labour falls short to the supply due
schedule caste/schedule tribe who are living below
41. Consider the following statement: to rapidly growing population and their immobility 57. List-I List-II
the poverty line.
1. The Planning Commission was established in 1950, 1. Structural Unemployment (A) Development (1) UN India Human
2. A minimum of 60% of funds is to be utilized for
by Article 39 of the Directive Principles of the 2. Disguised Unemployment Programme Development Report
construction of houses for the SC/ST people.
Constitution of India. 3. Seasonal Unemployment (B) National Council of (2) India Development
3. From 1995-96, IAY benefits have been extended to
2. Prime Minister, Narendra Modi dissolved the Choose the correct Code Applied Economic Report
widows or next to kin of defence personnel killed in
planning commission in his first Independence Day (a) 1 only (b) 2 only Research
action.
speech in 2014. It has since been replaced by a new (c) 3 only (d) 2 and 3 (C) Indira Gandhi Institute (3) World Development
4. Benefits have also been extended to ex-servicemen
institution named niti Aayog. 47. Which of the following statements is/are incorrect? of Development Report
and retired members of Para military forces as long
Which among the following statement is not true? 1. Open Unemployment: It refers to an unemployment Research
as they fulfil the normal eligibility conditions of IAY.
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only that occurs at certain seasons of the years. The (D) World Bank (4) Human Report
Which of the following is / are correct
(c) 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 period of such unemployment varies from state to Development
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 3 and 4
42. NITI AAYOG is defined as: state, depending upon the methods of farming, the (a) A – 4 ; B – 1 ; C – 2 ; D – 3
(c) 1 and 4 (d) 1, 2, 3, 4
1. The National Institution for Transforming India condition of soil, the type and numbers of crops 52. Whose objective is to facilitate credit support to poor (b) A – 4 ; B – 2 ; C – 1 ; D – 3
aayog grown, etc. women for this socio-economic upliftment. (c) A – 2 ; B – 3 ; C – 4 ; D – 1
2. It has replaced YojanaAayog by Prime Minister, 2. Frictional Unemployment: It refers to temporary (a) RashtriyaMahilaKosh (d) A – 2 ; B – 1 ; C – 4 ; D – 3
Narendra Modi unemployment that exists during the period, wherein (b) National Rural Health Mission 58. Match List I with List II and select the correct answer
3. Niti Aayog provides less opportunity than Yojana workers leave one job and join some other. (c) Village Grain Bank Scheme using the codes given below the list
Aayog 3. Cyclical Unemployment: It is associated with the (d) Annapurna Scheme List-I List-II
Which among the following statement is true? downswing and depression phases 9 business cycle. 53. Consider the following statement regarding usual status (Five Year Plan) (Objective)
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only It is the most common type of unemployment in the 1. One year 2. Indefinite A. First Plan 1. Growth with social justice
(c) 1 and 2 (d) 1 and 3 developed capitalist economies. 3. One month 4. One week B. Third Plan 2. Sustainable inclusive growth
43. The difference between Niti Aayog and Yojana Aayog is Select the incorrect definition using the code given below: Usual status (US) unemployment is calculated with C. Fifth Plan 3. Self reliant and generating
as follows: (a) 1 only (b) 2 only reference to a period of? economy
1. In Niti Aayog there are 3 full time members while (c) 3 only (d) 2 and 1 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only D. Twelfth plan 4. Agriculture, Irrigation and
Yojana Aayog has 8 members. 48. Scheme ______ is a Government of India program aimed (c) 3 only (d) 4 only power projects
2. NITI is a think-tank and does not have the power at providing 24x7 uninterrupted power supply to all 54. Consider the following statements: Codes :
to impose policies while Yojana impose policies on homes in Rural India 1. Indira Gandhi Matritva Sahyog Yojana (IGMSY) has A B C D
been launched to improve the health and nutrition (a) 2 4 3 1
states and tied allocation of funds with projects it 1. Deendayal Disabled Rehabilitation Scheme
status of pregnant, lactating women and infants. (b) 2 3 4 1
approved. 2. Deen Dayal Upadhyaya Gram JyotiYojana
2. The scheme envisages Cash Incentives for the above (c) 4 3 1 2
3. NITI has power to allocate funds while Yojana 3. Digital IndiaProgramme
beneficiaries (d) 1 3 2 1
doesn’t. Select the name of the scheme
3. All Government Women Employees are beneficiaries 59. Match the items in List-I with List-II:
Which among the following statement is true? (a) 1 only (b) 2 only of the IGMSY List-I List-II
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 1 and 3 (c) 3 only (d) 2 and 3 Which among the above statements is / are correct? A. Reproductive 1. Police Research
(c) 2 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3 49. Consider the following statements (a) 1 and 2 (b) 2 and 3 Child Health
44. Consider the following statement 1. Absolute Poverty: It refers to the total number (c) 1 only (d) 1, 2, 3 B. The National Rural 2. Trauma
1. The major objective of first plan is to increase National of people living below Poverty line. As per this 55. Which of the two employment programmes are Employment
Income by 25% through rapid industrialisation. This measure, around 30% of India’s population is below being merged in newly introduced Prime Minister’s
plan was developed by Professor Mahalanobis. poverty line. Guarantee Act
Employment Generation Programme?
2. The major objective of second plan is to stimulate 2. Reative Poverty: It refers to Poverty of people, C. Post Traumatic 3. Mother
1. PMRY 2. NREP
balanced economic development while correcting in comparison to other people, regions in the nation. 3. REGP 4. RLEGP Stress Disorder and Child
imbalances caused by World War II and partition. Which among the following statement is/ are incorrect? Choose the right option D. Bureau of Police 4. Employment at
The plan targeted the socio-economic development (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 Research and village level
but the outcome was very poor. (c) Neither 1 nor 2 (d) Both 1 and 2 (c) 1 and 3 (d) 2 and 4 Development
E-40 Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India E-41

Codes : 63. Match the important dates


A B C D Dates Event
(a) 2 1 3 4 I. 1934 a. Planning commission set
(b) 3 4 2 1 up
(c) 4 3 2 1 II. 1944 b. Interim government sets poor and enact wide ranging social and economic
EXERCISE-1
(d) 1 2 3 4 up the Planning Advisory reforms.
60. Match List-I with List-II and select the correct Board 1. (c) 2. (d) 3. (d) 4. (b) 5. (c) 6. (a)
55. (d) Charan Singh wrote the book named, “Indian
answer from the codes given below – III. 1946 c. M. Visvesvaryya, in his 7. (d) 8. (b) 9. (d) 10. (c) 11. (c) 12. (a)
Economy: Gandhian Blue Print”. He was the fifth
List-I List-II book Planned Economy 13. (b) 14. (d) 15. (b) 16. (b) 17. (a) 18. (d)
Prime Minister of India, serving from 1979 until
A. Sarva Shiksha 1. 1987 of India, advocates the 19. (b) 20. (d) 21. (c) 22. (d) 23. (d) 24. (c)
necessity of planning in 25. (b) 26. (c) 27. (c) 28. (d) 29. (c) 1980.
Abhiyan 56. (b) Sixth five year plan (1980–85) marked the beginning
the country much before 30. (d) All adult members of the household who registered
B. Saakshar Bharat 2. 1988 of economic liberalisation.
Independence can apply for work. To register, they have to : Be
Mission In Sixth Five year plan, a shift in pattern of
IV. 1950 d. Planning and Development local residents
C. Operation Blackboard 3. 2001 Department set up under Industrialisation with lower emphasis of the heavy
D. National Literacy 4. 2009 31. (c) Inclusive growth is ‘broad-based growth’, ‘shared
the chairmanship of A. growth’, and ‘pro-poor growth’. It excludes the industry and move on infrastructure begins.
Mission Dalal 57. (a) Under the third five year plan, the government
Codes : capital markets which is left to operate by itself in
(a) I-a, II-b, III-c,IV-d introduce an agricultural strategy which gave rise to
A B C D the open market.
(b) I-c, II-d, III-b, IV-a green revolution in India. Under the third plan the
(a) 3 4 1 2 32. (c) It was during eighth plan period (1992-97) that
(c) I-d, II-c, III-b, IV-a goal was to establish self reliance and self generating
(b) 4 3 2 1 (d) I-a, II-d, III-a, IV-b emphasis was put on infrastructure development.
33. (c) 34. (b) 35. (b) 36. (a) 37. (a) 38. (a) economy. But the earlier plans had shown that the
(c) 1 2 3 4 64. Match the plans with the years
Plan Year 39. (c) 40. (b) 41. (b) 42. (a) 43. (c) 44. (d) agricultural production was the limiting factor so
(d) 1 2 4 3
61. Match the following I. First Plan a. 1961-1966 45. (a) agriculture was given top priority .
List-I List-II II. Second Plan b. 1951-1956 46. (b) The Second Five Year Plan’s broad objective was 58. (a) 59. (c) 60. (c) 61. (d)
(Five Year Plan) (Emphasis) III. Third Plan c. 1956-1961 establishment of a socialistic pattern of society. It 62. (a) 63. (d) 64. (b) 65. (c)
A. First 1. Food security and women (a) I-a, II-b, III-c aimed at rebuilding rural India, development of 66. (b) The Second Five Year Plan’s broad objective was
empowerment (b) I-b, II-c, III-a basic and heavy industries and enlarging scope of establishment of a socialistic pattern of society. It
B. Second 2. Heavy industries (c) I-c, II-b, III-a public sector. aimed at rebuilding rural India, development of
(d) I-a, II-c, III-b 47. (d) The revised targeted annual rate of growth of 9th basic and heavy industries and enlarging scope of
C. Fifth 3. Agriculture and
65. Match the following plan was 6.5% while the actual growth rate was public sector.
community development Date of Launch Scheme
D. Ninth 4. Removal of poverty 5.5%. 67. (d) In March 1950, Government of India constituted a
I. 2007 a. Aam Admi Bima Yojana
Codes : 48. (b) statutory body with the Prime Minister of India as
II. 2009 b. Bachat Lamp Yajana
A B C D 49. (c) Supply-side measures can be used to reduce the its chairman called Planning Commission of India.
III. 2015 c. Atal Pension Yojana
(a) 1 2 4 3 (a) I-a, II-b, III-c natural rate of unemployment. In this case training 68. (b)
(b) 1 4 2 3 (b) I-c, II-b, III-a enables more employees to accept jobs thereby 69. (d) The revised targeted annual rate of growth of 9th
(c) 3 2 4 1 (c) I-b, II-c, III-a reducing the natural rate of unemployment. plan was 6.5% while the actual growth rate was
(d) 3 4 2 1 (d) I-c, II-c, III-b 50. (c) Low interest rates might encourage more spending 5.5%.
62. Match the members of NitiAayog: 66. Match the following and reduce cyclical unemployment. 70. (b) 71. (c)
Column-A Column-B Year of starting Name of programme 51. (a) After India gained independence, a formal model 72. (d) The aim of 11th Five Year Plan is to connect
I. Chairperson a. Arvind Panagariya I. 1971-72 a. Pilot Intensive Rural of planning was adopted, and the Planning every village by telephone and provide broadband
II. CEO b. Narendra Modi Employment Commission, was established on 15 March 1950, connectivity to all villages by 2012.
III. Vice Chairperson c. Nitin Gadkari II. 1972-73 b. Crash Scheme for Rural with Prime Minister Jawaharlal Nehru as the
Employment 73. (d) Cyclical unemployment is unemployment that results
IV. Special Invitees d. Smt. Sindhushree Khullar chairman. when the overall demand for goods and services
(a) I-b, II-d, III-a,IV-c III. 1973-74 c. Food for work Programme 52. (a) The second five year plan was based on
IV. 1977-78 d. Drought Prove Areas in an economy cannot support full employment. It
(b) I-a, II-b, III-c, IV-d P.C. Mahalnobis Model. The Mahalanobis model
Programme occurs during periods of slow economic growth or
(c) I-c, II-b, III-d, IV-a is a Neo-Marxist model of economic development,
(a) I-a, II-b, III-c, III-d (b) I-b, II-a, III-d, IV-c during periods of economic contraction.
(d) I-c, II-b, III-d, IV-a created by statistician Prasanta Chandra Mahalanobis
(c) I-d, II-c, III-b, IV-a (d) I-a, II-d, III-a, IV-b 74. (d) 12th Five Year Plan of the Government of India aims
in 1953. Mahalanobis became essentially the key
at faster, sustainable and more inclusive growth.
economist of India’s Second Five Year Plan.
75. (c) Pradhan Mantri Jan-Dhan Yojana (PMJDY) is
53. (a) The main objective of the third five year plan was to
National Mission for Financial Inclusion to ensure
make economy self-dependent. The third Five-year
Plan stressed on agriculture and improvement in the access to financial services, namely, Banking/
production of wheat so as to be self-sufficient. Savings & Deposit Accounts, Remittance, Credit,
54. (c) Fifth five year plan was focused on poverty and Insurance, Pension in an affordable manner.
unemployment for the first time. The slogan of 76. (d) The Government of India has established NITI
‘poverty abolition’ was given by Indira Gandhi in Aayog to replace the Planning Commission. The
1971 and it was implemented during the fifth five Union Government of India announced formation of
year plan(1974–79). Gandhi promised to reduce NITI Aayog on 1 January 2015 and the first meeting
poverty by targeting the consumption levels of the of NITI Aayog was held on 8 February 2015.

E-42 Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India E-43

EXERCISE-2 MNREGA was launched in 200 select districts in 41. (d) The Planning Commission was established in 1950, speech in 2014. It has since been replaced by a new
2006. However Indira Awas Yojana was lauched by Article 39 of the Directive Principles of the institution named nitiaayog.
1. (c) 2. (b) 3. (d) 4. (d)
in the 9th Five Year Plan to provide housing for the Constitution of India. The planning commission 42. (c) Nitiaayog (The National Institution for Transforming
5. (d) The concept of the inclusive growth is based on both
rural poor in India. (yojanaaayog) was an institution in the government India AAYOG) established by Prime Minister
economic and social empowerment of ordinary and Narendra modi (chairperson) to replace the planning
under privileged individuals. Thus all the statement 24. (c) The Ninth Five Year Plan was launched in the of India, which formulated India’s five-year plans,
50th year of India’s independence. Under the plan among other function. Prime Minister Narendra commission. Nitiaayog will provide opportunities
are correct. that the previous planning commission structure
6. (a) Deprivation of education, health, assets and services for the first time in the Indian Economy the GDP modi announced his intention to dissolve the
lacked, to represent the economic interests of the
at household level growth rate was set at 7%. planning commission in his first Independence Day
state governments and union territories of India.
7. (c) The statements 1st and 3rd are correct, but 2nd 25. (b) Regarding the 11th Five Year Plan, in the middle
of the plan, the import growth was negative due to 43. (a)
statement is wrong because, the member should be
aged between 18 and 59 years not 30 and 65 years. external factors and the growth rate of the export S. No. Points of Difference NITI Aayog Planning Commission
8. (a) Second Five-Year Plan (1956-1961); The fourth was negative during certain periods. 1 Financial clout To be an advisory body, or a think-tank. Enjoyed the powers to allocate funds to
Five-Year Plan (1969-74) introduced the concept of 26. (b) Despite big investments during the first three Plans The powers to allocate fund vested in the ministries and state governments
import substitution as a strategy for industrialization. the living standards of the poor could not be raised finance ministry.
9. (c) 10. (d) 11. (b) 12. (a) 13. (b) and poverty and inequity in distribution of state 2 Full-time members Three full-time members. had eight full-time members
14. (c) 15. (b) 16. (d) 17. (b) 18. (d) resources remained stark. Consequently, the period
between 1966 and 1969 marked the shift from a 3 States’ role Includes the Chief Ministers of all States States’ role was limited to the National
19. (a) National Development Council aims to prescribe and the Lieutenant Governors of all Union Development Council and annual interaction
guidelines for the formulation of the National Plan, ‘growth approach’ to a ‘distribution from growth
approach’. Looking at the failures and pitfalls the territories in its Governing Council, during Plan meetings
including the assessment of resources for the Plan; devolving more power to the States of the
to consider the National Plan as formulated by planners suspended the impending Fourth Plan,
Union.
the Planning Commission; to consider important which was due in 1966, until 1969 for a revision of
questions of social and economic policy affecting objectives and targets. This was called as the ‘Plan 4 Member secretary To be known as the CEO and to be Secretaries or member secretaries were
national development; and.to review the working of Holiday’ extending from 1 April 1966 to 31 March appointed by the prime minister appointed through the usual process
the Plan from time to time and to recommend such 1969. 5 Part-time members To have a number of part-time members, Full Planning Commission had no provision
measures as are necessary for achieving the aims 27. (b) Indicative planning is a form of economic planning depending on the need from time to time for part-time members
and targets set out in the National Plan. implemented by a state in an effort to solve the 6 Constitution Governing Council has state chief ministers The commission reported to National
20. (d) Inclusive growth is a concept which involves problem of imperfect information in market and and lieutenant governors. Development Council that had state chief
equitable allocation of resources during the process mixed economies in order to increase economic ministers and lieutenant governors.
of economic growth with benefits incurred by every performance. Regarding the indicative planning,
7 Organization New posts of CEO, of secretary rank, and Had deputy chairperson, a member secretary
section of society. Inclusive growth necessitates state sets broad parameters and goals for the
Vice-Chairperson. Will also have two full- and full-time members.
development of infrastructural facilities, revival of economy and the targets to be achieved are broadly
time members and part-time members as
agriculture and also increases availability of social set by the state.
per need. Four cabinet ministers will serve
services such as education and health. 28. (a) LPG model of economic development process in
as ex-officio members.
21. (c) The Second Five Year Plan heralded in a true sense India involves disinvestment of profit making public
the Socialist Project of the then Prime Minister, sector enterprises, permitting private sectors to 8 Participation Consulting states while making policy and Policy was formed by the commission and
Jawaharlal Nehru. The economic policies of Nehru establish industrial units without taking a licence and deciding on funds allocation. Final policy states were then consulted about allocation of
were heavily influenced by the erstwhile Union chronically sick industries were referred to BIFR would be a result of that. funds.
of Soviet Socialist Republics (USSR) which had for the formulation of revival or rehabilitation. 9 Allocation No power to allocate funds Had power to decide allocation of government
followed the path of speedy industrialisation to 29. (c) 30. (d) 31. (c) 32. (a) 33. (b) funds for various programs at national and
expand the manufacturing base of its economy. 34. (b) 35. (a) 36. (a) 37. (b) state levels.
The Second Five year Plan focused mainly on 38. (a) According to The National Food for Work 10 Nature NITI is a think-tank and does not have the Imposed policies on states and tied allocation
heavy industry as against the First Plan which was Programme, food subsidy should be better targeted power to impose policies. of funds with projects it approved.
essentially an agricultural plan. This was done to through targeted public distribution system and
44. (c) The major objective of first plan is to stimulate 46. (a) Structural Unemployment: In this type of
boost domestic production and manufacturing of specific programmes for the poor like Food for unemployment demand for labour falls short to the
balanced economic development while correcting
goods. Third plan aimed to achieve self-sufficiency Work Programme. The National Food for Work supply due to rapidly growing population and their
imbalances caused by World War II and partition.
in foodgrains and to increase agricultural production Programme was launched on 14 November 2004 immobility.
The plan targeted the socio-economic development
to meet the requirements of industry and exports. in 150 of the most backward districts of India with 47. (a) Seasonal Unemployment: It refers to an
but the outcome was very poor. The major Objective
22. (c) During The eleventh plan ( 2007-12)the food grain the objective of generating supplementary wage unemployment that occurs at certain seasons of the
of second plan is to increase National Income by
production steadily increased and the average employment. The Planning commission is not a years. The period of such unemployment varies
25% through rapid industrialisation. This plan was
inflation on the wholesale price Index was above constitutional body. from state to state, depending upon the methods of
developed by Professor Mahalanobis. The major farming, the condition of soil, the type and numbers
10%. 39. (c) 11th Five Year Plan’s initiatives for agriculture
objective of third plan is continued emphasis on of crops grown, etc.
23. (b) The Mahatma Gandhi National Rural Employment were:
basic industries together with an increased outlay of Frictional Unemployment: It refers to temporary
Guarantee Act (MNREGA) is an Indian law that • Focusing on land reform issues
35% in agriculture and applied sectors. unemployment that exists during the period, wherein
aims to guarantee the ‘right to work’ and ensures • Doubling the rate of growth of irrigated area
45. (a) After the disastrous experience of the Third Plan, workers leave one job and join some other.
livelihood security in rural areas by providing at • Promoting animal husbandry and fishery
a plan holiday was declared for three years. This Cyclical Unemployment: It is associated with the
least 100 days of guaranteed wage employment in • Providing easy access to credit at affordable rates downswing and depression phases 9 business cycle.
period was named as Plan Holiday as there was
a financial year to every household whose adult 40. (c) Inclusive growth is a phrase used in India for 11th It is the most common type of unemployment in the
discontinuity in the planning process. Gap in Plan
members volunteer to do unskilled manual work. (2007-2012) and 12th (2012-2017) Five year plans. Period (1966-69) developed capitalist economies.
E-44 Planning, Unemployment & Poverty in India

48. (b) Deen Dayal Upadhyaya Gram Jyoti Yojana is a 61. (c) 1. First Five Year Plan (1951-56)- Agriculture
Government of India program aimed at providing and community development
24x7 uninterrupted power supply to all homes in 2. Second Five Year Plan (1956-61)- Heavy
Rural India. It was launched in 2015. Industry
49. (c) Absolute Poverty: It refers to the total number 3. Fifth Five Year Plan (1974-79)- Removal of
of people living below Poverty line. As per this Poverty

3
measure, around 30% of India’s population is below 4. Ninth Five Year Plan (1997-2002)- Food
poverty line. Relative Poverty: It refers to Poverty Security and woman empowerment
of people, in comparison to other people, regions in 62. (a) The various members of NITIAAYOG are:
the nation.  Chairperson: Prime Minister Narendra Modi
50. (a) The objective of Prime Minister Rojgar Yojana  Ceo: Smt. Sindhu shree Khullar, IAS
(PMRY) is to provide self-employment to educated
unemployed by setting up of sever lakh micro-
enterprises.
 Vice Chairperson: Arvind Panagariya
 Special invitees: Nitin Gadkari, Smriti Zubin AGRICULTURE
Irani and Thawar Chand Gehlot
51. (d) 1. Since 1993-94, the benefit of Indira
63. (b) 1934: M. Visvesvaryya, in his book Planned
AwasYojana is being provided even to those
Economy of India, advocates the necessity of
rural poor of non-schedule caste/schedule tribe
planning in the country much before Independence.
who are living below the poverty line.
1944: Planning and Development Department set up
2. A minimum of 60% of funds is to be utilized for
construction of houses for the SC/ST people. under the chairmanship of A. Dalal. Introduction
3. From 1995-96, IAY benefits have been 1946: Interim government sets up the Planning
Advisory Board. Agriculture has always been one of the most important sectors of Indian economy, be it pre- independence or post- independence
extended to widows or next to kin of defence periods. This is further proved by the large number of Indians whose livelihood depends on agriculture. Indian agriculture has
personnel killed in action. 1947: Economic Programme Committee set up
under the chairmanship of Jawaharlal Nehru. a fairly successful history. It is now first in the world in the production of milk, pulses, jute and many fruits; second in rice,
4. Benefits have also been extended to ex-
1950: Planning Commission set up. wheat, sugarcane, cotton, etc. and a leading producer of spices, plantation crop, livestock, fishes and poultry.
servicemen and retired members of Para
military forces as long as they fulfil the normal 64. (b) First plan – 1951-56, Second Plan – 1956-61, Third
eligibility conditions of IAY. plan – 1961-66 Agriculture
52. (a) The objective of Rashtriya Mahila Kosh is to 65. (d) Aam Admi Bima Yojana was launched in 2007, Atal
facilitate credit support to poor women for this socio- Pension Yojana was launched on May 9, 2015 and
economic upliftment. Bachat Lamp Yojana was launched in 2009.
53. (a) Usual status (US) unemployment is calculated with 66. (b)
reference to a period of one year. Growth and Agriculture Points to
S. Name of the Year of Main Objectives Introduction National Major Land
54. (a) Indira Gandhi Matritva Sahyog Yojana (IGMSY) Productivity Insurance remember
No. Programme Starting Agriculture Agriculture Reforms
has been launched to improve the health and policy Revolutions
1. Crash Scheme 1971-72 Generation of new employment Public Distribution
nutrition status of pregnant, lactating women and Major Cooperative AICIL
for Rural rural development. Features of System
infants. The scheme envisages Cash Incentives for Agriculture Agriculture Farmaing
Employment Indian NAIS
the above beneficiaries. in five Programmes Green
55. (c) 56. (d) 57. (a) 2. Pilot Intensive 72-73 Construction work in Villages. Agriculture year plans Revolutios
Rural Rural Credit Agricultural FCI
58. (c) First plan – agriculture, Irrigation and power projects
Third Plan – self reliance and generating economy Employment Second and Extension Marketing TPDS
Fifth Plan – growth with social justice NFSM Green Services
3. Drought 73-74 To develop natural resources
Twelfth plan – sustainable inclusive growth Revolution Agricultural
Prove Areas in drought prove rural areas. RKVY
59. (b) Programme White Price Policy
60. (a) Sarva Shiksha Abhiyan, 2001; Saakshar Bharat NHM Cooperative
Revolution
4. Food for work 77-78 To provide food for work in Credit WTO and
Mission, 2009; Operation Blackboard, 1987. ISOPOM
Programme development process Blue Societies Agriculture
National Literacy Mission, 1988.
NMSA Revolution subsidies
NABARD
Evergreen
RADP
Revolution Kisan
NeGPA Credit Green Box
Card Subsidies
NMFP
Commerical Blue Box
Banks Subsidies
NAFED Amber Box
Subsidies
TRIFED
NCDC

E-46 Agriculture Agriculture E-47

Features of Indian Agriculture •• Indian agriculture is still largely dependent on Agriculture in Five Year Plans
the uncertainties of monsoon for its irrigational
•• Agriculture is the primary occupation in India as it requirements. However, India’s water resources, Five year Plan Major Features
provides direct livelihood to more than 49% (2015) of if fully harnessed, can irrigate more than 50% of our 1st (1951-56) •• Launch of the Community development Programme, abolition of Zamindari system, campaigns for
its labour force. In India, 75% of below the poverty line cultivated area. growth in food and other related areas like fisheries, forestry, animal husbandry, soil conservation,
(BPL) population lives in rural areas, and is directly or
etc. were the major features.
indirectly dependent on agriculture. Growth and Productivity •• Growth in agriculture was 2.71%.
•• Agriculture contributes to more than 17.9% (2015) of
GDP, although this share has progressively declined •• The total irrigated area increased from less than one 2nd (1956-61) •• Industrial sector was given more importance in this plan.
from 57% in 1950-51. In developed countries, like the million hectares per annum before the green revolution to •• Industrial sector was given more importance in this plan.
about 2.5 million hectares per annum during the 1970’s. •• Agricultural Expenditure was only 20% of the actual plan expenditure.
UK and USA, the share of agriculture in GDP is only
The total gross irrigated area now is 80 million hectares. •• The agricultural growth, however, was high at 3.15%.
around 2%.
•• Total food grains (cereals and pulses) production increased
•• India accounts for 7.68 % (2015) of total global 3rd (1961-66) •• Achieving self- sufficiency in foodgrains and increase in agricultural production was one of the main
from 48.1 million tonnes in 1950-51 to an expected 257.07
agricultural output. India is the second largest producer aims of this plan.
million tonnes in 2014-15. This remarkable progress
of agricultural products in the world. •• Higher priority was given to agricultural and allied areas as compared to industrial development.
which the nation has achieved in food self-sufficiency is
•• Agriculture contributes to around 10% of the total shown in the given table. •• However, the plan did not achieve its goals and agricultural growth fell to 0.73%.
value of India’s commodity exports. Thirteen •• Land reforms, land ceiling and Green Revolution were some of the major initiatives in this plan.
•• As evident in the table, overall growth in food grains
major commodities including tea, coffee, tobacco, production has been impressive, assisted largely by Annual Plans •• Priority was given to minor irrigation projects and High Yielding Variety of seeds was preferred so as
cashew, spices, raw cotton and sugar are the primary technological breakthrough. However, one disturbing (1966-69) to increase agricultural productivity.
agricultural exports in India. Almost 30% of tea and aspect is the year-to-year fluctuation in cereals output •• Agricultural growth was high at 4.16%.
50% of coffee and jute produced in the country are which affects the employment and income of the poor
exported. In addition to this, credit must be given to 4th (1969-74) •• The results of the introduction of Green revolution and HYV seeds were good.
who depend solely on on-farm activities. This emphasizes
export of manufactured goods using agricultural raw •• Expenditure on agriculture was 22% of annual expenditure.
the need for the government to procure and store food
materials, which further accounts for another 15% of grains in years of surplus and release the same through •• Agricultural growth was 2.57%.
India’s exports. PDS in drought years in order to avoid famine conditions. 5th (1974-79) •• Emphasis was laid on spread of HYV seeds, use of fertilizers, pesticides and insecticides to increase
•• Indian agriculture has been able to improve its per •• Although production has increased several folds, production.
capita net availability of food-grains to 491.2 grams Indian agriculture is still lagging behind because of low •• Expenditure on agriculture was around 21% of annual expenditure.
(2014) from 395 grams in 1950s. productivity. •• Agricultural growth was 3.28%.
Change in Area and Production of Crops During 2012-13 and 2013-14 6 (1980-85)
th
•• It was realised by this plan that growth of Indian economy depends on rural and agricultural development.
•• The growth rate in agricultural production was a high 4.3% against a target of 3.8%.
Area (MHA) Production (MT)
Name of Crops •• Overall growth in agricultural sector was 2.52%.
2012-13 2013-14 change 2012-13 2013-14 change
7th (1985-90) •• Expenditure on agriculture was 22% of annual expenditure.
Wheat 30.00 30.61 +0.61 93.51 95.60 +2.09 •• Growth in agriculture was 3.47%
Rice (Rabi) 3.84 4.38 +0.54 12.87 14.19 +1.32 8th (1992-97) •• The growth target was 4.1% but the agricultural sector showcased an impressive growth of 4.68%.
Sorghum 3.79 3.55 –0.24 2.44 3.21 +0.77 9th (1997-2002) •• This plan was a failure in the agricultural sector and it registered an agricultural growth rate of 2.44%.
Maize 1.46 1.49 +0.03 6.06 6.40 +0.34 10th (2002-07) •• Against a target of 4%, the average agricultural growth rate was only 2.3%.
Barley 0.69 0.76 +0.07 1.75 1.92 +0.17 11th (2007-12) •• The major emphasis was on increasing agricultural productivity and profitability by making available
affordable institutional credit, farm mechanisation, biotechnology, cold storages, and marketing.
Total coarse cereals 5.94 5.80 –0.14 10.25 11.53 +1.28
•• Growth in agriculture was 3.5%.
Gram 8.52 9.66 +1.14 8.83 9.79 +0.96
12th (2012-17) •• This plan, like its predecessors, has a target of 4% agricultural growth rate, with growth in food-grains
Urad 0.69 0.75 +0.06 0.47 0.41 –0.06 at 2% and non- food grains at 5.6%.
Moong 0.74 0.65 –0.09 0.40 0.31 –0.09 •• The plan puts an emphasis on improvement in technology, use of public- private partnership, greater
Total Pulses 13.30 14.66 +1.36 12.43 13.52 +1.09 road connectivity, development of horticulture, dairying, and other related agricultural fields.

Total food grains 53.09 55.45 +2.36 129.06 134.84 +5.78 National Agricultural Policy 1. Over 4 % annual growth rate aimed over next two decades.
Groundnut 0.79 1.08 +0.29 1.51 2.12 +0.61 2. Greater private sector participation through contract
The National Agriculture Policy aims to realise the vast farming.
Rapeseed &Mustard 6.36 6.63 +0.27 8.03 8.25 +0.22 untapped potential for growth in Indian agriculture, developing 3. Price protection for farmers.
Total Rabi Oilseeds 8.16 8.63 +0.47 10.15 10.96 +0.81 rural infrastructure, promote value addition, accelerate the 4. National agricultural insurance scheme to be launched.
growth of agro business, create employment in rural areas, 5. Dismantling of restrictions on movement of agricultural
Total Area /Production 61.25 64.08 +2.84 139.21 145.80 +06.59
secure a fair standard of living for the farmers and agricultural commodities throughout the country.
It is evident that the yield per hectare of food grains has shown variety of seeds, plant protection measures, fertilizers and workers and their families, discourage migration to urban areas 6. Rational utilisation of country’s water resources for
remarkable increase in the post Green Revolution period. irrigation. The growth was less impressive in the case of rice and face the challenges arising out of economic liberalization optimum use of irrigation potential.
The growth is comparatively less in the case of wheat where and minimal in pulses, as the latter is still grown in marginal and globalisation. The major features of the new agricultural 7. High priority to development of animal husbandry,
technology could provide an optimum mix of high-yielding lands under rain-fed conditions in vast areas of the country. policy are: poultry, dairy and aquaculture.
E-48 Agriculture Agriculture E-49

8. Capital inflow and assured markets for crop production. related to “sustainable agriculture” in the context of risks Impact of Green Revolution the dairy development through the co-operative societies.
9. Exemption from payment of capital gains tax on associated with climate change. It hopes to achieve its aims by •• The Green Revolution has resulted in phenomenal increase Prof. Verghese Kuerin was the father of White Revolution
compulsory acquisition of agricultural land. preparing appropriate adaptation and mitigation strategies for in the production of ‘wheat’ gain maximum benefit from in India. White revolution helped India become not only self
10. Minimise fluctuations in commodity prices. enhancing livelihood opportunities, ensuring food security and green Revolution. sufficient but also the largest dairy producer of the world.
11. Continuous monitoring of international prices. contributing to economic stability. It works through a network of co-operative societies which
•• This revolution led to prosperity of farmers, especially
are owned and managed by the milk producers. The co-
12. Plant varieties to be protected through a legislation. Rainfed area Development Programme (RADP): those who were having more than 10 hectares of land.
operative societies were most successful in the Anand District
13. Adequate and timely supply of quality inputs to farmers. RADP was launched by the government as a pilot scheme •• Increased production of food grains resulted in reduction of Gujarat. The main objectives of the co-operative society
14. High priority to rural electrification. under RKVY, focusing on small and marginal farmers and in imports. Also, sometimes India exported foodgrains. are the procurement, transportation, storage of milk at the
15. Setting up of agro-processing units and creation of off- farming systems. It targets integrated farming, on- farm water •• This revolution increased farmer’s income and farmer’s chilling plants. These co-operatives, apart from providing
farm employment in rural areas. management, storage, marketing and value addition of farm invested surplus income to increase agriculture productivity. financial help, also provide consultancy. The increase in milk
produce in order to enhance farmers’ income in rain-fed areas. The phenomenon of Green Revolution in India led to an production has also been termed as Operation Flood.
Major Agriculture Programmes increase in yields due to improved agronomic technology.
National e-Governance Plan in Agriculture The first phase of green revolution included introduction of Blue Revolution
The Central government supplements the efforts of the state
governments through centrally sponsored schemes. Some of NeGPA high-yielding varieties of crops and application of modern This is very similar to green revolution, but the focus here is
these major schemes are as follows : This aims to achieve rapid development of agriculture in agricultural techniques. This led to an increase in production on aquaculture and water preservation. It has been used in
India through ICT enabled  multiple delivery channels such needed to make India self-sufficient in food grains. The India for several years to increase the number of fresh water
National Food Security Mission (NFSM) as Internet, Government Offices, Touch Screen Kiosks, Krishi production of wheat produced the best results in fuelling self- fishes.
NFSM was launched in 2007-08 to increase the production of Vigyan  Kendras , Kisan Call Centres,  Agri-Clinics, Common sufficiency of India. Other positive effects of this phenomenon
rice, wheat and pulses by 10, 8 and 2 million tonnes respectively, were reduction in imports of food grains, prosperity of farmers, Evergreen Revolution
Service Centres, Mobile Phones for ensuring timely access to
by the end of 11th plan through productivity enhancement and development of industries, overall growth of economy and The emphasis in this revolution is on sustainable agriculture by
agriculture related information for the farmers of the country. 
area enhancement, enhancing farm level economy and creating many more. means of organic and green agriculture. Dr. MS Swaminathan
This includes information on pesticides, fertilizers, seeds, soil
employment opportunities. This has been extended to the 12th health, weather forecast, fishery inputs, drought relief and gave this concept. It includes the use of integrated pest
plan too with additional production targets.
Second Green Revolution management, nutrient supply and resource management.
management, etc.
Post green revolution, due to the rise in use of chemical
Rashtriya Krishi Vikas Yojana (RKVY) National Mission on Food Processing (NMFP) pesticides and fertilizers, there were negative effects on the Yellow Revolution
RKVY was launched in 2007-08 for the 11 plan to incentivize
th soil and the land such as land degradation, thereby becoming Yellow Revolution refers to a marked increase in the production
NMFP was launched in 2012. It is a centrally sponsored
states to enhance investment in agriculture and allied sectors ecologically untenable. Other challenges also became of oilseeds in India. It started in year 1986-87 and within a
scheme for giving greater role to states/ UTs, decentralised
to achieve 4% growth rate. The government has approved apparent. India achieved an increase in production of food decade India became a leading producer of oilseeds by the
administration, better outreach and effective supervision and
continuation of the RKVY scheme in the 12th plan whereby the grains so much so as to have an overflowing buffer stock, but years 1996-97.
monitoring. The NMFP would also provide flexibility to states/
funding will be routed into three components- the economic access to food was a huge problem. We had to This revolution can be attributed to governmental support
UTs in the selection of beneficiaries, location of projects, etc.
(i) production growth, export excess food which was not consumed by Indians due to especially the setting up of the Technology mission on oilseeds
for development of food processing industry in India.
(ii) infrastructure and assets, and lack of economic power. in 1986. Factors that played an important role in bringing
To counter these and other such problems, a Second Green yellow Revolution are:
(iii) sub-schemes and flexi-fund. Major Agricultural Revolutions Revolution is visualised and it will largely depend on Indo-US •• Institution support and linkages.
National Horticulture Mission (NHM) Green Revolution collaboration. •• Provision of extension and training in oilseeds technology.
NHM was launched in 2005-06 for promotion of holistic The Second Green Revolution seeks to minimise post-harvest •• Governments support price policy.
Introduction
growth of horticulture sector, including fruits, vegetables, wastage, improve storage and help Indian farmers meet •• Use of hybrid and improved varieties of seeds.
root and tuber crops, mushroom, spices, flowers, aromatic The world’s worst recorded disaster the Bengal famine, which the phyto-sanitary conditions so that they can participate
hit India in year 1943 claimed approximately 4 million lives. •• Provision of plant genetic resources.
plants, cashew and cocoa. Central share would be 85%, while productively in the global agricultural trade. The first Green
the states will contribute 15% of the share. From 2014-15, It was, therefore, first priority of the government to ensure Revolution was assisted by research undertaken by public
the Mission for Integrated Development in Horticulture food security for all. This led to various measures taken by institutions such as Universities. However, the Second Green Land Reforms
(MIDH) has been started by bringing all ongoing schemes government to increase production of food grain in the country. Revolution (appropriately also called Gene Revolution, Factors like the size of holdings, the pattern of ownership, the
related to horticulture under a single umbrella scheme. The green Revolution which began in year 1967/68 focused because of the predominance of Biotechnology) will be directed method of inheritance and security of tenure have a definite
on expansion of farming areas and use of high yield variety by proprietary research and governed by Intellectual Property impact on investment in agriculture. In pre-Independent India
Integrated Scheme For Oilseeds, Pulses, Oil seeds along with adoption of double cropping in the existing Rights. the following three types of land tenure system existed:
Palm And Maize (Isopom) farmland. Moreover, the research so far has been confined to crops of •• The Zamindari System It prevailed in Bengal, Bihar,
ISOPOM provides flexibility to states in implementation based It included a technology package. Comprising use of HYV high value meant solely for the market. No public or private Orissa and North Madras. It was introduced by the East
on a regionally differentiated approach for promoting crop of two staple cereals (rice and wheat), improved irrigation, sector has invested significantly in new genetic technologies for India Company and under it a class of revenue collectors,
diversification and providing a focus to the programme. This proper utilisation of fertilizer and pesticides and associate the so-called orphan crops such as cowpea, millet, sorghum, called zamindars, was created. These zamindars acted
scheme is under implementation in the country for increasing management skills. M.S. Swaminathan is considered father etc. which are critical for the food supply and livelihoods of as intermediaries between the cultivators and the
area, production and yield of these crops from 2004-05. The of Green Revolution in India. the world’s poorest people. The Second Green Revolution on government. Revenue was ‘settled’ by the government
pulses component was merged with NFSM w.e.f. April 2010. the other hand seeks to focus on such crops and increases their with zamindars, either permanently or temporarily. As
Objectives of the Green Revolution productivity too. long as the zamindar assured the remittance of the settled
National Mission for Sustainable Agriculture •• To ensure food security by increasing production of main revenue to the government he was free to fix and extort
(NMSA) crops like wheat, rice, etc. White Revolution any revenue from the tenant. This led to gross abuses and
NMSA is one of the eight missions outlined under National •• To increase agriculture productivity. It occurred in India in 1970, when the National Dairy exploitation and spread of rural poverty in Bengal and
Action Plan for Climate Change. It seeks to address issues •• To enhance modernisation of farm practices. Development Board (NDDB) was established to organise Bihar.

E-50 Agriculture Agriculture E-51

•• Mahalwari System It was introduced in North India It is the last type of farming which was sought to be encouraged Credit Development (ACD), Rural Planning and Credit Cell Government (50%), State Government (15%) and the
in terms of which the village community was jointly in the five-year plans. However, no breakthrough could be (RPCC) of RBI and the Agricultural Refinance Development sponsoring bank (35%). There were 196 RRBs covering
responsible for payment of rent. made due to: Corporation (ARDC). 427 districts with a total of 14475 branches. With a
•• Ryotwari System It was prevalent in parts of Madras, •• the farmer’s reluctance to alienate his land which is NABARD is associated with policy, planning, operation and view towards consolidating and strengthening RRBs, the
Bombay province and Assam. Under this system, the usually the only inheritance he has; even monitoring levels for providing agricultural credit. It has Government of India initiated a process of amalgamation
cultivator paid the revenues directly to the state without •• unscrupulous elements using the co-operative farming been jointly set up by the government and the Reserve Bank of RRBs, in a phased manner.
an intermediary. concept to circumvent land ceiling; of India.
NAFED
•• lack of political and administrative will.
Purpose Objectives of NABARD National Agricultural Co-operative Marketing federation of
The purpose of land reforms was to achieve the following three •• To provide refinance to banks and other credit institution India was established in 1958. It is the highest co-operative
Rural Credit and Extension Services in rural areas.
objectives: organistaion at the national level. Its major functions are
•• to increase production by ensuring security of tenure to Three types of loans are provided to Indian farmers to meet •• To promote institutional development. procurement, distribution, export and import of selected
the cultivator; their financial requirements - •• To evaluate, monitor and inspect client banks. agricultural commodities.
•• to increase the purchasing power of the rural population (i) Short term loans •• To act as a coordinator of rural credit institution.
and thereby boost the demand for industrial products; and
TRIFED
•• To act as a regulator for cooperative banks and RRBs.
These are provided for a period of less than 15 months The Tribal Co-operative Marketing Development Federation
•• to achieve social justice along with economic growth •• To maintain close link with RBI.
to meet out expenses of routine farming and domestic of India Limited came into existence in 1987. It is a national-
through a single set of measures rather than through Most of the functions of RBI in the area of agricultural credit
consumptions. This type of loan is demanded by farmers level apex organization functioning under the administrative
different, and sometimes contradictory, measures. have been taken over by NABARD.
for purchasing seeds, fertilizers and for meeting family control of Ministry of Tribal Affairs, Govt. of India. 
Major Land Reform Measures Taken after requirements. Function of NABARD
NCDC
Independence (ii) Medium term loans 1. It frames policies and guidelines for rural financial
National Cooperative Development Corporation was set up
Several important land reform measures were brought about These are provided for a period of 15 months to 5 years institutions.
by an Act of Parliament in 1963 as a statutory Corporation
by the government after Independence, like. to purchase agricultural equipments, animals and for land 2. It provides credit facilities to issuing organisation and
under Ministry of Agriculture and Farmers Welfare. It aims to
•• Abolition of intermediaries like zamindars, jagirdars, improvements. monitors flow of ground level rural credit.
provide financial assistance to co-operatives for infrastructure
etc. It resulted led in several states promulgating laws 3. It helps RRBs to prepare development action plans. and business development, for their economic upliftment,
for putting an end to ‘absentee landlordism’. As a result, (iii) Long term loans 4. It provides financial support for the training institutes of along with capacity building interventions.
about 30 lakh tenants acquired land ownership over an These are provided for a period of more than 5 years. co-operative banks, commercial banks and RRBs.
area of 62 lakh acres throughout the country. This type of loan is taken by farmers to purchase land and
•• Imposition of ceiling laws It laid down the maximum
5. It undertakes inspection of RRBs, Co-operative banks, Agricultural Insurance
expensive agricultural equipments and for repayment of rural development banks and apex credit co-operative
land that can be owned by a land holder (which was old loans. societies. Many crop insurance schemes are available in our country
subsequently amended to ‘holding’ by a family with effect During 2004-05 (up to December 2004) commercial such as,
from 1972). The excess land was to be surrendered to the banks accounted for 61 % of the total institutional credit Kisan Credit Card
government. to agriculture, RRBs for 11 % and co-operatives for 28 NABARD formulated a model scheme for issue of Kisan
AICIL
•• Consolidation of holding It was introduced as a measure %. Credit Cards (KCCs) to farmers so that they may use them to Agriculture Insurance Company of India Limited was
of improving farming efficiency. It made considerable readily purchase agricultural inputs such as seeds, fertilizers, incorporated in 2002 and is under the administrative control
progress in Punjab, Haryana and Western U.P. However, Co-operative Credit Societies (CCS) pesticides, etc. These are operated by commercial banks, of Ministry of Finance, Government of India, and under
it did not have much effect in the southern and eastern These are the most important source of rural credit. More than RRBs and co-operative banks. the operational supervision of Ministry of Agriculture,
states. 88,000 primary agricultural credit societies provided short- The scheme, introduced in 1998-99, has made rapid progress Government of India. It seeks to provide insurance coverage
The land reforms are included in the Ninth Schedule of the term loans of Rs. 34,520 crores during 2000-01. with the banking system. The scheme has helped in augmenting and financial support to the farmers in the failure of any of the
Constitution, thereby making these laws immune to judicial Co-operatives are organised on a three-tier system. Each state the flow of short-term crop loans for seasonal agricultural notified crop, to encourage the farmers to adopt progressive
challenge. However, implementation of these laws requires far has a State Co-operative Bank (SCB) and Central Co-operative operations of farmers. farming practices, high value in-puts and higher technology;
stronger political will than is required in including them in the Banks (CCBs) in each district with the Primary Agricultural From January 31, 2006, the scheme has been extended to all to help stabilize farm incomes, particularly in disaster years. 
Ninth Schedule. Credit Societies (PACS) as the lower tier. NABARD funding to types of loan requirements of borrowers of State Co-operative
PACS is routed only through state co-operative banks.
NAIS
Agriculture Rural Development Banks (SCARDBs). It covers
Co-operative Farming In addition to the above, Land Development Banks (LDBs) short-term/medium-term credit and long-term credit for National Agricultural Insurance Scheme is a central sector,
provide long-term rural credit for land improvement, soil agriculture and allied activities and a reasonable component of government sponsored crop insurance scheme, in operation
Co-operative farming had been advocated by Mahatma Gandhi since 1999. This scheme aims at tackling the issue of
conservation and other investments of a capital nature. LDBs consumption credit within the overall limit sanctioned to the
as far back as in 1942. Complete benefits of agriculture can be production risk faced by the agricultural sector. It provides
have now been renamed as State Co-operative Agricultural borrowers.
acquired through co-operative farming. financial support to the  farmers  in the failure of any of the
and Rural Development Banks (SCARDBs). They raise their
Co-operative farming can take the form of:
funds through long-term debentures offering state government Commercial Banks crops. The AICIL is the implementing agency of this scheme.
•• Co-operative tenant farming, where the society holds guarantee, and refinancing from NABARD. •• The CBs finance rural credit directly through Regional NAIS has been further modified as MNAIS with the aim of
the land and leases it to individual members; Rural Banks (RRBs). further helping the farm sector.
•• Co-operative collective farming, where land is National Bank for Agriculture and Rural •• Direct financing is mainly through crop loans and term
irrevocably surrendered to the collective; Development (NABARD) loans for equipment and machinery. Agricultural Marketing
•• Co-operative joint farming, where the farmers pool NABARD is the apex institution for providing credit facility to •• In 1975, five RRBs were set up to provide direct loans to Increase in agricultural production alone will not bring about
their land and reap the economies of scale, although the agricultural and rural areas. It came into existence on July 12, small and marginal farmers, rural artisans and agricultural prosperity for the farmers. It is essential that agricultural
ownership continues to remain with the individual farmer. 1982 and took over the functions of the erstwhile Agricultural labourers. The RRBs were co-sponsored by Central produce fetches a remunerative price too.
E-52 Agriculture Agriculture E-53

The Indian system of agricultural marketing suffers from a Agriculture Price Policy Blue Box subsidies reaching the truly needy and as a system for keeping general
number of defects, as a consequence of which the Indian farmer consumer prices in check. More than 80 % of grain to the Public
It includes direct payments to farmers to limit production and
is deprived of a fair price for his produce. The following are The main objectives of an agriculture price policy are: Distribution System is provided by the Punjab, Haryana and
certain government assistance to encourage agriculture and
the primary defects in the system of agricultural marketing in •• To ensure that the producer gets a minimum western Uttar Pradesh.
rural development in developing countries.
India. remunerative price. Blue Box subsidies are seen as being trade distorting. Food Corporation of India (FCI)
•• To maintain a reasonable terms of trade between
(i) Inadequate Warehouses agricultural sectors; Amber Box subsidies The Food Corporation of India (FCI) was established in
Unscientific methods of storage lead to considerable •• To maintain the general price level and protect the non- 1965, as the public sector marketing agency responsible for
It includes all agricultural subsidies that do not fall into either
wastage. The setting up of Central Warehousing producing consumer from violent fluctuations in price implementing government price policy through procurement
blue or green boxes. These include government policies of and public distribution operations. It was responsible for
Corporation and State Warehousing Corporations has of food grains. Minimum support Prices (MSP) for agricultural products securing for the government a commanding position in the
improved the situation. During the pre-green revolution period, due to the shortage or any help directly related to production quantities (e.g. food-grain trade. By 1979, the Corporation was operating in
in domestic production, the terms of trade were in favour power, fertiliser, seeds, pesticides, irrigation, etc.). These
(ii) Lack of grading and standardisation all states as the sole agent of the central government in food-
of the agriculture sector. However, with the surplus of food are subject to reduction commitment to the de-minimus level grain procurement. The Corporation uses the services of state
Different varieties of agricultural produce are not graded grains in the years following the green revolution, the policy of agricultural outputs- to 5% for developed and 10% for government agencies and co-operatives in its operations.
properly and hence, do not meet official standardisation shifted towards protecting the farmers from the prospect of developing countries.
non- remunerative prices. FCI is the sole repository of food-grains reserved for the
requirements fully. India insisted that developed countries should first dismantle Public Distribution System. Food-grains, primarily wheat and
The Commission for Agricultural Costs and Prices (CACP) their agricultural subsidy structure before asking developing rice, account for between 60 and 75 % of the Corporation’s
(iii) Inadequate transport facilities formerly known as the Agricultural Prices Commission countries to open up their market for farm imports. Our total annual purchases.
Most of the roads are not cemented and therefore, are analyzes the input costs and recommends the minimum emphasis has been on making farm trade fair before it is made
unfit for motor vehicles. Thus, the produce has to be support prices for 24 major crops. MSP announced by free. TPDS Targeted
the government is that price at which government is ready
carried on slow moving transport vehicles like bullock Targeted PDS (TPDS) means targeting the PDS to the poor.
to purchase the crop from farmers directly if the crop prices
carts, and this is one of the reasons that farmers sell their
become lower than MSP. As a result, market price of the crop
Public Distribution System This system started when the procurement and issue prices of
products to the nearest mandis even if prices offered there PDS items saw a rise with the ushering in of economic reforms
are fairly low.
never comes down from the level of MSP. The minimum Objectives of Public Distribution System in the 1990s. Thus, while till 1992 any one could avail of
price security gives incentives to farmers to increase their
The objectives of “public Distribution system” are as follows: the PDS, beginning from 1996-97, the TPDS targeted only
production. However, historically, the actual support prices
(iv) Presence of a large number of middlemen are fixed far above the recommended prices due to intense •• To protect the low income groups by guaranteeing the poor households across all regions. The below poverty line
The chain of middlemen in the agricultural marketing lobbying by the interested parties. Procurement price and supply of certain minimum quantity of food grains at (BPL) households were identified and were provided with
system is so prevalent that the share of farmers has minimum support price are different from each other. affordable price. food-grains at very low prices. From March 2000, the above
reduced substantially. •• To ensure equitable distribution of food grains. poverty line (APL) cardholders had to pay a much increased
Procurement price (PP) is that price at which government
purchases the crop after harvesting, while Minimum •• To control price fluctuation of essential commodities in price. The ‘poorest of the poor’ category was established by
(v) Malpractices in unregulated markets Support price (MSP) is the minimum price at which the open market. the ‘Antyodaya’ programme. Those under this category are
government declares it will buy the crop. Since 1968-69, the entitled to avail rice and wheat at prices lower than those for
Even after so many years since the advent of technological
changes in the Indian agricultural system, the number of MSP is usually the procurement price. Features BPL households.
unregulated markets in the country is substantially large. Apart from fixing support prices, government action in Features of Public Distribution system are: Points to Remember
Agents or brokers, taking advantage of the ignorance and holding the price consists of: 1. PDS is a system of distribution of selected essential
After independence Indian Government undertook various
illiteracy of farmers, use unfair means and cheat them. Buffer stocking, which is the practice of holding large commodities through ‘fair price shops’ which are operated
measures to improve the condition of Agriculture.
Another malpractice in the mandis relates to the use of stocks by government agencies like Food Corporation of by private dealers.
India (FCI) and releasing the stocks in the market to counter •• The ‘Land Reform’ measures and ‘Green Revolution’
wrong weights and measures. 2. Items which are distributed through PDS are rice, wheat,
price rise. The buffer stock also helps to maintain the Public were the greatest achievements of the Indian
Sugar, edible oil and kerosine
Government in enhancing the agricultural production
(vi) Inadequate market information Distribution System (PDS). 3. The purpose of PDS is to offer basic minimum quantity of and productivity.
Most of the farmers have virtually no contact with the Import of food grains in case shortage is apprehended. There essential commodities at lowest price to poorer sections of
has not been an occasion to resort to imports since 1996 •• Between 1950 and 1990, there was a substantial
mandis. As a result, they accept whatever price the society.
largely because of the vast stock of food grain accumulated increase in the agricultural productivity. As a result of
trader offers to them. The government is using radio and 4. The required commodities are acquired by the government Green Revolution, India became self sufficient in food
by the FCI. through procurement or import and a buffer stock is
television media to broadcast market prices regularly so production.
as to tackle this very problem. maintained. •• Land Reforms resulted in abolition of Zamindari system.
WTO and Agricultural Subsidies Public Distribution System (PDS) was conceived as a primary •• The proportion of GDP contributed by agriculture
(vii) Inadequate credit facilities The WTO Agreement on Agriculture (AoA), 1995 permitted the social welfare and poverty alleviation programme of the changed significantly, but not the population depending
The Indian small and marginal farmers are poor and developed countries to continue to provide farm subsidies, but government to ensure price stabilisation in the grain market. on it.
lack staying power. They try to sell off the produce under certain restrictions. In WTO terminology, agricultural
Achievements •• Around 65% of the country’s population continued to
immediately after the crop is harvested though prices at subsidies have been segregated into various ‘boxes’:
be employed in agriculture, even till as late as 1990’s.
that time are very low. Government’s objective of providing reasonable prices for
Green Box subsidies basic food commodities like food grains, sugar, edible oil and
Agricultural output could have increased with much
Warehousing and marketing facilities are essential to less people working in this sector, but industrial and
It includes amounts spent on research, disease control, kerosene is achieved through the Public Distribution System
ensure that these defects are overcome. The Government service sectors required the extra people involved in
infrastructure and food security. These also include direct of India, the largest PDS of the world. Channelling basic
has come out with solutions such as agriculture price agriculture. This was regarded as a major failure of
payments made to farmers such as income support that do not food commodities through the PDS serves as a conduit for
policy and maintaining buffer stocks so as to assist policies followed during the planning periods.
stimulate production. These are not considered trade distorting
marketing of agricultural produce. and are encouraged.

E-54 Agriculture Agriculture E-55

24. Which one of the following methods of soil conservation 32. The central nodal agency for implementing the price
is most effective in arid areas? support operations for commercial crops is:
(a) Mulching (b) Shelter belt (a) NAFED (b) NABARD
(c) Gully plugging (d) Terracing (c) TRIFED (d) FCI
11. When the Kisan Credit Card schemes for the farmers 25. NABARD was established in the 33. Which among the following has been discontinued after
1. First Agricultural University in India was established in
started in India? (a) Fourth Five Year Plan the Cabinet decision in small saving schemes?
(a) Jabalpur (b) Kanpur (a) National Saving Certificates (NSC)
(c) Faizabad (d) Pant Nagar (a) 1995–1996 (b) 1998–1999 (b) Fifth Five Year Plan
(c) 2005–2006 (d) 2007–2008 (c) Sixth Five Year Plan (b) Kisan Vikas Patras (KVP)
2. Which one of the following agencies is not included in (c) Monthly Income Scheme (MIS)
the operation of the Kisan Credit Cards? 12. Which one of the following apex co-operative organisation (d) Eighth Five Year Plan
at the national level of India? 26. In India, which of the following has the highest share (d) Recurrent Deposit Schemes
(a) Co-operative Banks 34. Which of the following is an apex financing agency for
(b) Regional Rural Banks (a) TRIFED (b) NAFED in the disbursement of credit to agriculture and allied
(c) FCS (d) RRBs activities? the institutions providing investment and production
(c) Scheduled Commercial Banks credit for promoting the various developmental activities
(d) NABARD 13. Which one of the following co-operative societies is (a) Commercial Banks
responsible for the production of fertilizers? (b) Co-operative Banks in rural areas ?
3. Which one of the following is the objective of the (a) RBI (b) NABARD
(a) NAFED (b) IFFCO (c) Regional Rural Banks
National Watershed Development project for rainfed (c) SIDBI (d) RRB
(c) NCDC (d) TRI FED (d) Microfinance Institutions
areas of India? 35. In 1982, the Rural Planning and Credit Cell (RPCC)
14. Which one of the following states is the first state to 27. An objective of the National Food Security Mission is to
(a) Sustainable farming systems of Reserve Bank of India was merged to which of the
impose Agriculture Income Tax in India? increase the production of certain crops which are
(b) Integrated Watershed Management (a) Madhya Pradesh (b) Uttar Pradesh following banks?
(c) Reclanation of Forest Area (a) Rice and wheat only (a) SIDBI (b) NABARD
(c) West Bengal (d) Bihar (b) Rice, wheat and pulses only
(d) Both ‘a’ and ‘b’ 15. Which one of the following five year plans has the highest (c) IDBI (d) RRB
4. Which one among the following Agricultural sectors is (c) Rice, wheat, pulses and oil seeds only 36. Which among the following states is the highest producer
growth rate in Agriculture sector in India ? (d) Rice, wheat, pulses, oil seeds and vegetables
covered under the market Intervention scheme (MIS) of (a) Sixth Five Year Plan of Soya bean in India?
the Indian Government? 28. What will be the ultimate impact on the poor and landless (a) Uttar Pradesh (b) Andhra Pradesh
(b) Seventh Five Year Plan
(a) Forestry (b) Irrigation farmers if all of a sudden, government decides to raise the (c) Rajasthan (d) Madhya Pradesh
(c) Eighth Five Year Plan
(c) Horticulture (d) Animal Husbandry (d) Ninth Five Year Plan Minimum Support Prices of rice & foodgrains inexorably 37. Which among the following is largest producer of wheat
5. The price at which the Government purchase foodgrains 16. National Seed Policy, 2002 was based on the or excessively? in India?
for maintaining the public distribution system and for recommendation of (a) The poor farmers will become rich (a) Punjab (b) Uttar Pradesh
building up buffer stocks are known as (a) Kelkar Committee (b) The markets will crash (c) Rajasthan (d) Madhya Pradesh
(a) Minimum support prices (b) M.V Rao Committee (c) The poor farmers will get poorer 38. The Rural Infrastructure Development Fund (RIDF),
(b) Procurement prices (c) Y.V Reddy Committee (d) This will encourage the exports of rice and food which is used by the state governments to develop
(c) Issue prices (d) Abhijit Sen Committee grains infrastructure in rural areas, is managed by which among
(d) Coiling prices 17. When was the National Food Security Mission (NFSM) 29. Which among the following is the largest food item the following?
6. Which one of the following agencies assigns the launched in India? imported by India? (a) IDBI (b) RBI
Agricultural Income Tax to states in India? (a) Rabi Season (1999–2000) (a) Vegetable Oils (c) NABARD (d) Rural Ministry of India
(a) Inter – State council (b) Kharif Season (1999–2000) (b) Food Grains 39. Which among the following commodity come under the
(b) National Development Council (c) Rabi Season (2007–2008) (c) Milk and Dairy Products preview of Open Market Sale Scheme of the Government
(c) Agriculture Finance Corporation (d) Kharif Season (2007–2008) (d) Meat and Poultry products of India to maintain a minimum buffer stock for meeting
(d) Finance commission 18. The Bonded Labour System (Abolition) Act was legislated 30. What is the main motive of the government behind having the unforeseen exigencies like drought, flood and other
7. Which one of the following agencies of Indian in a dual price system & setting up of fair price shops? natural calamities and also for providing food grains
(a) 1974 (b) 1976 (a) To demote speculation and hoarding required for Public Distribution System and the other food
Government implements the price support scheme (PSS)?
(c) 1977 (d) 1978 (b) To incentivise the trading of essential commodities grain based welfare programmes of the Government?
(a) FCI
19. In which of the following years was the Food Corporation (c) To eliminate the monopoly of the traders and (a) Wheat only
(b) NAFED
of India (FCI) set up ? (b) Wheat & Rice
(c) Agriculture pricing agency of India speculators
(a) 1955 (b) 1960 (c) Wheat , Rice and Pulses
(d) None of the above (d) To make the essential commodities available to the
(c) 1965 (d) 1970 (d) Wheat , Rice and Oilseeds
8. Which one of the following is not included in the weaker sections of the society
20. Rashtriya Krishi Vikas Yojna was launched in the year? 40. Which among the following facility has been started in
Agriculture and Allied Services of Indian Economy? 31. Which among the following is an example of Green Field
(a) 2003 (b) 2004 India for refinance assistance for small irrigation, IRDP,
(a) Fishing (b) Forestry Investment? Dairy Development and Mechanism of farms?
(c) 2006 (d) 2007
(c) Logging (d) Food Processing 21. “Everything else can wait, but not agriculture”. The (a) Investment made by a real estate company in (a) National Credit Fund
9. In which five year plan in Indian Economy, the targets statement is attributed to agriculture land to develop it later when the land (b) National Rural Credit Fund
for the crop function were not fixed for the first time- (a) Jagjivan Ram (b) J.L. Nehru prices increase (c) National Credit Stabilization Fund
(a) Seventh five year plan (c) Mahatma Gandhi (d) Sardar Patel (b) Investment made by a company in a new factory (d) Rural Infrastructural Development Fund
(b) Eighth five year plan 22. The head office of the National Bank for Agriculture and complex in a remote land of the country where there 41. Which programme targets integrated farming, on- farm
(c) Ninth five year plan Rural Development (NABARD) located in was no facilities water management, storage marketing and value addition
(d) Tenth five year plan (a) Lucknow (b) Hyderabad (c) Investment made by a company to clean up a of farm produce in order to enhance farmers’ income in
10. The importance of agriculture in Indian Economy is (c) New Delhi (d) Mumbai cement factory located in populated area because of rainfed areas?
indicated by its contribution to which of the following? 23. Which is not a source of Agriculture finance in India? its pollution and using it for a commercial office (a) Integrated Scheme for Oilseeds, Pulses, Oil Palm
(a) National income and employment (a) Co-operative societies purpose and Maize
(b) Industrial development and international trade (b) Commercial Banks (d) Investment made by a company to clean up a cement (b) National Mission for Sustainable Agriculture
(c) Supply of foodgrains (c) Regional Rural Banks factory located in populated area because of its (c) Mission for Integrated Development in Horticulture
(d) All of the above (d) None of these pollution and using it for a residential purpose (d) Rainfed Area Development Programme
E-56 Agriculture Agriculture E-57

13. Consider the following statements: (a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1, 2 and 4


1. Regarding the procurement of foodgrains, (c) 1, 3 and 4 (d) 2, 3 and 4
Government of India follows a procurement target 18. Consider the following statements ;
rather than an open-ended procurement policy. 1. The Union Government fixes the Statutory Minimum
2. Government of India announces minimum support Price of sugarcane for each sugar season
1. It seeks to minimise post-harvest wastage
Statement Based MCQ 2. It will focus on improved storage
prices only for cereals 2. Sugar and sugarcane are essential commodities
3. For distribution under Targeted Public Distribution under the Essential Commodities Act.
3. It will help the Indian farmers meet phyto-sanitary
1. Index ‘Residex’ is associated with- System (TPDS), wheat and rice are issued by the Which of the statements .given above is/are correct?
conditions
1. Share Prices 2. Mutual Fund Prices Government of India at uniform Central issue prices (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
4. It will equip the Indian farmers to participate more
3. Price Inflation Index 4. Land Prices to the States/Union Territories. (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
fully in global agricultural trade
Choose the right option Which of the statements given below above is/are correct? 19. Increase in wheat production depends on
Which of these statement/s is/are correct?
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 (a) 1 and 2 (b) 2 only 1. Area expansion
(a) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (b) 1, 3 and 4
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only (c) 1 and 3 (d) 3 only 2. Developing marketing infrastructure
(c) 4 only (d) 2, 3 and 4
2. Green Revolution has led to: 14. Consider the following statements. 3. Better inputs
8. With reference to India’s food policy, consider the
1. Spurt in production of all food grains. 1. The loans disbursed to farmers under Kisan Credit (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
following statements:
2. Greater regional inequalities Card Scheme are covered under Rashtiya Krishi (c) 1, 2 and 3 (d) 2 and 3
1. It seeks to avert famines by maintaining a buffer
3. reduction in inter-personal inequalities. Bema Yojna of Life Insurance Corporation of India 20. Which statements regarding wheat production is/ are
stock
4. Increase in production of wheat. 2. The Kisan Credit Card holders are provided personal
2. It ensures remunerative price for the farmers so that incorrect?
(a) 1 and 3 (b) 1, 2 and 3 accident insurance of ` 50,000 for accidental death
they do not switch crops 1. Maximum area under wheat is in Uttar Pradesh
(c) 2, 3 and 4 (d) 2 and 4 and ` 25,000 for permanent disability.
3. It encourages surplus production for the export 2. Maximum production is in Uttar Pradesh
3. Increase in agricultural production is due to: Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
market 3. Highest productivity is in Haryana
1. increase in cultivable area. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
2. improvement in yield 4. It aims to maintain general price line. (a) 1 and 3 (b) 2 only
Which of these statements are correct? (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (c) 1 and 2 (d) 3 only
3. better cropping pattern 15. Consider the following statements:
4. implementation of land reforms: (a) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (b) 1 and 4 21. Which of the fallowing are responsible for the decrease
(c) 1, 2 and 4 (d) 1 and 2 India continues to be dependent on imports to meet the of per capita holding of cultivated land in India?
(a) 1 and 3 (b) l and 2 requirement of oilseeds in the country because
(c) 1, 2 and 3 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 9. The purpose of the tenancy reform legislation was to: 1. Low per capita income.
1. afford security of tenure to tenants 1. farmers prefer to grow foodgrains with highly
4. Consider the following statements 2. Rapid rate of increase of population.
2. enact fixation of air rent remunerative support prices.
1. Food for Work Programme was launched in India 3. Practice of dividing land equally among the heirs.
3. conferment of ownership right on tenants in some 2. most of the cultivation of oilseed crops continues to
during the 10th Five Year Plan. 4. Use of traditional techniques of ploughing.
cases be dependent on rainfall
2. The Planning commission in India is a constitutional Select the correct answer using the codes given below
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 3. oils from the seeds to tree origin and rice bran have
body. (a) 1 and 2 (b) 2 and 3
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? (c) 1 and 2 (d) 1, 2 and 3 remained unexploited
(c) 1 and 4 (d) 2,3 and 4
(a) Only 1 (b) Only 2 10. Which of the following are features of Indian agriculture? 4. it is far cheaper to import oilseeds than to cultivate
22. Which among the following statements is/are true with
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 1. Disguised unemployment the oilseed crops
regard to WTO membership?
5. The consequences of colonialism on Indian agriculture 2. High productivity Which of the statements given above are correct?
1. All WTO members automatically receive the ‘most
were: 3. Majority of large farmers (a) 1 and 2 (b) 1, 2 and 3
favoured nation’ status.
1. fragmentation of holdings 4. Dependent on monsoon (c) 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4
2. Over 75% of WTO members are from developing
2. impoverishment of the peasantry (a) 1 and 2 (b) 2 and 3 16. In India, rural incomes are generally lower than the
urban incomes, which of the following reasons account countries, WTO membership allows them access to
3. eviction of land owners for non-payment of dues (c) 2 and 4 (d) 1 and 4
for this? developed markets at the lower tariff.
4. better farming practices 11. Indian poverty is said to be predominantly rural. Yet
1. A large number of farmers are illiterate and know Select the correct answer using the codes given below.
5. Commercialization of agriculture the problem of urban poverty appears to have reached
little about scientific agriculture (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(a) 1, 2 and 4 (b) 1, 2, 3 and 5 unmanageable proportions. The paradox is explained by:
(c) 2, 3 and 4 (d) 2, 3 and 5 2. Prices of primary products are lower than those of (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
1. greater visibility of urban poverty 23. Ministry of Agriculture has decided that despite adequate
6. With reference to Indian agriculture, consider the manufactured products
2. migration of rural population to urban areas stocks of wheat and rice, India will not export these
following statements: 3. Investment in agriculture has been low when
3. seasonality of agricultural operations commodities. What are the reason(s) for this decision ?
1. Agriculture provides direct livelihood to 59% of the compared to investment in industry.
4. the cycle of drought and floods 1. Indian variety of wheat and rice are in limited
labour force in India. Codes:
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 demand abroad.
2. It contributes more than 20% to the GDP (a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1 and 2
3. It accounts for about 10% of the total value of (c) 1 and 4 (d) All of these 2. National Food Security Bill provides 25 kg of wheat
(c) 1 and 3 (d) 2 and 3
India’s commodity exports 12. Which of the following statements with regard to Indian or rice to all BPL families. Huge stock of grains will
17. Which of the following are the objectives of the
4. Almost 80% of the area under agriculture is Agriculture is/are true? Commission for Agricultural Costs and Prices (CACP)? be needed for this initiative.
irrigated. 1. Although rice is the most important cereal being 1. To stabilize agricultural prices 3. As nations recover from global recession, a formula is
Which of the above statement/s is/are correct? cultivated in India in terms of total production, wheat 2. To ensure meaningful real income levels to the being worked out, where imports and exports will be
(a) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (b) 1, 2 and 3 is fast catching up. farmers conducted by exchange of surplus commodities with
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only 2. Green revolution did not make an impact on the 3. To protect the interest of the consumers by providing the trading nations. India will use its food stocks for
7. Consider the following statements regarding the production of pulses. essential agricultural commodities at reasonable such trade.
objectives of the Second Green Revolution announced in (a) 2 only (b) 1 only rates through public distribution system. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
2005: (c) 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 4. To ensure maximum price for the farmer (c) 3 only (d) All 1, 2 and 3

E-58 Agriculture Agriculture E-59

24. As a policy to boost the agricultural sector, the GOI has Which of the statements given above is/are correct? 36. Consider the following statements : 1. Paper
taken special measures over time. Which of the following (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 1. In the Eleventh Five Year Plan, the average 2. Hank Yarn
are not a measure with a direct impact on the agricultural (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 foodgrains production was more than 200 million 3. Fertilizers
sector? 30. Consider the following statements about the National tonnes. 4. Petroleum and Petroleum Products
1. Setting up of a National Food Processing Bank Cooperative Marketing Federation of India Limited 2. The main reason for the increase in the production of 5. Cotton and Jute seeds
2. Opening irrigation, sanitation and water projects for (NAFED). the coarse cereals in 2000s is mainly due to increase (a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1, 3 and 4
Private Participation. 1. NAFED promotes the inter-state trade as well as in demand of coarse cereals as a nutri-food. (c) 3, 4 and 5 (d) 2, 3, 4 and 5
3. Efforts to reduce fiscal deficit to 5.5 per cent export of certain agricultural commodities to many Which of the statements given above is/are correct? 43. Consider the following statements:
level of GDP foreign countries. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
1. 14 major dairying states account for more than 90%
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 2. NAFED is responsible for the movement of the (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
essential commodities from surplus areas to scarcity of India’s Milk Production
(c) 3 only (d) 1 and 2 37. Consider the following statements :
areas. 1. India is the 4th largest producer of Natural Rubber 2. National Dairy Plan was launched to improve the
25. Consider the following statements
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? in the world. quality of Milch animals in these 14 states
1. The recent decision of Government of India to
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 2. India in the world, shares more than 8.0% in the Which among the above statements is / are correct?
partially decontrol the sugar industry gives the
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 Natural Rubber Production. (a) Only 1 is correct
millers the freedom to sell sugar in open market
31. Consider the following statements about the Agriculture Which of the statements given above is/are correct? (b) Only 2 is correct
and removes their obligation to supply sugar at
subsidised rates to ration shops. Income Tax (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (c) Both 1 and 2 are correct
1. Agriculture Income Tax is levied and collected by (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 is correct
2. C. Rangarajan panel also suggested decontrolling of
the Union Government. 38. Consider the following statements : 44. Consider the following statements:
sugar industry in India.
2. Agriculture Income Tax is levied throughout the 1. India is the 6th largest producer of coffee. 1. Among Fruits, Largest Area under cultivation in
Which of the statements given above is/ are correct?
country in India. 2. India’s share in Global Area under coffee is about India is that of Banana
(a) Only 1 (b) Only 2
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? 2%. 2. Among Fruits, Largest Production is India is that of
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 3. India contributes about 4% to world coffee Mango
26. Consider the following statements :
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 production as well as in the International trade.
1. National Agricultural Insurance Scheme (NAIS) was Which among the above is / are correct statements?
32. Consider the following statements : Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
launched in the Sixth Five Year Plan of the Indian (a) Only 1 is correct
1. In India, more than 85% agriculture workers are (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
Economy. mainly casual labourers. (b) Only 2 is correct
(c) 1 and 2 (d) 1, 2 and 3
2. The growth rate of the primary sector of the Indian 2. Agriculture labourers in India are mainly dominated (c) Both statements are correct
39. Consider the following statements :
Economy sector never reached 8% during the by the backward classes. (d) Both statements are incorrect
1. The farm power availability in India is much lower
planning history of Indian economy. Which of the statements given above is/are correct? 45. Consider the following statements:
than that of Korea.
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 1. Both Coffee and Tea prefer slightly acidic Soil
2. India is meeting 80% of its urea requirement through
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Netiher 1 nor 2 indigenous production. 2. Both Coffee and Tea show winter dormancy
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 33. Consider the following statements : Which of the statements given above is/are correct? Which among the above statements is / are correct?
27. With reference to the agriculture sector of India, consider 1. Regional Rural Banks grant direct loans and (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (a) Only 1 is correct
the following statements advances to marginal farmers and rural artisans. (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (b) Only 2 is correct
1. Rural infrastructure Development Fund disperses 2. NABARD is responsible for laying down policies 40. Consider the following: (c) Both 1 and 2 are correct
loans to the states to complete the minor irrigation and to oversee the operations of the RRBs. 1. Uneconomic & Fragmented Holdings (d) Neither 1 nor 2 is / are correct
projects. Which of the statements given above is/are correct? 2. Inefficient Labor Force 46. Consider the following statements:
2. Rural infrastructure Development Fund is managed (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 3. No use of HYV seeds 1. Most of the wool produced in India is not enough to
by the public sector Commercial Banks. (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 Which among the above is/ are the reasons for low fulfill demand of the country
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? 34. Consider the following statements : productivity in Indian Agriculture? 2. Most of the wool produced in India is NOT of
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 1. National project for Cattle and Buffalo Breeding (a) Only 1 (b) Only 1 & 2
(NPCBB) was started for genetic improvement. apparel grade
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (c) Only 2 & 3 (d) 1, 2 & 3
28. Consider the following statements : 2. National Project for Cattle and Buffalo Breeding Which among the above statements is are correct ?
41. Public Distribution System (PDS) means distribution
1. Central warehousing corporation is responsible for (NPCBB) was launched in 2000. (a) Only 1 is correct
of essential commodities to a large number of people
the construction and running of the godowns for Which of the statements given above is/are correct? (b) Only 2 is correct
through a network of Fair Price Shops on a recurring
storage of agriculture products. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (c) Both 1 and 2 are correct
basis. The Commodities distributed under PDS are:
2. Central warehousing corporation of India was (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 is correct
(1) Wheat (2) Rice
established in 1957. 35. Consider the following statements about National (3) Sugar (4) Pulses 47. Consider the following statements:
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? Watershed Development project for rainfed areas (5) Kerosene 1. All kinds of Development Banks in India appeared
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only Select the correct option: Post-Independence
launched in India?
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 1. National Watershed Development Project for rainfed (a) 1,2 and 4 (b) 1, 2, 3 and 4 2. NABARD is the only agricultural Development
29. Consider the following statements : areas was launched in 1990-91. (c) 1, 2, 3 and 5 (d) All of the above Bank in India
1. Agriculture including allied activities accounted for 2. National Watershed Development Project for rainfed 42. The government has powers under the Essential Which among the above statements is / are correct?
about 55% employment in the country according to areas was launched throughout the country. Commodities Act, 1955 (EC Act) to declare a commodity (a) Only 1 is correct
census 2011. Which of the statements given above is/are correct? as an essential commodity to ensure its availability to (b) Only 2 is correct
2. The growth in agriculture and allied sectors is a (a) 1 only (b) 2 only people at fair price. The Commodities covered under the (c) Both 1 and 2 are correct
necessary condition for inclusive growth in India. (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 Act include: (d) Neither 1 nor 2 is correct
E-60 Agriculture Agriculture E-61

48. Consider the following statements: 54. In the context of food and nutritional security of India, 59. What is a Green Box subsidy? growth, infrastructure and assets, and sub-schemes
1. Price Stabilization Fund Scheme was launched for enhancing the ‘Seed Replacement Rates’ of various crops I. These include direct payments to farmers to limit and flexi-fund.
Coffee, Tea, Rubber and Tobacco growers in the helps in achieving the food production targets of the production and certain government assistance to (a) Only I (b) Only II
country future. But what is/ are the constraint/ constraints in encourage agriculture and rural development in (c) All the above (d) None of the above
2. In this scheme Government procures the commodities its wider/greater implementation? developing countries 64. Which is correct with respect to second green revolution?
when the prices fell below a certain level to support 1. There is no National Seeds Policy in place. II. These include government policies of Minimum I. It seeks to minimize post-harvest wastage
the growers 2. There is no participation of private sector seed support Prices (MSP) for agricultural products or II. Improve storage and help Indian farmers meet the
Which among the above statements is/ are correct ? companies in the supply of quality seeds of any help directly related to production quantities (for phyto-sanitary conditions so that they can participate
vegetables and planting materials of horticultural eg. power, fertiliser, seeds, pesticides, irrigation productively in the global agricultural trade.
(a) Only 1 is correct
crops. etc.). III. It is assisted by research undertaken by public
(b) Only 2 is correct
3. There is a demand-supply gap regarding quality III. These include amounts spent on research, disease institutions such as Universities.
(c) Both 1 and 2 are correct
seeds in case of low value and high volume crops. control, infrastructure and food security IV. It is directed by proprietary research and governed
(d) Neither 1 nor 2 is correct Select the correct answer using the code given below. (a) I & III (b) Only II by Intellectual Property Rights.
49. Consider the following: (a) 1 and 2 (b) 3 only (c) Only III (d) III & II (a) I & II (b) I, II & III
1. Prevent Black marketing (c) 2 and 3 (d) None of these 60. Which statement is correct according to the growth and (c) I, II & IV (d) All the above
2. Trade and earn revenue 55. Which among the below are the products in which India productivity of agriculture?
3. Become the sole controller of food grain supply 65. Which of the following is correct statement?
is 1st in the world? I. The total irrigated area increased from less than
Which among the above is/ are the primary objective I. Agriculture is the primary occupation in India as it
I. Milk one million hectares per annum before the green
of the government to buy food grains directly from the provides direct livelihood to 59% of its labour force
II. Pulses revolution to about 2.5 million hectares per annum
farmers? II. In India, 75% of below the poverty line (BPL)
III. Spices during the 1970’s
(a) Only 1 (b) Only 1 & 3 IV. Jute population lives in rural areas, and is directly or
II. The total gross irrigated area now is 40 million indirectly dependent on agriculture.
(c) Only 2 & 3 (d) 1, 2 & 3 (a) I, II & III (b) I, II & IV hectares.
(c) II, III &IV (d) All the above III. Agriculture contributes to more than 13.7% (2013)
50. Public Distribution System (PDS) is operated under the III. The yield per hectare of food grains has shown
56. What are the features of Indian agriculture? of GDP, although this share has progressively
responsibility of the: remarkable increase in the pre Green Revolution
I. Agriculture is the primary occupation in India as declined from 57% in 1950-51.
1. Central Government period.
it provides direct livelihood to 70% of its labour IV. In developed countries, like the UK and USA, the
2. State Governments (a) Only I (b) I & II
force. share of agriculture in GDP is only around 2%.
(a) Only 1 (b) Only 2 (c) I & III (d) None of the above
II. Agriculture contributes to about 10% of the total (a) I & II (b) I & III
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 61. Which statement is correct regarding NAIS?
value of India’s commodity exports. (c) I, II & III (d) All the above
51. Arrange the following in the descending order of the I. It is a central sector, government sponsored crop
III. Almost 30% of tea and 50% of coffee and jute 66. What are the factors that have a definite impact on
largest agricultural imports of India: insurance scheme, in operation since 1999.
produced in the country are exported. investment in agriculture?
1. Pulses II. It provides financial support to the farmers in the
(a) I,II,III (b) I & II I. Size of holdings
2. Wood and Wood Products failure of any of the crops.
(c) II & III (d) All the above II. The pattern of ownership
3. Edible Vegtable Oils III. The AICIL is the implementing agency of this
57. What are long term loans? scheme. III. The method of inheritance and security of tenure
(a) 1-2-3 (b) 1-3-2 (a) Only I (b) I & II
I. These are provided for a period of less than 15 (a) I & II (b) Only II
(c) 2-1-3 (d) 3-2-1 months to meet out expenses of routine farming and (c) All the above (d) None of the above
52. Vegetable Oil has been India’s largest non-oil import (c) Only III (d) All the above
domestic consumptions 62. Which of the following statement is correct? 67. Which of the following statement is correct according to
commodity. In this context please consider the following II. These are provided for a period of 15 months to 5 Zamindari System?
reasons. I. ISOPOM provides flexibility to states in
years to purchase agricultural equipments, animals implementation based on a regionally differentiated I. The Zamindari System prevailed in Bengal, Bihar,
1. The Food grain are grown more in India because of and for land improvements. Orissa.
the remunerative support prices approach for promoting crop diversification and
III. These are provided for a period of more than 5 providing a focus to the programme. II. It was introduced by the East India Company
2. The Oil seed cultivation in India is mostly dependent years. and under it a class of revenue collectors, called
II. This scheme is under implementation in the country
upon the Rain fed Areas (a) Only II (b) Only I zamindars, was created.
for increasing area, production and yield of these
3. The import of Vegetable oil has been cost effective (c) Only III (d) None of the above III. Revenue was ‘settled’ by the government with
crops from 2009-10
Which among the above statements hold correct ? 58. What is National Food Security Mission? zamindars, either permanently or temporarily.
III. The pulses component was merged with NFSM
(a) 1 & 2 I. Mission to increase the production of rice, wheat and IV. Revenue was ‘settled’ by the.
w.e.f. April 2013.
(b) 2 & 3 pulses by 10, 8 and 2 million tonnes respectively. (a) I, II & IV (b) I & II
Which is correct?
(c) 1 & 3 II. To enhance investment in agriculture and allied
(a) I & II (b) Only I (c) I & III (d) I, II & III
(d) All are correct statements sectors to achieve 4% growth rate.
(c) Only II (d) All the above 68. Which statement is correct regarding Ryotwari system?
53. Which among the following gives a justification about III. For promotion of holistic growth of horticulture
63. Which of the following is correct regarding Rashtriya I. System was introduced in North India in terms
sector, including fruits, vegetables, root and tuber
the fact that “ Green Revolution has not been green as it Krishi Vikas Yojana? of which the village community was jointly and
crops, mushroom, spices, flowers, aromatic plants,
made out to be” ? cashew and cocoa. I. RKVY was launched in 2007-08 severally responsible for payment of rent.
1. It confined only to wheat IV. Provides flexibility to states in implementation II. Aim was to incentivize states to enhance investment I. Zamindars acted as intermediaries between the
2. It confined to selected areas only based on a regionally differentiated approach for in agriculture and allied sectors to achieve 4% cultivators and the government.
3. It helped only big farmers promoting crop diversification and providing a focus growth rate. II. Revenue was ‘settled’ by the government with
Choose the correct options: to the programme. III. The government has approved continuation of the zamindars, either permanently or temporarily.
(a) Only 1 (b) 1 & 2 (a) II (b) III RKVY scheme in the 12th plan whereby the funding (a) I & II (b) Only III
(c) 1, 2 & 3 (d) 2 & 3 (c) IV (d) I will be routed into three components- production (c) Only II (d) None of the above

E-62 Agriculture Agriculture E-63

69. What were the objectives of Land reforms? may use them to readily purchase agricultural inputs 79. What are Co-operative Credit Societies? 85. What is Co-operative joint farming?
I. to increase production by ensuring security of tenure such as seeds, fertilizers, pesticides, etc. I. They are apex institution for providing credit facility I. Where the society holds the land and leases it to
to the cultivator; II. These are operated by only commercial banks. to agricultural and rural areas. individual members
II. to increase the purchasing power of the rural III. The scheme has helped in augmenting the flow II. These are the most important source of rural credit. II. Where land is irrevocably surrendered to the
population and thereby boost the demand for of short-term crop loans for seasonal agricultural III. They are finance rural credit directly through collective;
industrial products; and operations of farmers. Regional Rural Banks (RRBs). III. Where the farmers pool their land and reap the
III. to achieve social justice along with economic growth IV. From January 31, 2006, the scheme has been (a) I & II (b) Only III economies of scale, although the ownership
through a single set of measures rather than through extended to all types of loan requirements of (c) Only II (d) None of the above continues to remain with the individual farmer.
different, and sometimes contradictory, measures. borrowers of State Cooperative Agriculture Rural 80. Which of the statement is correct regarding White (a) I & II (b) Only II
(a) I & II (b) I, II & III Development Banks (SCARDBs). revolution? (c) Only III (d) None of the above
(c) I & III (d) None of the above (a) I & II (b) Only IV I. It occurred in India in 1970. 86. What are the primary defects in the system of agricultural
70. Which of the following sentences are correct? (c) I, III & IV (d) All the above II. Prof. Verghese Kuerin was the father of White marketing in India?
I. Second Green Revolution is also called Gene 75. Which of the statement is true? Revolution in India. I. Inadequate warehouses
Revolution. I. Co-operative farming had been advocated by III. It works through a network of co-operative II. Lack of grading and standardization
II. Cowpea and Millets are called Orphan crops. Mahatma Gandhi as far back as in 1942. societies which are owned and managed by the milk III. Inadequate transport facilities
III. Second green revolution is directed by proprietary II. The phenomenon of Green Revolution in India led producers. IV. Presence of a large number of middlemen
research. to an increase in yields due to improved agronomic (a) I & II (b) I & III (a) I & II (b) I, II & III
(a) I & II (b) I, II & III technology. (c) Only I (d) All the above (c) Only IV (d) All the above
(c) I & III (d) All the above III. The third Green Revolution is called Gene 81. What is Co-operative collective farming? 87. What are the main objectives of an agriculture price
71. What is a Blue Box subsidy? Revolution I. Where the society holds the land and leases it to policy?
I. These include direct payments to farmers to limit IV. The first phase of green revolution included individual members. I. To ensure that the producer gets a minimum
production and certain government assistance to introduction of high-yielding varieties of crops and II. Where land is irrevocably surrendered to the collective. remunerative price.
encourage agriculture and rural development in application of modern agricultural techniques III. Where the farmers pool their land and reap the II. To maintain a reasonable terms of trade between
developing countries (a) I, II & III (b) I & III economies of scale, although the ownership agricultural sectors.
II. These include government policies of Minimum (c) II & III (d) I, II & IV continues to remain with the individual farmer. III. To maintain the general price level and protect the
support Prices (MSP) for agricultural products or any 76. What are short term loans? (a) I & II (b) Only II non-producing consumer from violent fluctuations
help directly related to production quantities (for eg.
I. These are provided for a period of less than 15 (c) Only III (d) None of the above in price of food grains.
power, fertiliser, seeds, pesticides, irrigation etc.).
months to meet out expenses of routine farming 82. What is NABARD? (a) Only I (b) I & II
III. These include amounts spent on research, disease
and domestic consumptions. I. They are apex institution for providing credit facility (c) All the above (d) None of the above
control, infrastructure and food security
II. These are provided for a period of 15 months to 5 to agricultural and rural areas. 88. What are medium term loans?
(a) I & III (b) Only I
years to purchase agricultural equipments, animals II. These are the most important source of rural credit. I. These are provided for a period of less than 15
(c) Only III (d) III & II
and for land improvements. III. They provide finance rural credit directly through months to meet out expenses of routine farming and
72. What is Co-operative tenant farming?
III. These are provided for a period of more than 5 Regional Rural Banks (RRBs). domestic consumptions
I. Where the society holds the land and leases it to
years. (a) I & II (b) Only I II. These are provided for a period of 15 months to 5
individual members.
(a) Only II (b) Only I (c) Only II (d) None of the above years to purchase agricultural equipments, animals
II. Where land is irrevocably surrendered to the
(c) Only III (d) None of the above 83. NABARD took over the function of which all institutes? and for land improvements.
collective.
III. Where the farmers pool their land and reap the 77. Which statement is correct with regard to 2nd Five year I. Agricultural Credit Development (ACD) III. These are provided for a period of more than 5
economies of scale, although the ownership plan? II. Rural Planning and Credit Cell (RPCC) of RBI years.
continues to remain with the individual farmer. I. Industrial sector was given more importance in this III. Agricultural Refinance Development Corporation (a) Only II (b) Only I
(a) I & II (b) Only I plan. (ARDC) (c) Only III (d) None of the above
(c) Only III (d) None of the above II. Agricultural Expenditure was only 20% of the actual IV. State Co-operative Agricultural and Rural 89. What is correct statement with regard to buffer stocking?
73. Which of the statement is correct regarding Land plan expenditure. Development Banks (SCARDBs). I. It is the practice of holding large stocks by
Development Banks? III. The agricultural growth, however, was high at (a) I, II & III (b) I & II government agencies like Food Corporation of
I. It provides long-term rural credit for land 3.15%. India (FCI) and releasing the stocks in the market to
(c) Only IV (d) All the above
improvement, soil conservation and other (a) Only I (b) Only II 84. What are the functions of NABARD? counter price rise
investments of a capital nature. (c) I & II (d) All the above I. It is associated with policy, planning, operation and II. The buffer stock also helps to maintain the Public
II. LDBs have now been renamed as State Co-operative 78. What is procurement price? even monitoring levels for providing agricultural Distribution System (PDS).
Agricultural and Rural Development Banks I. It is that price at which government purchases the credit. (a) Only I (b) Only II
(SCARDBs) crop after harvesting, while MSP is the minimum II. Its primary task is to function as refinancing (c) Both I & II (d) None of the above
III. They raise their funds through long-term debentures price at which government declares it will buy the institution for all types of lending for agricultural 90. What is the WTO Agreement on Agriculture (AoA)?
offering state government guarantee, and refinancing crop. and rural development. I. It permitted the developed countries to continue to
from NABARD. II. It is that price at which people purchases the crop III. In addition to this, it provides term credit to state provide farm subsidies, but under certain restrictions.
(a) I & II (b) II & III after harvesting, while MSP is the maximum price co-operative banks, regional rural banks, land II. It permitted the developing countries to continue to
(c) Only II (d) All the above at which government declares it will buy the crop. development banks and state governments (only provide farm subsidies, but under certain restrictions.
74. Which of the following statements are correct in III. It is the price at which people purchase the product for share capital contribution to co-operative credit III. It does not permit the developed countries to
accordance to Kisan Credit Cards? from the government societies). continue to provide farm subsidies.
I. NABARD formulated a model scheme for issue of (a) Only I (b) II & III (a) Only I (b) I & II (a) Only III (b) Only I
Kisan Credit Cards (KCCs) to farmers so that they (c) Only III (d) None of the above (c) II & III (d) All the above (c) Only II (d) None of the above
E-64 Agriculture Agriculture E-65

91. What is Rashtriya Krishi Vikas Yojana? I. The Food Corporation of India (FCI) was established 100. Which statement is correct regarding AICIL? 102. Match the following states with Land Tenure System:
I. Mission to increase the production of rice, wheat and in 1975. I. It was incorporated in 2002 and is under the States Land Tenure System
pulses by 10, 8 and 2 million tonnes respectively. II. It was responsible for securing for the government administrative control of Ministry of Finance, I. Bengal, Bihar a. Ryotwari System
II. To enhance investment in agriculture and allied a commanding position in the food-grain trade. Government of India, and under the operational II. North India b. Zamindari system
sectors to achieve 4% growth rate. III. By 1979, the corporation was operating in all states supervision of Ministry of Agriculture, Government III. Madras, Bombay c. Mahalwari system
III. For promotion of holistic growth of horticulture as the sole agent of the central government in food- of India. (a) I – b, II – c, III – a (b) I – a, II – b, III – c
sector, including fruits, vegetables, root and tuber grain procurement. II. It seeks to provide insurance coverage and financial (c) I – c, II – b, III – a (d) None of the above
crops, mushroom, spices, flowers, aromatic plants, (a) I & III (b) Only I support to the farmers in the failure of any of the 103. Match the followingtotal institutional credit to agriculture:
(c) I & II (d) II & III notified crop. Banks Percentage
cashew and cocoa.
96. Which statement is correct regarding TPDS? III. It encourages the farmers to adopt progressive
IV. Provides flexibility to states in implementation I. Commercial bank a. 28%
I. It is targeted for rich people. farming practices, high value in-puts and higher
based on a regionally differentiated approach for II. RRB’s b. 61%
II. It is targeted to poor people. technology; to help stabilize farm incomes,
promoting crop diversification and providing a focus III. Co-operative banks c. 11%
III. This system started when the procurement and issue particularly in disaster years.
to the programme. prices of PDS items saw a rise with the ushering in (a) I – b, II – c, III – a (b) I – a, II – b, III – c
(a) I & II (b) II & III
(a) II (b) III of economic reforms in the 1990s. (c) Only III (d) All the above (c) I – c, II – a, III – b (d) I – b, II –a, III – c
(c) IV (d) I (a) I & III (b) Only III 101. Match the following 104. In the context of food and nutritional security of India,
92. What are the land reforms taken after Independence? (c) II & III (d) None of the above List I List II enhancing the ‘Seed Replacement Rates’ of various crops
I. Abolition of intermediaries like zamindars, jagirdars, 97. What were the measurements taken by government to (Five Year Plan) (Emphasis) helps in achieving the food production targets of the
etc., which resulted in several states promulgating improve the condition of agriculture? A. First 1. Food security and women future. But what is/are the constraint/ constraints in its
laws for putting an end to ‘absentee landlordism’. I. The ‘Land Reform’ measures and ‘Green empowerment wider/greater implementation? [CSAT 2014 - I]
II. Imposition of ceiling laws which lay down the Revolution’ were the greatest achievements of the B. Second 2. Heavy industries 1. There is no National Seeds Policy in place.
maximum land that can be owned by a land holder Indian Government in enhancing the agricultural C. Fifth 3. Agriculture and community 2. There is no participation of private sector seed
III. Consolidation of holding was introduced as a production and productivity. development companies in the supply of quality seeds of
measure of improving farming efficiency II. Between 1950 and 1990, there was a substantial D. Ninth 4. Removal of poverty vegetables and planting materials of horticultural
(a) I & II (b) I & III increase in the agricultural productivity. As a result Codes : crops.
(c) Only I (d) All the above of Green Revolution, India became self sufficient in A B C D 3. There is a demand-supply gap regarding quality
food production. (a) 1 2 4 3 seeds in case of low value and high volume crops.
93. What is an AmberBox subsidy?
III. Land Reforms resulted in abolition of zamindari (b) 1 4 2 3 Select the correct answer using the code given below.
I. There include direct payments to farmers to limit
system. (c) 3 2 4 1 (a) 1 and 2 (b) 3 only
production and certain government assistance to IV. The proportion of GDP contributed by agriculture (d) 3 4 2 1 (c) 2 and 3 (d) None
encourage agriculture and rural development in changed significantly, but not the population
developing countries. depending on it.
II. These include government policies of Minimum (a) I & II (b) I, II & IV
support Prices (MSP) for agricultural products or (c) Only III (d) All the above
any help directly related to production quantities (for 98. Which statement is correct regarding Evergreen
eg. power, fertiliser, seeds, pesticides, irrigation Revolution?
etc.). I. The emphasis in this revolution is on sustainable
III. There include amounts spent on research, disease agriculture by means of organic and green
control, infrastructure and food security. agriculture.
(a) I & III (b) Only I II. Dr. MS Swaminathan gave this concept.
(c) Only II (d) III & II III. It includes the use of integrated pest management,
94. Which statement is correct regarding public distribution nutrient supply and resource management.
system? (a) I & II (b) Only II
I. Public Distribution System (PDS) was conceived (c) Only III (d) All the above
99. What is National Horticulture Mission?
as a primary social welfare and poverty alleviation
I. Mission to increase the production of rice, wheat and
programme of the government to ensure price
pulses by 10, 8 and 2 million tonnes respectively.
stabilization in the grain market. II. To enhance investment in agriculture and allied
II. Government’s objective of providing reasonable sectors to achieve 4% growth rate.
prices for basic food commodities like food grains, III. For promotion of holistic growth of horticulture
sugar, edible oil and kerosene is achieved. sector, including fruits, vegetables, root and tuber
III. It is the second largest system in the world. crops, mushroom, spices, flowers, aromatic plants,
IV. More than 50 per cent of grain to the Public cashew and cocoa.
Distribution System is provided by the Punjab, IV. Provides flexibility to states in implementation
Haryana and western Uttar Pradesh. based on a regionally differentiated approach for
(a) I & II (b) Only II promoting crop diversification and providing a focus
(c) Only III (d) III & IV to the programme.
95. Which statement is correct regarding Food Corporation (a) II (b) III
of India? (c) IV (d) I

E-66 Agriculture Agriculture E-67

(2011–12). Accordingly, a centrally sponsored plan by a special act by the parliament and its main
Scheme, ‘National Food Security Mission’, had focus was to uplift rural India by increasing the
been launched from the rabi season 2007–08 to credit flow for elevation of agriculture & rural non
operationalize the above mentioned resolution. farm sector.
18. (b) The Bonded Labour System (Abolition) Act, 1976 26. (a) In India, commercial banks have the highest share in
EXERCISE-1 10. (d) The importance of agriculture in Indian Economy
the disbursement of credit to agriculture and allied
was enacted to provide for the abolition of bonded
1. (d) G. B. Pant University of Agriculture and Technology is indicated by its contribution to national income,
labour system with a view to prevent the economic activities.The commercial banks disburse around
(GBPUA&T, Pant Nagar,Uttara Khand) is the first industrial development and supply of foodgrains. It 60% credit followed by cooperative banks around
and physical exploitation of the weaker sections of
agricultural university of India. It was inaugurated contributes around 13.7% to GDP , supplies raw 30% and RRB and others.
the society. It freed all the bonded labourers from
by Jawahar Lal Nehru on 17 November 1960. material for development of industries along with 27. (b) ‘National Food Security Mission’, had been
bondage with simultaneous liquidation of their debts.
2. (d) A Kisan Credit Card is a credit card to provide supplying food grains for livelihood. It made the practice of bondage a cognisable offence launched from the rabi season 2007–08 to increase
affordable credit for farmers. It was started by 11. (b) A Kisan Credit Card is a credit card to provide punishable by law. The Act is being administered the production of rice by 10 million tons, wheat by
the Government of India, Reserve Bank of India affordable credit for farmers. It was started by the and implemented by the Ministry of Labour and the 8 million tons pulse by 2 million tons decided by
(RBI), and National Bank for Agricultural and Reserve Bank of India (RBI), and National Bank for State governments concerned. National Development Council.
Rural Development (NABARD) in 1998–99 to Agricultural and Rural Development (NABARD) in 19. (c) The Food corporation of India (FCI) was set up 28. (c) 29. (a) 30. (d) 31. (b) 32. (a) 33. (b)
help farmers access timely and adequate credit. 1998–99 to help farmers access timely and adequate in 1965. Its objectives are Effective price support 34. (b) 35. (b) 36. (d) 37. (b) 38. (c) 39. (b)
The credit is available to farmers in most of the credit. operations for safeguarding the interests of the 40. (c)
banks like commercial banks cooperative banks 12. (b) The Tribal Cooperative Marketing Development farmers. Distribution of food grains throughout 41. (d) RADP was launched by the government as a pilot
and regional rural banks. However in day to day Federation of India Limited (TRIFED) started the country for public distribution system and scheme under RKVY, focusing on small and
operations NABARD is not included. functioning in 1988 under the Administrative maintaining satisfactory level of operational and marginal farmers and farming systems. It targets
3. (d) Sustainable farming system and Integrated watershed control of the Ministry of Tribal Affairs, Govt. of buffer stocks of foodgrains to ensure National Food integrated farming, on- farm water management,
systems are the objective of the National Watershed India. FCS is food and supplies department. RRB Security. storage marketing and value addition of farm
Development project for rainfed areas of India. The is regional rural bank . All the above three are not 20. (d) Rashtriya Krishi Vikas Yojana was launched in produce in order to enhance farmers’ income in
scheme of National Watershed Development Project apex bodies at national level. However National August 2007 as a part of the 11th Five Year Plan rainfed areas.
for Rainfed Areas(NWDPRA) was launched in Agricultural cooperative Marketing Federation of by the Government of India. Launched under the
India Ltd. (NAFED) is one of the Central Nodal EXERCISE-2
1990–91 in 25 States and 2 Union Territories based on aegis of the National Development Council, it seeks
Agencies and apex body which implements PSS. 1. (d) 2. (d) 3. (c)
twin concepts of integrated watershed management to achieve 4% annual growth in agriculture through
13. (b) Indian Farmer Fertilizer cooperative Ltd (IFFCO) 4. (a) According to The National Food for Work Programme,
and sustainable farming systems. Its objective development of Agriculture and its allied sectors
are conservation, development and sustainable is the co-operative society responsible for the during the period under the 11th Five Year Plan food subsidy should be better targeted through targeted
management of natural resources, enhancement of production of fertilizers. Indian Farmers Fertiliser (2007–11). public distribution system and specific programmes for
agricultural production in a sustainable manner, Co-operative Limited (IFFCO) was registered on 21. (b) The statement, “Everything else can wait, but not the poor like Food for Work Programme. The National
restoration of ecological balance and creation of November 3, 1967 as a Multi-unit Co-operative agriculture” is attributed to J.L. Nehru. Nehru Food for Work Programme was launched on 14
sustained employment opportunities for the rural Society. mentioned these words after independence . He said November 2004 in 150 of the most backward districts
community. 14. (d) Bihar is the first state to impose agricultural income this in the context of the Bengal Famine of 1942–43 of India with the objective of generating supplementary
4. (c) The Market Intervention Scheme (MIS)is an tax in India. Agricultural income tax is levied on and the acute food scarcity prevailing in the country wage employment. The Planning commission is not a
adhoc scheme under which horticultural commodities the income from Agriculture. At present agriculture in 1947. constitutional body.
and other agricultural commodities falls which are is subjected to two direct taxes and they are 22. (d) The head office of the National Bank for agriculture 5. (d) 6. (b) 7. (a) 8. (c) 9. (d) 10. (d)
perishable in nature and are not covered under the Agricultural Income tax and Land Tax. They are and Rural Development (NABARD) is located in 11. (b) 12. (c) 13. (d) 14. (b) 15. (d) 16. (a)
minimum price support scheme. levied by the state governments. Bihar was the first Mumbai. It helps farmers access timely and adequate 17. (a) 18. (c) 19. (d) 20. (d)
5. (b) The price at which the Government purchases state in India to levy a tax on agricultural income in credit. 21. (b) Rapid rate of increase of population and practice of
foodgrains for maintaining the public distribution 1938. 23. (d) Co-operative societies, Commercial Banks and dividing land equally among the heirs are responsible
system and for building up buffer stocks are known 15. (c) The growth performance of the agriculture sector Regional Rural Banks are source of agriculture for the decrease of per capita holding of cultivated land
as procurement prices. has been fluctuating across the plan periods. It finance in India. They provide finance under in India.
6. (d) Finance commission witnessed a growth rate of 4.8 per cent during the various schemes run by central government and 22. (b) 23. (b) 24. (c)
7. (b) In Order to help the farmers in getting remunerative Eighth plan period (1992–97). state governments to purchase seeds, implements, 25. (c) The decision to partially decontrol the sugar sector
prices for their produce with a view to encourage 16. (b) National seed policy was based on the fertilizer, pesticides etc. was taken by the Cabinet Committee on Economic
higher investment and as also to increase production recommendation of M.V. Rao committee in 24. (b) The shelter belt method of soil conservation is most Affairs (CCEA). This gives millers the freedom to
and productivity of a commodity, the government 2002. The Policy was meant to “strengthen the effective in arid areas. A shelterbelt is a barrier of sell in the open market and remove their obligation
declares Minimum Support Price (MSPs) for 25 seed industry’’ in view of the liberalisation in the trees or shrubs. The term “field shelterbelt” is used
to supply the sweetener at subsidised rates to ration
notified agricultural commodities for each Kharif & farm sector under the World Trade Organisation. to distinguish between rows of trees or shrubs on
The policy seeks to provide intellectual property agricultural fields from those planted in other ways: shops. The Rangarajan Committee has recommended
Rabi crop season.National Agricultural cooperative
protection to stimulate investment in research and around farmyards or livestock facilities (farmstead total decontrol of the sugar industry by doing away
Marketing Federation of India Ltd (NAFED) is one
of the Central Nodal Agencies which implements development of new plant varieties. shelterbelts). It controls soil erosion and traps the with the levy sugar obligation, release mechanism
PSS. 17. (c) The National Development Council (NDC) on moisture which is necessary to grow crop in such and freeing of export-import.
8. (d) Agriculture(crops) and allied sectors are like 29th May, 2007 adopted a resolution to launch a regions. 26. (d) In the year 1999 the National Agricultural Insurance
forestry, logging and fishing. Food processing is Food Security Mission comprising rice, wheat 25. (c) National Bank for Agriculture and Rural Scheme was introduced by replacing comprehensive
not included in the Agriculture and allied services of and pulses to increase the production of rice by 10 Development (NABARD) is an apex development crop Insurance Scheme. NAIS covers all food
Indian Economy. million tons, wheat by 8 million tons and pulses bank in India having headquarters based in Mumbai. crops (cereals and pulses), oilseeds, horticultural
9. (d) Tenth five year plan by 2 million tons by the end of the Eleventh Plan It was established on 12 July, 1982 in sixth five year and commercial crops. It covers all farmers, both
E-68 Agriculture Agriculture E-69

loanees and non-loanees, under the scheme. Growth 35. (a) The scheme of National Watershed Development 59. (c) Green Box subsidies include amounts spent on 68. (d) Ryotwari System was prevalent in parts of Madras,
rate of primary sector reached above 8% with Project for Rainfed Areas(NWDPRA) was launched research, disease control, infrastructure and food Bombay province and Assam. Under this system,
green revolution. Both the given statements are not in 1990-91 in 25 States and 2 Union Territories security. These also include direct payments made the cultivator paid the revenues directly to the state
correct. based on twin concepts of integrated watershed to farmers such as income support that do not without an intermediary.
27. (a) Rural Infrastructure Development Fund (RIDF) was management and sustainable farming systems. stimulate production. These are not considered trade 69. (b) 70. (d)
instituted in NABARD with an announcement in the At present, this scheme is being implemented as distorting and are encouraged. 71. (b) Blue Box subsidies include direct payments to
Union Budget 1995-96 with the sole objective of a programme of Centrally Sponsored Scheme of 60. (a) The total irrigated area increased from less than farmers to limit production and certain government
Macro Management of Agriculture in 28 States and one million hectares per annum before the green assistance to encourage agriculture and rural
giving low cost fund support to State governments
revolution to about 2.5 million hectares per annum development in developing countries. Blue Box
and state owned corporations for quick completion 2 Union Territories.
during the 1970’s. The total gross irrigated area subsidies are seen as being trade distorting.
of ongoing projects relating to medium and minor 36. (c) In the Eleventh Five Year Plan, the average
now is 80 million hectares. 72. (b) In Co-operative tenant farming, the society holds
irrigation, soil conservation, watershed management foodgrains production was more than 200 million 61. (d) National Agricultural Insurance Scheme is a central
and other forms of rural infrastructure. tonnes, and during 2000s production of the coarse the land and leases it to individual members.
sector, government sponsored crop insurance 73. (d) Land Development Banks (LDBs) provide long-
28. (c) CWC is a Warehousing Agency in India, established cereals increased mainly due to increase in demand scheme, in operation since 1999. This scheme aims
in 1957. It provides logistics support to the agricultural of coarse cereals as a nutri-food. term rural credit for land improvement, soil
at tackling the issue of production risk faced by the
37. (c) India is the fourth largest producer, of natural conservation and other investments of a capital
sector. CWC is operating 464 Warehouses across agricultural sector. It provides financial support to
rubber and fifth largest consumer of natural rubber nature. LDBs have now been renamed as State
the country with a storage capacity of 10.54 million the farmers in the failure of any of the crops. The
and synthetic rubber together in the world. India in Co-operative Agricultural and Rural Development
tonnes providing warehousing services for a wide AICIL is the implementing agency of this scheme.
NAIS has been further modified as MNAIS with the Banks (SCARDBs). They raise their funds through
range of products ranging from agricultural produce the world, shares more than 8.0% in the Natural
aim of further helping the farm sector. long-term debentures offering state government
to sophisticated industrial products. Rubber Production.
62. (b) ISOPOM provides flexibility to states in guarantee, and refinancing from NABARD.
29. (c) The growth in agriculture and allied sectors is a 38. (d) India is the 6th largest producer of coffee in the
implementation based on a regionally differentiated 74. (c) NABARD formulated a model scheme for issue of
necessary condition for inclusive growth in India. world having a share of around 2% in terms of
approach for promoting crop diversification and Kisan Credit Cards (KCCs) to farmers so that they
Agriculture including allied activities accounted for global area. India contributes about 4% to world
providing a focus to the programme. This scheme is may use them to readily purchase agricultural inputs
about 55% employment in the country according to coffee production as well as in the International
under implementation in the country for increasing such as seeds, fertilizers, pesticides, etc. These
census 2011. trade.
area, production and yield of these crops from 2004- are operated by commercial banks, RRBs and co-
30. (c) National cooperation marketing federation of India 39. (c) The farm power availability in India is much lower operative banks.
05. The pulses component was merged with NFSM
limited NAFED promotes cooperative marketing, than that of Korea. India is meeting 85% of the urea 75. (d)
w.e.f. April 2010.
promotes the inter-state trade as well as export of fertilizer through indigenous production. However, 76. (b) These are provided for a period of less than 15
63. (c) RKVY was launched in 2007-08 for the 11th plan
certain agricultural commodities to many foreign we are deficient in phosphatic and potassic resources to incentivize states to enhance investment in months to meet out expenses of routine farming and
countries. It is responsible in stabilizing prices of and around 90% is imported. agriculture and allied sectors to achieve 4% growth domestic consumptions.
commodities and thus responsible for the movement 40. (a) rate. The government has approved continuation 77. (d) Industrial sector was given more importance in this
of the essential commodities from surplus areas to 41. (c) The commodities distributed under PDS are as of the RKVY scheme in the 12th plan whereby plan, Agricultural Expenditure was only 20% of the
scarcity areas. follows :- • Wheat • Rice • Sugar • Kerosene the funding will be routed into three components- actual plan expenditure, The agricultural growth,
31. (d) Agricultural income tax is levied on the income from 42. (d) There are seven broad categories of essential production growth, infrastructure and assets, and however, was high at 3.15%.
Agriculture. At present agriculture is subjected to commodities covered by the Act. These are (1) sub-schemes and flexi-fund. 78. (a) Procurement price is that price at which government
two direct taxes and they are agricultural Income Drugs; (2) Fertilizer, inorganic, organic or mixed; 64. (c) The second Green Revolution seeks to minimize purchases the crop after harvesting, while MSP is
tax and Land Tax. They are levied by the state (3) Foodstuffs, including edible oilseeds and oils; (4) post-harvest wastage, improve storage and help the minimum price at which government declares
Hank yarn made wholly from cotton; (5) Petroleum Indian farmers meet the phyto-sanitary conditions so it will buy the crop. Since 1968-69, the MSP is
governments. Not all states levy agricultural income
and petroleum products; (6) Raw jute and jute that they can participate productively in the global usually the procurement price.
tax.
textile; (7) (i) seeds of food-crops and seeds of fruits agricultural trade. The first Green Revolution was 79. (c) These are the most important source of rural credit.
32. (c) Agriculture labourers in India are mainly dominated assisted by research undertaken by public institutions
by the backward classes and more than 85% and vegetables; (ii) seeds of cattle fodder; and (iii) 80. (d)
jute seeds. Recently cotton seed was also included in such as Universities. However, the second Green 81. (b) Co-operative collective farming, where land is
agriculture workers are mainly casual labourers. Revolution (appropriately called Gene Revolution,
33. (c) National Bank for Agriculture and Rural the list. irrevocably surrendered to the collective
because of the predominance of Biotechnology) will
Development (NABARD) is an apex development 43. (a) 44. (d) 45. (a) 46. (c) 47. (d) 48. (a) 82. (b) NABARD is the apex institution for providing
be directed by proprietary research and governed by
bank in India . It was established on 12 July 1982 in 49. (a) 50. (c) 51. (d) 52. (a) 53. (b) 54. (b) credit facility to agricultural and rural areas. It
Intellectual Property Rights.
55. (d) 56. (c) came into existence on July 12, 1982 and took over
sixth five year plan and its main focus was to uplift 65. (d)
57. (c) These are provided for a period of more than 5 years. 66. (c) Factors like the size of holdings, the pattern of the functions of the erstwhile Agricultural Credit
rural India by increasing the credit flow for elevation
This type of loan is taken by farmers to purchase ownership, the method of inheritance and security Development (ACD), Rural Planning and Credit
of agriculture and rural non-farm sector and laying
land and expensive agricultural equipments and for of tenure have a definite impact on investment in Cell (RPCC) of RBI and the Agricultural Refinance
down policies and to oversee the operations of the
repayment of old loans. agriculture. Development Corporation (ARDC).
RRBs. Moreover Regional Rural Banks grant direct
58. (d) NFSM was launched in 2007-08 to increase the 67. (d) The Zamindari System prevailed in Bengal, Bihar, 83. (a)
loans and advances to marginal farmers and rural 84. (d) Its primary task is to function as refinancing
artisans. So both statements are correct. production of rice, wheat and pulses by 10, 8 and Orissa and North Madras. It was introduced by
2 million tonnes respectively, by the end of 11th the East India Company and under it a class of institution for all types of lending for agricultural and
34. (c) Government of India has initiated a major rural development. In addition to this, it provides
plan through productivity enhancement and area revenue collectors, called zamindars, was created.
programme ‘National Project for Cattle and Buffalo term credit to state co-operative banks, regional
enhancement, enhancing farm level economy These zamindars acted as intermediaries between
Breeding’ (NPCBB) from October 2000. The the cultivators and the government. Revenue was rural banks, land development banks and state
NPCBB envisages genetic upgradation on priority and creating employment opportunities. This has
been extended to the 12th plan too with additional ‘settled’ by the government with zamindars, either governments (only for share capital contribution to
basis with a focus on development and conservation permanently or temporarily. co-operative credit societies).
production targets.
of important indigenous breeds.

E-70 Agriculture

85. (c) Co-operative joint farming, where the farmers policy through procurement and public distribution
pool their land and reap the economies of scale, operations. It was responsible for securing for the
although the ownership continues to remain with the government a commanding position in the food-grain
individual farmer. trade. By 1979, the corporation was operating in all
86. (d) 87. (c) states as the sole agent of the central government in
88. (a) These are provided for a period of 15 months to 5 food-grain procurement.

4
years to purchase agricultural equipments, animals 96. (c) Targeted PDS (TPDS) means targeting the PDS to
and for land improvements. the poor. This system started when the procurement
89. (c) Buffer stocking, which is the practice of holding and issue prices of PDS items saw a rise with the
large stocks by government agencies like Food ushering in of economic reforms in the 1990s.

FISCAL AND MONETARY


Corporation of India (FCI) and releasing the stocks 97. (d)
in the market to counter price rise. The buffer stock 98. (d) The emphasis in this revolution is on sustainable

POLICY
also helps to maintain the Public Distribution System agriculture by means of organic and green
(PDS). agriculture. Dr. MS Swaminathan gave this concept.
90. (b) The WTO Agreement on Agriculture (AoA), 1995 It includes the use of integrated pest management,
permitted the developed countries to continue to nutrient supply and resource management.
provide farm subsidies, but under certain restrictions 99. (b) NHM was launched in 2005-06 for promotion of
91. (a) RKVY was launched in 2007-08 for the 11th plan holistic growth of horticulture sector, including
to incentivize states to enhance investment in fruits, vegetables, root and tuber crops, mushroom,
agriculture and allied sectors to achieve 4% growth spices, flowers, aromatic plants, cashew and cocoa. Introduction
rate. The government has approved continuation 100. (d) Agriculture Insurance Company of India Limitedwas Fiscal Policy deals with the taxation and expenditure decisions of the goverment covered in the annual budget. Monetary Policy
of the RKVY scheme in the 12th plan whereby incorporated in 2002 and is under the administrative deals with the supply of money in the economy and the rate of interest. In India, the goverment deals with fiscal policy, while
the funding will be routed into three components- control of Ministry of Finance, Government of the Central bank (RBI) is resoponsible for monetary policy.
production growth, infrastructure and assets, and India, and under the operational supervision of
sub-schemes and flexi-fund. Ministry of Agriculture, Government of India. It
92. (d) seeks to provide insurance coverage and financial
93. (c) Amber Box subsidies include all agricultural support to the farmers in the failure of any of the
subsidies that do not fall into either blue or green notified crop.
boxes. These include government policies of 101. (c) 1. First Five Year Plan (1951-56)- Agriculture and
Minimum support Prices (MSP) for agricultural community development
products or any help directly related to production 2. Second Five Year Plan (1956-61)- Heavy Industry
quantities (for eg. power, fertiliser, seeds, pesticides, 3. Fifth Five Year Plan (1974-79)- Removal of
irrigation etc.). Poverty
94. (a) Public Distribution System (PDS) was conceived
4. Ninth Five Year Plan (1997-2002)- Food Security
as a primary social welfare and poverty alleviation
and woman empowerment.
programme of the government to ensure price
102. (a) 103. (a)
stabilization in the grain market. Government’s
objective of providing reasonable prices for basic 104. (b) We have a National Seed policy made in 2002. So 1
food commodities like food grains, sugar, edible is not a constraint. The private sector produces high- /
oil and kerosene is achieved through the Public priced seeds but in lower volume. It supplies nearly
Distribution System of India, the largest PDS of the the entire hybrid seeds required for vegetables. So 2
world. is not a constraint. In the case of low value and high /
95. (d) The Food Corporation of India (FCI) was established volume crops such as wheat and rice, farmers tend
in 1965, as the public sector marketing agency
to use their own preserved seeds as there is demand
responsible for implementing government price
and supply gap. So 3 is a constraint.

Fiscal policy (i) a systematic effort to simplify tax structure and tax laws
(ii) a deliberate move to a regime of reasonable direct tax
Fiscal policy or budgetary policy refers to the use by rates and better administration and enforcement.
the government of the various instruments such as
The budget or the annual financial statement of the government
taxation, expenditure and borrowing in order to achieve
gives expression to its fiscal policy. Under Article 112 of the
the objectives of balanced economic development, full
Indian Constitution, the President shall cause to be laid, before
employment or to establish a welfare state. In the context of both the Houses of Parliament a financial statement at the
economic liberalization, the major themes of the fiscal policy commencement of every financial year. The General Budget is
comprises: presented in Lok Sabha by the Minister of Finance.
E-72 Fiscal and Monetary Policy Fiscal and Monetary Policy E-73

Union budget or Annual financial statement is a statement (central excise, custom duty, corporation tax) dividends of On the recommendations of the Sukhomoy Chakravarti such, the Kelkar panel in 2012 on fiscal consolidation
of estimated receipts and expenditures of the Government of public sector units (PSU’s) and expenditure of the Government. Committee, from the financial year 1987-88, Indian budget recommended a series of measures like disinvestment, raising
India. It has to be placed before Parliament for every financial started being classified as plan and non-plan expenditure, diesel prices, auction of spectrum, pruning some plan schemes
Capital Account consists of all capital receipts and expenditure
year, i.e. April 1 to March 31 & being presented at 11 a.m. instead of developmental and non-developmental. and rationalising of subsidies.
such as domestic and foreign loans, loan repayment, foreign, etc.
on the last working day of February. The annual financial
statement gives the following details: Primary Deficit = Fiscal Deficit–Interest Payments.
Expenditure Deficit
(a) An outline of the results of the last financial year India started using this term since 1997-98. Primary deficit is
compared with the previous budget estimates. Total expenditure of the government can be classified into It means shortage. The gap between Revenue and Expenditure considered a very useful tool in helping bring more transparency
(b) Government forecasts of receipts and payments for the two categories- Developmental or Non-developmental. is called Deficit. in the government’s pattern of expenditure. It shows the current
next year. Developmental expenditure includes government spending state of government finances. If interest payments are deducted
with the aim of creating economic and social infrastructure Types of Deficit
(c) Proposed changes in taxes and expenditure allocations. from fiscal deficit, then it will obviously show a lesser deficit
For instance, the Government can change the proportion like transport, roads, communication, hospitals, school, etc. Revenue deficit means the excess of current revenue expenditure for that year as the interest payments are on account of loans
of revenue collected from direct taxes and indirect taxes Non-developmental does not directly contribute to over current revenue receipts. Revenue deficit indicates that taken in the past and not in the present year.
or it might increase public expenditure on defence and development of economy, for example expenditure for loan the government cannot meet its current expenditure from its Monetised deficit refers to that part of deficit for which the
decrease that of social services. repayment, interest payable on internal and external loans, current revenue. government borrows from the RBI. To meet the government’s
The budget shows the receipts and payments of the defence expenditure, subsidies, etc. In the Indian budget Revenue Deficit= Revenue expenditure – Revenue receipts such requirements, the RBI prints fresh currency, as a result
Government under three heads: management, this classification is not used. of which the economy gets monetised. This term was adopted
Budget deficit is the overall deficit, i.e. the excess of total
(i) Consolidated fund In India, the public expenditure is of two types – Plan and Non-plan. by India in 1997-98.
expenditure over total revenues. It includes both capital and
It consists of all revenues and loans received by the
Plan Expenditures revenue items in receipts and expenditure. Traditionally, Budget 2015-16
government. Article 114(3) of the Constitution declares
deficit financing in Indian budgets had meant filling this gap.
that no money can be taken out of Consolidated Fund on Expenditure on central plans such as agriculture, rural
India without the approval of the Lok Sabha. Budget Deficit= Total expenditure – Total receipts Tax revenue (income and 9,19,842 crores
development, irrigation, transport, communications, environment corporate taxes)
(ii) Contingency fund and welfare schemes are considered plan expenditure. Fiscal deficit is budget deficit plus borrowings and other
It comprises of the sum placed at the disposal of the liabilities. Previously, when budgetary deficit was the prime Non-tax revenue (customs, 2,21,733 crores
President to meet unforeseen expenditure. Non-plan Expenditures consideration, borrowings from the market and receipts from excise duties and service
Non-plan expenditure is further divided into Revenue national savings, provident funds, etc. were being treated as taxes)
(iii) Public Account
expenditure, which includes interest payments, subsidies, capital receipts. To this extent, government’s actual deficit Total Revenue Receipts 11,41575 crores
It consists of receipts and payments, which are in the
form of deposit account with the Government, such as defence expenditure and Capital expenditure, which includes was being understood. In other words, fiscal deficit indicates
loans to PSUs, states, foreign governments. the total borrowing requirements of the government from all Fiscal Deficit 3.9% (555649 Cr.)
provident funds, small savings, etc.
In short, all asset creating and productive expenditure is sources, whereas budgetary deficit only indicated government’s Revenue Deficit 2.8% (394472 Cr.)
There are two parts of budget, i.e. Revenue Account and
part of plan expenditure, and all non- productive, consumptive borrowing from RBI. Primary Deficit 0.7% (99504 Cr.)
Capital Account.
and non- asset building expenditure is part of non- plan Fiscal deficit = Revenue receipts (net tax revenue and
Revenue Account contains all current receipts, such as taxation, expenditure. non tax revenue capital receipts (only Non-Planned expenditure 13,12,200 crores
recoveries of loans and other receipts) – Planned expenditure 4,65,277 crores
Total expenditure (Plan and non-plan)
Public Expenditure Total Expenditure 17,77,477 crores
or
Fiscal deficit = Budget deficit + Government’s market Taxes
borrowing and liabilities.
Taxes are the main source of government revenues. The pri-
Non–Plan (Expenditures Plan (Expenditures The fiscal deficit situation shows whether the government is
envisaged in mary purpose of taxation is the mobilisation of resources and
not envisaged in spending beyond its income. India has, unfortunately, been a channelising the same for productive investment. Taxation can
5 year plan documents) 5 year plan documents)
country prone to constant and high fiscal deficit situations. A also be used as a measure to promote equity and reduce dispar-
high fiscal deficit implies high indebtedness of the government ities or to encourage or discourage consumption of particular
and a deficit above 3% in the Indian context means an alarming items. Taxation is in the nature of a compulsory levy and there
Central Assistance situation for the government finances. is no quid pro quo between the amount paid and the services
Central Palns for Plans of States In India, a high fiscal deficit is mainly due to high revenue provided by the government.
Revenue Capital & UTs.
deficit which implies that it is mainly due to the government’s Taxes are broadly divided into two - direct and indirect.
day to day expenditure being more than its day to day income, Taxes like income tax and property tax are direct taxes, while
Police Social Services such that it has to borrow to meet its daily requirements which,
Interest Pensions Loans to public excise duty and sales tax are examples of indirect taxes. The
Payments Broadcasting Enterprises Transport & others by definition, is unhealthy and dangerous, because borrowing difference between the two is that in the case of direct taxes
Education Agriculture is good only if it is for productive purposes. Hence, the FRBM
Technology & the burden or ‘incidence’ has to be borne by the taxpayers
Loans to States Environment Act, 2004 laid down that the government’s revenue deficit themselves whereas in the case of an indirect tax, the burden
Industries & UTs & Foreign should be brought down to zero and its fiscal deficit should not can be shifted to another person. For example, a trader who is
Agricultural Defence Revenue Governments. Rural Development
Subsidies be allowed to exceed 3% of the GDP by 2008-09, but this has the assessee in the case of sales tax shifts the burden on to the
Expenditure still not been achieved. purchasers by recovering the sales tax from them.
Grants to States &, A high fiscal deficit is also inflationary because it is mainly Another difference between indirect and direct taxes is that
UTs & Foreign due to the government’s high non plan expenditure which the rich and the poor will have to pay the same rate of indirect
Governments is unproductive. Besides, a high fiscal deficit imposes huge tax while a direct tax can be made progressive by prescribing
burden by way of repayment of interest and principal. As different rates of tax for different income levels.

E-74 Fiscal and Monetary Policy Fiscal and Monetary Policy E-75

Corpora Commodities Minimum Custom Service by introducing a new system of taxation of services in India. (vi) A non-vatable additional tax, not exceeding 1% on inter-
Income Wealth Excise
Duties VAT GST In the new system all services, except those specified in the state supply of goods would be levied by the Centre and
Tax the Tax Tax Transaction Tax Alternate Tax Duties Tax
negative list, are subject to taxation. retained by the originating state at least for a period of
two years.
Value Added Tax (VAT)
(vii) CGST, SGST, and IGST would be levied at rates to be
DIRECT INDIRECT It was introduced in France to overcome the cascading effect recommended by the Goods and Services Tax Council
of several taxes-from raw material to the final product in
(GSTC) which will be chaired by the Union Finance
the process of production. In VAT, the tax on all inputs can
Minister and will have Finance Ministers of states as its
be deducted from the excise paid on the output so taxes are
TYPES members.
levied on the value added to each stage in the production
process. VAT system of taxation is adopted in more than 150 (viii) GST would apply to all goods and services except alcohol
countries including Australia and Canada. The main advantage for human consumption.
TAX
of VAT over any other form of indirect tax is that it shifts (ix) GST on petroleum products would be applicable from a
the tax base towards the point of final consumption from the date to be recommended by the GST Council.
Classification first point of sale. It thus ensures the “tax neutrality” of the
production decisions. VAT is introduced in India in 2005. The (x) Tobacco and tobacco products would be subject to the
basic features of the tax include 2 rates of 4% for comman CST. In addition, the Centre could continue to levy
Proportional Progressive Regressive consumption commodities and inputs and 12.5% for the Central excise duty.
Taxation Taxation Taxation others. Some essential items are exempted and precious metals (xi) A common threshold exemption would apply to both
Taxes can also be categorized as progressive, regressive and Corporation tax are taxed at 1%. CGST and SGST Taxpayers with a turnover below it
proportional taxes. would be exempt from GST. Compounding option (i.e.to
(1) Progressive Tax
It is the tax on income (profit) of the companies. In 1996, gover Goods and Services Tax* pay tax at a flat rate on turnover without credits) would
introduced Minimum Alternate Tax (MAT) on companies be available to small taxpayers below a certain threshold.
Progressive tax means rates of tax increase for increasing which escaped the corporation tax net by using the provisions The introduction of the GST would be a significant step in the
values or volumes on which the tax is levied. field of indirect tax reforms in India. By subsuming a large However, a taxable person falling within the limit of
of exemptions, deductions incentives, depreciation and so on.
threshold or compounding could opt to pay tax at the
Income tax is a progressive tax as it has exemptions for number of central and state taxes into a single tax, it would
very small incomes, low rates for the first slab of taxable (B) Indirect Taxes mitigate cascading or double taxation in a major way and pave normal rate in order to be part of the input tax credit
income, and higher rates for the largest incomes. the way for a common national market. From the consumer’s chain.
Central excise duty point of view, the biggest advantage would be in terms of a (xii) The list of exempted goods and services would be kept
Indirect taxes can be progressive if there are exemptions or
low tax rates for goods heavily consumed by the poor, and The commodities which are produced within the country levied reduction in the overall tax burden on goods, which is currently to a minimum and it would be harmonized for the Centre
higher rates on luxury items, mostly consumed by the rich. by central excise duty. However, commodities on which state estimated at 25%- 30%. Introduction of the GST is also and states as far as possible.
India has adopted this system for income tax. This is pro- governments impose excise duties (e.g. liquor, drugs) are expected to make Indian products competitive in domestic and
(xiii) Exports would be zero-rated.
poor way of taxation and is popular in the whole world. exempted from the central excise duty. In recent years large international markets. Studies show that this would instantly
number of goods has come under excise duty. Moreover, the spur economic growth. Because of its transparent character, it (xiv) Credit of CGST paid on inputs may be used only for
(2) Regressive tax is expected that the GST would be easier to administer. paying CGST on the output and the credit of SGST paid
rates of these duties have also been increasing.
Regressive tax is one where the proportion of tax paid falls The broad features of the proposed GST model are as follows: on inputs may be used only for paying SGST. In other
as income rises. Customs duty (i) GST would be applicable on supply of goods or services words, the two streams of input tax credit (ITC) cannot
The most regressive tax is a poll tax, levied at a fixed rate as against the present concept of tax on the manufacture be cross utilized, except in specified circumstances of
It is the tax imposed on commodities imported into India
per person regardless of income. A tax system can be made or on sale of goods or on provision of services. inter-state supplies, for payment of IGST.
(import duty) or those exported from India (export duty). Since
regressive by having indirect taxes levied at relatively high (ii) GST would be a destination-based tax as against the
imposing duties on exports reduced the competitive position Over the past four decades, the value added tax (VAT) has
rates on goods heavily consumed by the poor. present concept of origin-based tax.
of the country, the government withdrew export duties. In been an important instrument of indirect taxation, with 130
(3) Proportional Tax recent times; there has been considerable increase in revenue (iii) It would be a dual GST with the Centre and the states countries having adopted it, resulting in one-fifth of the world’s
Proportional tax is one by which the revenue collected from import duties because of heavy imports of iron and steel, simultaneously levying it on a common base. The GST tax revenue. Tax reform in many of the developing countries
rises proportionally with income. A tax system could be petroleum products, chemicals, etc. In the new requirements to be levied by the Centre would be called Central GST has focused on moving to VAT.Federal countries like Canada,
made approximately proportional by having a uniform rate under WTO, import duty will be the only means to curb inputs. (CGST) and that to be levied by the states would be New Zealand, and Australia have successfully adopted the
of income tax with very few exemptions, and indirect taxes Custom duty had been the target revenue generator since called State GST (SGST). GST into their structure. Implementation of a comprehensive
levied at similar rates on as many goods and services as independence. But in recent years the excise duty has overtaken (iv) An integrated GST (1GST) would be levied on inter-state GST in India is expected, ceteris paribus, to lead to efficient
possible. the custom duty as the largest revenue earner. supply (including stock transfers) of goods or services. allocation of factors of production thus bringing about gains in
At some level, progressive and regressive taxes have to This would be collected by the Centre so that the credit GDP and exports. This would translate into enhanced economic
be made proportional, otherwise there will be no limit to Service tax chain is not disrupted. welfare and higher returns to the factors of production, viz.
increase or decrease as the case may be. It is a tax imposed on the person, who avails any specified (v) Import of goods or services would be treated as inter- land, labour, and capital. However, in the near term, as GST
service. It was introduced in 1994-95 to address the state supplies and would be subject to IGST in addition replaces a number of state-level and Central taxes, revenue
Indian Tax Structure asymmetric and distortionary treatment of goods and services to the applicable customs duties. gains may not be significant.
in tax framework and to widen the tax net. The number of
(A) Direct taxes * Source: Department of Revenue and and NCAER 2015-16 Budget Estimate- Gross Tax receipts are estimated
services liable for taxation was raised from 3 in 1994-95 to 119
Working Paper No. 103 titled ‘Moving to Goods and to be ` 14,49,490 crore. Devolution to the States is estimated
Income Tax in 2011-12. However, this concept of a list of services liable
Services Tax in India-Impact on India’s growth and to be ` 5,23,958 crore. Share of Central Government will be
for taxation was changed by the Budget 2012. In this budget,
It is the tax levied directly on the income of the people by the International Trade’, 2009. j` 9,19,842 crore.
the government revamped the taxation provisions for services
Central Government.
E-76 Fiscal and Monetary Policy Fiscal and Monetary Policy E-77

There are three techniques of deficit financing


• The launching of the five-year plans with large expenditure Finance Commission
on projects and the consequent enlargement of bureaucracy;
• The regime of controls over economic activity providing Under Article 280 of the Constitution, the President appoints a

9% s
Finance Commission every five years to determine:

m
scope for corrupt practices;

Custo

ve x
• the distribution of net proceeds of taxes to be shared

Re -ta
Borrowings

10 nue
• Heavy taxation and cumbersome procedures which prompt

n
24% between Centre and states;

No

%
Creation Of Issue Of New Accumulated the evasion;
cise New Money Currency Cash Balance • Rent control and other regressive laws which led to • the principles which should govern the payment by Union
n Ex
Unio es 10% concealment of actual values in real estate transaction; of grants-in-aid to states; and
Duti
Income tax Serv External aid and borrowings • Dishonest foreign trading involving under-invoicing of • any other matter concerning financial relations between
14% ta
l & oth ice Tax centre and states.
pi er Ta
xes A developing country often resorts to foreign aid if it finds that exports and over-invoicing of imports;
ca 9% Finance Commission is a constitutional body. However, its
bt % domestic sources are not large enough. But a country going for There are numerous deleterious effects of black money. It
- de pt 4 Corporation tax recommendations, called awards, are only advisory in nature
on ei foreign aid has to take two precautions: distorts the real picture of the economic system. It leads to
N ec 20% and not binding on Central and State governments. After the
R
(i) Keeping the borrowing level low so that country does not investment of scarce resources in unproductive areas such as
real estate, bullion and precious stones. It acts against the poor 73rd and 74th amendments, Finance Commissions are required
fall in a debt trap, and to recommend steps to supplement resources of local bodies also.
Share of Govt. Earnings In and those with fixed incomes. Most importantly, the existence
(ii) Keeping foreign aid strings-free. of black money distorts the value system of the society and The latest Finance Commission was set up on January 2,
Union Budget 2015-16
External grants and borrowings are different things. External affects the moral fabric of the society in the long run. 2013, under the chairmanship of Dr. Y. V. Reddy, former
aids and grants may come free or with very low or even zero RBI Governor. This is the 14th Finance Commission. Other
DEFICIT FINANCING interest rates. However, these may come with many terms
There is no one solution for the evils of black money. The
most obvious remedy is to simplify the tax structure so that members include Prof. Abhijit Sen, Ms. Sushma Nath, Dr. M.
The process of bridging the gap between the revenue and and conditions attached which are usually not good for a from a feeling of extortion, the taxpayer is made to feel a sense Govinda Rao and Dr. Sudipto Mundle. The recommendations
expenditure is called deficit financing. In other words, Deficit country’s economy and autonomy. External borrowings means of participation in nation building. This requires considerable of the commission will apply on the period 2015-20.
financing refers to the ways in which the budgetary gap is taking loans from other countries. External borrowing is often scaling down of the rates and easy settlement of pending cases. Finance Commissions Appointed So Far:
financed. preferred as it brings foreign currency which may help the Easing of import controls, especially of quantitative types,
government in various ways. It is also preferred over internal Finance Commission Chairman Operational
Deficit financing was first done in the USA in 1930s as a tool and allowing liberal import of consumer goods subject to
borrowings because if the government itself starts borrowing Duration
to get out of the effects of the Great Depression. India tried payment of duty is another measure. Removal of restrictive
from the banks of the country, there might not be enough left laws like rent control and urban land ceilings, which have only First K.C. Neogy 1952-57
this in 1969 and it gradually became a routine phenomenon in for other borrowers.
Indian fiscal management. encouraged the generation of black money, will obviate the Second K. Santhanam 1957-62
Objectives of Deficit financing Internal Borrowings need for entering into concealed transactions. Third A.K. Chanda 1962-66
1. It is used as a tool for meeting financial needs of These are not usually preferred because they might hamper the The Black Money and Imposition Act, 2015, which came Fourth P.V. Rajamannar 1966-69
government, especially in times of war. investment scenario of the public and corporate sector of India. into effect from 1 july 2015, lends 90-days compliace Fifth Mahavir Tyagi 1969-74
But, it may be resorted to as and when required. window. This gives the person having undisclosed foreign Sixth K.Brahmananda 1974-79
2. In under-developed countries, deficit-financing has been assets and income, a chance to come clean by declaring all
considered essential for financing the plans of economic Printing currency Reddy
such assets and paying a total of 60% tax and penalty.
development. Seventh J.M. Shelat 1979-84
It is usually the last resort for the government in managing its
3. It is used for the mobilisation of surplus, non- utilised and deficit. It might help the government in times of need but it General Anti Avoidance Rules (GAAR) Eighth Y.B. Chavan 1984-89
idle resources in the economy. should be undertaken only in case of extreme necessity as it has GAAR has been introduced as a very important component of Ninth N.K.P. Salve 1989-95
4. It is used as an instrument of economic policy for many damaging effects on the economy. It increases inflation Direct Tax code with the objective of preventing such deals Tenth Late Shri KV Pant 1995-2000
removing the conditions of depression and to raise the proportionally. It may also lead to a pressure on the government and transactions that are carried out to evade and avoid paying
Eleventh A.M.Khusro 2000-2005
level of output and employment. for an upward revision in salaries of government employees, taxes. In other words, GAAR seeks to prevent such transactions
which in turn will lead to an increase of government’s that are carried out by way of aggressive tax planning so as to Twelfth C. Rangarajan 2005-2010
Public debt
expenditure, further necessitating printing of currency and avoid paying taxes. GAAR has been prompted by practices Thirteenth Dr. Vijay L Kelkar 2010-2015
Governments in developing countries borrow internally under more inflation. Thus, it may begin a vicious cycle. Moreover, of ‘round- tripping’ whereby a company operating in India Fourteenth Yega Venugopal 2015-2020
various attractive schemes of capital accumulation. Public debt it also has the obvious drawback in the fact that it cannot help may deliberately incorporate its office in a tax haven country, Reddy
has three components: in case of expenditures that are to be done in foreign currency. moves its assets there and invests back in India, thereby
(i) Internal debt: It includes market loans from banks and avoiding paying tax in India. Monetary Policy
financial institutions, short-term borrowings on treasury Black Money The announcement to implement GAAR from 2012-13 caused
bills and other bonds and certificates issued by the panic among foreign investors and led to massive outflow of Monetary policy refers to the set of measures adopted by the
It is unaccounted money which is concealed from tax authorities. Central bank for monetary management.
government. foreign funds, which led the government to set up Shome
All illegal economic activities are dealt with this Black Money.
(ii) Other internal liabilities: It includes small saving committee to review GAAR. The Committee recommended, Monetary Policy Objectives
Hawala market has deep roots with this black money. Black
schemes, provident fund, reserve fund of the railways, among other things, postponement of GAAR and also • Stability of external value Fluctuation in exchange rate
money creates parallel economy. It puts an adverse pressure
post and telegraph on which the Central Government has recommended that it should not be imposed on investments of a currency affects foreign trade and investment. It is,
on equitable distribution of wealth and income in the economy.
to pay interest. from Mauritius and Singapore. It also recommended that therefore, important that the rate of exchange is maintained
Some of the reasons for the spread of black money in India GAAR should not be imposed if the tax liabilities are less
(iii) External debt: It includes loan from foreign countries and without violent fluctuations.
are: than 3 crores. It also suggested doing away with the arbitrary
international financial institutions like the World Bank, powers given to tax authorities in India. • Maintenance of domestic price level Fluctuation in
• The shortage and consequent black marketing during the
IMF, ADB, etc. prices affects investment decisions. It also leads to
war years and the troubled days of partition;

E-78 Fiscal and Monetary Policy Fiscal and Monetary Policy E-79

increasing income disparities. However, monetary policy or gold or govt. approved securities before providing credit
CREDIT CONTROL MEASURES
alone cannot ensure the maintenance of domestic prices, to the customers. Here by approved securities we mean bond
as several other factors such as erratic monsoons, changes and shares of different companies. Statutory liquid ratio is
in tastes, fluctuation in world prices, etc. affect domestic determined and maintained by RBI in order to control the
prices. expansion of bank credit. It is determined as percentage total
• Reducing the impact of business cycles (slumps and demand and percentage of time liabilities. Time liabilities refer
booms) by manipulation of credit and interest policy. to liabilities, which the commercial banks are liable to pay to Quantitative Qualitative
However, economists are not of the same opinion on the customers on demand or pay within one month’s time, due
whether business cycles are primarily caused by monetary to completion of maturity period. The maximum limit of SLR
factors. is 40%. At present, the SLR is 21.5%.
Indian Monetary Policy If any Indian bank fails to maintain the required level of SLR,
Planned economic development adopted by India required an then it becomes liable to pay penalty to RBI. The defaulter Bank Open Market Cash Statutory Margin Moral Direct
Rationing
active monetary policy. The two stated aims of this policy bank pays penal interest at the rate of 3% per annum above Rate Policy Operations Reserve liquidity Requirements of Credit Suasion Action
were: the bank rate on the shortfall amount for that particular day. Ratio Ratio
• boost economic development. If the defaulter bank continues to default on the next working
day then the rate of penal interest can be increased to 5% per Capital Account Convertibility (CAC) While India made the rupee fully convertible under current
• control inflationary pressure. account, it was felt that the economy was not yet ready for
annum above the bank rate. This restriction is imposed by RBI A currency is said to be convertible when it can be freely capital account convertibility. The countries which went in
The Reserve Bank of India is the nodal agency for on banks to make funds available to customers on demand as
implementing the monetary policy. RBI has defined its exchanged for another currency at market rates. Transaction for hasty CAC in the 1980s had to face financial crisis. The
soon as possible. Gold and Government securities (Gilts) are of current account includes dealing with payments relating to thinking was that trade and domestic liberalization process
monetary policy in terms of “adequate financing of economic
included along with cash because they are highly liquid and foreign trade, travel and other services. Capital account deals should be completed before CAC can be thought of. Many
growth and at the same time ensuring reasonable price
safe assets. with transaction in financial assets. While India has made the economists feel that CAC will only help the drain of Indian
stability”. The agreement on Monetary Policy framework
RBI can increase the SLR to contain inflation, suck liquidity Indian rupee fully convertible on current account, it is yet capital, which will get invested abroad. The present policy is
between the Government and the RBI dated february 20, 2015
from the market, and to safeguard the customers’ money. to accept capital account convertibility as a goal. Broadly, to go slow on CAC.
defines the price stability objective explicitly in terms of the
capital account convertibility would mean freedom for firms The RBI appointed the Committee on Capital Account
target for inflation- as measured by the consumer price index- Open Market Operations and residents to freely buy into overseas assets such as equity, Convertibility (CAC) with S.S Tarapore as chairman. The
combined (CPI-C) in near to medium term, i.e.
This refers to the RBI buying and selling eligible securities to bonds, property, and acquire ownership of overseas firms Committee submitted its report in 1997 setting a three-phase
(a) below 6% by january 2016, and regulate money supply. Traditionally RBI was not resorting to besides free repatriation of proceeds by foreign investors. time-table (1997-98, 1998-99, 1999-2000) to achieve CAC.
(b) 4% for the financial year 2016-17 and all subsequent years. this method. However, after the large inflow of foreign funds India is reluctant to increase the pace capital account Committee, recommended that capital account convertibility
RBI instruments to achieve a stable monetary policy since 1991, RBI has had to step in to sterilize the flow to avoid convertibility by taking experience of Mexico. It was one of would be greatly beneficial for India by making available
includes: excess liquidity. the largest recipients of foreign private capital ($29 billion in large funds (which would promote economic growth) and
Bank Rate It is the rate at which RBI rediscounts the bills of 1993). But, with the devaluation of its currency and the collapse improved access to world financial markets, bringing about
Repo and Reverse Repo
exchange. In practice, it is the rate at which RBI lends to other of the exchange rate, much of the capital fled the country. This an improvement of the country’s financial system in the
Repo (Repurchase Option) and Reverse Repo are instruments catastrophic collapse was due to capital account convertibility, global context, besides allowing Indians to acquire and hold
commercial banks. It thus acts as a signal to the economy on
used by RBI in day-to-day liquidity management. Repo rate is which encouraged even Mexican residents to convert their international securities and assets.
the direction of the monetary policy. Bank rate had a limited
the rate at which RBI lends to commercial banks and Reverse capital into dollars, precipitating the crisis. Similar situation Before attaining full convertibility, the CAC recommended,
impact in the period before economic reforms (1991) when
Repo is the rate at which RBI borrows from commercial arose in the late 1997 in South East Asian countries also where India was to fulfill certain important preconditions:
RBI would determine the interest rate structure. However, with
banks. In inflationary situations, RBI can hike the Reverse their local currencies were devaluated by 58% in one month.
the delegating of this power to the commercial banks (except Fiscal consolidation: Reduction in gross fiscal deficit from
interest rates in priority sectors) the importance of bank rate Repo rate and absorb the excess liquidity in the market. There is a difference in concept between ‘Full Currency 4.5% of GDP in 1997-98 to 3.5 % in 1999-2000.
has been revived. RBI uses changes in Bank Rate to regulate Similarly, in case there is a requirement to increase liquidity Convertibility’ and a ‘Fully Open Capital Account’. Currency
into the system, RBI can reduce the Repo rate which will lead convertibility refers to the absence of any restriction on the Mandated inflation rate: The mandated rate of inflation for 3
fluctuations in exchange rate and domestic inflation. Now-a- years should be an average of 3 to 5 %.
days the Prime Lending Rate (PLR) is decided by commercial to release of money into the market. RBI occasionally resorts holding of foreign currencies by residents and of the national
banks with reference to bank rate and the deposit position of to the Repo rate to fine-tune the liquidity position, without currency by foreigners, and on free conversion between Based on the recommendations of the Committee, the Foreign
each bank. At the moment, this rate is 7.75%. resorting to major policy instruments such as changes in currencies. It does not preclude restrictions on the type and Exchange Regulation Act (FERA) was repealed and replaced
CRR and Bank Rate. However, markets are bound to react to quantity of non-currency assets that residents can hold abroad with Foreign Exchange Management Act (FEMA) in June
Cash Reserve Ratio (CRR) 2000. FERA was considered a very rigid regulation and
frequent changes in the Repo rates and this will be reflected to or foreigners can hold in the country. An Open Capital
Every commercial bank is required to keep a certain percentage Account, on the other hand, is the absence of restrictions promoted conservation of foreign exchange. FEMA in turn
frequent in corresponding changes in the deposit and lending
of its demand and time liabilities (deposits) with the RBI on non-currency asset holdings, and can exist without free encouraged the formation of a foreign exchange market and
rates of commercial banks.
(either as cash or book balance). The RBI varies this ratio to conversion of the currency. facilitated trade.
change the liquidity of market. RBI is empowered to fix the l Margin Requirement- refers to difference between the
CRR at a rate ranging between 3% per cent and 15%. Like securities offered and amount borrowed by the banks.
the Bank Rate, CRR is also subject to frequent changes as RBI l Rationing of Credit - RBI controls the credit granted/
intervenes from time to time to correct monetary or exchange allocated by commercial banks.
rate imbalances. This ratio, currently, is 4%. l Moral suasion - Psychological means and informal
Statutory Liquidity Ratio (SLR) means of selective credit control.
Statutory liquidity ratio refers to the amount that the l Direct Action - Refers to the step taken by the RBI
commercial banks require to maintain in the form of cash, against banks don’t fulfil conditions and requirements.
E-80 Fiscal and Monetary Policy Fiscal and Monetary Policy E-81

Exercise - 1 18.



____ is not a non-Plan expenditure?
(a) Interest payment
(b) Subsidies
(c) Central assistance for states and UT plans
24. The banks are required to maintain a certain ratio between



their cash in hand and total assets. This is called:
(a) SBR (Statutory Bank Ratio)
(b) SLR (Statutory Liquid Ratio)
1. The process of budget making after re-evaluating every 10. Fiscal deficit means: (d) Defense expenditure (c) CBR (Central Liquid Reserve)
item of expenditure in every financial year is known as- (a) Total receipts minus expenditure 19. Which one of the following statements regarding the levying, (d) CLR (Central Liquid Reserve)
(a) Performance Budgeting (b) Total receipts minus interest payments on external collecting, and distribution of Income Tax is correct? 25. The sales tax you pay while purchasing a toothpaste is a
(b) Deficit Budgeting debt (a) The Union levies, collects, and distributes the (a) tax imposed by the Central Government
(c) Zero Based Budgeting (c) Revenue receipts minus ex-penditure proceeds of income tax between itself and the states. (b) tax imposed by the Central Government but collected
(d) Fresh Budgeting (d) Revenue receipts minus defense expenditure (b) The Union levies, collects, and keeps all the by the State Government
2. Which of the following is not viewed as a national debt? 11. Value-added tax is proceeds of income tax itself. (c) tax imposed by the State Government but collected
(a) ad valorem tax on domestic final consumption collected (c) The Union levies and collects the tax but all the by the Central Government
(a) Provident Fund
at all stages between production and the point of final proceeds are distributed among the states (d) tax imposed and collected by the State Government
(b) Life Insurance Policies
sale (d) Only the surcharge levied on income tax is shared 26. According to the provisions of the Fiscal Responsibility
(c) National Saving Certificate
(b) ad valorem tax on final consumption collected at between the Union and the states. and Budget Management
(d) Long-term Government Bonds
manufacturing level 20. The diagram shows a relationship between inflation and Act., 2003 and FRBM Rules, 2004, the Government is
3. Tarapore Committee submitted its report on “Full under obligation to present three statements before the
(c) tax on final consumption collected at the consumption unemployment for an economy.
Convertibility on Rupee” in- parliament along with the Annual Budget. Which one of
(a) Current account stage
the following is not one of them?
(b) Capital account (d) special tax levied by states on products from other
(a) Macroeconomic Framework Statement
(c) Both in current as well as in capital account states
(b) Fiscal Policy Strategy Statement
(d) Special Drawing Rights (SDRs) 12. States’ debt does not include:
(c) Medium-term Fiscal Policy Statement
4. CENVAT is related to- (a) loos from State Bank of India
(d) Statement showing Short term Fiscal Policy
(a) Sales Tax (b) Excise Duty (b) loans from the Central government
27. As per the Economic Survey 2007-2008, which one
(c) Custom Duty (d) Service Tax (c) provident fund of the following is the largest source of revenue of the
5. Plan expenditure in India is met by- (d) treasury bills issued to inter-national financial Government of India?
(a) Internal debt and other resources institutions (a) Excise Duty (b) Personal income Tax
(b) Assistance from Aid India Club 13. An instrument of qualitative credit control is (c) Corporation Tax (d) Customs Duties
(a) Open market operations Which of the following policies would move the economy
(c) Assistance from IMF from A to B? 28. Fiscal Policy in India is formulated by
(d) Assistance from OECD countries (b) variable reserve ratio (a) the Reserve Bank of India
(c) Bank rate (a) Reduce interest rate and increase income tax rates
6. High fiscal deficit is cause for concern for any economy. (b) Reduce interest rates and decrease income tax rates (b) the Planning Commission
What does it denote? (d) Credit rationing (c) the Finance Ministry
14. Budget deficit is: (c) Increase interest rates and decrease income tax rates
(a) It is a measure of the borrowing of an economy (d) the Securities and Exchange Board of India
(a) excess of total expenditure including loans net of (d) Increase interest rates and increase Income tax rates
(b) It is total expenditure less total receipts excluding 29. Corporation tax is imposed by
lending over revenue receipts 21. If a government budgets for a surplus and there is an
borrowings (a) State Government
(b) difference between revenue receipts and revenue unexpected increase in the level of economic activity,
(c) It reflects the decrease in tax collections for the year (b) Central Government
expenditure which of the following is likely to occur?
(d) it means the lack of liquidity and earnings for the (c) Local Government
(c) difference between all receipts and all expenditure (a) There will be an increase in tax revenues and an (d) State as well as Central Government
economy increase in the budget surplus
7. With reference to the Finance Commission of India, (d) fiscal deficit less interest payments 30. Convertibility of rupee implies [CSAT 2015-I]
15. Current account in the Balance of Payment comprise is (b) There will be an increase in tax revenues and a (a) being able to convert rupee notes into gold
which of the following statements is correct ? decrease in the budget
(a) It encourages the inflow of foreign capital for ___? (b) allowing the value of rupee to be fixed by market
(a) difference of total exports and imports in one year (c) There will be a decrease in tax revenues and an forces
infrastructure development increase in the budget surplus
(b) invisible account like tourism, shipping, insurance, (c) freely permitting the conversion of rupee to other
(b) It facilitates the proper distribution of finances (d) There will be a decrease in tax revenues and a
etc. currencies and vice versa
among the Public Sector Undertakings decrease in the budget surplus
(c) transactions like net external assistance, NRI deposits, (d) developing an international market for currencies in
(c) It ensures transparency in financial administration 22. In India, deficit financing is used for raising resources for
etc. India
(d) None of the statements (a), (b) and (c) given above (a) economic development 31. When the Reserve Bank of India reduces the Statutory
(d) trade balance plus invisible balance
is correct in his context (b) redemption of public debt Liquidity Ratio by 50 basis points, which of the following
16. Fiscal stability means that, other things remaining
8. Which one at the following is responsi­ble for the (c) adjusting the balance of payments is likely to happen? [CSAT 2015-I]
constant
preparation and presentation of Union Budget to the (d) reducing the foreign debt (a) India’s GDP growth rate increases drastically
(a) debt-GDP ratio declines over time
Parliament? 23. Which one of the following is the correct statement? (b) Foreign Institutional Investors may bring more
(b) both debt and GDP decrease over time
(a) Department of Revenue Service tax is a/an: capital into our country
(c) debt and GDP increase at the same rate
(b) Department of Economic Affairs (a) direct tax levied by the Central Government. (c) Scheduled Commercial Banks may cut their lending
(d) debt increases but GDP remains the same
(c) Department of Financial Services (b) indirect tax levied by the Central Government. rates
17. Which is incorrect about convertibility?
(d) Department of Expenditure (c) direct tax levied by the State Government. (d) It may drastically reduce the liquidity to the banking
(a) Exchange rate should be based on forces of demand
9. In India, the tax proceeds of which one of the following (d) indirect tax levied by the State Government. system
and supply.
as a percentage of gross tax revenue has significantly
(b) Exchange rate should show the strength of the
declined in the last five years?
economy.
(a) Service tax (b) Personal income tax
(c) Discourage black market transactions.
(c) Excise duty (d) Corporation tax
(d) RBI would become a direct player.

E-82 Fiscal and Monetary Policy Fiscal and Monetary Policy E-83

Exercise - 2 13. With reference to Union Budget, which of the following



is/are covered under Non-Plan Expenditure?
1. Defence expenditure
2. Interest payments


1. Hawala market has deep roots with this black money
2. It is unaccounted money which is concealed from tax
authorities
3. All legal economic activities are dealt with this Black
Statement Based MCQ ten years in consonance with India’s demographic 3. Salaries and pensions Money
dividend. 4. Subsidies 4. It puts an adverse pressure on equitable distribution of
3. Devolution of a specified share of central taxes to Select the correct answer using the code given below. wealth and income in the economy
1. After 1947, development and non-development
local bodies as grants. (a) 1 only (b) 2 and 3 only
expenditures have increased, the increase in the former (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
Select the correct answer using the codes given below (c) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (d) None
being more. Nondevelopment expenditure involves (a) 1 only (b) 2 and 3 (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 4
1. interest payments 2. subsidies 14. Which of the following are included in the category of 21. Which of the following is the tax imposed on commodities
(c) 1 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3
3. defence 4. irrigation 7. Which statements about indirect taxes in India are true? direct tax in India? imported into India (import duty) or those exported from
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 1 only 1. Yield from indirect taxes is more than that from direct 1. Corporation tax 2. Tax on income India (export duty)?
(c) 1, 2 and 3 (d) 2, 3 and 4 taxes. 3. Wealth tax 4. Customs duty 1. Customs duty 2. Central excise duty
2. Consider the following statements in respect of Financial 2. Indirect taxes have grown faster than direct taxes after 5. Excise duty 3. Incorporate duty
Commission: 1947. Select the correct answer using the codes given below (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
1. It is mandatory to appoint a Finance Commission 3. Indirect taxes are ultimately paid for by persons who (a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1, 2, 4 and 5
do not actually pay taxes to the government. (c) 3 only (d) 2 and 3
every five years. (c) 2 and 3 (d) 1, 3, 4 and 5
4. Increase in indirect taxes is good in a developing 22. Which among the following statements is incorrect in
2. Finance Commission lays down the principles 15. Which of the following refers to that part of deficit for
governing grant-in-aid to states. country. regards to Statutory liquid ratio?
which the government borrows from the RBI?
3. Finance Minister is the ex-officio Chairperson of the (a) 1, 2 and 4 (b) 1 and 2 1. Statutory liquid ratio refers to the amount that the
(c) 2 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 1. Primary deficit 2. Secondary deficit
Finance Commission. commercial banks require to maintain in the form
8. Which are the pre-requisites required by the Indian 3. Regulatory deficit 4. Monetised deficit
4. The award given by the Finance Commission is of cash, or gold or govt. approved securities before
economy to implement convertibility of rupee on trade (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
binding on Central and State governments. providing credit to the customers
account as suggested by the Rangarajan Committee? (c) 3 only (d) 4 only
Which of the above statements are correct? 1. There should be comfortable foreign exchange resources 2. Statutory liquid ratio is determined and maintained by
16. Which of the following statements is/are correct in terms
(a) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (b) 1, 2 and 4 2. Low rate of inflation. RBI in order to control the expansion of bank credit
of Direct and Indirect taxes?
(c) 1, 2 and 3 (d) 1, 3 and 4 3. Mechanism by which the government can pass on the 3. At present, the SLR is 4%
1. Excise duty and sales tax are examples of indirect
3. Increase in net RBI credit for Central Government changes in the price of imported goods to the consumers 4. It is determined as percentage total demand and
taxes
represents- 4. SLR and CRR must be low. percentage of time liabilities
1. Budgetary Deficit 2. Revenue Deficit 2. Taxes like income tax and property tax are direct taxes
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 1, 2 and 3 (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
3. Fiscal Deficit 4. Monetised Deficit (c) 1 and 4 (d) All of the above 3. There is no difference between Direct and Indirect tax
Select the correct answer using the code given below: (c) 3 only (d) None of the above
Choose the right option 9. Consider the following statements
Full convertibility of the rupee may mean (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 23. Which of the following statements is/are correct in regards
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
1. Its free float with the international currencies. (c) 1 and 2 (d) 1, 2 and 3 to Revenue budget?
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only
2. Its direct exchange with any other international 17. Which of the following refers to the freedom for firms and 1. It consists of all capital receipts and expenditure
4. Which of the following is the main aim of Indian Monetary
Policy? currency at any prescribed place inside and outside residents to freely buy into overseas assets? such as domestic and foreign loans, loan repayment,
the country. 1. Capital Account Consumption foreign and etc
1. Control inflationary pressure
3. It acts just like any other international currency. 2. Capital Across Convertibility 2. It consists of all current receipts, such as taxation,
2. Boost economic development Which of these statements are correct?
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 3. Capital Account Continuity dividends of public sector units (PSU’s) and
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 1 and 3
(c) 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (c) 2 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3 4. Capital Account Convertibility expenditure of the government
5. With reference to the Indian Public Finance, consider the 10. Which of the following is/are type of Budget? (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
following statements. 1. Capital budget 2. Revenue budget (c) 3 only (d) 4 only (c) 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
1. External liabilities reported in the Union Budget are (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 18. Which of the following refers to the RBI buying and selling 24. With reference to ‘Central excise duty’, which of the
based on historical exchange rates. (c) 2 only (d) Neither 1 nor 2 eligible securities to regulate money supply? following statements is/are correct?
2. The continued high borrowing has kept the real 11. Which of the following are among the non-plan expenditures 1. Repo and Reverse Repo 1. Commodities on which state governments impose
interest rates high in the economy. of the Government of India? 2. Open Market Operations excise duties are exempted from the central excise
3. The upward trend in the ratio of Fiscal Deficit to 1. Defence expenditure 3. Response and Reverse Repo duty
GDP in recent years has an adverse effect on private 2. Subsidies 4. Relative Market Operations 2. In recent years large number of goods has come under
investments. 3. All expenditures linked with the previous plan periods (a) 1 and 2 (b) 2 only excise duty. Moreover, the rates of these duties have
4. Interest payments is the single largest component 4. Interest payment (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 4 also been increasing
of the non-plan revenue expenditure of the Union 19. Which of the following is/are the major Objectives of
Codes: 3. Commodities which are produced within the country
Government. Deficit financing?
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 1 and 3 levied by central excise duty
Which of these statements are correct? 1. Used as an instrument of economic policy
(c) 2 and 4 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
(a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1 and 4 2. It is used as a tool for meeting financial needs of
(c) 2, 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 12. Consider the following statements: (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3
The Indian rupee is fully convertible: government
6. Which of the following is /are among the noticeable 25. Mobilization of resources and channelizing the same for
1. in respect of Current Account of Balance of payment 3. Used for the mobilization of surplus, non- utilized and
features of the recommendations of the Thirteenth Finance idle resources in the economy productive investment is the primary purpose of
2. in respect of Capital Account of Balance of payment 1. Expenditure 2. VAT
Commission? (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
1. A design for the Goods and Services Tax, and a 3. into gold 3. Taxation 4. CRR
(c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3
compensation package linked to adherence to the Which of these statements is/are correct ? (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
20. Which of the following statements is incorrect in regards
proposed design. (a) 1 alone (b) 3 alone to Black money? (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 4
2. A design for the creation of lakhs of jobs in the next (c) 1 and 2 (d) 1, 2 and 3
E-84 Fiscal and Monetary Policy Fiscal and Monetary Policy E-85

26. Which of the following is the process of bridging the gap 35. Which of the following statements is incorrect about Repo 42. Annual financial statement has to be placed before (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
between the revenue and expenditure? and Reverse Repo? parliament for every financial year i.e. (c) 3 only (d) 4 only
1. Multiple financing 2. Bridge financing 1. At present, the repo rate is 11.75% 1. January 1 to December 31 51. Which of the following has been introduced as a very
3. Accurate financing 4. Deficit financing 2. At present, the reverse repo rate is 5.75% 2. March 31 to April 1 important component of Direct Tax code with the objective
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 3. Repo rate is the rate at which RBI lends to commercial 3. April 1 to March 31 of preventing such deals and transactions?
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only banks (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 1. General Avoidance Rules
27. In which year was Service tax introduced? (c) 3 only (d) None of the above 2. General Anti Affect Rules
4. Reverse Repo is the rate at which RBI borrows from
1. 1983-84 2. 1994-95 43. Consider the following: 3. General Anti Avoidance Rules
3. 1967-68 4. 2003-2004 commercial banks
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 1. Market borrowing 4. General Arm Affect Rules
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(c) 1, 3 and 4 (d) None of the above 2. Treasury bills
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 4
36. Which of the following is/are the components of Public 3. Special securities issued to RBI
28. Which of the following means rates of tax increase for 52. Which of the following details can be obtained by Annual
debt? Which of these is/are components(s) of internal debt?
increasing values or volumes on which the tax is levied financial statement?
1. Progressive tax 2. Proportional tax 1. External debt (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
(c) 2 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 1. Government forecasts of receipts and payments for
3. Regressive tax 4. Indirect tax 2. Other internal liabilities the next year
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 44. Consider the following statements with regard to Statutory
3. Internal debt 2. An outline of the results of the last financial year
(c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 4 Liquidity Ratio (SLR)
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 compared with the previous budget estimates
29. Which of the following is not a technique of Deficit 1. To meet SLR, Commercial banks can use cash only.
(c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 3. Proposed changes in taxes and expenditure allocations
financing? 2. SLR is maintained by the banks with themselves.
37. Choose the correct one from the below expressions (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
1. Internal Borrowings 3. SLR restricts the banks leverage in pumping more
1. Fiscal deficit = Budget deficit – Government’s market money into the economy. (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3
2. Counting Currency
3. Printing Currency borrowing and liabilities Which of the statements given above is/are correct? 53. Excess of total expenditure over total revenues is termed as
4. External aid and borrowings 2. Fiscal deficit = Budget deficit + Government’s (a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1 and 3 1. Revenue deficit 2. Fiscal deficit
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only market borrowing and liabilities (c) 2 and 3 (d) only 2 3. Budget deficit 4. Overall deficit
(c) 2 and 3 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 3. Fiscal deficit = Revenue expenditure – Budget 45. Which among the following is/are the nodal agency for (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
30. Where was VAT introduced? receipts implementing the monetary policy? (c) 3 only (d) 4 only
1. France 2. USA 4. Fiscal deficit = Revenue expenditure + Budget 1. State Bank of India 54. Which of the following may lead to a pressure on
3. Australia 4. China receipts the government for an upward revision in salaries of
2. Reserve Bank of India
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only government employees?
3. Union Bank
(c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 (c) 3 only (d) None of the above 1. Internal Borrowings
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
31. Which of the following taxes is the one by which the 38. Regressive tax can be defined as 2. External aid and borrowings
(c) 2 only (d) 1, 2 and 3
revenue collected rises proportionally with income? 3. Counting Currency
1. The one by which the revenue collected rises 46. Which of the following refers to the set of measures adopted
1. Regressive tax 2. Progressive tax 4. Printing currency
proportionally with income by the central bank?
3. Corporate tax 4. Proportional tax (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2
2. The rates of tax increase for increasing values or 1. Monetary policy 2. GAAR
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only (c) 3 only (d) 4 only
volumes on which the tax is levied 3. Finance Commission 4. Black Money 55. Which of the following is the tax on income of the
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only
32. Which of the following statements is/are correct with 3. The one where the proportion of tax paid falls as (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 companies?
reference to Primary deficit? income rises (c) 3 only (d) 4 only 1. Corporation tax
1. India started using this term since 1997-98 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 47. Which of the following refers to the use by the government 2. Reliable tax
2. Primary deficit is fiscal deficit minus interest payments (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 of the various instruments such as taxation, expenditure and 3. Compensatory tax
3. It shows the current state of government finances 39. Which of the following precautions has to be taken by a borrowing in order to achieve the objectives of balanced (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 country going for foreign aid? economic development etc? (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3
(c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 1. Keeping foreign aid strings-free 1. Annual financial statement 56. Who among the following appoints a Finance Commission
33. In the context of economic liberalization, which of the 2. Keeping the borrowing level low so that country does 2. Fiscal policy under Article 280 of the Constitution?
following is/are the major themes of the fiscal policy? not fall in a debt trap 3. Revenue budget 1. Prime Minister 2. Finance Minister
1. A deliberate move to a regime of reasonable direct tax (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 3. President 4. Public
rates and better administration and enforcement (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
2. A systematic effort to simplify tax structure and tax 40. Which of the following is a type of the Public expenditure 48. Which among the following is/are the main objective of (c) 3 only (d) 3 and 4
laws in India? Monetary Policy? 57. Which of the following statements is/are correct as per
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 1. Plan 2. Non-plan 1. Maintenance of domestic price level Article 114(3) of the Constitution?
(c) 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 2. Reducing the impact of business cycles 1. No money can be taken out of consolidated fund
34. With reference to ‘Cash Reserve Ratio’, which of the (c) 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 3. Stability of external value without the approval of the Rajya Sabha
following statements is/are correct? 41. Choose the correct one from the following. (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 2. No money can be taken out of consolidated fund
1. The RBI varies Cash Reserve Ratio to change the 1. Revenue deficit = Revenue expenditure – Revenue (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 without the approval of the Lok Sabha
liquidity of market receipts 49. The highest rate of income tax before 1975 was
2. CRR is subject to frequent changes as RBI intervenes 3. Money can be taken out of consolidated fund without
2. Revenue deficit = Revenue receipts – Revenue 1. 72.85 2. 97.25
from time to time to correct monetary or exchange expenditure any approval
3. 46.89 4. 27.14 Select the correct answer using the code given below:
rate imbalances 3. Revenue deficit = Revenue receipts – Total
expenditure (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
3. CRR currently is 4%
4. RBI is empowered to fix the CRR at a rate ranging 4. Revenue deficit = Revenue expenditure – Total (c) 3 only (d) 3 and 4 (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3
between three per cent and 15 per cent receipts 50. In which of the following years, did govt introduce 58. Which of the following statements of the government gives
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 Minimum Alternate tax on companies? expression to its fiscal policy?
(c) 3 only (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 1. 1996 2. 1949 1. Annual financial statement
3. 1972 4. 2005 2. Deficit financing

E-86 Fiscal and Monetary Policy Fiscal and Monetary Policy E-87

3. Open capital account (a) I-c, II-a, III-b (b) I-b, II-c, III-a
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 (c) I-a, II-d, III-b (d) I-b, II-a, III-c
(c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 64. List-I List-II
59. Which of the following is the rate at which RBI lends to (A) Partial (1) Unified exchange rate,
commercial banks? convertibility applied for export and
1. Corporate rate 2. Economy rate import of goods only, visible EXERCISE-1 maintain with itself at any given point of time in
3. Bank rate 4. Growth rate transaction of BoP. the form of liquid assets like cash in hand, current
1. (c) 2. (c) 3. (b) 4. (a) 5. (a) 6. (b)
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 (B) Convertibility (2) Currency can be balances with other banks and first class securities
7. (d) The Commission shall make recommendations as to
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only on trade account converted on all accounts. which can be turned into cash (gold, cash or other
the following matters, namely :
(C) Convertibility (3) 60% of foreign exchange approve securities). This ratio at present is 25%.
Matching Based MCQ on current account to be converted at market
(i) The distribution between the Union and the States
Some assets have to be in liquid form to take care of
of the net proceeds of taxes which are to be, or may
rates and rest at official rate. financial emergencies which every bank has to face.
be, divided between them under Chapter I Part XII
DIRECTIONS (Qs. 60-67) : Match List-I with List-II and (D) Full convertibility (4) Full convertibility in It regulates the credit growth in India.
of the Constitution and the allocation between the
select the correct answer using the codes given below the lists. all visible and invisible 25. (d) Taxes on tooth paste come under GST which is
States of the respective shares of such proceeds;
60. Match columns A and B wherein Column B defines Column A transaction of goods and administered by State government.Sales tax is paid
(ii) The principles which should govern the grants-in-aid to sales tax authority in the state from where the
Column A Column B services.
of the revenues of the States out of the Consolidated goods are moved.
I. Public Account a. Consists of all revenues (a) A-1, B-2, C-3, D-4 (b) A-3, B-1, C-4, D-2
Fund of India and the sums to be paid to the States 26. (d) The Act requires the government to lay before
and loans received by the (c) A-4, B-2, C-1, D-3 (d) A-1, B-4, C-3, D-2
which are in need of assistance by way of grants- the parliament three policy statements in each
government 65. Match columns A and B wherein Column B defines Column A
II. Consolidated fund b.  Comprises of the sum in-aid of their revenues under article 275 of the financial year namely Medium Term Fiscal Policy
Column A Column B Constitution for purposes other than those specified
placed at the disposal of the Statement; Fiscal Policy Strategy Statement and
President to meet unforeseen Capital a. Includes interest payments, in the provisions to clause (1) of that article; and Macroeconomic Framework Policy Statement.
I.
expenditure expenditure subsidies, defence expenditure (iii) The measures needed to augment the Consolidated 27. (c) As per economic survey 2007-2008 corporation tax
III. Contingency fund c.  Consists of receipts and b. Includes loans to PSUs, states, Fund of a State to supplement the resources of the is the largest source of revenue of the Government
payments, which are in II. Plan expenditure Panchayats and Municipalities in the State on the
foreign governments of India.
form of deposit account basis of the recommendations made by the Finance 28. (c) The Department of Economic Affairs (DEA) under
c. Includes expenditure on central
with the government, such Commission of the State. Ministry of Finance is the nodal agency of the Union
plans such as agriculture,
as provident funds, small Revenue 8. (b) The DEA or the Department of Economic Affairs Government to formulate and monitor country’s
savings, etc III. rural development, irrigation,
expenditure is also responsible for preparation and presentation economic policies and programmes having a bearing
(a) I-c, II-a, III-b (b) I-a, II-b, III-c transport, communications,
environment and welfare schemes to the Parliament of Central Budget and the Budgets on domestic and international aspects of economic
(c) I-a, II-d, III-b (d) I-b, II-a, III-c
(a) I-c, II-a, III-b (b) I-b, II-c, III-a for the State Governments under President’s Rule management.
61. Match columns A and B wherein column B shows the tax
(c) I-a, II-d, III-b (d) I-b, II-a, III-c and Union Territory Administration. 29. (d) Corporation Tax is imposed by State as well as
to GDP ratio for respective year in Column A
Column A Column B 66. In the context of Indian economy, which of the following is/are 9. (c) The excise duty’s share in the total tax revenue, Central Government. Corporation tax is imposed on
I. 1950-51 a. 10.60% the purpose/purposes of ‘Statutory Reserve Requirements’? which was 41.3 percent in 1992-93, declined to 25.1 the income or capital of some types of legal entities.
II. 2007-08 b. 6% (CSAT 2014-I) percent in 2006-07. The customs duty’s share in the The taxes may also be referred to as income tax.
III. Present c. 11.89% 1. To enable the Central Bank to control the amount of total tax revenue, which was 31.9 percent in 1992- 30. (c) Convertibility of rupee implies freely permitting
(a) I-c, II-a, III-b (b) I-a, II-c, III-b advances the banks can create 93, fell to 17.5 percent in 2006-07, as a result of the conversion of rupee to other currencies and
(c) I-b, II-c, III-a (d) I-b, II-a, III-b 2. To make the people’s deposits with banks safe and massive structuring on excise and customs. vice versa. Currency Convertibility is the ease with
62. Match columns A and B Column A liquid 10. (c) 11. (a) 12. (d) 13. (d) 14. (c) 15. (d) which a country’s currency can be converted into
Column A Column B 3. To prevent the commercial banks from making 16. (a) 17. (d) 18. (c) 19. (a) 20. (d) 21. (a) gold or another currency.
I. Planned expenditure a. 2,21,733 Crores excessive profits 31. (c) When the Reserve Bank of India reduces the
22. (a) Deficit financing refers to the difference between
II. Non-Planned b. 4,65,277 4. To force the banks to have sufficient vault cash to Statutory Liquidity Ratio by 50 basis points; the
Crores expenditure expenditure and receipts. In public finance, it means
meet their day-to-day requirements the govt. is spending more than what it is earning. Scheduled Commercial Banks may cut their lending
III. Tax revenue c. 13,12,200 Crores rates.
Select the correct answer using the code given below. Deficit financing is a necessary evil in a welfare
IV. Non-tax revenue d. 9,19,842 Crores
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 only state as the states often fail to generate tax revenue EXERCISE-2
(a) I-c, II-a, III-b, IV-d (b) I-b, II-c, III-d, IV-a
(c) I-a, II-c, III-d, IV-b (d) I-d, II-c, III-d, IV-a (c) 2 and 3 only (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 which is sufficient enough to take care of the
63. Match columns A and B wherein Column B defines Column A 67. With reference to Indian economy, consider the following. 1. (c) 2. (b) 3. (d)
expenditure of the state. The basic intention behind
(CSAT 2015-I) 4. (c) Planned economic development adopted by India
Column A Column B deficit financing is to provide the necessary impetus
1. Bank rate 2. Open market operations to economic growth by artificial means. required an active monetary policy. The two
External debt a. Includes small saving schemes,
I. 3. Public debt 4. Public revenue stated aims of this policy were to boost economic
of the provident fund, reserve fund railways 23. (b) All taxes which are the personal liability of an
Which of the above is/are component/ components of development and control inflationary pressure
b. Includes loan from foreign countries assessee come under direct taxes. They include
II. Internal debt Monetary Policy? 5. (c)
and international financial institutions income tax, professional tax, wealth tax, securities
(a) 1 only (b) 2, 3 and 4 6. (a) A design for the Goods and Services Tax, and a
Other internal c. Includes market loans from banks and transaction tax, commodity transaction tax and the
III. (c) 1 and 2 (d) 1, 3 and 4 compensation package linked to adherence to the
liabilities financial institutions like. On the other hand, the taxes which a person
can recover from some other person but the liability proposed design
of which remains of the person collecting such taxes 7. (d) 8. (b) 9. (d)
are indirect taxes. These are custom duty, excise, 10. (a) There are two types of budgets i.e., Revenue budget
service tax, vat, CST and the like and Capital budget.
24. (b) SLR or the Statutory Liquidity Ratio is that ration Revenue budget contains all current receipts, such as
of total deposits which a commercial bank has to taxation, (central excise, custom duty, corporation
E-88 Fiscal and Monetary Policy Fiscal and Monetary Policy E-89

tax) dividends of public sector units (PSU’s) and 20. (c) Black money deals with all illegal economic activities balance). The RBI varies this ratio to change the 48. (d) Objectives of Monetary Policy are:
expenditure of the government. Capital budget 21. (a) Customs duty is the tax imposed on commodities liquidity of market. RBI is empowered to fix the Stability of external value: Fluctuation in exchange
consists of all capital receipts and expenditure such imported into India (import duty) or those exported CRR at a rate ranging between three per cent and rate of a currency affects foreign trade and
as domestic and foreign loans, loan repayment, from India (export duty). Since imposing duties 15 per cent. Like the Bank Rate, CRR is also investment. It is, therefore, important that the rate of
foreign and etc. on exports reduced the competitive position of the subject to frequent changes as RBI intervenes from exchange is maintained without violent fluctuations.
11. (d) Non-plan expenditures include non-developmental country, the government withdrew export duties time to time to correct monetary or exchange rate Maintenance of domestic price level: Fluctuation in
expenditure (interest payment, subsidies, defence 22. (c) At present, the SLR is 21.5% imbalances. This ratio, currently, is 4% prices affects investment decisions. It also leads to
expenditure, civil administration), developmental 23. (b) Revenue budget contains information about taxation 35. (a) At present, the repo rate is 6.75% increasing income disparities. However, monetary
expenditure and expenditure incurred on projects such as central excise, custom duty, corporation tax 36. (d) Public debt has three components - Internal debt, policy alone cannot ensure the maintenance of
which remained unfinished in the earlier plans. etc Other internal liabilities and External debt
domestic prices, as several other factors such as
12. (a) In respect of capital account of balance of payment, 24. (d) The commodities which are produced within the 37. (b) Fiscal deficit is budget deficit plus borrowings and
erratic monsoons, changes in tastes, fluctuation in
the Indian rupee is partially convertible after 1991. country levied by central excise duty. However, other liabilities.
world prices etc., affect domestic prices.
13. (c) Non-plan expenditure covers interest payments, commodities on which state governments impose Fiscal deficit = Budget deficit + Government’s
market borrowing and liabilities. Reducing the impact of business cycles (slumps
subsidies (mainly on food and fertilisers), wage and excise duties (e.g., liquor, drugs) are exempted
The fiscal deficit situation shows whether the and booms) by manipulation of credit and interest
salary payments to government employees, grants to from the central excise duty
government is spending beyond its income. India policy. However, economists are not of the same
States and Union Territories governments, pensions, 25. (c) Taxation is used for mobilizing and channelizing
has, unfortunately, been a country prone to constant opinion on whether business cycles are primarily
police, economic services in various sectors, resources for productive investment. It can also
defence, loans to public enterprises, loans to States, be used as a measure to promote equity and and high fiscal deficit situations. A high fiscal deficit caused by monetary factors.
Union Territories and foreign governments. reduce disparities or to encourage or discourage implies high indebtedness of the government and 49. (b) The highest rate of income tax was 97.25, before
14. (a) Corporation Tax, Wealth Tax and Income Tax are consumption of particular items a deficit above 3% in the Indian context means an 1975. Moderate rates of income tax encourage
in the category of direct tax. 26. (d) The process of bridging the gap between the revenue alarming situation for the government finances savings, faster growth and motivate voluntary
15. (d) Monetised deficit was adopted by India in 1997- and expenditure is called deficit financing. In other 38. (c) Regressive tax is one where the proportion of tax compliance to tax regime. Over the years, the rates
98. It refers to that part of deficit for which the words, Deficit financing refers to the ways in which paid falls as income rises. The most regressive tax is have been brought down
government borrows from the RBI. To meet the the budgetary gap is financed a poll tax, levied at a fixed rate per person regardless 50. (a) In 1996, govt introduced minimum Alternate tax
government’s such requirements, the RBI prints 27. (b) Service tax was introduced in 1994-95 to address of income. A tax system can be made regressive by (MAT) on companies which escaped the corporation
fresh currency, as a result of which the economy the asymmetric and distortionary treatment of goods having indirect taxes levied at relatively high rates tax net by using the provisions of exemptions,
gets monetised and services in tax framework and to widen the tax on goods heavily consumed by the poor deductions incentives, deprecation and so on
16. (c) In the case of direct taxes the burden or ‘incidence’ net 39. (c) A country going for foreign aid has to take several 51. (c) General Anti Avoidance Rules (GAAR) has been
has to be borne by the taxpayers themselves whereas 28. (a) Income tax is a progressive tax as it has exemptions precautions. However two major precautions are: introduced as a very important component of Direct
Keeping the borrowing level low so that country
in the case of an indirect tax, the burden can be for very small incomes, low rates for the first slab Tax code with the objective of preventing such deals
does not fall in a debt trap; and Keeping foreign aid
shifted to another person of taxable income, and higher rates for the largest and transactions that are carried out to evade and
strings-free
17. (d) A currency is said to be convertible when it can incomes avoid paying taxes. In other words, GAAR seeks
40. (c)
be freely exchanged for another currency at market 29. (b) There are three techniques of Deficit financing: to prevent such transactions that are carried out by
41. (a) Revenue deficit means the excess of current revenue
rates. Transaction of current account includes Printing Currency, Internal Borrowings and way of aggressive tax planning so as to avoid paying
expenditure over current revenue receipts. Revenue
dealing with payments relating to foreign trade, External aid and borrowings. Counting Currency is taxes
deficit indicates that the government cannot meet its
travel and other services. Capital account deals with not a technique of Deficit financing 52. (d) Annual financial statement gives various information
current expenditure from its current revenue.
transaction in financial assets. While India has made 30. (a) It was introduced in France to overcome the for the current, last and next year
Revenue deficit= Revenue expenditure – Revenue
the Indian rupee fully convertible on current account, cascading effect of several taxes-from raw material 53. (c) Budget deficit is the overall deficit i.e., the excess
receipts
it is yet to accept capital account convertibility as a to the final product in the process of production 42. (c) of total expenditure over total revenues. It includes
goal. Broadly, capital account convertibility would 31. (d) Proportional tax is one by which the revenue 43. (d) Treasury Bills are money market instruments to both capital and revenue items in receipts and
mean freedom for firms and residents to freely buy collected rises proportionally with income. A tax finance the short term financial requirements of expenditure. Traditionally, deficit financing in
into overseas assets such as equity, bonds, property, system could be made approximately proportional the Government of India. These are discounted Indian budgets had meant filling this gap
and acquire ownership of overseas firms besides by having a uniform rate of income tax with very securities and are issued at a discount to face value. 54. (d) Printing currency is usually the last resort for the
free repatriation of proceeds by foreign investors few exemptions, and indirect taxes levied at similar 44. (c) SLR used by bankers indicates the minimum government in managing its deficit. It might help
18. (b) Open Market Operations refers to the RBI buying rates on as many goods and services as possible percentage of deposits that the banks have to the government in times of need but it should be
and selling eligible securities to regulate money 32. (d) Primary deficit is fiscal deficit minus interest maintain in the form of gold, cash or other approved undertaken only in case of extreme necessity as
supply. Traditionally RBI was not resorting to this payments. India started using this term since securities.
method. However, after the large inflow of foreign it has many damaging effects on the economy. It
1997- 98. Primary deficit is considered a very 45. (c) The Reserve Bank of India is the nodal agency for
funds since 1991, RBI has had to step in to sterilize useful tool in helping bring more transparency in increases inflation proportionally. It may also lead to
implementing the monetary policy. RBI has defined a pressure on the government for an upward revision
the flow to avoid excess liquidity the government’s pattern of expenditure. It shows its monetary policy in terms of “adequate financing
19. (d) In under-developed countries, deficit-financing has the current state of government finances. If interest in salaries of government employees, which in turn
of economic growth and at the same time ensuring
been considered essential for financing the plans payments are deducted from fiscal deficit, then it will lead to an increase of government’s expenditure,
reasonable price stability”.
of economic development. It is used as a tool for will obviously show a lesser deficit for that year as further necessitating printing of currency and more
46. (a) Monetary policy refers to the set of measures
meeting financial needs of government, especially in the interest payments are on account of loans taken adopted by the central bank (RBI) for monetary inflation
times of war. It is used for the mobilization of surplus, in the past and not in the present year management 55. (a) Corporation tax is the tax on income/profit of the
non- utilized and idle resources in the economy. It 33. (c) Fiscal policy comprises of several major themes 47. (b) It is used to achieve the objectives of balanced organizations. In India, at one time, corporation tax
is also used as an instrument of economic policy for 34. (d) Every commercial bank is required to keep a economic development, full employment or to was quite high
removing the conditions of depression 4 to raise the certain percentage of its demand and time liabilities establish a welfare state Economics takes care of 56. (c) Under Article 280 of the Constitution, the President
level of output and employment. (deposits) with the RBI (either as cash or book various needs and wants of life appoints a Finance Commission every five years

E-90 Fiscal and Monetary Policy

57. (b) Lok Sabha approval is mandatory in order to take Expenditure


out money from the Consolidated fund Non-Planned expenditure 13,12,200 crores
58. (a) Fiscal policy is expressed by the budget Planned expenditure 4,65,277 crores
59. (c) Bank rate is an instrument of monetary policy which Total 17,77,477 crores
is the rate at which RBI lends to commercial banks 63. (b) Internal debt, Other internal liabilities and External
60. (a) The budget shows the receipts and payments of the debt are three components of Public debt wherein

5
government under three heads. All revenues and Internal debt includes market loans from banks
loans received by the government comes under and financial institutions, short-term borrowings
Consolidated fund, sum placed at the disposal of the on treasury bills and other bonds and certificates
President to meet unforeseen expenditure falls under issued by the government. External debt includes
Contingency fund and receipts & payments which loan from foreign countries and international
financial institutions like the World Bank, IMF,
MONEY SUPPLY AND
INDIAN FINANCIAL SYSTEM
are in form of deposit account with the government
ADB, etc. Other internal liabilities includes small
comprises Public Account
saving schemes, provident fund, reserve fund of the
61. (c) The tax to GDP ratio (centre and states together) railways, post and telegraph on which the central
was 6 percent in 1950-51, rose to 11.89 in 2007-08 government has to pay interest
and is currently around 10.60% 64. (b)
62. (b) A summary of the expected Income and Expenditure 65. (b) All asset creating and productive expenditure is
data of the Union Budget 2015-16 is given in the part of plan expenditure, and all non- productive,
consumptive and non- asset building expenditure is Introduction
Table. It shows a revenue deficit of 2.8 percent and
part of non- plan expenditure. Non-plan expenditure A well established financial system plays very important role in economic development of any country. A financial system
fiscal deficit of 3.9 percent is further divided into revenue expenditure and capital consists of financial institutions, financial markets, financial instruments and financial services. This system provides a frame-
Fiscal and Monetary Policy expenditure work by which savings and surplus funds are mobilized in a productive manner.
Budget 2015-16(Revenue Receipts) 66. (b) Because Reserve Requirements are designed as
A financial system server as a link between savers and investors
Tax revenue (income and 9,19,842 Crores “precautionary measures” and not to stop banks from
“excessive” profit. This eliminates (c) and (d). It promotes the capital formation by bringing together supply of savings and demand for funds.
corporate taxes)
67. (c) The RBI implements the monetary policy through This system provides detailed information about the players in the market such as individuals, corporate houses, government
Non-tax revenue (customs, excise 2,21,733 Crores open market operations, bank rate policy, reserve agencies etc.
duties and service taxes) system, credit control policy, moral persuasion and It also provides a mechanism for controlling risks involved in managing savings and allocating funds.
Total 11,41,575 Crores through many other instruments. It covers the whole gamut of demand for and supply of funds for productive purposes. The financial system promotes eco-
nomic development through mobilising savings and channelising these to investment avenues.
The Indian financial system consists of both short term and long term finances.

Indian Financial System

Introduction Capital Money Supply Insurance Micro


Sector
Money Market Inflation Indian Banking Finance
Market System
Securities Financial LIC GI C IRDA
Institution Inflation
Call Money Gilt in India Evolution Commodity
Market Edged SEBI Types of RBI Futures
Corporate DFI Inflation
Treasury Bill Market
Securities Objectives
Market Calculation
ICICI Function NBFIs
Commercial Bill Of Inflation of RBI
IDBI
Market Impact of Composition Exim
Collateral Loan Inflation Bank
Market Control of RRB NHB
Certificate of Inflation Private SIDBI
Banks
Deposit and Deflation NABARD
Co-operative
Commercial paper Bank
Markets Checking SCB
Money Market Deflation Banking Systems in India
Instruments Banking Sector Reforms
E-92 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-93

The seller, who has sold his goods on credit draws the bill range of money market instruments and give investors greater
MONEY MARKET and sends it to the buyer for acceptance. After the buyer or flexibility in the deployment of their short-term surplus funds.
his bank writes the word ‘accepted’ on the bill, it becomes a
Money market refers to the short term (6-12 months) (iv) The call money market is highly sensitive and competitive
borrowings and lending, whereas market. As such, it acts as the best indicator of the
marketable instrument and is sent to the seller. 6. Money Market Instruments
liquidity position of the organised money market. The seller can now sell the bill (i.e. get it discounted) to his
Capital market refers to longer term lending/ borrowing. Chakravarthy committee and Narasimhan committee
bank for cash. In times of financial crisis, the bank can sell
Money market refers to that mechanism whereby borrowers (v) The rate of interest in the call money market is highly recommended certain money market instruments to reform
the bills to other banks or get them rediscounted from the
manage to obtain short term loan- able funds on the one hand, unstable. It quickly rises under the pressures of excess Indian money market. Some of these are:
Reserved Bank.
and lenders succeed in getting credit worthy borrowers for demand for funds and quickly falls under the pressures of • 182 days treasury bills which are sold through fortnightly
excess supply of funds. In India, the bill market is undeveloped as compared to the
their money on the other. In this way, any institution or person auctions. They carry attractive rates of interest and
same in advanced countries like the U.K. There is absence
who is willing to provide short-period monetary debt becomes (vi) The call money market plays a vital role in removing practically no risk and are therefore popular with
the day-to-day fluctuations in the reserve position of the of specialised institutions like acceptance houses and discount
a part of the money market. commercial banks.
individual banks and improving the functioning of the houses, particularly dealing in acceptance and discounting
Under Indian money market, the Reserve Bank of India business. • 364 days treasury bills were also introduced in 1992.
occupies the central position because it regulates and controls banking system in the country.
• Dated government securities with maturities up to 10
the credit supply of the country.
Ordinarily, the Indian money market is divided into two parts: 2. Treasury Bill Market 4. Collateral Loan Market years have also been introduced primarily to develop a
secondary market.
1. The Unorganised sector. The Treasury bill market deals in treasury bills which are Collateral loan market deals with collateral loans i.e. loans
• Money market mutual funds have been permitted to be
2. The Organised sector. the short-term (i.e. 91, 182 and 364 days) liability of the backed by security. In the Indian collateral loan market, the
floated by commercial banks.
Government of India. Theoretically, these bills are issued to commercial banks provide short- term loans against government
securities, shares and debentures of the government, etc. • Repurchase options (repos) and reverse repos have been
Unorganised Sector meet the short-term financial requirements of the government. introduced in order to even out sharp fluctuations in the
But, in reality, they have become a permanent source of funds money market. Repos provide an opportunity for RBI
The Unorganised sector is formed of the unregulated non-bank to the government. Every year, a portion of treasury bills are 5. Certificate of Deposit and to repurchase government securities from commercial
financial intermediaries, indigenous bankers, and moneylenders. converted into long-term bonds. Treasury bills are of two types: Commercial Paper Markets banks. Reverse repos are government securities sold
(i) Ad hoc (ii) Regular
Organised Sector Certificate of Deposit (CD) and Commercial Paper (CP) through auction at fixed cut-off rate of interest.
(i) Ad hoc : Ad hoc treasury bills are issued to the state
markets deal with certificates of deposit and commercial • Liquidity Adjustment Facility (LAF) refers to RBI’s policy
The organised sector includes the State Bank of India and governments, semi-government departments and foreign
papers. These two instruments (CD and CP) were introduced of using Repos and Reverse Repos to adjust liquidity on a
its associated banks, 19 nationalised banks, Regional Rural central banks. They are not sold to the banks and the
by Reserve Bank of India in March 1989 in order to widen the day-to-day basis.
Banks, Co-operative Banks, Non-governmental sectors and general public, and are not marketable.
other banks, whereas the unorganised sector includes the (ii) Regular : The regular treasury bills are sold to the banks
money-lenders and indigenous bankers. and public and are freely marketable. Both types of ad
CAPITAL MARKET
Organised sector includes Reserve bank of India, Private banks, hoc and regular treasury bills are sold by Reserve Bank of
Capital market deals with long-term finance (more than The main players in Indian capital markets are:
public sector banks, developmental banks and other non banking India on behalf of the Central Government.
365 days) funds. It includes all facilities and institutional • Banks, indigenous and commercial.
financial companies (NBFCs) such as life insurance corporation The Treasury bill market in India is underdeveloped as arrangements available for borrowing and lending of term • Insurance companies
of India (LIC), Unit trust of India (UTI), the International compared to the Treasury bill markets in the U.S.A. and the funds (including medium-term). • Development Finance Institutions (DFI),
Finance Corporation, IDBI and the co-operative sector. U.K. In the U.S.A. and the U.K., the treasury bills are the The difference between money market and capital market is • Non-Banking Finance Companies, (NBFCs)
The organised sector of Indian money market can be further most important money market instrument: not so much in the institutions involved as in their term of • Non-Banking Financial Institutions.
classified into the following sub-markets: (a) Treasury bills provide a risk-free, profitable and highly borrowing or lending. Long-term funds are raised either by
The capital market may be divided into
liquid investment outlet for short-term, surpluses of borrowing from certain institutions or by issuing securities.
(i) the securities market; and (ii) the financial institutions.
1. Call Money Market various financial institutions; Capital Market
(b) Treasury bills from an important source of raising fund
The most important component of organised money market
for the government; and
Securities Market
is the call money market. It deals in call loans or call money The securities market is further divided into the gilt-edged
(c) For the central bank the treasury bills are the main Main Players Securities Financial
granted for one day. Since the participants in the call money Institutions market and the corporate securities market.
instrument of open market operations. Market
market are mostly banks, it is also called interbank call money
market. On the contrary, the Indian Treasury bill market has no Gilt Edged Securities (G-sec)
dealers except the Reserve Bank of India. Besides the Reserve Gilt Edged Corporate IFCI
The banks with temporary deficit of funds form the demand Indian capital market consists of market for gilt-edged securities
Bank, some treasury bills are held by commercial banks, state Securities Securities
side and the banks with temporary excess of funds form the ICICI guaranteed by the government (Central or state). These
government and semi-government bodies.
supply side of the call money market. securities are issued by local authorities (like city corporations,
But, these treasury bills are not popular with the non-bank Primary Secondary IDBI municipalities and port trusts) and autonomous government
The main features of Indian call money market are as follows: Market Market
financial institutions, corporations, and individuals mainly undertaking like the state electricity boards, development banks,
(i) Call money market provides the institutional arrangement
because of absence of a developed Treasury bill market. etc. The RBI plays a dominant role in the gilt-edged market
for making the temporary surplus of some banks available Stock Exchange Over the through its open market operations. Mostly financial institutions
to other banks which are temporary in short of funds. (23) Counter Exchange that have statutory obligations to keep a certain portion of their
(ii) Mainly the banks participate in the call money market. 3. Commercial Bill Market investments in government securities buy these. RBI trades in
The State Bank of India is always on the lenders’ side of Commercial bill market deals in commercial bills issued by National Regional G-sec as part of its open market operations.
the market. the firms engaged in business. These bills are generally of (21)
(iii) The call money market operates through brokers who three months maturity. A commercial bill is a promise to pay Corporate Securities
NSE BSE
always keep in touch with banks and establish a link a specified amount in a specified period by the buyer of goods ISE Others It refers to the stocks, shares, debentures, etc. of companies
between the borrowing and lending banks. to the seller of the goods. (15) (6) which are traded in stock market forming primary market. For

E-94 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-95

inducing the public to invest their savings in new issues, services ISE Development Finance Institutions (DFIs) modernising industrial enterprises; encouraging private
of specialised institutions (underwriters and stock brokers) are Interconnected Stock Exchange of India (ISE) is a capital participation (both domestic and external) and help to
The Industrial Finance Corporation of India (IFCI):
required. This kind of underwriting (guaranteeing purchase of collaboration of India’s 15 regional stock exchanges (RSEs), develop capital markets. Its main aim was to give term loans
a new issue at a fixed price) was non-existent in India until and was set up in 1998. The RSEs were provided more power The IFCI was the first DFI to be established in 1948 under in rupee and foreign exchange, underwrite issue of shares and
the establishment of the ICICI in 1951. Other institutions like and reach through this. It is a web based exchange. an Act of Parliament. It was originally a shareholders’ debentures and directly subscribe to these issues. Among all
the LIC, IDBI, UTI, IFCI and GIC, commercial banks, stock Corporation, but in 1993 it was converted into a company under
Indo Next is a new stock exchange, set up to promote liquidity the DFIs, ICICI had the most spectacular growth. In a ‘reverse
brokers and investment funds soon became the participants in the Companies Act. It grants loans and advances to industrial
to stocks of small and medium enterprises (SMEs) was merger’, ICICI was merged with the ICICI Bank in March
the new issues market. concerns, repayable normally within 25 years; guarantees
launched in 2005 jointly by the BSE and FISE (Federation 2002 and became the first ‘universal bank’ in the country.
Secondary market, deals in securities already issued by of Indian Stock Exchanges, representing 18 regional stock loans raised by industrial units; subscribes to and underwrites
companies. The main purpose of such a market is to provide the issue of stocks and shares by industrial concerns; and Industrial Development Bank of India (IDBI)
exchanges). It is better known as BSE Indo Next.
liquidity (easy convertibility into cash) to such securities. extends guarantees for deferred payments by importers. It was The IDBI was established under an Act of Parliament in
The secondary market has two segments: stock exchange and Approved Stock Exchanges in India converted into a public limited company in 1993 to provide it 1964 for providing direct term finance to large industrial
over -the-counter exchange. 1. Bhuvneshwar Stock Exchange, Bhuvneshwar. more operational freedom. However, huge NPAs have made units and assisting small and medium units through banks
2. Calcutta Stock Exchange, Calcutta. IFCI a sick financial institution. and State Finance Corporations (SFCs). It was converted
Stock Exchange 3. Cochin Stock Exchange, Cochin. Industrial Credit and Investment Corporation of India (ICICI): into a company by the 2003 Act and became a universal bank
A stock exchange is an organised market, i.e association of 4. Delhi Stock Exchange, Delhi. like ICICI through reverse merger with the IDBI Bank.
The ICICI was established in 1955 for promoting and
persons or firms to regulate and supervise all transactions, 5. Guwahati Stock Exchange, Guwahati.
rules, regulations and standard practices to govern all market
transactions, authorised stock brokers and an exchange floor
6.
7.
Hyderabad Stock Exchange, Hyderabad.
Jaipur Stock Exchange, Jaipur.
MONEY SUPPLY
where stock broker or their authorised agents meet during 8. Canara Stock Exchange, Mangalore.
fixed business hours to buy and sell securities. The stock 9. Ludhiana Stock Exchange, Ludhiana. Money supply is the stock of liquid assets held by the public, M1 measure represents the most liquid form of money among
exchange is an institution for orderly buying and selling of 10. Chennai Stock Exchange, Chennai. which can be freely exchanged for goods and services. The four money stock measures adopted by RBI. As we move
listed securities. Listed securities are those that appear on the 11. M.P. Stock Exchange, Indore. money supply includes notes and coins to bank deposits. It from M1 to M4, the liquidity gets reduced. In other words,
approved list of a stock exchange. (A particular security is 12. Magadh Stock Exchange, Patna. includes all economic units (households, firms and institutions) M4 possesses the lowest liquidity among all these measures.
listed or quoted when it is incorporated in the register of the 13. Pune Stock Exchange, Pune. The reduction in liquidity indicates the shifting from ‘medium
14. U.P. Stock Exchange, Kanpur. but excludes the producers of money (such as the government
stock exchange so that it can be bought / sold there.) There are of exchange’ to ‘store of value’. All these four money stock
15. Vadodara Stock Exchange, Vadodara. and the banking system as this is not in circulation). As it
23 stock exchanges in the country out of which 20 (including measures are not of equal importance. Their relative importance
Bombay Stock Exchange) are regional and two national. 16. Koyambtour Stock Exchange, Coimbatore. excludes the money held by the government in its treasuries
17. Merrut Stock Exchange, Meerut. varies from the point of view of monetary policy
and the money with the banking system, money supply is bound Generally, in developed countries, the bank deposits are the
NSE 18. Mumbai Stock Exchange, Mumbai.
19. Over the Counter Exchange of India, Mumbai. to be smaller than the total stock of money in the country’s most important component in money supply, while due to
National Stock Exchange (NSE) was set up in 1984. NSE grew 20. National Stock Exchange, Mumbai. economic system. less banking habits in under-developed countries people want
rapidly to become India’s biggest exchange. The NSE share 21. Ahmedabad Stock Exchange, Ahmedabad. to keep their money in the most liquid form i.e., currency.
The four concepts of money used in calculating money
index is known as Nifty. There is a 50 share index, S and P 22. Bangalore Stock Exchange, Bangalore. M3 is the most important component among all money stock
CNX 50 (Nifty fifty), S & P CNX 500 (500 share index). Nifty 23. Capital Stock Exchange, Kerala Ltd., Tiruvananthapuram, supply are known as the money stock measures or measures
measures and is generally termed as ‘Broad money’.
junior is the second-tier index of 50 stocks. The NSE became Kerala of monetary aggregates. These are In economics, the money supply or money stock is the
the first stock exchange in India to admit overseas shareholders. On July 9, 2007 SEBI has withdrawn units approval from 1. M1 → Money with the Public (currency notes and coins) total amount of monetary assets available in an economy at a
Saurashtra Stock Exchange, Rajkot due to its passive working. + Demand deposits of banks (on current and saving specific time. There are several ways to define ‘money’ but
BSE Hence the number of approved stock exchanges has reduced to 23.
standard measures usually include currency in circulation
bank accounts) + Other demand deposits with RBI. It
Bombay Stock Exchange (BSE), India’s oldest stock exchange Securities and Exchange Board of India (SEBI): and demand deposits.
is highly liquid and banks will not be able to run their
formally came into being in 1887 and was a regional exchange The SEBI was set up in 1988 in place of the Controller Money supply data are usually recorded and published by
till 2002 when it became a national exchange. It became a lending programmes on this basis.
of Capital Issue who was a functionary of the Ministry of the government or the central bank of the country. Public
corporate entity, BSE Ltd. in 2005. Finance. It was made a statutory body in 1992. It is the main 2. M2 → M1 + Saving bank deposits with Post-offices. and private sector analyst have long monitored changes in
The BSE has four indices. Sensex or sensitive Index has 30 regulatory institution of the Indian capital market. 3. M3 → M1 + Term deposits with the bank. money supply because of its possible effect on the price level
stocks. BSE-200 is a 200 stock share index (including the Sensex SEBI is managed by six members - one chairman (nominated 4. M4 → M3 + All deposits of Post-offices. inflation, exchange rate and the business cycle.
stocks). Dollex is its dollar version. BSE-500 is a 500-stock by Central Government), two members (officers of central
index which was developed in 1999 and represents several major ministries) one member (from RBI) and remaining two
industries, with special emphasis on IT sector. The National members are nominated by Central Government. The office INFLATION
Index of 100 stocks quoted on a national level gives a wider of SEBI is situated at Mumbai with its regional offices at
representation of the stock market. It includes the Sensex stocks. Kolkata, Delhi and Chennai. In 1988 the initial capital of Inflation is an increase in price of goods. It can be seen as increases in the money supply (monetarism). Inflation affects
SEBI was 7.5 crore which was provided by its promoters a devaluation of the worth of money. A crucial feature of all segments of the economy. It hurts persons having fixed
Over the Counter Exchange of India (OTCEI) was set up (IDBI, ICICI, IFCI). This amount was invested and with it’s inflation is that price rises are sustained. Once only increase incomes, as they can purchase less number of goods in the
in 1989, but began to trade only in 1992. The OTCEI deals interest amount day-to-day expenses of SEBI are met. in the rate of, say, value-added tax, will immediately put up same amount of money. It affects those like retired persons
in securities that are not listed on a stock exchange. These The SEBI is authorised to:
unlisted securities are basically securities of small companies prices, but this does not represent inflation, unless the indirect who depend on interest income on their savings. It upsets
(with paid -up capital between 30 lakh and 25 crore) and • oversee the working of stock exchanges; effects of the VAT rise have repercussions of prices in periods macro-economic decision making, as the uncertainty regarding
have a limited market. Their prices are determined through • regulate merchant banks and mutual funds; after the direct effects. future costs can affect projections.
direct negotiations between stock brokers and not by bidding • register and regulate intermediaries such as stock brokers; Accounts of the causes of inflation are numerous. The most It may appear that inflation benefits borrowers, as it leads to
as in stock exchanges. With the prevalence of screen-based • curb fraudulent and unfair trade practices including popular arguments are that it is caused by excess demand in a fall in the real cost of capital. But this is only a temporary
trading, the relevance of regional stock exchanges has insider trading; the economy (demand-pull inflation), that it is caused by high phase and the interest rate is bound to go up to compensate for
diminished. • promote the development of a healthy capital market. costs (cost-push inflation) and that it results from excessive the inflation.
E-96 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-97

Inflation In India Calculation of Inflation GDP deflator, which distinguishes between physical growth Policy Measure to Control Inflation
in output and price rise, and gives an accurate picture of the
In India inflation is a structural as well as a monetary Changes in price level are measured by the following: over-all price level. The issue of inflation is addressed from both demand and
phenomenon. In the short term, localised demand-supply • Wholesale Price Index The GDP Deflator is arrived at by dividing GDP at current supply sides. Demand management implies putting a check
imbalances in wage goods, often due to seasonal variations • Consumer Price Index prices by GDP at constant prices in terms of base year prices on the demand of the public for goods and services. Demand
in production- coupled with market rigidities and regulatory • Gross Domestic Product (GDP) Deflator (1993-94 in India). This indicates as to how much of the management is achieved by measures such as postponing
failures have supported inflation that have resulted in a The Wholesale Price Index (WPI) is a weighted average growth in GDP in a year is due to price rise and how much public expenditure, reducing excess liquidity either through
more widespread impact on the consumers than the initial of indices covering 676 commodities, which are traded in taxes or saving schemes and restrictions on ad hoc treasury
due to increase in output. GDP deflator is now available only
inflationary impulse. In the medium to long-term, the primary, manufacturing and fuel and power-sectors. WPI is bills. While such measures help contain the money supply,
movement and outcome of monetary aggregates such as the annually with a gap of one year.
thus a measure of inflation on an economy-wide scale. Services there is a danger that these will contract the economy and lead
money supply and interest rates of the financial systems have Theoretically, the growth in physical output in an economy has
do not figure in this, as there is usually no wholesale price to an increase in unemployment. Rationalisation of excise and
influenced aggregate demand and consequently changes in for services. The weightage for primary articles is only 20 to be matched by a corresponding growth in monetary flows.
import duties of essential commodities leads to higher burden
price levels in the economy. The latter considerations and percent. A revised WPI with 1993-94 as the base year has been Any mismatch between the two gets reflected in the growth
on poor.
the influence of global commodity prices on the domestic adopted. WPI figures are available on weekly basis with a gap rate and price changes. Monetary policy aims at managing the
prices have become more important with the opening and balance between growth in real flows and growth in monetary RBI assists in controlling inflation through monetary measures
of about two weeks, and are, therefore, useful in continuous
growing integration of the Indian economy with the rest of monitoring of prices for policy making. flows. such as quantitative and selective credit controls and by
the world. manipulating the Cash Reserve Ratio (CRR) and the Statutory
Consumer Price Index (CPI) is the retail price average of a Causes of Inflation
basket of goods and services directly consumed by the people. Liquidity Ratio (SLR). These are the monetary policies adopted
Types of Inflation The inflation occurs due to two main factors: by government.
It is computed separately for the following three groups:
(i) Industrial workers - 260 commodities (a) Increase in demand for goods and services. On the supply side, the mechanism of Public Distribution
1. Demand Pull Inflation occurs when excessive demand (b) Decrease in the supply of goods & services
(ii) Urban Non-Manual Employees-180 commodities. System (PDS) ensures availability of essential commodities
for commodities increases their prices. This is the
(iii) Agricultural labourers - 60 commodities (a) Factors causing an Increase in demand for goods & for the vulnerable sections of society. This helps maintain
conventional inflationary situation of ‘too much money
These indices, however, did not cover all the segments of the services: price levels. Fixation of maximum prices helps to eliminate
chasing too few goods’. The main demand-pull factors in
India are: population and thus, did not reflect the correct picture of the (i) Increase in public expenditure the incentive for hoarding and speculative activity in food-
price behaviour of the whole country. (ii) Increase in private expenditure grains. Control over private trade in food-grains and adoption
(i) Mounting government expenditure
A result, there was a strong need for compiling a CPI for (iii) Increase in exports of Open General Licence (OGL) to ease the imports of sugar,
(ii) Deficit financing and increase in money supply pulses, etc., in case of shortages are also some of the common
entire urban and rural population of the country to measure (iv) Reduction in taxation
(iii) Role of black money measures undertaken. Coupled with this is the open market
the inflation in Indian economy based on CPI. Thus, now (v) Rapid growth of population
(iv) Rapid population growth. Central Statistics Office (CSO) of the Ministry of Statistics sale of rice and wheat resorted to by FCI from its buffer stock
(vi) Black money
2. Cost Push Inflation occurs when wages and other costs and Programme Implementation has started compiling a new in times of price rise.
(vii) Deficit financing
rise and the producers are successful in passing on the series of CPI:
(viii) Cheap money policy Inflation and Price Control in the Post-reform Period
higher costs to the consumers in the shape of higher (a) CPI for the entire urban population viz CPI (Urban); 225
prices. The main cost -push factors in India are : (ix) Increase in consumer spending One of the major achievements of economic reforms of
commodities.
(x) Department of Tax internal debts. 1991 was the removal of restrictions on production and
(i) Fluctuations in output and supply in both agriculture (b) CPI for the entire rural population viz CPI (Rural) 250
and industry sectors. Fluctuations in output of food commodities. (b) Factors causing Decrease in supply of goods and prices. The direction was to move from a regulated to a
grains have been a major factor responsible for rise services: market-related environment. Contrary to expectations, the
(c) Consolidated CPI for Urban + Rural will also be
in food-grain prices as well as general price. In the compiled based on above two CPIs (i) Shortage of supplies of factors removal of restrictions did not lead to a spurt in prices.
same way, the supply of manufactured goods also (ii) Industrial disputes However, inflationary pressure remained moderately high
These reflect the changes in the price level of various goods
did not increase adequately in last few years. Power and services consumed by the Urban and rural population. (iii) Natural calamities caused, paradoxically, by the very success of the reform
breakdowns, strikes and lock-outs and shortage of These new indices are now compiled at State / UT and all (iv) Loop-sided Production process, which brought in large foreign investment leading
transport facilities have been the major constraints India levels. (v) Hoarding by consumers an increase in money supply. Foreign inflows need to be
responsible for lowering production of manufactured The CPI inflation series is wider in scope than the one based on (vi) Hoarding by traders ‘sterillised’ by the RBI by withdrawing from circulation
goods. With ever-rising demand for manufactured the wholesale price index (WPI), as it has both rural and urban (vii) Operation of Law of Diminishing Returns. an equivalent amount of rupee either through open market
goods, the producers are in a position to hike the figures, besides state-wise data. The new series, with 2010 as operation or through regulating bank credit. At the same
the base year, also includes services, which is not the case with time, it was important to maintain the correct exchange
prices of their products Impact of Inflation rate for the rupee so that its appreciation does not make
(ii) Problem of hoarding by traders and black the WPI series.
marketeers. A comparison of this new series with WPI is given below: 1. Inflation is the most regressive form of taxation as it our exports uncompetitive. Following are some of the fiscal
affects the poor and vulnerable sections of the society policies adopted by government.
(iii) Taxation which gives the traders an opportunity to WPI CPI - New Series the most. Such a situation leads to increasing income
raise the prices of goods, the proportion of which is wef Feb 2012 • Release of buffer stock of food grains to maintain the price
disparities. level;
often more than the levy of taxes. 2. Inflation dampens exports by making our products
Base Year 2004-05 2010 • Import of some essential commodities like edible oils;
(iv) Administered Prices. expensive and, conversely, makes imports attractive.
Elemenetary Items 676 200 (Weighted items) • Strict fiscal and monetary discipline
(v) Hike in Oil Prices. Such a situation may warrant formal or informal
3. Stagflation is a situation when high rates of inflation Weightage of Food products 243 49.71 devaluation of the currency in order to make our exports • Compensating farmers for the loss on account of withdreawal
coexist with high rate of unemployment (a combination of (%) competitive. offertilizer subsidy, through upward revision of procurement
stagnation and inflation). Weightage of Energy products 14..91 9.49 3. Inflation leads to recession, as people with fixed incomes prices.
(%) set apart an increasing share of their income to meet • To maintain price stability, the Central Issue Price for rice
4. Hyperinflation refers to a situation of runaway inflation
the growing costs of essential commodities, leaving ans wheat has not been revised sonce july 2002. There has
reaching even up to 100 percent per annum. It also refers Weightage of Miscellaneous Services 26.31
very little for expenditure on non-essential terms. The
to rapid inflation in which prices increase so fast that Items (%) not been a continuous reduction in the import duty on edible oils.
production of such items has to be reduced, leading to
money loses its importance as a medium of exchange. included
shutdowns and recession.

E-98 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-99

Inflation and Price Control in the Post-reform (ii) Merit goods: It includes primary education, immunisation, 9. Union Bank of India 1. Andhra Bank
public health programme, etc. Not only individual beneficiary 10. Dena Bank 2. Punjab and Sindh Bank
Period
but society at large benefits by making these goods available. 11. Allahabad Bank 3. New Bank of India
One of the major achievements of economic reforms of 1991 Providing subsidy for these goods is essential. 12. Indian Bank 4. Vijaya Bank
was the removal of restrictions on production and prices. (iii) Non-merit goods: In non merit goods the benefit goes 5. Corporation Bank
13. Indian Overseas Bank
The direction was to move from a regulated to a market- directly to the individual while the costs are borne by the 6. Oriental Bank of Commerce
14. Bank of Maharashtra
related environment. Contrary to expectations, the removal society. Pollution caused by automobile emission is an On 4th September, 1993 the Government merged the New Bank
After one decade, on April 15, 1980, those 6 private sector
of restrictions did not lead to a spurt in prices. However, example of non-merit goods. of India with Punjab National Bank and as a result of this the
banks whose reserves were more than 200 crores each were
inflationary pressure remained moderately high caused, total number of nationalised bank got reduced from 20 to 19.
nationalised. These banks are as:
paradoxically, by the very success of the reform process, which
brought in large foreign investment, leading an increase in
Deflation Evolution of the Indian Banking Industry
money supply. Foreign inflows need to be ‘sterilised’ by the RBI “Deflation is that state in which the value of money rises and
by withdrawing from circulation an equivalent amount of rupee the price of goods and services falls.”
either through open market operation or through regulating The state of deflation may appear in the economy due to Trigger Phases Major
following reasons- Events
bank credit. At the same time, it was important to maintain Changes
(i) When the Government withdraws money from
the correct exchange rate for the rupee so that its appreciation circulation.
does not make our exports uncompetitive. Following are some
(ii) When Government imposes heavy direct taxes or takes  Birth of joint stock banking
of the fiscal policies adopted by government. heavy loans from the public (voluntary or compulsory
Beginning of institutional
• Release of buffer stock of food grains to maintain the banking with 3 joint stock companies
or both). banks  Introduction of deposit banking
price level;
• Import of some essential commodities like edible oils; (iii) When the Central Bank sells the securities in open Phase 1 and bank branches
market (which reduces the quantity of money in Pre Nationalisation Phase  Presidency banks and other joint
• Strict fiscal and monetary discipline stock banks formed setting the
• Compensating farmers for the loss on account of circulation).
foundation of modern banking
withdrawal of fertilizer subsidy, through upward revision (iv) When Central Bank controls the credit money and system.
Nationalisation of Imperial
of procurement prices. adopts various measures such as increase in CRR, Band and 20 other scheduled
• To maintain price stability, the Central Issue Price for credit rationing and direct action. commercial banks  State Bank of India formed out of
rice and wheat has not been revised since July 2002. (v) When the Central Bank increases the Bank rate (which imperial bank
There has been a continuous reduction in the import duty curtails the quantity of credit in the economy).  20 SCBs nationalised in two
Phase 2
on edible oils. (vi) When state of over-production (excess supply over Era of Nationalisation phases
demand) takes place in the economy. and Consolidation  Directed credit programmes on
Public Goods, Merit Goods and Subsidies Measures of Checking Deflation the rise
Subsidies are a major burden on the national budget. There (i) Increasing money supply. Acceptance of  Introduction of social banking
are inevitable leakages in subsidies and much of it does not (ii) Promote credit creation by the banks. recommedations of the
reach the intended beneficiaries. In many cases, the benefits Narasimham Committee
(iii) Curtailment in taxes so as to increase the purchasing  Major changes in prudential
are taken by the undeserving. Most of our agricultural and
power of the people. regulations
food subsidies suffer from this drawback. In order to assist  Interest rates deregulated
(iv) Increasing the public expenditure and the employment
proper targeting of subsidies, goods are classified into three Phase 3  Statutory presumption of
opportunities in the economy. Introduction of Indian
categories: resources eased more private
(i) Public goods: It includes national defence, police, general (v) Increasing the money supply in circulation by repayment Financial & Banking Sector
sector players came in
Reforms and Partial
administration, etc. These services are available to all and of old public debts. Liberalisation strengthened the system as a
Hike in
the enjoyment by one is not at the expense of another. No (vi) Providing of economic subsidy by the Government to the FDI celling for
whole
price can be put on these services. the industrial sector of the economy. banking sector and declaration
of roadmap for  FDI ceiling for the banking sector
INDIAN BANKING liberalisation
Phase 4 
increased to 74% from 49 %
Roadmap for inclusion of foreign
Period of increased
banks declared
Reserve Bank of India was nationalised on January 1, 1949. 4. The State Bank of Mysore Liberalisation
 More liberal branch licensing
For the co-ordinated regulation of Indian banking, the Indian 5. The State Bank of Saurashtra policy followed.
Banking Act was passed in March 1949. By Act, the Reserve 6. The State Bank of Patiala Phase 4
Bank of India was granted extended powers for the inspection 7. The State Bank of Travancore Continues-more
of non-scheduled banks. For extending banking facilities in In order to have more control over the banks, 14 large liberalisation expected
the rural areas the Imperial Bank of India was partially commercial banks, whose reserves were more than 50 crores With the change of the Indian economy to a higher growth As certain rigidities and weaknesses were found to have
nationalised on July 1, 1955 and it was named as the State each, were nationalised on 19th July, 1969. The nationalised trajectory, the provision of adequate and timely availability developed in the banking system during the late eighties,
Bank of India. Along with SBI other 8 (at present 7) banks banks are as follows: of bank credit to the productive sectors of the economy has the Government felt that these had to be addressed to enable
were converted as its associate banks which form what is 1. The Central Bank of India acquired importance. As public sector banks still own about 71 the financial system to play its role in ushering in a more
named as the State Bank Group. They are as follows- 2. Bank of India % of the assets of the banking system, they continue to play efficient and competitive economy. Accordingly, a high-level
1. The State Bank of Bikaner and Jaipur (In the beginning 3. Punjab National Bank an important role in responding to the changes in the economic Committee under the Chairmanship of Shri M. Narasimham
the State Bank of Bikaner and the State Bank of Jaipur 4. Canara Bank environment. As the banking regulator and supervisor and as on the Financial System (CFS), was set up on August 14, 1991
were separate. But they were merged and named as the 5. United Commercial Bank the monetary policy authority, the Reserve Bank of India (RBI) to examine all aspects relating to the structure, organisation,
State Bank of Bikaner and Jaipur). 6. Syndicate Bank continues to guide the banking system, including foreign, functions and procedures of the financial systems. Based on the
2. The State Bank of Hyderabad 7. Bank of Baroda private sector and public sector banks, to meet emerging recommendations of the Committee a comprehensive reform
3. The State Bank of Indore 8. United Bank of India economic challenges. of the banking system was introduced in 1992-93.
E-100 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-101

Another high-level Committee, under the Chairmanship of Shri issued by Ministry of Finance are circulated through it. rate of interest at which they would lend to various sectors • Statutory Liquidity Ratio (SLR): It is that ratio of the total
M. Narasimham was constituted by the Government of India The Reserve Bank has adopted the Minimum Reserve in the economy. On the other hand, when bank rate is deposits of liquid funds, consisting mainly of government
in December 1997 to review the record of implementation of System for the note issue. Since 1957, it maintains gold lowered, it is called “cheap money policy” Generally, bank securities and, to some extent, cash in hand. It mainly
financial system reforms recommended by the CFS in 1991 and and foreign exchange reserves of 200 crores, of which at rate may be raised during period of inflation, and may be serves the purpose of lending to government , and to a
chart the reforms necessary in the years ahead. The Committee least 115 crores should be in gold. lesser extent, it also prevents a panic run on the banks.
lowered during a period os slowdown and recession.
submitted its report to the Government in April 1998. • Repo and Reverse Repo rate: Under repo rate, the RBI
2. Banker to the Government : • Cash Reserve Ratio (CRR) : It is that ratio of total undertakes to repurchase government securities from
The second important function of the Reserve Bank is to deposits of a bank which a bank has to keep in cash with banks,, with a commitment that it will give them back
Reserve Bank of India (RBI) act as the Banker, Agent and Adviser to the Government. the central bank. When this ratio is raised, it is called a to the banks. Thus, under Repos, the RBI lends to
It performs all the banking functions of the State and policy of “credit squeeze” and when lowered, it is known commercial banks by repurchasing government securities
It is the Central Bank of the country. The Reserve Bank of
Central Government and it also tenders useful advice as a policy of “credit liberalisation” it may generally be lying with them and therefore, repos imply injection of
India was established in 1935 with a capital of 5 crore. This liquidity in the banking system.
capital of 5 crore was divided into 5 lakh equity shares to the Government on matters related to economic and raised during inflation and lowered during a slowdown.
of 100 each. In the beginning the ownership of almost all monetary policy. It also manages the public debt for • Open market Operations: These are conducted by the RBI
the share capital was with the non-government shareholders. the Government. The RBI also channelises bank credit by selling and buying government securities from banks. Composition of Banking System in
In order to prevent the centralisation of the equity shares in in favour of priority sectors. RBI has thus developed Generally, the RBI may sell government securities during India
the hands of a few people, the Reserve Bank of India was institutions like IDBI, SIDBI, NABARD, NHB, etc. inflation, so as to mop up excess funds lying with banks. The Indian banking system consists of commercial banks both
nationalised on January 1, 1949. The RBI also promotes cooperative banking and the bill It may buy these during a period of slowdown to release in public and private sector, Regional Rural Banks (RRBs) and
market. liquidity in the banking system. co-operative banks.
The general administration and direction of RBI is managed by
a Central Board of Directors consisting of 20 members which 3. Banker’s Bank :
The Reserve Bank performs the same function for Indian Banking Industry
includes 1 Governor, 4 Deputy Governors,
1 Government official appointed by the Union Government of other banks as these banks ordinarily perform for their
India to give representation to important stratas in economic customer. It regulates, penalizes and helps banks as and
life of the country. Besides, 4 directors are nominated by when needed. Scheduled Unscheduled
the Union Government to represent local boards. Apart from 4. Controller of Credit : Banks Banks
the central board there are 4 local boards also and their head The Reserve Bank undertakes the responsibility of
offices are situated in Mumbai, Chennai, Kolkata and New controlling credit created by the commercial banks.
Delhi. 5 members of local boards are appointed by the Union To achieve this objective it makes extensive use of
Government for a period of 4 years. The local boards work quantitative and qualitative techniques to control and
according to the instructions and orders given by the Central regulate the credit effectively in the country. Scheduled Scheduled
Board of Directors, and from time to time they also tender 5. Custodian of Foreign Reserves : Commercial Co-operative
useful advice on important matter. The head office of Reserve For the purpose of keeping the foreign exchange rates Banks Banks
Bank of India is in Mumbai. At present, Raghuram Rajan is the stable, the Reserve Bank buys and sells foreign currencies
Governor of Reserve Bank of India. and also protects the country’s foreign exchange funds. SBI & Public
6. Other Functions : Associates Sector
Objectives of RBI Rural Urban
The bank performs a number of other developmental National Banks Banks (PSBs) Co-operative Co-operative
• The objectives of the RBI is to regulate the issue of bank works. These works include the function of being a (including IDBI) Banks Banks
notes and keeping of reserves with a view of securing clearing house, arranging credit for agriculture (which Foreign Banks
monetary stability in India and generally to operate the has been transferred to NABARD), collecting and
currency and credit system of the country to its advantage. Regional Rural Signal
publishing the economic data, (weekly, monthly and Short term Long term Multi-state
• The formulation, framework and institutional architecture Banks
annual reports are published by the RBI in the field of
of monetary policy in India have evolved around these the country’s currency and finance status), buying and
Other Scheduled
State, district and SCARDBs &
objectives - maintaining price stability, ensuring adequae selling of Government securities and trade bills, giving Commercial Banks
primary level PCARDBs
flow of credit to sustain growth momentum and securing loans to the Government, buying and selling of valuable Cooperative Banks
financial stability. commodities, etc. It also acts as the representative of Regional Rural Banks (RRBs) incorporated in India and so have their head offices in India.
• The responsibility for ensuring financial stability has Government in I.M.F. and represents the membership of Foreign banks, on the other hand, have been incorporated in
involved the vesting of extensive power in and operational India. RRBs were set up with the objective of developing the rural
economy by providing credit and encouraging other productive foreign countries and have their head offices outside India.
objectives for the RBI for regulation and supervision of As mentioned abve, RBI also acts as Controller of Credit, and
financial system and its constituents, the money, debt and activities in the rural areas.
in this role makes extensive use of quantitative and qualitative
Public sector banks sponsor RRBs, subscribing to the share Co-operative Banks
foreign exchange segments of the financial markets in techniques. These are as follows :
India and the payment and settlement system. capital. The RRBs meet the credit needs of the weaker sections– These banks are so called because they have been organised
Quantitative Credit Control Measures small and marginal farmers, artisans, small entrepreneurs, etc. under the provisions of the co-operative society’s law of the
Functions of Reserve Bank These measures ae those through which the Central bank of
The RRBs accumulated huge losses and fared badly in their states.
1. Issue of Notes : recovery of loans; the government allowed them to grant loans State co-operative Banks (SCB) : In terms of organisational
Country regulates and controls the total quantum. i.e. volume
to non-priority sectors as well so as to improve their financial
The Reserve Bank has the monopoly over issuing of loans and credit given by commercial banks. set-up of the co-operative banking system, the state co-
position.
of notes in the country. It has the sole right to issue • Bank Rate : It is that rate of interest at which the Central operative bank (SCB) in each state (co-operation being a state
currency notes of various denominations except one Bank provides financial assistance to commercial banks. Private Sector Banks subject) are at the apex level; at the district level are the central
rupee note. The Reserve Bank acts as the only source of When bank rate is raised, it is called “dear money policy” co-operative banks (CCBs); and at the village level, there are
These banks in India are of two kinds- Indian and foreign.
legal tender of money because even the one rupee notes which implies that commercial banks would also raise the primary agricultural credit societies (PACS).
The Indian private sector banks are those which have been

E-102 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-103

Scheduled and Non-Scheduled Banks RRBs and state co-operative banks are scheduled banks. The
Insurance Regulatory and Some of the functions of the authority include:
non-scheduled banks are those which have not been included • To protect the interest of and secure fair treatment to
The Reserve Bank of India has divided the banks as scheduled
and non-scheduled banks. The scheduled banks are those which
in the Second Schedule of the RBI Act, 1934. While in 1960- Development Authority policy holders.
61, there were 256 non-scheduled banks, most have been now IRDA is a multimember nodal agency and is vested with • To bring about speedy and orderly growth of the
have a paid-up capital and reserves of an aggregate value of not
amalgamated with bigger banks. regulatory powers in respect of the insurance sector similar insurance industry.
less than Rs 5 lakh. All commercial banks–Indian and foreign,
to those vested in SEBI in respect of the capital markets and • To ensure speedy settlement of genuine claims and to
Banking System in India of RBI for the banking sector. The IRDA Act, 1999 cleared prevent frauds and malpractices.
Indicators 2010 2011 2012 2013 the way for private sector entry into the insurance business.
• Promote fairness, transparency and orderly conduct in
The IRDA has powers to lay down prudential norms and financial markets dealing with insurance.
Number of 163 163 169 151 investment guidelines. It has ended the monopoly of LIC/
Commercial Banks GIC in the insurance sector, by permitting private players to
Number of Branches 88,203 94,019 102,377 109,811 enter, as recommended by Malhotra Committee.

Aggregate Deposits ` 44928 billion (US$660 ` 52078 billion (US$770 ` 59091 billion (US$870 ` 67504.54 billion COMMODITY FUTURES MARKET
billion) billion) billion) (US$1.0 trillion)
Bank Credit ` 32448 billion (US$480 ` 39421 billion (US$580 ` 46119 billion (US$660 ` 52605 billion (US$780 India has a long history of commodity futures trading. A The MCX recorded the highest turnover in terms of value
billion) billion) billion) billion) commodity includes all types of goods. Futures trading is of trade during 2009, followed by National Commodity and
organised in such goods or commodities as is permitted by the Derivatives Exchange Ltd. (NCDEX) and National Multi-
Deposit as percentage 78% 78% 78% 79%
government. A commodity exchange which is an association or Commodity Exchange of India Ltd. (NMCE) respectively.
to GNP (at factor cost)
a company or any corporate body organizing future trading in

Credit Deposit Ratio


commodities Forwards Market Commission (FMC)
74% 76% 79% 79% A future contract is a type of ‘forward contract’ which means
FMC is a statutory body set up by the Forwards Contracts
a contract for the delivery of goods that is not a ready delivery
Narsimhan Committee on Banking Sector • Banks should classify their assets into four categories, (Regulation) Act, 1952. It functions under the administrative
contract. A ready delivery contract provides delivery of goods
Reforms: namely-standard, sub-standard, doubtful and loss.
and payment of price either immediately or within a period not
control of Department of Consumer Affairs, Ministry of
The major recommendations of the committee are as follows : • Banks should conform to BASEL norms and have a capital Consumer Affairs, Food and Public Distribution. The
exceeding 11 days. The ready delivery contracts are known as
adequacy ratio (CAR) of 8% by 1998. Commission is a Regulatory body set up to ensure financial
• Banks should be free to open or close a branch, except “spot” or “cash” contracts.
• Priority sector lending should be brought down from 40% integrity, market integrity and protection and promotion of the
in rural areas, where banking cannot depend on a bank’s All contracts in commodities providing delivery of goods and interest of consumers.
choice, Also, there should be no further branch expansions. to 10% payment of price after 11 days are forward contracts which may
• Nationalisation of banks should not take place any more. • There should be a four-tier banking structure (international, be either “specific delivery contracts” or “ futures contracts”.
There are four commodity exchanges working in the country.
Foreign Portfolio Investments
• Private and foreign banks should be set up to promote national, regional and local).
competition. They are NMCE (National Multi Commodity Exchange) - The government has allowed Foreign Institutional Investors
Non performing assets: the oldest commodity exchange in the country which became (FIIs) to invest in Indian stock markets since September 1992.
• There should be a phased reduction of CRR and SLR
As per recommendations of the Narasimham Committee, it operational in 2002, MCX (Multi Commodity Exchange), These FIIs are foreign pension funds, mutual funds, investment
• Speedy computerization of banks. NCDEX (National commodity and Derivatives Exchange) trusts, asset management companies (AMCs) and portfolio
• Setting up of special “ debt recovery tribunals” has been decided that credit facilities granted by banks will be
and ICEX (Indian Commodity Exchange). ICEX is the managers. FIIs have generally been actively participating in
classified into performing and non-performing assets (NPA).
• Setting up of Asset Reconstruction of companies for not latest commodity exchange which becomes operational since the Portfolio Investment Scheme, although there are charges
performing assets (NPAs). NPA is a loan (whether term loan, cash credit, overdraft, or that they have brought greater volatility to the Indian stock
November 27, 2009. India bulls of private sector and MMT
bills discounted), which is in default for more than six months. of the public sector are the main promoter companies of this market. Net FII inflow at end of 2012 stood at US $ 31.01
• A board for financial supervision should be set up.
In case of such assets, the income should be shown only on exchange. billion (as per the economic Survey 2012-13). 1759 FIIs are
• Banks should adopt provisioning norms to keep provisions
against bad loans in their books. receipt and not in the bank’s book on a due basis. currently registered with SEBI.

INSURANCE SECTOR NON-BANKING FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS (NBFIS)


NBFIs work in similar ways as banks, but there are certain in view of the difficulties expressed by the NHB and EXIM
The Insurance sector was nationalised in two stages. General Insurance Corporation of differences Bank, their aggregate borrowing limit has been enhanced to 11
India (GIC) According to the Economic Survey, there are four Institutions, times of their net owned funds (NOF) for one year (for NHB
Life Insurance Corporation of India namely: up to 30 September, 2012 and for EXIM Bank up to 31 March,
The GIC was formed in November 1972 upon the nationalisation
(LIC) of general insurance business. The 107 private companies (i) Export Import Bank of India (EXIM Bank), 2012, subject to review.)

The LIC was established on first of September 1956 after operating in the field were grouped together into four : (ii) National Bank for Agriculture and Rural Development
(i) National Insurance Company, (NABARD), Export-Import Bank of India (EXIM
nationalising the existing private insurance companies. LIC has
a strong social security scheme which is funded by the Social (ii) United India Insurance Company, (iii) National Housing Bank (NHB) and Bank)
(iii) Oriental Insurance Company, and (iv) Small Industries Development Bank of India (SIDBI). EXIM bank in India was established on January 1, 1982 for
Security Fund (SSF) set up and administrated by it since 1989-
(iv) New India Assurance Company, These institutions are regulated by the RBI as all-India FIs. The financing, facilitating and promoting foreign trade in India.
90. The LIC runs three schemes supported by SSF - Janashree
with GIC as the holding company. These companies can outstanding of total resources mobilized at any point of time Besides, EXIM Bank also discharges duties of co-ordinating
Bima Yojana, Krishi Shramik Samajik Suraksha Yojana and by an FI, including funds mobilized under the ‘umbrella limit’,
compete among themselves for all types of general insurance the activities of various financial institutions, providing
Shiksha Sahayog Yojana. These schemes benefit persons and except aviation insurance and crop insurance which are the as prescribed by the RBI, should not exceed 10 times its net finances for export and imports of goods and services. Besides
families below the poverty line. monopoly of GIC. owned funds as per its latest audited balance sheet. However, India, this bank also manages finances to third world countries
E-104 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-105

for export and import of goods and services. The Government


of India wholly owns EXIM Bank of India.

National Housing Bank (NHB)


It is also free to obtain loans in foreign currencies from foreign
institutions. SIDBI will provide loans (both in Indian and
Foreign Currencies) under its ‘Single Window Service’.
While IDBI continues to be the single largest shareholder of
Exercise - 1
SIDBI, the State Bank of India and LIC follow as the next two 1. Demand management to control inflation may lead to: 9. Bank rate refers to:
National Housing Bank was established in July 1988 as wholly
(a) increase in government expenditure (a) the rate at which banks lend to its prime borrowers
owned subsidiary of RBI. NHB is the apex banking institution large share holders in that order.
(b) increase in unemployment due to contraction of the (b) the maximum rate that banks can pay for deposit
providing finances for houses. The statutory mandate of
economy (c) the rate at which banks rediscount bills with RBI
NHB covers promotional, developmental and regulatory National Bank for Agriculture and (c) expansion of credit (d) the rate of interest charged on inter-bank transactions
aspects of housing finance with focus on developing a sound
housing finance system. NHB amended its Act called NHB
Rural Development (NABARD) (d) creation of excess liquidity 10. Open market operation of RBI refers to:
2. Which of the following is not a function of the Securities (a) buying and selling of shares
(Amendment) Act, 2000 which came into force on June 12, It is an apex depevlomental bank in India. Setting up of
and Exchange Board of India (SEBI)? (b) auctioning of foreign exchange
2000. NHB has made a number of efforts to promote the NABARAD was recommended by the committee to review (c) trading in securities
supply of real resources like land and building material. (a) Supervising the working of the Stock Exchanges
arrangements for institutional credit for agriculture and rural (d) transaction in gold
(b) Underwriting new capital issues
NHB has been permitted to mobilise resources by issuing development, set up by the RBI, under the chairmanship of Shri 11. According to the Chakravarthy Committee, one of the
(c) Regulating merchant banks and mutual funds
bonds and debentures. NHB can obtains short term loan for B.Sivaraman. It was established in 1982 and its main focus has principal causes affecting price stability in India is:
(d) promoting the development of a healthy capital
18 months period from RBI and obtain long-term loan from been on the upliftment of rural India by increasing credit flow (a) existence of black money
market
National Housing Credit Fund constituted by RBI. It can also into agriculture and rural non-farm sector. It has been entrusted (b) violent fluctuation in agricultural production
with matters concerning policy, planning and operations in the 3. It is said that, in order to control inflation, foreign inflow (c) India’s precarious balance of payment position
obtain loans from various financial institutions of India and
field of credit for agriculture and other economic activities needs to be sterlised. Sterlisation here refers to: (d) fiscal deficit
abroad. It can also obtain loans in foreign currencies. Besides,
in rural areas in India. NABARAD is active in developing (a) ensuring that black money is accounted. 12. International capital flows have been uncertain and
NHB can accept long term deposits from Central Government
financial inclusion policy and is a member of the Alliance for (b) compliance with import-export regulations volatile, causing exchange rate and balance of payment
and other institutions. (c) ensuring that counterfeit currency does not enter crisis among developing countries. Among the various
Financial Inclusion.
A major activity of NHB includes extending financial assistance circulation sources of external capital available to India which source
to eligible institutions in the housing sector by way of refinance Micro Finance (d) withdrawing equivalent local currency to maintain a should you consider as the most preferable?
and direct finance. The NHB is the regulator and supervisor of desirable rate of exchange (a) Foreign institutional investment
Financial Inclusion is the delivery of financial services at (b) Portfolio investment
Housing Finance Companies (HFCs) in the country. 4. The first public sector bank in India which obtained
an affordable cost to vast sections of the disadvantaged and (c) External commercial borrowing
license for Internet Banking from RBI is-
low income groups. It is crucial to innovate and provide (d) Foreign direct investment
Small Industries Development Bank means to include the financially disadvantaged by ensuring
(a) Punjab National Bank
13. Which of the following was described as the biggest ever
(b) Oriental Bank of Commerce
of India (SIDBI) access to financial services, and timely and adequate credit. (c) Corporation Bank cash purchase of the shares of a bank in India?
Financial inclusion can be described as the provision of (a) Purchase of Nedungadi Bank shares by Punjab
Small Industries Development Bank of India (SIDBI) was (d) State Bank of India
affordable financial services, like access to payments and National Bank
established as wholly owned subsidiary of IDBI under the 5. Which of the following markets are independently
remittance facilities, savings, loans and insurance services (b) Amalgamation of Global Trust Bank with Oriental
Small Industries Development Bank of India Act, 1989 as the regulated by Forward Market Commission?
by the formal financial system to those who are excluded. Bank of Commerce
principal financial institution for promotion, financing and (a) Mutual Funds (c) Merger of Centurion Bank of Punjab with HDFC
development of industries in the small scale sector. SIDBI The Self-Help Group (SHG)-bank linkage programme (b) Commodity Futures Market Bank
started its operations from April 2, 1990. It oversees the activity continued to be the main micro-finance model by which (c) Stock Market (d) Purchase of State Bank of India shares from RBI by
of agencies which provide finances to small enterprises. It’s the formal banking system reaches micro-enterpreneurs (d) Foreign Exchange Markets the Central Government
headquarter is situated at Lucknow. 5 Regional and 21 Branch (including farmers). Launched in 1992 as a pilot project, 6. Inflation, in theory, occurs: 14. To know whether the rich are getting richer and the poor
Offices have also been started in different parts of the country. it has since proved its efficacy as a mainstream programme (a) when the price of essential commodities outstrips getting poorer, it is necessary to compare
All duties related to small enterprises which were performed for banking by the poor who mainly comprise the marginal income (a) the wholesale price index over different periods of
by IDBI, have been shifted to SIDBI. SIDBI provides farmers, landless labourers, artisans and craftsmen and (b) when money supply grows at a higher rate than time for different regions
assistance to the small scale industrial sector in the country others engaged in small businesses like hawking and vending GDP in real terms (b) the distribution of income of an idential set of
in the rural areas. The main advantages of the programme are (c) when the exchange rate of a currency falls income recipients in different period of time
through other institutions like State Financial Corporations
(d) when fiscal deficit exceeds balance of payment (c) the distribution of income of different sets of income
(SFC), Commercial Banks, and State Industrial Development timely repayment of loans to banks, reduction in transaction
recipients at a point of time
Corporations, etc. Besides share capital, SIDBI can increase costs both to the poor and the banks, doorstep “saving and deficit
(d) the availability of foodgrains among two sets of
its resources by taking loans from the Government of India and credit” facility for poor and exploitation of the untapped 7. Among the supply side measures to contain inflation is:
people, one rich and the other poor, over different
business potential of the rural areas. (a) postponing public expenditure
RBI. SIDBI can also obtain loans from Indian Capital market. period of time
(b) mopping up excess liquidity through taxation
15. Which of the following statements correctly expresses the
(c) credit control measures of RBI difference between preference shares and equity shares?
(d) maintaining price levels through an effective PDS (a) equity shareholders have no voting right but
8. Which of the following is not true of the Regional Rural preference shareholders have voting rights
Banks (RRBs)? (b) preference shareholders have no have voting rights
(a) They provide direct loans to small and marginal but equity shareholders have voting rights
farmers; (c) preference shareholders have no right to profit
(b) They are co-sponsored by Reserve Bank of India; whereas equity shareholders have a right to profit
(c) They also perform other banking operations; (d) preference shareholders get exemption from taxes
(d) State Governments are share-holders in RRBs. while equity shareholders do not get any exemption

E-106 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-107

16. Which one of the following governmental steps has (a) Self Regulatory Organisations (b) a rise in prices of shares of all companies registered 35. Open market Operation by RBI are the part of its :
proved relatively effective in controlling the double digit (b) Small Revenue Operators with National Stock Exchange (a) Fiscal Policy (b) Credit Policy
rate of inflation in the Indian economy during recent (c) Securities Roll-back Operators (c) an overall rise in prices of shares of group up (c) Income Policy (d) Monetary Policy
years? companies registered with Bombay Stock Exchange 36. Which of the following statements is not correct regarding
(d) Securities Regulatory Organisations
(a) enhanced rate of production of all consumer goods (d) a rise in prices of shares of all companies belonging the ‘Banking Sector’ of India?
23. Debentures and Equity differ in? to a group of companies registered with Bombay
(b) streamlined public distribution system (a) Debentures are bonds confirming that money has (a) At present there are 26 Nationalized Banks in India.
(c) pursuing an export oriented strategy Stock Exchange
been borrowed; equity is a shareholder’s voting (b) Foreign Banks and Regional Rural Banks do not
(d) containing budgetary deficit and unproductive 29. Which of the following would best describe the role of a
rights in proportion to his shareholding come under the category of Scheduled Commercial
expenditure merchant bank?
(b) An equity shareholder cannot withdraw his Banks.
17. Which one of the following is not a feature of “Value (a) To monitor the activities of publicly-list companies
investment but debenture holder can withdraw his (b) To act as banker and financial agent to the federal (c) Banks have the freedom to regulate their own
Added Tax” ? government Savings Bank Deposit interest rates.
money.
(a) It is multi-point destination-based system of taxation. (c) To provide borrowing and leading services, (d) Narsimham Committee is related to Banking Sector
(c) Equity shares have greater risk compared to
(b) It is a tax levied on value addition at each stage of primarily to the business sector reforms.
debentures which have fixed interest on the amount
transaction in the production distribution chain. (d) To provide loans to the corporate sector through
paid. 37. The concept of ‘Universal Banking’ was implemented in
(c) It is a tax on the final consumption of goods or receipts of insurance premiums
(d) Both have the right to vote irrespective of the size of 30. Which action by the Reserve Bank would stimulate the India on the recommendations of:
services and must ultimately be borne by the
their holdings. Debentures are of lower value than economy in an economic downturn? (a) Abid Hussain Committee
consumer.
equity (a) Selling government securities in the cash market (b) R H Khan Committee
(d) It is basically a subject of the central government
24. How do we define the terms bull and bear with regard to (b) Buying government securities in the cash market (c) S Padmanabhan Committee
and the state governments are only a facilitator for
stock markets? (c) Selling foreign currencies on the foreign exchange
its successful implementation. (d) Y H Malegam Committee
(a) A bull is an optimistic operator who first buys and market
18. Which one of the following statements is an appropriate 38. Which among 1the following is considered to be a part of
then sells shares in expectation of the price going (d) Buying foreign currencies on the foreign exchange
description of deflation? Shadow Banking in India?
up; a bear is a pessimistic market operator who sells market
(a) It is a sudden fall in the value of a currency against (a) Business Correspondents
the shares in expectation of buying them back at a 31. Which of the following could be a cause of demand
other currencies (b) Bankassurance Providers
lower price. inflation?
(b) It is a persistent recession in both the financial and (c) Non-Banking Financial Companies
(b) There is nothing significantly different as both
real sectors of economy (a) An increase in the cost of labour
operate in the capital market. (d) Private Banks
(c) It is a persistent fall in the general price level of (b) An increase in domestic interest rates
(c) Bull is one who first sells a share and then buys it 39. Which among the following is the only correct statement?
goods and services (c) An increase in the level of consumer spending
at a lower price; bear means one who first buys and (a) Money market meets long term financing needs
(d) It is a fall in the rate of inflation over a period of (d) An increase in import prices, resulting from a
then sells it in expectation of prices going up. (b) Recession in industrial sector in India is normally
time depreciating dollar
(d) A bull is ready to buy any share; a bear only deals due to fall in exports
19. A rapid increase in the rate of inflation is sometimes 32. Other things being equal, what would be the impact of an
in government securities. (c) Ways and means advances given by RBI are nowhere
attributed to the “base effect”. What is “base effect”? increase in net capital inflow on the Indian currency?
25. What do you understand by the term “Jobber”? related to State’s revenue
(a) It is the impact of drastic deficiency in supply due to (a) There would be an increase in the demand for the
(a) A stock dealer who deals directly with the public for (d) Exchange rate is fixed by RBI
failure of crops American dollar and an appreciation of the currency.
which he gets a commission 40. Bring out the only incorrect statement:
(b) It is the impact of the surge in demand due to rapid (b) There would be a decrease in the demand for the
(b) A broker who buys and sells on behalf of his clients (a) Reverse Repo operation by RBI aims at injecting/
economic growth rupees (`) and a depreciation of the currency.
(c) A stock dealer who is a member of a stock exchange increasing liquidity
(c) It is the impact of the price levels of previous year (c) There would be an increase in the supply of the
and deals with the public only through the medium (b) SDR refers to special drawing rights
on the calculation of inflation rate American dollar and an appreciation of the currency.
of brokers (c) Rupee appreciation results in decrease in imports
(d) None of the statements (a), (b) and (c) given above (d) There would be a decrease in the supply of the
(d) A stock broker who deals only with shares and not (d) Increase in inflation rate leads to decline in real
is correct in this context American dollar and a depreciation of the currency.
any other form of securities interest rate
20. The basic aim of Lead Bank Scheme is that: 33. If an exporter earns money and deposits that with RBI,
26. What are “Futures”? 41. Which among the following correctly defines the Net
(a) big banks should try to open offices in each district what will be the ultimate impact on country’s money
(a) Securities or commodities sold or bought with the Interest Income?
(b) there should be stiff competition among the various supply?
assumption of delivery at a later stage (a) Money supply will increase (a) Interest earned on advances
nationalized banks
(b) Shares and debentures bought at a cheaper rate and (b) Money supply will decrease (b) Interest earned on investments
(c) individual banks should adopt particular districts for
sold later at high rates (c) Money supply will remain unaltered (c) Total interest earned on advances and investment
intensive development
(c) Particular types and quantities of securities and (d) Money supply will depend upon the current exchange (d) Difference between interest earned and interest paid
(d) all the banks should make intensive efforts to
com-modities bought for selling at higher prices rate 42. In which among the following types comes the Interest
mobilize deposits
(d) None of these 34. ‘SHG Bank Linkage Programme’ is a programme which Rate Risk?
21. The International Development Association, a lending
27. An outward shift in the demand for money, other things encourages India’s banks to lend to self-help groups
agency, is administered by the: (a) Credit risk (b) Market risk
being equal should lead to: (SHGs) composed mainly of poor women, this has
(a) International Bank for Reconstruction and (c) Operational risk (d) All the above categories
(a) A lower interest rate but the same quantity of money evolved into an important Indian tool for microfinance.
Development (b) A higher interest rate but the same quantity of 43. When there is an inflationary trend in the economy, what
(b) International Fund for Agricultural Development This programme was initiated by ? would be trend in the pricing of the Bank Products?
money
(c) United Nations Development Programme. (a) Reserve Bank of India (RBI) (a) Increasing Trend
(c) A higher quantity of money but lower interest rates
(d) A higher quantity of money but the same interest (b) Agricultural Refinance and Development
(d) United Nations Industrial Development Organization (b) Decreasing Trend
rate Corporation (ARDC)
22. The acronym SRO, being used in the capital market for (c) Constant Trend
28. A rise in ‘SENSEX’ means: (c) National Bank for Agriculture and Rural
various market participants, stands for which one of the (d) There is no relevance of the inflation in pricing of
(a) a rise in prices of shares of all companies registered Development (NABARD)
following? the Banking Products
with Bombay Stock Exchange (d) Non-Banking Finance Companies (NBFC)
E-108 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-109

44. From time to time, which among the following body 52. Which among the following gives a precise definition of 60. Which among the following is correct about the Vostro 62. The most active segment of the Money Market in India is
publishes the “Exchange Control Manual” in context “ Arbitrage” in Financial World? Account? which one of the following?
with the Foreign Exchange in India? (a) To profit from an existing discrepancy among prices, (a) It is an account maintained by a foreign bank with a (a) Call Money / Notice Money Market
(a) Foreign Trade Promotion Board exchange rates, and/or interest rates on Different Bank in India in Indian Rupees. (b) Repo / Reverse Repo
(b) Department of Commerce Markets without risk of these changing (b) It is an account maintained by an Indian bank with a (c) Commercial Paper (CP)
(c) Reserve Bank of India (b) to profit from an existing discrepancy among prices, Bank in Foreign country in Foreign Currency. (d) Certificate of Deposit (CD)
(d) SEBI exchange rates, and/or interest rates on Same market (c) It is an account maintained by a Indian Bank Branch 63. An increase in the Bank Rate generally indicates that the :
45. As per Section 24 (2A) of Banking Regulation Act without risk of these changing with a Foreign Bank in Foreign Currency. (a) market rate of interest is likely to fall
1949, every banking company in India has to maintain (c) To profit from an existing discrepancy among (d) It is an account maintained by a Foreign Bank (b) Central Bank is no longer making loans to
equivalent to an amount which shall not at the close of prices, exchange rates, and/or interest rates on new Branch with a Indian Bank in Foreign Currency. commercial banks
the business on __________ be less than 25% of the total techniques or products in same market. 61. What do we call an arrangement whereby an issuing (c) Central Bank is following an easy money policy
of its net demand and time liabilities, which is known as (d) All of above Bank at the request of the Importer (Buyer) undertakes (d) Central Bank is following a tight money policy
SLR. 53. “A statement of estimated receipts and expenditures to make payment to the exporter (Beneficiary) against 64. What does venture capital mean?
called annual Financial Statement (Budget) has to be (a) A short-term capital provided to industries
Which among the following is the correct option? stipulated documents?
placed before parliament for each financial year.” The (b) A long-term start-up capital provided to new
(a) Any Day (b) Any Week (a) Bill of Exchange
above provision has been enshrined in which among the entrepreneurs
(b) Letter of Exchange
(c) Any Fortnight (d) Any Month following articles of Constitution of India? (c) Funds provided to industries at times of incurring
46. Which among the following is NOT Tier I Capital? (c) Letter of Credit
(a) Article 110 (b) Article 111 losses
(d) Bill of Entry
(a) Paid up Capital (c) Article 112 (d) Article 113 (d) Funds provided for replacement and renovation of
(b) Statutory Reserves 54. Capitalism is based upon “Laissez-faire system”. What is industries
“Laissez-faire system”?
(c) Revaluation Reserves
(a) No governmental intervention
(d) Investment Fluctuation Reserves (b) Maximum governmental intervention
47. For which of the following, the Reserve Bank of India has (c) Role of market forces is minimum
stipulated a maximum Capital Adequacy Requirements in (d) Limited government Intervention
India? 55. Which among the following is true about “deficit
(a) Private Sector Banks financing”?
(b) Banks that Undertake Insurance Business. (a) Public expenditure in excess of public revenue
(c) Local Area Banks (b) Public revenue in excess of public expenditure
(d) Scheduled Commercial Banks (c) New currency replaced by old currency
48. Which one of the following Public Sector Bank’s emblem (d) None of above
figures a dog and the words ‘faithful friendly, in it? 56. An excise duty is a charge on which of the following?
(a) Punjab National Bank (a) Export of goods
(b) Syndicate Bank (b) Production of goods
(c) Oriental Bank of Commerce (c) Production or sale of goods
(d) State Bank of India (d) Consumption of good
49. Which among the following is NOT an instrument of
57. “Bad money (if not limited in quantity ) drives good
qualitative control in India ?
money out of circulation.” The above statement is from
(a) Regulation of the Consumer Credit
which among the following laws?
(b) Rationing of the Credit
(a) Keynes’ law (b) Wagner’s law
(c) Margin Requirements
(c) Gresham’s law (d) Grimm’s law
(d) Variable Costs and Reserves
58. Which among the following is a correct definition of
50. Which among the following would most likely follow if
currency drain?
the Reserve Bank of India effects selling of the securities?
(a) A currency drain is an export of the domestic
(a) The cash resources at the disposal of the commercial
currency
banks increase.
(b) A currency drain is an increase in currency held
(b) The cash resources at the disposal of the commercial
outside the banks.
banks get diminished.
(c) A currency drain is the currency holding by a
(c) The cash resources of the commercial banks remain
parallel economy
unchanged.
(d) None of these
(d) None of the above.
59. Which among the following is a correct definition of
51. The Laffer curve is the graphical representation of:
Fiduciary Issue of notes?
(a) The relationship between tax rates and absolute
(a) The issue of currency notes without metallic
revenue these rates generate for the government.
backing.
(b) The inverse relationship between the rate of
unemployment and the rate of inflation in an (b) The issue of currency notes with metallic backing.
economy. (c) The issue of currency notes with partial metallic
(c) The inequality in income distribution. backing.
(d) The relationship between environmental quality and (d) The issue of currency notes with proportional
economic development. metallic backing.

E-110 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-111

Exercise - 2 11. What is ‘Future Trading’?



1. It is a trade between two stock exchanges wherein
it is decided to purchase stocks of each other on a
fixed price throughout the year
2. It is an agreement between two parties to buy or sell





1. Cutting the frequency of Open Market Operations
2. Cutting the Cash Reserve Ratio
3. Cutting the Repo and Reverse Repo rates
Choose the correct options:
(a) Only 1 (b) Only 1 & 2
Statement Based MCQ Which of these statements are correct?
an underlying asset in the future at a predetermined (c) Only 2 & 3 (d) 1, 2 & 3
(a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1 and 4
price 18. Which one among the following is an appropriate
(c) 2, 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 3. It is an agreement between stock exchange that they
1. Consider the following statements : description of deflation?
6. Consider the following statements: will not trade in stocks of each other in future or for
The function of the Reserve Bank of India does not (a) it is a sudden fall in the value of a currency against
1. The repo rate is the rate at which other banks borrow a predetermined period of time
include: other currencies
from the Reserve Bank of India. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (b) It is a persistent recession in the economy
1. Open market operations
2. A value of 1 for Gini Coefficient in a country implies (c) 3 only (d) All 1, 2 and 3 (c) It is a persistent fall in the general price level of
2. Monitoring revenue collection
that there is perfectly equal income for everyone in 12. Brent index is associated with : goods and services
3. Supervising non-banking finance companies
4. Review of public expenditure its population. (1) crude oil prices (2) copper future prices (d) It is fall in the rate of inflation over a period of time
Which of the statement/s given above is/are correct? Which of the statements given above is/are correct? (3) gold future prices (4) shipping rate index 19. Consider the following statements:
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only Which of the following is true? 1. Not all banks come under the regulation of Right to
(a) 1 only (b) 2 and 4
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (a) Only 1 (b) Only 2 Information Act
(c) 1, 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4
7. Consider the following statements: (c) Only 3 (d) Only 4 2. Not all banks come under the Schedule 2 of RBI
2. Consider the following statements with regard to
1. Sensex is based on 50 of the most important stocks 13. Which of the following statements is/ are correct? Which among the above statements is / are correct?
Statutory Liquidity Ratio (SLR) : 1. NIFTY is based upon 50 firms in India.
1. To meet SLR, Commercial banks can use cash only. available on the Bombay stock Exchange (BSE). (a) Only 1 is correct
2. For calculating the Sensex, all the stock are assigned 2. NIFTY is governed and regulated by the Reserve (b) Only 2 is correct
2. SLR is maintained by the banks with themselves. Bank of India.
3. SLR restricts the banks leverage in pumping more proportional weightage. (c) Both 1 and 2 are correct
3. New York Stock Exchange is the oldest stock 3. NIFTY does not trade in mutual funds. (d) Neither 1 nor 2 is correct
money into the economy. Select the correct answer using the codes given below :
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? exchange in the world. 20. Consider the following statements regarding the Office of
(a) Only 1 (b) Only 2 Economic Advisor (OEA):
(a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1 and 3 Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
(c) Only 3 (d) 1 and 3
(a) 2 only (b) 1 and 3 1. It is attached to the Ministry of Finance.
(c) 2 and 3 (d) only 2 14. Which of the following measures should be taken when
(c) 2 and 3 (d) none 2. The weekly compilation and Publication of
3. Consider the following statements. an economy is going through in inflationary pressures?
8. Name the 3 commodities in the Wholesale Price Index. Wholesale Price Indices (WPI) is done by the Office
1. The National Housing Bank, the apex institution of 1. The direct taxes should be increased.
1. Primary articles of Economic Advisor.
housing finance in India, was set up as a wholly- 2. The interest rate should be reduced.
2. Fuel, power, light and lubricants Which of the statement(s) given above is/are correct?
owned subsidiary of the Reserve Bank of India. 3. The public spending should be increased.
3. Manufactured products (a) Only 1 (b) Only 2
2. The Small Industries Development Bank of India Select the correct answer using the codes given below:
4. Food articles and industrial raw materials (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
was established as a wholly-owned subsidiary of the (a) Only 1 (b) Only 2
(a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 2, 3 and 4 21. Consider the following statements regarding Non-
Industrial Development Bank of India. (c) 2 and 3 (d) 1 and 2
(c) 1, 3 and 4 (d) 1 and 3 15. Consider the following statements: Banking Finance Companies (NBFCs):
Which of the statement given above is/are correct? 1. NBFCs can also engage in Micro-Finance Activities.
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 9. Which of the following measures would result in an 1. High growth will lead to inflation.
2. High growth will lead to deflation. 2. Housing-finance companies form a distinct sub-
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 increase in the money supply in the economy?
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? group of the NBFCs.
4. Why is the offering of “teaser loans’’ by commercial 1. Purchase of government securities from the public
(a) Only 1 (b) Only 2 3. The deposit insurance facility of the Deposit
banks a cause of economic concern ? by the Central Bank
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 Insurance and Credit Guarantee Corporation is not
1. The teaser loans are considered to be an aspect of 2. Deposit of currency in commercial banks by the
16. Which of the following are the provisions of SARFAESI available for NBFC depositors.
sub-prime lending and banks may be exposed to the public Which among the above statement(s) is/are not correct?
3. Borrowing by the government from the Central Act which enables banks to reduce their non-performing
risk of defaulters in future. (a) Only 1 (b) 1 and 3
Bank assets (NPAs)?
2. In India, the teaser loans are mostly given to 1. Enforcement of Security Interest by secured creditor (c) All of there (d) None of these
inexperienced entrepreneurs to set up manufacturing 4. Sale of government securities to the public by the 22. Which among the following are the ‘Credit-Rating
(Banks/ Financial Institutions).
or export units. Central Bank Agencies’ of India?
2. Transfer of non- performing assets to asset
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? Select the correct answer using the codes given below : 1. CRISIL 2. CARE
reconstruction company which will then dispose of
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only (a) 1 only (b) 2 and 4 those assets and realise the proceeds. 3. ICRA 4. ONICRA
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 (c) 1 and 3 (d) 2, 3 and 4 3. To provide a legal framework for securitization of (a) 1 and 3 (b) 1, 2 and 3
5. With reference to the Indian Public Finance, consider the 10. A company undertakes a public issue which means that assets. (c) 1, 3 and 4 (d) All of them
following statements: _____ . 4. Assisting banks in making the credibility track 23. Which among the following are the wholly/partly owned
1. External liabilities reported in the Union Budget are 1. Shares of the company will be issued only through record of customers under Credit Information subsidiaries of the Reserve Bank of India (RBI)?
based on historical exchange rates public sector organizations like banks/central Bureau of India (CIBIL). 1. Deposit Insurance and Credit Guarantee Corporation
2. The continued high borrowing has kept the real financial institutions etc. (a) 1 and 2 (b) 1, 2 and 3 (DICGC)
interest rates high in the economy 2. Shares of the company will be issued to general (c) 2, 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 2. National Housing Bank (NHB)
3. The upward trend in the ratio of Fiscal Deficit of public through the primary market. 17. Recently, one of the well known market analysts made 3. National Bank for Agriculture and Rural
GDP a recent years has a adverse effect on private 3. means some stakeholders/promoters are leaving this statement: “We expect the Reserve Bank of India to Development (NABARD)
investment the company and wish to sell their stock to general continue to ease liquidity” Which among the following 4. Bharatiya Reserve Bank Note Mudran Private
4. Interest payments is the single largest component public. instruments can be used by RBI to continue to ease Limited (BRBNMPL)
of the non-plan revenue expenditure of the Union (a) 1 only (b) 2 only liquidity? (a) 1 and 4 (b) 1, 2 and 4
Government (c) 3 only (d) All 1, 2 and 3 (c) 2, 3 and 4 (d) All of them
E-112 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-113

24. Consider the following statements: Which among the above statements is/ are correct? 36. Consider the following statements: 43. The Reserve Bank of India regulates the commercial
1. Increase in deposit rate results in higher savings (a) Only 1 is correct 1. There is almost no speculation in the G-sec market banks in matters of:
2. Increase in deposit rate results in fall in credit off (b) Only 2 is correct 2. The Investors in the G-Sec Market are predominantly 1. liquidity of assets 2. branch expansion
takes (c) Both 1 and 2 are correct the institutions 3. merger of banks 4. winding-up of banks
3. Increase in deposit rate results in increase in (d) Neither 1 nor 2 is correct Which among the above statements is / are correct? Select the correct answer using the codes given below.
investment 30. Consider the following: (a) Only 1 is correct (a) 1 and 4 only (b) 2, 3 and 4 only
Which among the above statements is / are correct? (b) Only 2 is correct (c) 1, 2 and 3 only (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4
1. Commercial Banks 2. Central Bank of India
(c) Both 1 & 2 are correct 44. Which of the following grants / grant direct credit
(a) 1 & 2 (b) 1 & 3 3. Government (d) Neither 1 nor 2 is correct assistance to rural households?
(c) 1, 2, 3 (d) Only 1 Which among the above can create money? 37. Consider the following: 1. Regional Rural Banks
25. Consider the following statements: (a) Only 1 (b) Only 1 & 2 1. Change in the Reserve Requirements
1. As per the Basel II accords, Banks have to maintain (c) Only 3 (d) All 1 2 & 3 2. National Bank for Agriculture and Rural
2. Taxation
a minimum 8% CRAR 31. The Non-Votable charges or ‘Charged Expenditure’ Development
3. Government Spending
2. Out of 8% Banks have to keep a Tier I Capital of included in the Union Budget include : Which among the above terms are closest to the Fiscal 3. Land Development Banks
5% policy ? Select the correct answer using the codes given below.
1. Salary and Allowances of the Presiding Officers of
3. In India, the Banks are required to keep the CAR of (a) Only 1 & 2 (b) Only 2 & 3 (a) 1 and 2 only (b) 2 only
the houses of Parliament.
9% at least. (c) Only 1 (d) Only 1 & 3 (c) 1 and 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3
2. Salary and Allowances of the Judges of the Supreme
Which among the above statements is / are correct? 38. Consider the following statements in context with 45. When the Reserve Bank of India reduces the Statutory
Court and High Courts.
(a) Only 1 Treasury Bills: Liquidity Ratio by 50 basis points, which of the following
3. Salary and Allowances of the CAG. is likely to happen?
(b) Only 1 & 2 1. They are issued by Government of India on behalf
4. Pension of the retired Judges of the Supreme Court. of Reserve Bank of India (a) India’s GDP growth rate increases drastically
(c) Only 1 & 3 5. Pension of the retired Judges of High Courts.
(d) All are correct statements 2. They are mostly for Short term borrowings (b) Foreign Institutional Investors may bring more
Select the option(s) which is/are correct? 3. Treasury Bills can not be purchased by any person capital into our country
26. Consider the following statements: (a) 1 and 2 (b) 1, 2 and 3 resident of India (c) Scheduled Commercial Banks may cut their lending
1. In Minimum Reserve System, RBI had to keep a (c) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (d) All of them Which among the above is / are correct ? rates
minimum reserve of Gold worth ` 115 Crores and 32. Which of the following are among the taxes levied (a) All are correct (b) 2 & 3 are correct
rest in Indian Rupees. (d) It may drastically reduce the liquidity to the banking
exclusively by the Central Government and are (c) Only 2 is correct (d) Only 3 is correct system
2. The Minimum Requirement of Foreign Securities 39. With reference to inflation in India, which of the following
mentioned in the Union List of the Seventh Schedule of 46. In the context of Indian economy, which of the following
was diluted when Minimum Reserve System was statements is correct?
the Constitution of India? is/are the purpose/purposes of ‘Statutory Reserve
launched. (a) Controlling the inflation in India is the responsibility
1. Corporation Tax Requirements’?
Which among the above statement is / are correct? of the Government of India only
2. Taxes on advertisement in the newspapers 1. To enable the Central Bank to control the amount
(a) Only 1 is correct (b) The Reserve Bank of India has no role in controlling
3. Taxes on Agricultural income the inflation of advances the banks can create
(b) Only 2 is correct
4. Taxes on consumption/sale of electricity (c) Decreased money circulation helps in controlling 2. To make the people’s deposits with banks safe and
(c) Both of them are correct
(a) Only 2 (b) Only 4 the inflation liquid
(d) Both of them are incorrect
(c) 1 and 2 (d) 3 and 4 (d) Increased money circulation helps in controlling the 3. To prevent the commercial banks from making
27. Consider the following steps:
33. Consider the following taxes: inflation excessive profits
1. Banking Department gets currency from the Issue 4. To force the banks to have sufficient vault cash to
1. VAT paid during purchase of a tyre tube for a 40. Consider the following liquid assets:
Department meet their day-to-day requirements
vehicle 1. Demand deposit with the banks
2. Government puts the currency in circulation Select the correct answer using the code given below.
2. Service Tax paid while making payments of dinner 2. Time deposit with the banks
3. Central Government incurs a deficit in its Budget 3. Savings deposit with the banks (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 only
4. Government Sells Treasury Bills to Banking in a restaurant
3. Duty paid while importing machinery from abroad 4. Currency (c) 2 and 3 only (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4
Department of RBI The correct sequences of these assets in the decreasing 47. Consider the following statement regarding concept of
Which among the following is the correct order of the which among the above are “direct taxes”?
order of liquidity is: money:
above steps? (a) Only 1 (b) 1 & 2 (a) 1-4-3-2 (b) 4-3-2-1 1. M1: Money with the Public (currency notes and
(a) 1 2 3 4 (b) 2 3 4 1 (c) 1, 2 & 3 (d) None of them (c) 2-3-1-4 (d) 4-1-3-2 coins) + Demand deposits of banks (on current and
(c) 3 4 1 2 (d) 4 3 2 1 34. Consider the following statements: 41. Convertibility of rupee implies: saving bank accounts) + Other demand deposits
28. Consider the following statements: 1. Deficit financing essentially involves public (a) being able to convert rupee notes into gold with RBI. It is highly liquid and banks will not be
1. In Narrow Banking, Banks just accept deposits and expenditure in excess of public revenue (b) allowing the value of rupee to be fixed by market able to run their lending programmes on this basis.
provide loans. 2. In Deficit financing, the new currency replaces the forces
2. M2: M1 + Saving bank deposits with Post-offices.
2. In Narrow Banking, there is rarely Asset Liability old currency (c) freely permitting the conversion of rupee to other
3. M3: M2 + Term deposits with the bank.
Mismatch. Which among the above statements is / are correct? currencies and vice versa
(d) developing an international market for currencies in 4. M4: M3 + All deposits of Post-offices.
Which among the above statements is / are correct? (a) Only 1 is correct (b) Only 2 is correct Which among the following is correct?
(c) Both are correct (d) Both are incorrect India
(a) Only 1 is correct (a) 1, 2, 3, 4 (b) 1, 2, 3
42. In the context of Indian economy, consider the following
(b) Only 2 is correct 35. Indian Currency Printing Institutions are located in which (c) 1, 3, 4 (d) 1, 2, 4
pairs:
(c) Both 1 and 2 are correct of the following places? 48. The _____ is the total amount of monetary assets available
Term Most Appropriate description
(d) None of them is correct (1) Nasik (2) Hoshangabad 1. Melt down Fall in stock prices in an economy at a specific time.
29. Consider the following statements: (3) Hyderabad (4) Aurangabad 2. Recession Fall in growth rate 1. Money Supply 2. Money Stock
1. In Banks, the “Staff Security Deposits” come under (5) Devas 3. Slow down Fall in GDP 3. Money Demand 4. Stock in Demand
Time Liabilities Select the correct option: Which of the pairs given above is/are correctly matched? Choose the correct answer from the above code:
2. In Banks. “Cash certificates” come under the (a) 1, 2 and 4 (b) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (a) 1 only (b) 2 and 3 (a) 1 and 2 (b) 3 and 4
Demand Liabilities (c) 1, 2, 3 and 5 (d) All of the above (c) 1 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3 (c) 1 and 3 (d) 2 and 4

E-114 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-115

49. Consider the following statement: 56. The definition of Wholesale Price Index (WPI) is as 62. Certificate of Deposit (CD) and Commercial Paper were 69. Who all are the main players in the Indian capital market?
1. Inflation is a decrease in price of goods follows: introduced by a Bank in March 1989: 1. Insurance companies
2. Inflation is caused by excess demand in economy 1. The WPI is a weighted average of indices covering 1. Reserve Bank of India 2. Development Finance Institutions (DFI)
3. Inflation results from excessive increase in the 676 commodities, which are traded in primary, 2. State Bank of India 3. Non-Banking Finance Companies, (NBFCs)
money supply manufacturing and fuel and power-sectors. 3. HDFC Bank 4. Non-Banking Financial Institutions.
4. Inflation effects all segments of the economy 2. It is the retail price average of a basket of goods and 4. ICICI Bank Choose the correct option.
Which among the following statement is/are incorrect? services directly consumed by the people. Choose the name of the Bank. (a) 1, 2, 3, 4 (b) 1, 2, 3
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only Choose the correct definition. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (c) 1, 2, (d) 1
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (c) 3 only (d) 4 only 70. Choose the type of capital market:
50. Consider the following statement regarding inflation: (c) 1 and 2 (d) None of the Above 63. Which among the following are the Nationalised Banks? 1. Securities Market
1. Inflation is beneficial for senior citizen 57. What is the difference between Inflation and Deflation? 1. Bank of India 2. Financial institutions
2. Inflation is beneficial for fixed income citizen 1. Inflation is an increase in price of goods while 2. Punjab National Bank 3. Gill-edged market
3. Inflation is beneficial for borrowers Deflation is that state in which the value of money 3. Canara Bank 4. Incorporated securities
Choose the person who gets the benefit of inflation. rises and the price of goods and services falls. 4. United Commercial Bank Which among the following code is correct?
(a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 2. Deflation is an increase in price of goods while Choose the code. (a) 1 and 4 (b) 1 and 3
(c) 2 only (d) 3 only Inflation is that state in which the value of money (a) 1 and 2 (b) 3 and 4 (c) 1 and 2 (d) 3 and 4
51. Which among the followings is the type of inflation? rises and the price of goods and services falls. (c) 1 and 4 (d) 1, 2, 3, 4 71. What all are local authorities?
1. Demand Pull Inflation 3. Inflation is that state in which the value of money 64. What are the functions of RBI? 1. City corporations 2. Municipalities
2. Cost Push Inflation rises and the price of goods and services falls while 1. Issue of notes 3. Port trusts
3. Stagflation deflation is an increase in price of goods. 2. Banker to the government Choose the incorrect option.
4. Hyperinflation Choose the correct difference between Inflation and 3. Controller of debit (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
Choose the correct type. Deflation. 4. Custodian of foreign reserves (c) 3 only (d) None of the Above
(a) 1, 2, 3, 4 (b) 1, 2 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only Choose the incorrect function of RBI. 72. Consider the following statement:
(c) 3, 4 (d) 1, 4 (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2, 3 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 1. Bombay Stock Exchange (BSE) is India’s oldest
52. What is the main cost-push factor in India? 58. The state of deflation appears in the economy due to (c) 3 only (d) 4 only stock exchange
various reason: 65. What are the reforms of Narsimham Committee on 2. It formally came into being in 1888
1. Problem of hoarding by traders and black marketeers
1. When the Government withdraws money from Banking sector? 3. It was a regional exchange till 2002 when it became
2. Taxation which gives the traders an opportunity to
circulation. 1. Nationalisation of banks should not take place any a national exchange
raise the prices of goods, the proportion of which is
2. When Government imposes heavy direct taxes or more. Choose the incorrect statement regarding BSE.
often more than the levy of taxes
takes heavy loans from the public 2. Private and foreign banks should be set up to (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
3. Administered Prices
3. When the Central Bank buys the securities in open promote competition. (c) 3 only (d) None of the Above
4. Hike in Oil Prices
market 3. There should be a phased reduction of CRR and SLR. 73. What are the authorities of SEBI?
Choose the correct code.
Choose the correct reason. Choose the correct option. 1. Oversee the working of stock exchanges
(a) 1, 2, 3 (b) 1, 2, 3, 4
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 2 and 3 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 2. Regulate merchant banks and mutual funds
(c) 1, 2 (d) None of the Above
(c) 1 and 3 (d) 1, 2, 3 (c) 3 only (d) All of the Above 3. Register and regulate intermediaries such as stock
53. How is the price level measured? 66. Consider the following statement: brokers
59. What are the measures of checking deflation?
1. Wholesale Price Index 1. As per recommendations of the Narasimham Choose the incorrect answer.
1. Increasing money supply
2. Consumer Price Index 2. Promote credit creation by the banks. Committee, it has been decided that credit facilities (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
3. Gross Domestic Product (GDP) Deflator 3. Curtailment in taxes so as to increase the purchasing granted by banks will be classified into performing (c) 3 only (d) None of the Above
4. Business Price Index power of the people. and non-performing assets (NPA) 74. _______ deals with long-term finance (more than 365
Choose the correct code. Choose the correct measure. 2. NPA is a loan which is in default for more than nine days) funds. It includes all facilities and institutional
(a) 1, 2, 3, 4 (b) 1, 2, 3 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only months. arrangements available for borrowing and lending of
(c) 1, 2 (d) 1 (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2, 3 Choose the incorrect statement. term funds (including medium-term).
54. Consider the following statement: 60. Which among the following is the type of organised (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 1. Capital market
1. Increase in private expenditure sector of Indian money market? (c) 1 and 2 (d) None of the Above 2. Stock market
2. Increase in exports 1. Call money market 67. Consider the following in regards of types of loan: 3. Debit
3. Increase in taxation 2. Treasury Bill Market 1. Draft Loan 2. Term Loan 4. Credit
4. Rapid growth of population 3. Commercial Bill Market 3. Cash credit 4. Overdraft Choose the correct answer.
Choose the factor that does not cause an increase in 4. Collateral loan market Choose the one which is not a loan. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
demand of goods and services. Choose the correct code. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (c) 3 only (d) 4 only
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only (a) 1 and 2 (b) 3 and 4 (c) 3 only (d) 4 only 75. Consider the following statement:
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only (c) 1, 2, 3, 4 (d) None of the Above 68. _______ are conducted by the RBI by selling and buying 1. GIC was formed in November 1972.
55. What are the causes of inflation? 61. Consider the following statement: government securities from banks. 2. The 107 private companies operating in the
1. Increase in demand for goods & services 1. Ad hoc treasury bills are sold to the banks and public 1. Bank rate field were grouped together into four - National
2. Decrease in the supply of goods & services and are freely marketable. 2. Cash reserve ratio Insurance Company, United India Insurance
3. Decrease in demand for goods & services 2. Regular treasury bills are not sold to the banks and 3. Open market operations Company, Oriental Insurance Company and New
4. Increase in the supply of goods & services the general public, and are not marketable. 4. Statutory Liquidity Ratio India Assurance Company.
Choose the correct code. Choose the correct code. Choose the correct code. Choose the incorrect statement.
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 3 and 4 (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(c) 1 and 4 (d) 2 and 3 (c) 1 and 2 (d) None of the Above (c) 3 only (d) 4 only (c) 1 and 2 (d) None of the Above
E-116 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-117

76. Name of four commodity exchanges working in the Choose the correct statement.
country: (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
1. National Multi Commodity Exchange (c) 3 only (d) All of the Above
2. Multi Commodity Exchange 82. ______ is set up to promote liquidity to stocks of small
3. National commodity and Derivatives Exchange and medium enterprises.
4. Indian Commodity Exchange 1. Indo Next EXERCISE-1 48. (b) Syndicate Bank. The symbol of dog implies that
Choose the correct answer. 2. Interconnected Stock Exchange of India Bank is trustworthy and a friend. Its slogan is : Your
1. (b) 2. (b) 3. (d) 4. (a) 5. (b) 6. (b)
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 1, 2, 3 3. Over the Counter Exchange of India faithful and friendly financial partner.
7. (d) 8. (b) 9. (c) 10. (c) 11. (b) 12. (d)
(c) 1, 2, 3, 4 (d) None of the Above 4. Bombay Stock Exchange 49. (d) 50. (b)
13. (d) 14. (b) 15. (c) 16. (d)
77. Name of four institutions that are regulated by the RBI as Choose the correct code. 51. (a) In economics, the Laffer curve is a hypothetical
17. (d) VAT is the State Subject.
all-India FIs: (a) 1 only (b) 2 only representation of the relationship between
18. (c) Deflation is a decrease in the prices of goods and
government revenue raised by taxation and all
1. Export Import Bank of India (EXIM Bank) (c) 3 only (d) 4 only services. It occurs when the annual inflation rate
possible rates of taxation. It is used to illustrate the
2. National Bank for Agriculture and Rural 83. Consider the following statement: falls below 0%, which is negative inflation rate.
concept of taxable income elasticity – which taxable
Development (NABARD) 1. Capital market deals with long-term finance funds. This is different from Disinflation which is a slow-
income will change in response to changes in the
3. National Housing Bank (NHB) 2. Capital Market includes all facilities and institutional down in the inflation rate. This is a situation when
rate of taxation.
4. Small Industries Development Bank of India arrangements available for borrowing and lending inflation declines to lower levels but prices continue
52. (a) 53. (c) 54. (a)
(SIDBI) of term funds (including medium-term). to rise.
55. (a) Deficit financing, practice in which a government
Choose the correct answer. 3. Long-term funds are raised either by borrowing 19. (c) Base effect is almost an ubiquitous term which says
spends more money than it receives as revenue,
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 3 and 4 from certain institutions or by issuing securities. that the previous data affects the calculation of the
the difference being made up by borrowing or
(c) 1, 3, 4 (d) 1, 2, 3, 4 Choose the correct statement. current data.
minting new funds. Although budget deficits may
78. Consider the following statement: (a) 1 only (b) 2 only 20. (c) The basic aim of Lead Bank scheme is that the
occur for numerous reasons, the term usually refers
1. EXIM bank in India was established on January 1, bank should adopt particular districts for intensive
(c) 3 only (d) All of the Above to a conscious attempt to stimulate the economy
1982 development by offering loans and banking services.
by lowering tax rates or increasing government
Matching Based MCQ 21. (a) International Development Association (IDA) , is
2. National Housing Bank was established in July, expenditures. The influence of government deficits
a part of the World Bank that helps the world’s
1988. upon a national economy may be very great. It is
DIRECTIONS (Qs. 84-86) : Match List-I with List-II and poorest countries. It complements the World
3. SIDBI started its operations from April 2, 1990. widely believed that a budget balanced over the span
Bank’s other lending arm— the International Bank
Choose the correct code. select the correct answer using the codes given below the of a business cycle should replace the old ideal of
for Reconstruction and Development (IBRD)
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only lists. an annually balanced budget. Some economists have
which serves middle-income countries with capital
(c) 3 only (d) 1, 2, 3 abandoned the balanced budget concept entirely,
84. List-I List-II investment and advisory services. IDA was created
79. The _________ bank linkage programme continued to considering it inadequate as a criterion of public
(A) Depression (1) Coexistence of inflation and in 1960.
be the main micro-finance model by which the formal policy.
stagnation 22. (a) A self-Regulatory organization (SRO) is a non-
banking system reaches micro-entrepreneurs (including 56. (c) 57. (c) 58. (b) 59. (a)
(B) Recession (2) Recovery from depression governmental organization that has the power
farmers). 60. (a) 61. (c) 62. (a)
(C) Reflation (3) Reduction in production to create and enforce industry regulations and
1. Self-Help Group 2. Indian bank 63. (d) A tight monetary policy is a course of action
over a short period standards. The priority is to protect investors
undertaken by Central bank to constrict spending in
3. SBI 4. PNB (D) Stagflation (4) Insufficient demand leading through the establishment of rules that promote
an economy, or to curb inflation when it is rising too
Choose the correct name of the bank. to idle men and machinery ethics and equality.
fast. The increased bank rate increases the cost of
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only over a long time 23. (a) 24. (a) 25. (c) 26. (a)
borrowing and effectively reduces its attractiveness.
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only (5) Reduction in level of economy 27. (b) An outward shift in the demand for money, other
64. (b) Venture capital (VC) is a long term financial capital
80. Consider the following statement. things being equal should lead to a higher interest
due to falling prices provided to early-stage, high-potential, start up
1. NABARD stands for National Bank for Agriculture rate but the same quantity of money. The supply
(a) A-1; B-2; C-3; D-5 (b) A-4; B-3; C-2; D-5 companies or new companies.
and Rural Design will not increase but with more demand the price
(c) A-4; B-3; C-2; D-1 (d) A-3; B-4; C-2; D-1 EXERCISE-2
2. NABARD is an apex developmental bank in India. (the interest rate) should increase.
85. Match the following. 28. (c) 29. (c) 30. (b) 31. (c)
3. Setting up of NABARD was recommended by the Stock exchange name Set up Year 1. (b)
committee to review arrangements for institutional 32. (a) 33. (a) 34. (c) 35. (d)
i. NSE a. 1887 2. (c) SLR used by bankers indicates the minimum
credit for agriculture and rural development, set 36. (b) Foreign Banks and Regional Rural Banks also come
ii. BSE b. 1984 under the category of Scheduled Commercial Banks. percentage of deposits that the banks have to
up by the RBI, under the chairmanship of Shri B. iii. OTCEI c. 1989 maintain in the form of gold, cash or other approved
Now, the banks are free to determine their savings
Sivaraman. iv. ISE d. 1998 securities.
bank deposit interest rate, subject to the following
Which statement is incorrect? (a) i-a, ii-b, iii-c, iv-d two conditions: 3. (c)
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only (b) i-b, ii-a, iii-c, iv-d 1. Each bank will have to offer a uniform 4. (a) The statement (1) is correct because it includes the
(c) 3 only (d) 4 only (c) i-d, ii-c, iii-b, iv-a interest rate on savings bank deposits up to ` 1 definition of teaser loans but the statement (2) is not
81. Consider the following statement: (d) i-c, ii-b, iii-a, iv-d lakh,irrespective of the amount in the account correct, because in India teaser loan is provided to
1. IRDA is a multimember nodal agency within this limit. the home buyers not for setting up manufacturing or
86. Match the following.
2. It is vested with regulatory powers in respect of the 2. For savings bank deposits over ` 1 lakh, a export units.
Goods Example
insurance sector similar to those vested in SEBI in bank may provide differential rates of interest, 5. (c)
i. Public goods a. Primary education
respect of the capital markets and of RBI for the if it so chooses. However, there should not be 6. (a) Repo Rate is the rate at which commercial banks
ii. Merit goods b. National defence
banking sector. any discrimination from customer to customer borrow funds from RBI. A reduction in the repo
iii. Non-merit goods c. Pollution
3. The IRDA Act, 1999 cleared the way for private on interest rates for similar amount of deposit. rate will help banks to get money from the central
(a) i-a, ii-b, iii-c (b) i-b, ii-a, iii-c
sector entry into the insurance business. 37. (b) 38. (c) 39. (c) 40. (c) 41. (d) 42. (b) bank at a cheaper rate. When the repo rate increases
(c) i-c, ii-b, iii-a (d) i-a, ii-c, iii-b
43. (a) 44. (c) 45. (a) 46. (c) 47. (c) borrowing from RBI becomes more expensive.

E-118 Money Supply and Indian Financial System Money Supply and Indian Financial System E-119

A value of (0) for Gini Coefficient in a country 32. (c) Taxes on Agricultural income and Taxes on caused by high costs (cost-push inflation) and that (iii) When the Central Bank sells the securities in open
implies that there is perfect equality in the system. consumption/sale of electricity are levied by the it results from excessive increases in the money market (which reduces the quantity of money in
If the value is 1 then there is complete inequality in State Governments. supply (monetarism). Inflation affects all segments circulation).
the country. 33. (d) 34. (a) 35. (c) 36. (c) 37. (b) 38. (c) of the economy. (iv) When Central Bank controls the credit money and
7. (a) The ‘BSE SENSEX’ is a value-weighted index 39. (c) When inflation becomes very high, the RBI 50. (d) Inflation benefits borrowers, as it leads to a fall in adopt various measures such as increase in CRR,
composed of 30 stocks and was started in 1 January, decreases supply of money (to check inflation) by the real cost of capital. But this is only a temporary credit rationing and direct action.
1986. The origin of the NYSE can be traced to 17 adopting light monetary policy. phase and the interest rate is bound to go up to (v) When the Central Bank increases the Bank rate
May, 1792. When the Buttonwood Agreement was 40. (d) compensate for the inflation. (which curtails the quantity of credit in the economy).
signed by 24 stock brokers outside 68 Wall Street 41. (c) Convertibility of rupee implies freely permitting 51. (a) Types of inflation are Demand Pull Inflation, Cost (vi) When state of over-production (excess supply over
in New York under a buttonwood tree. Amsterdam the conversion of rupee to other currencies and Push Inflation, Stagflation, Hyperinflation. demand) takes place.
Stock Exchange (1602) is considered oldest in the vice versa. Currency Convertibility is the ease with 52. (b) the main cost-push factor in India are: 59. (d) Measures of checking deflation are:
which a country’s currency can be converted into (i) Fluctuations in output and supply in both agriculture
world and was established by the Dutch East India (i) Increasing money supply.
and industry sectors. Fluctuations in output of food
company. gold or another currency. (ii) Promoting credit creation by the banks.
grains have been a major factor responsible for rise
8. (a) 9. (c) 10. (b) 11. (b) 42. (c) (iii) Curtailment in taxes so as to increase the
in food-grain prices as well as general price. In the
12. (a) Brent Crude is a major trading classification of sweet 43. (d) The Reserve Bank of India is the main monetary purchasing power of the people.
same way, the supply of manufactured goods also
light crude oil that serves as a major benchmark authority of the country and beside that, in its did not increase adequately in last few years. Power (iv) Increasing the public expenditure and the
price for purchases of oil worldwide. Brent Crude capacity as the central bank, acts as the bank of breakdowns, strikes and lock-outs and shortage of employment opportunities in the economy.
is extracted from the North Sea and comprises the national and state governments. Sometimes it transport facilities have been the major constraints (v) Increasing the money supply in circulation by
Brent Blend, Forties Blend, Oseberg and Ekofisk happens that some of the banks close down due to responsible for lowering production of manufactured repayment of old public debts.
crudes .The Brent Crude oil marker is also known non recovery of loans or such other issues. In such goods. With ever-rising demand for manufactured (vi) Providing of economic subsidy by the Government
as Brent Blend, London Brent and Brent petroleum. conditions people have to suffer as their money goods, the producers are in a position to hike the to the industrial sector of the econ.
The index represents the average price of trading in is with the bank then. For this reason there is prices of their products. 60. (c) The type of organised sector of Indian money market
the 25 day Brent Blend, Forties, Oseberg, Ekofisk provision for winding up of the banking company (ii) Problem of hoarding by traders and black are Call Money Market, Treasury Bill Market,
(BFOE) market in the relevant delivery month as under the Banking Regulation Act, 1949. The power marketeers. Commercial Bill Market and Collateral loan market
reported and confirmed by the industry media. of winding up of Bank lies in the hand of Reserve (iii) Taxation which gives the traders an opportunity to 61. (d) Ad hoc treasury bills are not sold to the banks and
13. (d) NIFTY is an Index computed from performance Bank of India. raise the prices of goods, the proportion of which is the general public, and are not marketable while
of top stocks from different sectors listed on NSE 44. (c) Land development bank started financing long term often more than the levy of taxes. regular treasury bills are sold by Reserve Bank of
(National stock exchange). NIFTY consists of 50 loan for more significant rural development activities (iv) Administered Prices.
India on behalf of the Central Government.
like rural and cottage industries, rural artisans etc. (v) Hike in Oil Prices.
companies from 24 different sectors. Indian Capital 62. (a) Certificate of Deposit (CD) and Commercial Paper
The main purpose of RRBs is to mobilize financial 53. (b) Price level is measured by Wholesale Price Index,
Markets are regulated and monitored by the Ministry (CP) markets were introduced by Reserve Bank of
resources from rural / semi-urban areas and grant Consumer Price Index, Gross Domestic Product
of Finance, the Securities and Exchange Board of (GDP) Deflator. India in March 1989 in order to widen the range
India and the Reserve Bank of India. It does not loans and advances mostly to small and marginal of money market instruments and give investors
farmers, agricultural labourers and rural artisans. 54. (c ) Factors causing an increase in demand for goods &
trade in mutual funds. services: greater flexibility in the deployment of their short-
14. (a) Cost-push inflation occurs when businesses respond 45. (c) When the Reserve Bank of India reduces the term surplus funds.
(i) Increase in public expenditure
to rising costs, by increasing their prices to protect Statutory Liquidity Ratio by 50 basis points; the
(ii) Increase in private expenditure 63. (d) The nationalised banks are Central Bank of India,
profit margins. There are many reasons why costs Scheduled Commercial Banks may cut their lending
(iii) Increase in exports Bank of India, Punjab National Bank, Canara Bank,
might rise: Component costs, Rising labour costs and rates.
(iv) Reduction in taxation United Commercial Bank, Syndicate Bank, Bank of
46. (b) Because Reserve requirements are designed as (v) Rapid growth of population
higher indirect taxes imposed by the government. Baroda, United Bank of India, Union Bank of India,
“precautionary measures” and not to stop banks (vi) Black money
So, the direct taxes should be increased when an Dena Bank, Allahabad Bank, Indian Bank, Indian
from “excessive” profit. This eliminates (c) and (d) (vii) Deficit financing
economy is going through inflationary pressures. Overseas Bank Bank of Maharashtra.
47. (d) The four concepts of money used in calculating (viii) Cheap money policy
15. (a) Typically, higher inflation is caused by strong 64. (c ) The functions of RBI are Issue of Notes, Banker
money supply are known as the money stock (ix) Increase in consumer spending
economic growth. If Aggregate demand in an to the Government, Banker’s Bank, Controller of
measures or measures of monetary aggregates. (x) Department of Tax internal debts.
economy expanded faster than aggregate supply, Credit, Custodian of Foreign Reserves.
These are M1, M2, M3, M4. 55. (a) The inflation occurs due to two main factors:
we would expect to see a higher inflation rate. M3 : M1 + Term deposits with the bank. 65. (d)
(i) Increase in demand for goods & services
If demand is rising faster than supply, then this 48. (a) In economics, the money supply or money stock is 66. (b) NPA is a loan (whether term loan, cash credit,
(ii) Decrease in the supply of goods & services
suggests that economic growth is higher than the the total amount of monetary assets available in an overdraft, or bills discounted), which is in default
56. (a) The Wholesale Price Index (WPI) is a weighted
long run sustainable rate of growth. economy at a specific time. average of indices covering 676 commodities, which for more than six months.
16. (b) 17. (c) 49. (a) Inflation is an increase in price of goods. It can are traded in primary, manufacturing and fuel and 67. (a) Types of loan are term loan, cash credit, overdraft,
18. (c) Deflation is defined as a fall in the general price be seen as devaluation of the worth of money. A power-sectors. or bills discounted.
level of goods and services. It is a negative rate of crucial feature of inflation is that price rises are 57. (a) Inflation is an increase in price of goods while 68. (c) Open Market Operations: These are conducted by
inflation. It means the value of money increases sustained. Once only increase in the rate of, say, Deflation is that state in which the value of money the RBI by selling and buying government securities
rather than decreases. value-added tax, will immediately put up prices, but rises and the price of goods and services falls. from banks.
19. (c) this does not represent inflation, unless the indirect 58. (a) The reasons for deflation in the economy are: 69. (a) The main players in Indian capital markets are:
20. (b) The Office of the Economic Advisor (OEA) is an effects of the VAT rise have repercussions of prices (i) When the Government withdraws money from • Banks, Indigenous and commercial.
attached office of the Ministry of Commerce & in periods after the direct effects. Accounts of the circulation. • Insurance companies
Industry. causes of inflation are numerous. The most popular (ii) When Government imposes heavy direct taxes or • Development Finance Institutions (DFI), and
21. (d) 22. (d) 23. (d) 24. (b) 25. (c) 26. (c) arguments are that it is caused by excess demand takes heavy loans from the public (voluntary or • Non-Banking Finance Companies (NBFCs)
27. (c) 28. (b) 29. (a) 30. (d) 31. (d) in the economy (demand-pull inflation), that it is compulsory or both). • Non-Banking Financial Institutions.
E-120 Money Supply and Indian Financial System

70. (c) The securities market is further divided into the gilt- 78. (d) EXIM bank in India was established on January 1,
edged market and the corporate securities market. 1982. National Housing Bank was established in
71. (d) Local authorities are city corporations, municipalities July 1988. SIDBI started its operations from April
and port trusts. 2, 1990.
72. (c) Bombay Stock Exchange (BSE) India’s oldest stock 79. (a) The Self-Help Group (SHG) bank linkage
exchange formally came into being in 1887 and programme continued to be the main micro-finance

6
was a regional exchange till 2002 when it became a model by which the formal banking system reaches
national exchange. micro-entrepreneurs (including farmers).
73. (d) The SEBI is authorised to: 80. (a) NABARD stands for National Bank for Agriculture
• oversee the working of stock exchanges; and Rural Development.


• regulate merchant banks and mutual funds;
• register and regulate intermediaries such as
81. (d) IRDA is a multimember nodal agency. It is vested
with regulatory powers in respect of the insurance FOREIGN TRADE AND
INVESTMENT IN INDIA
stock brokers; sector similar to those vested in SEBI in respect
• curb fraudulent and unfair trade practices of the capital markets and of RBI for the banking
including insider trading; sector.
• promote the development of a healthy capital The IRDA Act, 1999 cleared the way for private
market. sector entry into the insurance business.
74. (a) Capital market deals with long-term finance (more 82. (a) Indo Next is a new stock exchange, set up to promote
than 365 days) funds. It includes all facilities and
institutional arrangements available for borrowing
liquidity to stocks of small and medium enterprises. Introduction
83. (d) Capital market deals with long-term finance (more
and lending of term funds (including medium-term). than 365 days) funds. It includes all facilities and Foreign trade is exchange of capital, goods, and services across international borders or territories, which involves the activities
75. (d) The GIC was formed in November 1972 consequent of the government and individuals.
institutional arrangements available for borrowing
upon the nationalisation of general insurance In most countries, it represents a significant share of gross domestic product (GDP). Foreign trade in India, includes all
and lending of term funds (including medium-term).
business. The 107 private companies operating in imports and exports to and from India. At the level of Central Government it is administered by the Ministry of Commerce
The difference between money market and capital
the field were grouped together into four - National and Industry.
market is not so much in the institutions involved
Insurance Company, United India Insurance
as in their term of borrowing or lending. Long-term
Company, Oriental Insurance Company and New Foreign Trade and Investment
funds are raised either by borrowing from certain
India Assurance Company, with GIC as the holding
institutions or by issuing securities.
company.
84. (b) Recession is slow down in effective demand for
76. (c ) There are four commodity exchanges working
goods and services, slow down in the economy
in the country. They are NMCE (National Multi
implies a short run decline in the growth rate.
Commodity Exchange) - the oldest commodity Introduction Foreign Exchange India’s Foreign
85. (b) Stock exchange name Set up Year Balance of India’s Balance
exchange in the country which became operational in Reserves
(i) NSE a. 1984 Trade Payments of Payments
2002, MCX (Multi Commodity Exchange), NCDEX
(National Commodity and Derivatives Exchange) (ii) BSE b. 1887
and ICEX (Indian Commodity Exchange). (iii) OTCEI c. 1989
(iv) ISE d. 1998 Gold
77. (d) According to the Economic Survey, there are four Trends 2
Institutions, namely the Export Import Bank of 86. (b) Public goods include national defence, police,
Special Drawing Problems
India (EXIM Bank), National Bank for Agriculture general administration, Merit goods include primary
Right (SDR) Protectionist
and Rural Development (NABARD), the National education, immunisation, public health programme,
Non-merit goods include pollution caused by Foreign Currency Policies
Housing Bank (NHB) and Small Industries
automobile emission. Assests (FCA) External Debt
Development Bank of India (SIDBI).
Reserve Tranche
Export Promotion
Position (RTP)
Exchange Rate
Trade Policy
History India’s Export India’s Import Special Economic
Profile Profil e Zone (SEZ)
Foreign Direct
Investment
Introduction Structure of Balance
of Payments

Current Account
Capital Account
Reserve Account Balance

E-122 Foreign Trade and Investment in India Foreign Trade and Investment in India E-123

FOREIGN EXCHANGE RESERVES INDIA’S FOREIGN TRADE


Foreign exchange reserves also called forex reserves or FX Fixed Exchange rates History of Foreign Trade in India the year 2014, India was the 19th largest exporter (with a share
reserves are assets held by a central bank or other monetary of 1.7%) and 12th largest importer (with a share of 2.5%) of
Fixed rates are currency values which are tied to a precious •• Historically, India ran a trade surplus for centuries
authority, usually in various reserve currencies and used merchandise trade in the world. In Commercial services, India
to back its liabilities e.g. the local currency issued, and the metal such as gold, or anchored to another currency, like the together through export of spices, handicrafts, textiles, is the 6th largest exporter (with a share of 3.3%) and 7th largest
various bank reserves deposited with the central bank by the US Dollar. This method was brought by the International etc. No restrictions on imports or exports were officially importer (with a share of 2.9%). Service sector has been a major
government or by financial institutions. Monetary Fund (IMF). The IMF system involved the US$ as maintained. financer for India’s merchandise trade deficit. Service surplus
the anchor for the system with the US$ given a specific value •• Before India got independence, import of goods from financed around 53% of merchandise trade deficit during
Why do countries keep foreign exchange reserves?
great Britain received official encouragement through 2013-14.
In the past, during the Bretton Woods system — an international in terms of gold, and other currencies were then given a value
Imperial preferences. India has been pursuing a policy of market diversification
monetary system formed after the second world war, foreign in terms of the US$, such as £1 = $2.40. India was part of this
•• Statutorily, it was the Sea Customs Act, 1878 that directing her export promotion efforts at Asia and ASEAN,
exchange reserves were used by countries through their regime too and in 1948, 1$ was equal to Rs. 3.30. However, provided the basis for implementing the official bias in Latin America and Africa through Focus Market Initiatives
central banks to maintain the external value of their currencies the system collapsed in 1971 for a variety of reasons, including favour of imports from Britain. and bilateral trade agreements.
at fixed rate. Subsequently, with the collapse of this system,
the focus changed. Reserves are now generally maintained by
the build up of US debts abroad as a result of the need to fund •• The Government of India Act, 1935 granted Central
countries for meeting their international payment obligations the war in Vietnam, inflation in the USA and growing doubts government the exclusive legislative powers to regulate India’s Export Profile & Exports
about the stability of the US$. import of goods into India and export of goods from
— both short and long terms, including sovereign and
India. However, this power was used when the Imports Growth
commercial debts, financing of imports, for intervention in the
foreign currency markets during periods of volatility, besides Floating Exchange Rates and Exports (Control) Act, 1947 was enacted. Indian exports have grown at a robust annual average rate of
helping to boost the confidence of the market in the ability of Under a floating system, a currency can rise or fall due to •• The initial life of the Imports and Exports (Control) Act, 21.3% (CAGR) between FYO3 and FY13; the value of exports
a country to meet its external obligations and to absorb any 1947 was three years but it was extended from time to rising from USD 52.7 billion in FY03 to 300.2 billion in FY13.
changes in demand or supply of currencies on the foreign
unforseen external shocks, contingencies or unexpected capital time till 1971.
movements.
exchange market. The advantages of floating exchange rates are •• To protect industries from influx of imported goods the Commodity Basket : Exports
flexibility and automatic adjustment in case of balance of trade government issued the Imports (Control) Order 1955 •• Agriculture and allied products have registered high
The foreign exchange reserves of India comprise of three
disequilibrium. Under a floating regime, imports and exports allowing most of the imports only against an import growth of 22.2% (CAGR, FY03-FY13) and stood at USD
elements:
can readjust to move the balance of payments back towards licence. 40.6 billion in FY13.
(i) Gold,
a desirable equilibrium. Exogenous shocks, like the financial •• In 1976 many changes were made to the Imports and •• Major Agriculture and allied commodities exported by
(ii) Special Drawing Rights (SDR),
crisis of 2008-09, can occur from time to time and floating Exports (Control) Act, 1947. This act gave the Central India include basmati rice, marine products, meat and
(iii) Foreign Currency Assets (FCA). Government wider powers to prohibit, restrict and control meat products, oil meals, spices, wheat and sugar.
exchange rates can help the readjustment process. Moreover,
the imports and Exports Trade. •• At USD 183.6 billion in FY13, manufactured goods have
Gold policymakers are free to devalue or revalue to achieve specific
Beginning mid-1991, the Government of India introduced registered growth of 18.4% (CAGR, FY03-FY13).
objectives, such as stimulating jobs and growth and reducing a series of reforms to liberalise and globalise the Indian
It accounts for only 5% of our foreign exchange assets. •• Major manufactured goods, exported by India include
inflationary pressure. economy. Reforms in the external sector of India were intended engineering goods, chemicals and related products,
Special Drawing Rights (SDR) to integrate the Indian economy with the world economy. textiles and ready-made garments.
Managed Exchange Rates India’s approach to openness has been cautious, contingent on •• The exports of ores and minerals has grown by 12.1%
An international type of monetary reserve currency, created This is a combination of fixed and floating rates. In today’s achieving certain preconditions to ensure an orderly process (CAGR, FY03-FY13), to touch USD 5.6 billion in
by International Monetary Fund (IMF) in 1969 which operates economic situation, almost all countries follow this system of of liberalization and ensuring macroeconomic stability. This FY13, while export of petroleum and crude products has
as a supplement to the existing reserves of member countries. approach has been vindicated in recent years with the growing
exchange rate determination. The governments usually let the registered exponential growth of 41.9% (CAGR, FY03-
It is also known as “paper gold”. Created in response to incidence of financial crises elsewhere in the world. All the
market determine the exchange rates but intervene whenever FY13) to stand at USD 60.2 billion in FY13.
concerns about the limitations of gold and dollars as the sole same, the policy regime in India in regard to liberalization of
means of settling international accounts, SDRs are designed to needed. In terms of share in overall exports, the share of agriculture
the foreign sector has witnessed very significant change.
augment international liquidity by supplementing the standard and allied products, ores and minerals and other commodities
The success of foreign exchange management by RBI can The Import policies prior to 1992 contained an Open General
reserve currencies. Its value is based on a basket of five key has moved in a range-bound fashion. However, there has
be seen in the fact that from US$ 5.8 billion in March 1991 Licence under which specific goods could be imported and
international currencies and SDRs can be exchanged for freely been some perceptible shift from the manufactured goods to
(enough to meet the import requirements for three weeks) the exported by specific categories of importers and exporters
usable currencies. The basket of five international currencies the petroleum and crude products segment between FY03 and
country’s reserves have grown to around US$ 352 billion by subject to fulfilment of certain conditions.
includes US dollar, euro, Chinese yuan, Japanese yen and FY13.
In 1992, the policy was amended to open general licence and
British pound. December 2015. It is pertinent to note here that some of the
increase in the reserve is attributed to the weakness of the
allow imports and exports of all goods without a licence, except Direction of Exports
those specifically mentioned in a small negative list.
India’s largest exports partner has been Asia. Exports to Asia
Foreign Currency Assests (FCAs) dollar in the post-Iraq war scenario. Foreign Trade is one of the significant macro fundamental have grown by more than 23.0% (CAGR), from USD 22.2
Foreign currency assests include foreign exchange reserves variables of an economy. India, until recently, was billion in FY03 to USD 150.4 billion in FY13.
less gold holdings, special drawing rights and India’s reserve Reserve Tranche Position predominantly a primary goods exporting and an industrial
The next largest export destination is Europe (USD 58.8 billion
position in the IMF. goods importing country.
Each member of the IMF is assigned a quota, part of which is in FY13), followed by America (USD 53.4 billion).
In 1950s, India’s share in the world trade was 1.78% which was
Foreign Exchange Management payable in SDRs or Specified usable currencies and part in the decline to 0.59% in 1990 and remained low for many years.
member’s own currency. The difference between a member’s India’s share in world trade is currently around 2% (2015) and
Imports’ Profile & Import Growth
Foreign exchange management can be managed in three
possible ways: Fixed currency rates, floating currency rates quota and the IMF’s holdings of its currency is a country’s our country has set for itself the ambitious target of gaining As a growing country, India’s imports demand has consistently
and managed exchange rates. Reserve Tranche position (RTP). 3.5% of world trade by 2020. As per the rankings of WTO for been on the rise.
E-124 Foreign Trade and Investment in India Foreign Trade and Investment in India E-125

Barring a marginal dip in the year of recession in FY10, when •• Non-POL items on the other hand, have growth by 24.8% went in for hasty capital account convertibility in the 1980s The Reserve Account is also the indicator of Forex Reserves
imports fell from USD 299.3 billion to USD 287.6 billion, over this period, to stand at USD 321.3 billion in FY13. had to face financial crisis. The thinking was that trade and of the country. If surplus in the Capital Account is more than
imports to the country have always been on the rise. domestic liberalization process should be completed before deficit in the Current Account, there is net increase in the
In the last decade import growth has been high at 26.0%; from Direction of Imports full capital convertibility can be thought of. Many economists Forex Reserves of the country at the end of the year. On the
USD 61.4 billion in FY03 to USD 490.3 billion in FY13. A major part of India’s imports are sourced from Asia itself feel that CAC will only help the drain of Indian capital, other hand if deficit in the current account is more than surplus
(57.7% of overall imports which are due to the POL bill. which will get invested abroad. After the recommendations of in the Capital Account then there is net decrease in Foreign
Commodity Basket: Imports Imports from Asia stood at USD 283.0 billion in FY13, RBI appointed S.S Tarapore Committee on Capital Account Reserves of the country at the end of the year.
•• Commodity imports of the country are classified as POL registering growth of 26.0% over FY03 (CAGR, FY03-13). Convertibility (CAC), India is slowly moving towards full
(petroleum, oil and lubricants) and non-POL items. In fact, there appears to be substantial difference in the value convertibility, but with constant precautions. India still has Balance of Payment (BOP) Crisis
partial convertibility(40:60) but many reforms undertaken by If international reserves of a country are not enough to balance
•• Import of POL items has grown at 28.5% (CAGR, FY03- of imports from Asia and the next largest import partner of the
India hint at eventual movement towards CAC. a combined deficit in current and capital account on a sustained
FY13), from USD 17.6 billion in FY03 to USD 169.0 country. After Asia, the next largest import source is Europe
basis, then the phenomenon is called a BOP crisis. It can be
billion in FY13. (USD 91.7 billion), followed by America (USD 58.2 billion). Reserve Account Balance tackled by exporting more or by limiting imports through tariffs,
This is the adjusting account in balance of payment. It makes quotas, etc. Contractionary fiscal and monetary policies can
BALANCE OF PAYMENTS an adjustment between current account balance and capital also tackle the crisis through lower import demand with fall in
account balance. If the deficit in the current account is followed average income levels. Another short term solution is currency
Introduction Current Account by surplus in capital account than the excess foreign exchange devaluation which encourages exports and discourages costlier
This account is the summary of all international trade is diverted into capital account to current account so that deficit imports.
Balance of payments (BOP) is statistical statement of all
transactions of the domestic country in one year. It records the in the current account is eliminated. The remaining surplus However, for the Indian economy most of these solutions are
transactions made between one particular country and all other in the capital account is transferred to the Reserve account not realistic in the present context. The most potential solution
countries during a specified period of time. BOP compares following 3 items:
and recorded on the credit of reserve account. Therefore both lies in the form of greater FDI and FII inflows letting a Capital
the dollar difference of the amount of exports and imports, (i) Visible items of trade
Current Account and Capital Account is always balanced. Account surplus tackle any BOP crisis.
including all financial exports and imports. The balance of exports and imports of goods is called the
•• A negative balance of payments means that more money balance of visible trade, e.g. Tea, Coffee, etc. INDIA’S BALANCE OF PAYMENT
is flowing out of the country than coming in. The balance (ii) Invisible Trade
The international Balance of Payments (BOP) of a country was food scarcity too. Large amounts of food grains had to be
of payment is maintained by Central Bank of India, i.e. The balance of exports and imports of services is called
reflects its economic strengths and weaknesses. A typical imported to feed the huge population.
Reserve Bank of India. the balance of invisible trade.The invisbles are divided
problem of the developing countries is that of a chronic BOP India faced a major BOP crisis in the early 1990s. We had to
into three categories: (a) Services- insurance, travel,
•• Balance of payments may be used as an indicator of deficit, India being no exception. Our country has been facing borrow from IMF to be able to sustain the economy. This loan
transportation, miscellaneous (like communication, BOP disequilibrium right since independence, culminating into
economic and political stability. For example, if a country came with a number of conditions. The following are some of
construction, financial, software, etc.), (b) Income, and a disaster in 1990-91, the year of the acute BOP crisis. India
has a consistently positive BOP, this could mean that the conditions that came with the medium term loan given by
(c) Transfers (grants, gifts, remittances, etc.). then had foreign exchange reserve of mere 1 billion dollar,
there is significant foreign investment within that country. IMF to India for restructuring of the economy:
(iii) Unilateral transfers barely sufficient to finance a month’s import bill. The country
It may also mean that the country does not export much •• Government expenditure to be cut by 10% per annum,
Unilateral transfers are receipts which residents of a was on the verge of defaulting. This crisis led to the massive
of its currency.
changes in the country’s economic policy, popularly known as •• Devaluation of rupee by 22%,
country make without getting anything in return, e.g.
•• BOP indicates trade balance, foreign investments and the Structural Adjustment Program or New Economic Policy •• Excise duty to be increased by 20%,
gifts, etc.
investment by foreigners. Even a negative BOP does (NEP) regime, focusing on liberalization and globalization of •• Custom duty to be cut drastically from the peak of 130%
The net balance of visible trade, invisible trade and of to 30%.
not signify unfavourable climate for the economy. It is the economy.
unilateral transfers is the balance on current account.
unfavourable only if the economy lacks the means to fill We opted for a very cautious approach and today after having Even though there was strong opposition within India to
Current account in India is fully convertible now. It means
the gap created by negative BOP. overcome the initial hiccups of a newly liberalized economy, such a loan which came with so many conditions, the Indian
that if someone requires foreign exchange for current
we have a fairly comfortable BOP situation. Even though we government went ahead with its plan of restructuring Indian
Balance of trade and balance of payment purposes, it will be made available to him at official have attained a comfortable BOP position reflecting a strong economy guided by the pre conditions of the IMF. It led to
exchange rate and thus, an unprohibited outflow of foreign emerging economy, BOP management still remains a tightrope liberalisation of the Indian economy.
Balance of trade takes into account only those transactions
exchange is possible now. Current account convertibility walk for policy makers, as now we are exposed to each and
arising out of exports and imports (the visible items). It does not was a result of India’s obligations under Article VIII of
consider the exchange of services rendered such as shipping.
every change in the global economic scenario. Protectionist Policies
IMF which prohibits restrictions on exchange on current
Balance of payment takes into account the exchange of both The main objective of the Second Five Year Plan (1956-57 to
visible and invisible items. Hence, the balance of payments
international transactions. Trends & Problems Of India’s
1960-61) was to attain self reliance through industrialization.
represents a better picture of a country’s economic transactions Capital Account Bop – 1949-50 To 1999-2000. Self reliance was to be achieved through import substitution.
with the rest of the world than the Balance of trade. This account is the summary of foreign capital transactions. The disequilibrium in India’s BOP has been caused by both For this basic industries had to be set up which required import
On the credit side of this account receipt of foreign exchange internal as well as external factors. The need for development of capital goods. Exports were expected to automatically take-
Structure of Balance of Payments due to Foreign Direct Investment (FDI), Foreign Capital of such a big nation with a huge population is one of the main off with industrialization. The import substitution strategy
Investment (FCI) and Foreign Borrowing (FB) is recorded. causes for the recurring BOP problem. The BOP is always was based on non-price, physical- interventionist policies like
Accounts under pressure and had huge deficits due to high imports of food licensing, quotas and other physical restrictions on imports.
On the debit side of capital account payment of foreign
A balance of payments statement is a summary of a nation’s grains and capital goods, the heavy external borrowings and Heavy capital goods were imported but other imports were
exchange due to Direct Investment Abroad (DIA), Portfolio
total economic transaction undertaken on international account. its payment and poor exports. After achieving independence, severely restricted to shut off competition in order to promote
Investment Abroad (PIA) and Foreign Lending (FL) is the foremost challenge before India was of attaining economic domestic industries. All focus was on import substitution, with
It is usually composed of three sectors: recorded. growth with social justice. India’s aim after attaining gross neglect of exports. Such inward looking protectionist
1. Current account, While India made the rupee fully convertible under current independence was to attain economic self- reliance. For this, policies did result in some self-reliance in the consumer goods
2. Capital account, account, it was felt that the economy was not yet ready for the country had to tap both the internal as well as the external industries, but the capital goods industries remained mostly
3. Reserve account balance. capital account convertibility (CAC). The countries which resources. Not only was our technology backward then, there import intensive.

E-126 Foreign Trade and Investment in India Foreign Trade and Investment in India E-127

The high degree of protection to Indian industries led India followed a strongly inward looking policy, laying stress •• FTP would reduce export obligations by 25% and give exports, with Asia’s first EPZ set up in Kandla in 1965. With a
to inefficiency and poor quality products due to lack of on import substitution. Ideally, imports should be financed boost to domestic manufacturing. view to attract larger foreign investments in India, the Special
competition. The high cost of production further eroded our by export earnings. But because there was export pessimism, •• FTP 2015-20 introduces two new schemes, namely Economic Zones (SEZs) Policy was announced in April 2000.
competitive strength. the deficit was financed either by the invisible earnings or by “Merchandise Exports from India Scheme (MEIS)” Today, there are approximately 3,000 SEZs operating in 120
Rising petroleum products demand, the two oil shocks, harvest foreign aid or depletion of valuable foreign exchange reserve. and “Services Exports from India Scheme (SEIS)”. countries which account for over US $ 600 billion in exports
failure, all put severe strain on the economy. The BOP situation Much import constraint to check trade deficit was also not The ‘Services Exports from India Scheme’ (SEIS) is for and about 50 million jobs.
possible because India’s imports were mainly ‘maintenance increasing exports of notified services. These schemes As a major step forward meant to invoke confidence in
remained weak throughout the 1980s, till it reached the crisis
imports’. On one hand import reduction was not possible and (MEIS and SEIS) replace multiple schemes earlier in investors and signal the government’s commitment to a stable
situation in 1990-91, when India was on the verge of defaulting
on the other exports suffered due to the recession in the 1980s. place, each with different conditions for eligibility and SEZ policy regime, a comprehensive Special Economic Zones
due to heavy debt burden and constantly widening trade deficit.
India’s BOP was thus beset with several problems. The process usage. Incentives (MEIS and SEIS) to be available for Act, 2005 was passed by the Parliament in May 2005. It
of liberalization began from the mid 1980s. Restriction on SEZs also e-Commerce of handicrafts, handlooms, books, received Presidential assent on the 23rd of June 2005. This Act
External Debt certain imports were removed, particularly those which were etc. eligible for benefits of MEIS. FTP benefits from both came into force w.e.f. February 10, 2006.
India had to resort to large scale foreign borrowings for used as inputs for export production. But by then the situation MEIS and SEIS will be extended to units located in SEZs.
its developmental efforts in the field of basic social and was already bad and all the mismanagement ultimately led to •• Agricultural and village industry products to be supported The main objectives of the SEZ Act are:
industrial infrastructure. The country’s resources were very the 1990-91 BOP crisis. across the globe at rates of 3% and 5% under MEIS. (a) Generation of additional economic activity.
much limited due to low per capita income and savings. The •• Higher level of support to be provided to processed and (b) Promotion of exports of goods and services.
situation worsened because Government of India resorted to Trade Policy packaged agricultural and food items under MEIS. (c) Promotion of investment from domestic and foreign
heavy foreign borrowings to correct the BOP situation in the India’s trade policy since Independence had been guided by •• Industrial products to be supported in major markets at sources.
short run out of panicky. By the Seventh Five Year Plan, the what has been described as “export pessimism” and “economic rates ranging from 2% to 3%. (d) Creation of employment opportunities.
debt service obligations rose sharply because of harder average nationalism. The former assumed that India could never hope •• Served from India Scheme (SFIS) will be replaced with
(e) Development of infrastructure facilities.
terms of external debt, involving commercial borrowing, to compete with developed countries due to considerations of Service Export from India Scheme (SEIS).
repayments to the IMF and a fall in concessional aid flow. quality and cost. The latter assumed that self-sufficiency and •• Branding campaigns planned to promote exports in sectors The salient features of SEZs Act are:
domestic production was somehow superior to trade. This where India has traditional strength. •• Exemption from customs duty, excise duty, etc. on import/
Export Promotion concept, which can be traced to the Swadeshi movement, was •• SEIS shall apply to ‘Service Providers located in India’ domestic procurement of goods for the development,
further buttressed by the Mahalanobis strategy adopted during instead of ‘Indian Service Providers’. operation and maintenance of SEZs and the units therein.
Although by the Sixth Five Year Plan we had done away with the Second Plan and continued with modifications till the early •• The criteria for export performance for recognition of
the need of food grain imports and some crude oil was being 1980s. It was only from 1985-86 that a genuine attempt was •• 100% income tax exemption for 5 years, 50% for the next
status holder have been changed from Rupees to US 5 years and 50% of ploughed back export profits for 5
produced domestically, BOP position was still not comfortable made towards trade liberalisation. The result was spectacular dollar earnings.
as export increased at an average rate of 17 % per annum in years thereafter for SEZs units.
due to low exports. The need for export promotion was felt •• Manufacturers who are also status holders will be enabled
during the 1960s. The Third Five Year Plan introduced certain dollar terms between 1986 and 1990. A combination of factors •• Exemption from capital gains on transfer of an undertaking
to self-certify their manufactured goods as originating from an urban area of SEZs.
export promotion policies like cash compensatory schemes, tax such as bad policy, weak government and external factors led from India.
exemptions, duty drawbacks, Rupee devaluation, etc. However to the decline of this performance to 9% in 1990-91 and 4% in •• 100% income tax exemption to SEZ developers for a
•• Reduced Export Obligation (EO) to (75%) for domestic block of 10 years in 15 years.
our exports remained discouraging. Indian exports depended the subsequent years.
procurement under EPCG scheme.
largely on world trade situation. We were mainly primary As part of economic liberalisation, government introduced a •• Exemption from dividend distribution tax to SEZ
•• Online procedure to upload digitally signed document developers.
product exporters, the price of which fluctuated heavily with series of trade reforms on the fourth of 1991. The major thrust
by Chartered Accountant/Company Secretary/Cost
fluctuations in world market demand. was to make exports competitive, unshackle foreign trade •• 100% income tax exemption for 5 years and 50% for next
Accountant to be developed.
from the clutches of a control regime and allow import of most five years for off shore Banking units located in SEZ.
•• Primary products exporting countries have an unfavorable •• Inter-ministerial consultations to be held online for issue
goods using only tariff as a restraint. •• Exemption to SEZ developer and units from Minimum
term of trade. The earnings from primary product exports of various licences.
were low and unstable. Alternate Tax.
Foreign Trade Policy 2015-20 •• No need to repeatedly submit physical copies of documents
•• Secondly, the quality of Indian products was not up to available on Exporter Importer Profile. •• CST exemption to SEZ developer and units on inter-state
Aiming to nearly double India’s exports of goods and services purchase of goods.
the world standards due to which we could not sustain to $900 billion by 2020, the government has announced several •• Export obligation period for export items related to
markets. defence, military store, aerospace and nuclear energy to •• Constitution of an authority for each SEZ with a view to
incentives in the five-year Foreign Trade Policy for exporters
providing greater administrative, financial and functional
•• Third, only residue products were mainly exported. The and units in the Special Economic Zones (SEZ). Unveiling be 24 months instead of 18 months.
autonomy to these zones.
fact that export earnings also contribute to economic the first trade policy of the NDA government, Commerce •• Calicut Airport, Kerala and Arakonam ICDS, Tamil
development was overlooked. Cumbersome procedures Minister Nirmala Sitharaman said the FTP (2015-20) will Nadu notified as registered ports for import and export; •• Establishment of designated courts and a single enforcement
introduce Merchandise Exports from India Scheme (MEIS) and Vishakhapatnam and Bhimavarm added as Towns of agency to ensure speedy trial and investigation of offences
for license, etc. served as disincentives for exporters.
Services Exports from India Scheme (SEIS) to boost outward Export Excellence. committed in SEZs.
Domestic inflation further reduced the competitiveness of
India’s export. shipments.The new policy aims at boosting India’s exports and •• Certificate from independent chartered engineer for •• Encouragement to State Governments to liberalise State
it is believed that PM Narendra Modi’s pet projects, ‘Make redemption of EPCG authorisation no longer required. laws and delegate their powers to the Development
in India’ and ‘Digital India’ will be integrated with the new Commissioners to the SEZs to facilitate single window
Exchange Rate clearance.
Foreign Trade Policy. Special Economic Zone (SEZ)
The instability of the exchange value of the rupee was another
problem. The constant devaluations (to promote exports) Trade Policy (2015-20) Key Features Special Economic Zone (SEZ) is a specifically delineated duty- Export Oriented Units, Export processing Zone
raised the amount of external debt. The value of rupee was •• India to be made a significant participant in world trade free enclave that has economic laws different from a country’s and Special Economic Zone Schemes
managed by the central bank (fixed exchange rate). The gap by 2020. typical economic laws, usually the goal is to increase foreign The Government has liberalised the scheme for export-oriented
between official and market exchange rate created problems •• Merchandize exports from India (MEIS) to promote investments. units and export processing zones. Agriculture, horticulture,
for the exporters and importers. The strict foreign exchange specific services for specific Markets Foreign Trade India was one of the first in Asia to recognise the effectiveness poultry, fisheries and dairying have been included in export-
controls also encouraged hawala trade. Policy. of the Export processing Zone (EPZ) model in promoting oriented units. Export processing zone units have also been
E-128 Foreign Trade and Investment in India Foreign Trade and Investment in India E-129

allowed to export through trading and star trading houses and Odisha, Meghalaya, Manipur, Nagaland, Mizoram and have been made in the FDI policy regime by the government The following are some of the sectors with
can have equipments on lease. These units have been allowed Tripura. While the EPIP in Rajasthan at Sitapura (Distt. to ensure that India becomes an increasingly attractive and 100% FDI
cent per cent participation in foreign equities. Jaipur), Bangalore (Karnataka), Ambarnath (Distt. investor-friendly destination.
Thane, Maharashtra), Kakkinad (Distt. Ernakulam, Advertising, agriculture, air transport services (domestic
1. Export Processing Zones The current phase of FDI policy is characterized by negative
Kerala), Surajpur (Distt. Gautambudh Nagar, U.P.), airlines), courier services, drugs and pharmaceuticals,
Before getting converted into Special Economic Zones listing, permitting FDI freely except in a few sectors indicated
Gummidipoondi (Distt. Chengalpattu, Tamil Nadu), electricity, power, films and studios, hotel and tourism,
(SEZs), these Export Processing Zones (EPZs) were through a negative list. Under the current policy regime, there
Pashamylaram (Distt. Mendak, Andhra Pradesh) and housing and real estate, construction, mass rapid transport
playing important role in promoting exports of the country. are three broad entry options for foreign direct investors.
Amingaon (Near Guwahati, Assam) have been completed. system, mining (gold and silver), NBFC, marketing, pipelines
These zones were created to develop such an environment 1. In some sectors, FDI is not permitted (negative list); and refining of petroleum products, tourism, transport
in the economy which may provide capability of facing Exports have already commenced from Karnataka, Kerala 2. In another small category of sectors, foreign investment
and Rajasthan EPIPs. Other parks are at various stages of infrastructure, townships, SEZs, railways, single brand retail
international competition. The Export Processing Zone is permitted only till a specified level of foreign equity
implementation. (upto 49% automatic and from 49 to 100% has to be approved
(EPZs) set up as enclaves, separated from the Domestic participation, and by FIPB), telecommunications (upto 49% automatic, 49-100%
Tariff Area by fiscal barriers, were intended to provide a At present, the number of formally approved SEZs is 413, 327 3. The third category, comprising all the other sectors, by FIPB), and asset reconstruction companies ( upto 49%
competitive duty free environment for export production. SEZs have been notified, 202 SEZs are operational and the total is where foreign investment up to 100 % of equity automatic, 49-100% by FIPB).
All the 8 EPZs, located at Kandla and Surat (Gujarat), number of units approved in SEZs is 4,102. A total investment participation is allowed. The third category has two
Santa Cruz (Maharshtra), Cochin (Kerala), Chennai of Rs.3,48,983.22 crores has been done till 2015. Moreover, subsets – 74% FDI
(Tamil Nadu), Vishakhapatnam (Andhra Pradesh), Faeta till now15,04,597 persons have received employment through
a. one consisting of sectors where automatic approval Airports, broadcasting, coal and lignite, credit information
(West Bengal) and Noida (U.P) have been converted into SEZs.
is granted for FDI (often foreign equity participation companies, direct to home (DTH), mining ( diamonds &
Special Economic Zones. less than 100 %), and precious stones), satellites, and private sector banking are the
2. Export-Oriented Units Foreign Direct Investment (FDI) b. the other consisting of sectors where prior approval sectors with FDI limit of 74%.
Since 1981, the Government introduced a complementary Foreign direct investment (FDI) is an investment in a business by from the Foreign Investment Approval Board (FIPB)
plan of EPZ (Now converted into SEZ) scheme for 26-49% FDI
an investor from another country for which the foreign investor is required.
promoting export units (making export of their cent per cent has control over the company purchased. The Organisation Airlines/aviation, defence, insurance and pension are the
FDI policy changes increasingly reflect the requirements of
production. Under this scheme the Government provides of Economic Co-operation and Development (OECD) defines sectors which have 49% FDI limit. Sectors with 26% FDI
industry and are based on stakeholder’s consultation. Upfront
various incentives to increase the production capacity of control as owning 10% or more of the business. Businesses that limits print media (newspaper – 26%, scientific & periodicals
listing of negative sectors has helped focus on reform areas,
these units so as to increase exports of the country. This make foreign direct investment are after called Multinational – 100% ) and FM radio. Public sector Banks have the lowest
which are reflected in buoyant FDI inflows.
scheme offers a wider source of raw materials, hinterland Corporations (MNCs) or Multinational Enterprises (MNEs). FDI limit of 20%.
facilities, availability of technological skills, existence of • A MNE may create a new foreign enterprise by making a
an industrial base and the need for a larger area of land direct investment, which is called a greenfield investment.
for the project.
• A MNE may make a direct investment by the acquisition of
3. Export Houses, Trading Houses and Star Trading a foreign firm, which is called an acquisition or prownfield
Houses investment .
To increase the marketable efficiency of exporters, the
Government introduced the concept of export houses, Advantages of foreign Direct Investment
trading houses and star trading houses. Those registered 1. Economic Development Stimulation.
exporters who have shown good export performances 2. Easy International Trade.
over past few years have been given the status of 3. Employment and Economic Boost.
export houses, and trading houses. Units having such
4. Development of human capital Resources.
classification are required to achieve the prescribed
5. Tax incentives.
average export performance level and earning of foreign
exchange. These units are provided some special facilities 6. Resource Transfer.
and benefits by the Government. 7. Reduced disparity between revenues and costs.
Since April 1, 1994 a new category named Golden Super 8. Increased productivity.
Star Trading Houses was added by the Government 9. Increment in income.
which has the highest average annual foreign exchange Disadvantages of Foreign Direct Investment
earnings. On March 31, 2003 there were 4 Golden Super
Star Trading House working in the country. 1. Hindrances to domestic Investment.
4. Export Promotion Industrial Parks (EPIP) 2. Risk from political changes.
3. Negative influence on exchange rates.
A Centrally-sponsored ‘Export Promotion Industrial Park
(EPIP)’ scheme was introduced in August 1994 with a 4. Higher costs.
view to involving the state governments in the creation 5. Economic non-viability.
of infrastructure facilities for export oriented production. 6. Expropriation.
It provides for 75% (limited to 10 crore) grant to state 7. Modern-day Economic colonialism.
government towards creation of such facilities. The FDI, being a non-debt capital flow, is a leading source of external
Central Government has so far approved 25 proposals financing, especially for the developing economies. It not only
for establishments of EPIPs in the states of Punjab, brings in capital and technical know-how but also increases
Haryana, Himachal Pradesh, Rajasthan, Karnataka, the competitiveness of the economy. Overall it supplements
Kerala, Maharashtra, Tamil Nadu, Andhra Pradesh, domestic investment, much required for sustaining the high
U.P., Gujarat, Bihar, J&K, Assam, M.P., West Bengal, growth rate of the country. Since 2000, significant changes

E-130 Foreign Trade and Investment in India Foreign Trade and Investment in India E-131

15. Which is the role of the International Monetary Fund (c) The foreign capital earns profit in the country which
(IMF)? is repatriated
(a) To implement and advance global trade agreements (d) The Balance of Trade of the country is badly affected
(b) To settle industrial and trade disputes between by Foreign Capital Inflows
1. Which of the following organisation provides guarantee 9. Which of the following is not one of the features of members 23. TANKAN is revision of the Industry Classification of
(c) To help poorer countries with their economic the Short-term Economic Survey of Enterprises (usually
to exporters? the Special Economic Zones (SEZ) being set up for
development quarterly ) is used in following country ?
(a) EXIM Bank promoting exports ? (a) Japan (b) South Korea
(d) To maintain international financial stability in global
(b) Export Loan Guarantee Corporation (a) The SEZ area will be treated as foreign territory for (c) China (d) All of them
financial markets
(c) RBI trade operations, duties and tariff. 24. Which among the following is the most important source
16. Which of the following is not an argument for
(d) Commerce Ministry (b) No licence is required for import into the zone. region of NRI remittances to India ?
protectionism?
2. Which of the following does not form part of current (c) Foreign workers will be allowed free entry without (a) To protect infant industries (a) North America (b) Europe
account of Balance of Payments? visa restrictions. (b) To increase the level of imports (c) Middle East (d) Asia Pacific
(a) Export and import of goods (d) There will be no routine examination by customs (c) To protect strategic industries (e) South America
(b) Export and import of services authorities of import/export cargo. (d) To improve the balance of payments 25. In context with the two way trade of India with different
(c) Income receipts and payments 10. Which of the following is considered lending for 17. Dumping in the context of international trade refers to : regions, which among the following region is India’s
(d) Capital receipts and payments (a) Exporting goods at prices below the cost of largest trade partner?
promotion of exports?
3. Which institution is known as ‘soft loan window’ of (a) EU Region (b) Gulf Region
(a) Packing Credit production
(c) North America (d) Latin America
World Bank? (b) Overdraft (b) Exporting goods of inferior quality
26. Which among the following will be a debit entry in India’s
(a) IFC (c) Cash Credit Account (c) Exporting goods only to re-import them at cheaper
balance of payments?
(b) IDA (d) Bill Discounting rates
(a) Imports of goods by India.
(c) IMF 11. For National Manufacturing and Investment Zones (d) Exporting goods without paying appropriate taxes in (b) Income of Indian investments abroad.
(d) Indian Development Forum (NMIZ), Special Economic Zone (SEZ) and EOUs the receiving country (c) Receipts of transfer payments.
4. Global capital-flows to developing countries increased 18. Foreign Direct Investment involves: (d) Exports of services by India.
(Exports-Oriented Units), which of the following
significantly during the nineties. In view of the East (a) A speculator trying to make a profit by buying 27. Which among the following countries is currently the
statement is true?
Asian financial crisis and Latin American experience, company shares on a foreign stock exchange. biggest supplier of crude oil to India?
(a) NMIZs and EOUs will be located within SEZs (b) A UK energy company buying territory abroad
which type of inflow is good for the host country? (b) SEZs and EOUs will be located within NMIZs. (a) Iran (b) Saudi Arabia
where it expects to find oil reserves. (c) UAE (d) Nigeria
(a) Commerical loans (c) NMIZs are independent of SEZs and EOUs. (c) A tourist purchasing foreign currency to spend on a 28. IMF can grant loan to __________?
(b) Foreign Direct Investment (d) NMIZs and SEZs will be competitors in nature holiday abroad. (a) Any sovereign country of the World
(c) Foreign Portfolio Investment 12. Both Foreign Direct Investment (FDI) and Foreign (d) A company signing an agreement with a wholesaler (b) Any sovereign country of the World and Public
(d) External Commercial Borrowings Institutional Investor (FII) are related to investment in to distribute its products in foreign markets. Sector companies backed by Sovereign guarantee
5. The earnings of India from diamond export is quite high. a country. Which one of the following statements best 19. Many a times we read about Hot Money in newspapers. (c) Any Member country of IMF
Which one of the following factors has contributed to it? represents an important difference between the two ? Which among the following options rightly describes hot (d) Any Member country of IMF and Public Sector
(a) pre-independene stock-piling of diamonds in the (a) FII helps bring better management skills and money? Companies backed by Sovereign guarantee of
country which are now exported technology, while FDI only brings in capital. (a) Hot money is useful and generally durable and is Member Country ‘
(b) large production of industrial diamonds in the (b) FII helps in increasing capital availability in general, good for the country in all weathers 29. In which among the following forms, the Special Drawing
country while FDI only targets specific sectors. (b) Hot money is dangerous and volatile and leaves the Rights (SDR) are kept as currency of International
(c) expertise available for cutting and polishing of (c) FDI flows only into the secondary market while FII country in bad weather conditions Monetary Fund?
imported diamonds which are then exported (c) Hot money is good and adds to the development of (a) Paper Currency
targets primary market
(d) as in the past, India produces huge quantity of gem the country & it comes from exports of services (b) Gold
(d) FII is considered to be more stable than FDI.
diamonds which are exported (d) Hot money is bad & useless as its arises from (c) Book Keeping Entry
13. A great deal of Foreign Direct Investment (FDI) to India unusual activities like casinos, gambling, horse (d) A combination of all of three
6. Which one of the following modes of privatization is the
comes from Mauritius than from many major and mature races, speculations etc. 30. A new term Lourdes Treatment and Resuscitation Option
most comprehensive and complete?
economies like UK and France. Why? 20. A systematic record of all economic transactions (LTRO) was making news in context with which among
(a) introduction of private capital in public sector
(a) India has preference for certain countries as regards completed between residents of a country and the rest of the following?
(b) contracting out management of public enterprises to
receiving FDI the world in a year is known as..? (a) World Bank
the private sector
(b) India has double taxation avoidance agreement with (a) Net Capital Flow (b) Balance of Payment (b) International Monetary Fund
(c) transferring ownership and management to the
Mauritius (c) Balance of Trade (d) Absolute Flow (c) European Central Bank
workers (d) Federal Reserve Bank of America
(c) Most citizens of Mauritius have ethnic identity with 21. Asian Financial Crisis of 1997 started from which of the
(d) transferring ownership and management to the 31. Christine Lagarde is the head of which among the
India and so they feel secure to invest in India following countries?
private sector (a) Myanmar (b) Thailand following international agencies / bodies?
7. Which one of the following types of borrowings from the (d) Impending dangers of global climatic change prompt
(c) Cambodia (d) Malaysia (a) Asian Development Bank
IMF has the softest servicing conditions? Mauritius to make huge investments in India
22. Many a times we read in the newspapers that when (b) Non-alignment Movement
(a) Second tranche loan 14. TRIPS (Trade Related aspects of Intellectual Property (c) International Atomic Energy Agency
Foreign Capital is allowed to enter the country freely,
(b) SAF Rights) agreements is administered by (d) International Monetary Fund
it can affect the economy adversely. Which among the
(c) ESAF (a) United Nations Conference on Trade and following is a correct reason for the above assumption? 32. AoA in context with World Trade Organization is ___?
(d) Oil facility Development (UNCTAD) (a) It affects the balance of payments of the country by (a) Article of Association
8. Which unit of valuation is known as ‘paper gold’? (b) United Nations Organization (UNO) adversely affecting the Current Account (b) Agreement on Agriculture
(a) Eurodollar (b) Petrodollar (c) World Trade Organization (WTO) (b) It poses risks to the value of the country’s currency (c) Agreement on Association
(c) SDR (d) GDR (d) World Bank (WB) as well as management of local liquidity (d) Administration of Agriculture
E-132 Foreign Trade and Investment in India Foreign Trade and Investment in India E-133

11. Consider the following statements relating to the World 17. We read in the newspapers that the Foreign Direct
Trade Organization (WTO): Investments are preferred over the Capital Inflow. In this
1. The WTO deals with the global rules of trade context, please consider the following :
between nations. 1. FDI brings in latest technology
6. The New Economic Policy (1991) was launched in the 2. The goal of the WTO is to help producers of goods 2. FDI does not involve large outflow
Statement Based MCQ background of the following economic indicators: and services, exporters, and importers conduct their 3. FDI Improves efficiency of the economy
1. Consider the following statements. 1. India’s foreign exchange reserves had fallen to business. Which among the above is / are most suitable reasons for
Most internationals agencies which fund development US$1 billion. 3. The WTO, which is a successor body of the General the given statement?
programmes in Indian on inter-government bilateral 2. The fall of the Soviet Union had deprived India of Agreement on Tariffs and Trade, came into being (a) Only 1 (b) Only 1 & 3
agreements, mainly provide. almost a quarter of its export market. following the Uruguay Round of Negotiations. (c) Only 1 & 2 (d) All 1, 2 & 3
1. Technical assistance 3. There was negative growth in real GDP. 4. The WTO distances itself in framing of rules on trad 18. Which of the following constitute the Capital Account ?
2. Soft loans which are required to be paid back with 4. Indian rupee had to be devalued by 45 per cent. in intellectual property rights. 1. Foreign Loan.
interest Which of the statements given above are correct? 2. Foreign Direct Investment.
(a) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (b) 1 only
3. Grants, not required to be paid back (a) l, 2 and 3 (b) 2, 3 and 4 3. Private Remittances.
(c) 1 and 2 (d) 1, 2 and 3
4. Food assistance to alleviate poverty (c) 1, 2 and 4 (d) 1 and 3 only 4. Portfolio Investment.
7. Which of the following pairs are correctly matched?
(a) 2 and 4 are correct (b) 1, 2 and 3 are correct 12. Foreign Direct Investments are preferred over Capital Select the correct answer using the codes given below
1. Increase in—Monetary expansion Inflow. In this context, please consider the following.
(c) 1, 2 and 4 are correct (d) 3 and 4 are correct (a) 2 & 4 (b) 1 & 3
2. Low import growth rate in India-Recession in Indian 1. FDI brings in latest technology
2. FDI in Multi-Brand Retail Trade (MBRT) in all products (c) 1 & 2 (d) 1, 2 & 4
industry 2. FDI does not involve large outflow
is now permitted in India subject to 19. Consider the following:
3. Euro-issues—Shares held by Indian companies in 3. FDI improves working efficiency
1. a ceiling of 51% 1. International Bank for Reconstruction and
2. minimum amount to be brought in as FDI by the European countries Which is/are most suitable reason/reasons for the given Development (IBRD)
foreign investor is US $ 100 million. 4. Portfolio investment—Foreign institutional investors. statement? 2. International Development Association (IDA)
3. atleast 50% of the procurement of manufactured/ (a) 1, 2 and 4 (b) 3 and 4 (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 3 3. International Finance Corporation (IFC)
processed products should be sourced from ‘small (c) 1, 2 and 3 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (c) 1 and 2 (d) All 1, 2 and 3 4. Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency (MIGA)
industries’. 8. Which of the following would include Foreign Direct 13. Consider the following: 5. International Centre for Settlement of Investment
4. retail sales locations set-up only in cities with a Investment in India? 1. Balance of trade 2. Net factor income Disputes (ICSID)
population of more than 10 lakh. 1. Subsidiaries of foreign companies in India 3. Net transfer payments Which among the above constitute the World Bank
Select the correct answer using the codes given below 2. Majority foreign equity holding in Indian companies Which among the above make the part of the “Capital group?
(a) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (b) 1 and 4 3. Companies exclusively financed by foreign Account”? (a) 1 2 (b) 1 2 3
(c) Only 2 (d) 1, 2 and 4 companies (a) Only 1 (b) 1 & 2
(c) 1 2 3 4 (d) 1 2 3 4 5
3. Which of the following were the aims behind the setting (c) 2 & 3 (d) 1, 2 & 3
4. Portfolio investment 20. Consider the following statements:
up of the World Trade Organization (WTO)? 14. Consider the following statements:
Select the correct answer using the codes given below 1. The Foreign Exchange Management Act FEMA
1. promotion of free trade and resource flows across 1. Indian Rupee has faced 2 devaluations till now
(a) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (b) 2 and 4 became an act on the 1st day of June, 2002.
countries 2. Indian Rupee faced highest devaluation in 1966
(c) 1 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3 Which among the above statements is / are correct? 2. It replaced FERA.
2. protection of intellectual property rights 3. It made all offenses regarding foreign exchange civil
9. Which of the following is correct about ‘Foreign direct (a) Only 1 is correct
3. managing balanced trade between different countries offenses, as opposed to criminal offenses as dictated
4. promotion of trade betwen the former East Bloc investment’ (FDI)? (b) Only 2 is correct
1 Through FDI a company buys a company in the (c) Both 1 and 2 are correct by FERA.
countries and the Western World
target country. (d) Neither 1 nor 2 is correct Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
(a) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (b) 1 and 2
2. Through FDI a company expand operations of an 15. Consider the following statements regarding the Indian (a) 1 and 2 (b) 2 and 3
(c) 2 and 3 (d) 1 and 4
existing business in the target country. Depository Receipts? (c) 1 and 3 (d) None
4. Consider the following statements in respect of the
functions of World Trade Organisation (WTO): 3. FDI is an investment in the securities of another 1. An IDR declares ownership of shares of a Foreign 21. Consider the following statements:
1. It seeks to make international trade free by establishing country such as stocks and bonds. Company 1. Kelkar Committee is associated to oil and gas.
predictable and transparent ground rules. 4. FDI is an investment directly into production in a 2. The Shares in an IDR are held by an Indian Custodian 2. Kelkar Committee has to prepare a roadmap for
2. It promotes capital flow from developed to 3. Using IDR, the Indian Residents get a chance to enhancing import of oil and gas.
country by a company located in another country.
developing countries. invest in a listed foreign entity Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 1, 2 and 4
3. It provides a forum for trade negotiations. Which among the above statements is / are correct? (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(c) 1, 2 and 3 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4
4. It works as a neutral agency for settlement of trade (a) Only 1 (b) Only 2 (c) 1 and 2 (d) None
10. International Monetary Fund (IMF) argues that developing
disputes. (c) Only 1 & 2 (d) Only 1 & 3 22. Consider the following statements:
economies hold a massive stockpile of foreign exchange. 1. The Petrapole-Benapole border checkpoint controls
Identify the correct statements from the above: 16. Market Economy:
Which could be the consequences of such stockpiling? the foreign trade between India and Bangladesh.
(a) 1, 3 and 4 (b) 2, 3 and 4 1. The role of market forces and competition is
1. A trade imbalance or major difference in value of 2. Petrapole is on Bangladesh side and Benapole is on
(c) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2 and 3 eliminated by law
5. Which of the following statement is not correct in relation imports/exports is generated between the developing 2. There is a high degree of competition in both Indian side.
to International Monetary Fund? and emerging economies and the rich countries. commodity and factor markets Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
1. India is a founder member of the IMF. Such an imbalance is not a healthy sign. 3. Private gains are the main motivating and guiding (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
2. IMF conducts regular review of India’s economic 2. These imbalances have caused the current global force for carrying out economic activities (c) 1 and 2 (d) None
status under Article IV. economic crisis. Which among the above is/ are correct statements? 23. Which of the following would include Foreign Direct
3. India’s quota in the IMF is more than 2 per cent 3. Such stockpiling is responsible not only for problems (a) Only 1 & 2 are correct Investment in India?
4. Finance Minister is ex-officio Governor of the IMF. in trade balances but leads to money laundering. (b) Only 2 & 3 are correct 1. By incorporating a wholly owned subsidiary or
(a) 1 and 4 (b) 3 only (a) 1 only (b) 2 only (c) All are correct company anywhere
(c) 1 only (d) 2 and 4 (c) 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 (d) None of them is correct 2. By acquiring shares in an associated enterprise

E-134 Foreign Trade and Investment in India Foreign Trade and Investment in India E-135

3. Through a merger or an acquisition of an unrelated II. Under a fixed system, a currency can rise or fall due 36. What is meant by term Balance of Payment? (a) Only II (b) Only I
enterprise to changes in demand or supply of currencies on the I. Those transactions arising out of exports and imports (c) Both I & II (d) None of the above
4. Participating in an equity joint venture with another foreign exchange market. (the visible items) 42. Which of the below statements are correct?
investor or enterprise III. Under this imports and exports can readjust to move II. It is astatistical statement of all transactions made I. Reverse account balance makes an adjustment
Select the answer using the codes given below. the balance of payments back towards a desirable between one particular country and all other between current account balance and capital account
(a) 1 and 2 (b) 2, 3 and 4 equilibrium. countries during a specified period of time balance.
(c) 1, 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 (a) I & II (b) I & III III. This account is the summary of all international II. If surplus in the Capital Account is more than deficit
24. Consider the following statements: (c) II & III (d) Only I trade transactions of the domestic country in one in the Current Account, there is net increase in the
1. International Monetary Fund (IMF) was initiated in 30. Why did the fixed exchange rate system collapsed? year Forex Reserves of the country at the end of the year.
1944 at the Bretton Woods Conference and formally I. The build up of US debts abroad as a result of the (a) I & III (b) Only I III. If deficit in the current account is more than surplus
need to fund the war in Vietnam (c) Only II (d) None of the above in the Capital Account then there is net decrease in
created in 1945.
II. Inflation in the USA 37. What is meant by term Balance of Trade?
2. IMF grants loan to member country and other Foreign Reserves of the country at the end of the
III. Growing doubts about the stability of the US$. I. Those transactions arising out of exports and imports
developing countries. year.
(a) Only I (b) I & II (the visible items)
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? (a) I & II (b) I & III
(c) II & III (d) All the above II. It is a statistical statement of all transactions made
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only between one particular country and all other (c) Only II (d) All the above
(c) 1 and 2 (d) None 31. Match the following percentage of world trade in different 43. Which statement is correct regarding balance of payment
years of India: countries during a specified period of time
25. Consider the following statements regarding the III. This account is the summary of all international crises?
Federation of Indian Export Organisation (FIEO): Year Percentage I. If international reserves of a country are not enough
trade transactions of the domestic country in one
1. FIEO was set up in 1965 under the aegis of Ministry I. 1950’s a. 0.59% to balance a combined deficit in current and capital
year
of Commerce. II. 1990’s b. 2% account on a sustained basis, then the phenomenon
(a) I & III (b) Only I
2. It is an apex body of Export Promotion Organisations III. 2015 c. 1.78% is called a BoP crisis.
(c) Only II (d) None of the above
3. FIEO renders an integrated package of services (a) I –b, II – c, III – a (b) I – c, II – a, III – b 38. Which statement is correct regarding Current account? II. It can be tackled by exporting more or by limiting
to various organizations connected with export (c) I - a, II- b, III – c I. Those transactions arising out of exports and imports imports through tariffs, quotas, etc. Contractionary
promotion. 32. What are the categories in which India export? (the visible items) fiscal and monetary policies can also tackle the crisis
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? I. Agricultural and Allied Products II. It is a statistical statement of all transactions made through lower import demand with fall in average
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only II. Mineral Fuel and Lubricants between one particular country and all other income levels.
(c) 1 and 2 (d) 1, 2 and 3 III. Coal and petroleum countries during a specified period of time III. Another short term solution is currency devaluation
26. Match the following countries with its currencies: (a) Only II (b) I & II III. This account is the summary of all international which encourages exports and discourages costlier
Country Currency (c) Only III (d) None of the above trade transactions of the domestic country in one imports.
I. US a. Yen 33. What are the facts regarding structural change in India’s year (a) Both I & II (b) Only I
export since 1991? (a) I & II (b) Only I (c) II & III (d) All the above
II. China b. Dollar
I. There are indications that during 1990s, some (c) II & III (d) Only III 44. Which statement is incorrect regarding India’s balance of
III. Japan c. Pound
of Indian exports have moved upwards in value 39. Which statement is incorrect regarding balance of
IV. Britain d. Yuan payment?
addition chain whereby instead of exporting raw payment?
(a) I – b, II – d, III – a, IV – c I. 1994-95 was the year of the acute BOP crisis in India.
materials, the country has switched over to export I. BoP compares the dollar difference of the amount of
(b) I – a, II – d, III – b, IV – c II. India then had foreign exchange reserve of mere 3
of processed goods. exports and imports, including all financial exports
(c) I – b, II – c, III – a, IV – d billion dollar
II. There were significant compositional shift within and imports.
(d) I – a, II – c, III – b, IV – d III. This crisis led to the massive changes in the
the major manufactured product groups such as II. A negative balance of payments means that more
27. Which sentence is correct regarding foreign exchange? country’s economic policy, popularly known as the
engineering goods, chemicals and allied products, money is flowing out of the country than coming in
I. Foreign exchange reserves in India comprises of 6 Structural Adjustment Program or New Economic
etc. and vice versa.
elements. III. The balance of payment is maintained by State Bank Policy (NEP) regime, focusing on liberalization and
(a) Only II (b) Only I
II. Foreign exchange management can be done in three of India globalization of the economy.
(c) Both I & II (d) None of the above
possible ways: Fixed currency regime, floating (a) I & III (b) Only III (a) I & III (b) I & II
34. Match the following export products of India with the
currency regime and managed exchange rates. Percentage they constitute: (c) II & III (d) Only I (c) Only III (d) Only I
III. Silver is an element of foreign exchange reserve Products Percentage 40. Match the following current accounts with their examples: 45. What conditions are correct that came with the medium
(a) I & II (b) Only II I. Petroleum a. 4% CA term loan given by IMF to India for restructuring of the
(c) Only III (d) None of the above II. Gems & Jewellery b. 7.8% I. Visible Trade a. Gifts economy?
28. Which sentences are correct regarding special drawing III. Transport & c. 20.4% II. Invisible Trade b. Tea I. Government expenditure to be cut by 20% per annum
rights? Equipments III. Unilateral Transfer c. Insurance II. Devaluation of rupee by 22%.
I. It was created in 1980 IV. Machinery d. 16.3% (a) I – b, II – c, III – a III. Excise duty to be increased by 40% .
II. It is also known as “paper gold”. (a) I – c, II – d, III – b, IV – a (b) I – a, II – c, III – b IV. Custom duty to be cut drastically from the peak of
III. Its value is based on a basket of five key international (b) I – a, II – c, III – b, IV – d (c) I – c, II – a, III – b 130% to 30%
key currencies and SDRs can be exchanged for (c) I – b, II – a, III – d, IV – c 41. Which statement is correct regarding capital account? (a) II & IV (b) I & II
freely usable currencies (d) I – d, II – c, III – a, IV – b\ I. On the credit side of this account receipt of foreign (c) III & IV (d) Only II
(a) Only II (b) I & III 35. Which statements are true regarding India’s Import? exchange due to Foreign Direct Investment (FDI), 46. What are the factors on which import substitution strategy
(c) II & III (d) All the above I. In 1947-48 the main items of India’s imports were Foreign Capital Investment (FCI) and Foreign was based on?
29. Which of the statement is correct according to Fixed machineries, oil, grains, cotton, cutlery, hardware Borrowing (FB) is recorded. I. Non-price
Exchange rates? implements, chemicals, etc. II. On the debit side of capital account payment of II. Physical- interventionist policies like licensing,
I. Fixed rates are currency values which are tied to a II. They constituted 70% of India’s imports foreign exchange due to Direct Investment Abroad quotas and other physical restrictions on imports
precious metal such as gold, or anchored to another (a) Only II (b) Only I (DIA), Portfolio Investment Abroad (PIA) and (a) only II (b) Only I
currency, like the US Dollar. (c) Both I & II (d) None of the above Foreign Lending (FL) is recorded. (c) Both I & II (d) None of the above
E-136 Foreign Trade and Investment in India Foreign Trade and Investment in India E-137

47. Why there was the need for export promotion in India? IV. FTP benefits from both MEIS & SEIS will be 58. Match the States with their cities where there are EPZs in that India becomes an increasingly attractive and
I. Primary products exporting countries have an extended to units located in SEZs. India: investor-friendly destination.
unfavourable term of trade. The earnings from (a) I & II (b) II & IV States City (a) I & II (b) II & III
primary product exports were low and unstable (c) Only III (d) All the above I. Gujarat a. Noida (c) Only IV (d) All the above
II. Secondly, the quality of Indian products was not up II. West Bengal b. Kandla 64. Are the statements given below the subset of the third
53. Which statement is not correct according to MEIS? category of FDI?
to the world standards due to which we could not III. U.P c. Faeta (it is a placein West
I. Agricultural and village industry products to be Bengal which is mentioned I. It consists of sectors where automatic approval is
sustain markets. supported across the globe at rates of 3% and 5% in the chapter) granted for FDI (often foreign equity participation
III. Third, only residue products were mainly exported.
under MEIS. (a) I-b, II-c, III-a (b) I-a, II-c, III-b less than 100 per cent)
The fact that export earnings also contribute to II. It consists of sectors where prior approval from
II. Higher level of support to be provided to processed (c) I-b, II-a, III-c (d) I-c, II-b, III-a
economic development was overlooked. the Foreign Investment Approval Board (FIPB) is
and packaged agricultural and food items under 59. Which statement is correct regarding export oriented
(a) I & III (b) II & III required
MEIS. units?
(c) Only III (d) All the above I. Since 1981, the Government introduced a (a) Only I (b) Only II
48. Which of the below statements are correct regarding (a) Only I (b) Only II
complementary plan of EPZ (Now converted into (c) Both I & II
exchange trade? (c) Both I & II (d) None of the above 65. What are the sectors with 100% FDI?
SEZ) scheme for promoting export units.
I. The value of rupee was managed by the state bank 54. What are the objectives of SEZ act? II. Under this scheme the Government provides various I. Agriculture
II. The strict foreign exchange controls also encouraged I. Generation of additional economic activity. incentives to increases the production capacity of II. Advertising
hawala trade II. Promotion of exports of goods & services. these units so as to increase exports of the country. III. Air transport service
III. India followed a strongly inward looking policy, III. Promotion of investment from domestic and foreign III. This scheme offers a wider source of raw materials, IV. Drugs and pharmaceuticals
laying stress on import substitution sources. hinterland facilities, availability of technological (a) I & II (b) II & IV
(a) Only I (b) Both II & III IV. Creation of employment opportunities skills, existence of an industrial base and the need (c) Only III (d) All the above
(c) Only III (d) All the above for a larger area of land for the project. 66. Match the following sectors with the percentage of FDI:
(a) I & II (b) II & IV Sectors Percentage
49. Choose the correct sentence regarding the trade policy: (c) Only III (d) All the above (a) Only III (b) I & II
(c) II & III (d) All the above I. Private sector a. 49%
I. Mahalanobis strategy adopted during the First plan 55. Which points are correct regarding SEZ act?
60. Which statement is correct regarding Export houses? banking
II. Export increased at an average rate of 29 per cent I. Exemption to SEZ developer and units from II. Defence b. 20%
per annum in dollar terms between 1986 and 1990 I. To increases the marketable efficiency of exporters,
Minimum Alternate Tax. the Government introduced the concept of export III. Print media c. 74%
III. A combination of factors such as bad policy, weak IV. Public sector banks d. 26%
II. Constitution of an authority for each SEZ with a houses, trading houses and star trading houses.
government and external factors led to the decline of (a) I-c, II-a, III-d, IV-b (b) I-d, II-a, III-c, IV-b
view to providing greater administrative, financial II. Those registered exporters who have shown good
this performance to nine per cent in 1990-91 and 4 (c) I-a, II-a, III-c, IV-b (d) I-c, II-d, III-a, IV-b
and functional autonomy to these zones. export performances over past few years have been
per cent in the subsequent years. 67. Foreign exchange reserves of India comprise of which
III. Establishment of designated courts and a single given the status of export houses, and trading houses.
(a) Only III (b) I & II III. Units having such classification are required to elements?
(c) II & III (d) All the above enforcement agency to ensure speedy trial and I. Gold
investigation of offences committed in SEZs. achieve the prescribed average export performance
50. What was the main reason of introducing trade reforms level and earning of foreign exchange. II. Special Drawing Rights (SDR)
in 1991? (a) I & II (b) Only II III. Foreign currency assets
(a) Only III (b) I & II
I. Make exports competitive (c) Only III (d) All the above IV. Reserve Tranche Position (RTP) in the IMF
(c) II & III (d) All the above
II. Unshackle foreign trade from the clutches of a 56. Consider the following statements: (a) I & II (b) II & III
61. Which statement is correct regarding EPIP?
control regime I. Agriculture, horticulture, poultry, fisheries and (c) Only III (d) All the above
I. EPIP was introduced in 1996
dairying have been included in export-oriented 68. Which statement is correct regarding FDI?
III. Allow import of most goods using only tariff as a II. It is sponsored by centre
I. The success of foreign exchange management by RBI
restraint units. III. It provides 80% grant to the state
can be seen in the fact that from US$ 5.8 billion in
(a) I & II (b) Only II II. Export processing zone units have also been allowed (a) II & III (b) Only I March 1991 (enough to meet the import requirements
(c) Only III (d) All the above to export through trading and star trading houses (c) I & II (d) All the above for three weeks) the country’s reserves have grown
51. What are the key features of trade policy? and can have equipment on lease. 62. Match the area with the state where there are EPIPs in to around US $ 352 billion by December 2015.
I. India to be made a significant participant in world Which of the following statements are true regarding India: II. It is pertinent to note here that some of the increase
trade by 2025 Column I Column II in the reserve is attributed to the weakness of the
Export Units: I. Rajasthan a. Amingaon
II. Merchandize exports from India (MEIS) to promote (a) Only II (b) Only I dollar in the post-Iraq war scenario.
specific services for specific Markets Foreign Trade II. Maharashtra b. Sitapura (a) Only I (b) Only II
(c) Both I & II (d) None of the above III. Kerala c. Ambarnath
Policy (c) Both I & II
57. Consider the following statements: IV. Assam d. Kakkinad
III. FTP would reduce export obligations by 50% and 69. Imports of India are classified into:
I. These zones were created to develop such an (a) I-b, II-c, III-d, IV-a (b) I-a, II-c, III-d, IV-b I. Petroleum Products
give boost to domestic manufacturing
environment in the economy which may provide (c) I-d, II-c, III-b, IV-a (d) I-c, II-b, III-a, IV-d II. Pearls and Precious Stones
(a) I & II (b) Only II 63. Which statement is correct regarding FDI?
(c) II & III (d) All the above capability of facing international competition. III. Iron and Steel
II. The Export Processing Zone (EPZs) set up as I. FDI is a non-debt capital flow, is a leading source IV. Fertilizers
52. Which is the correct statement according to FTP 15 – 20? of external financing, especially for the developing
enclaves, separated from the Domestic Tariff (a) I & II (b) Only II
I. FTP 2015-20 introduces two new schemes, namely economies.
Area by fiscal barriers, were intended to provide (c) Only IV (d) All the above
“Merchandise Exports from India Scheme (MEIS)” II. It not only brings in capital and technical know- 70. Match the following imports of products with the
and “Services Exports from India Scheme (SEIS)” a competitive duty free environment for export how but also increases the competitiveness of the percentage:
II. These schemes (MEIS and SEIS) replace multiple production economy. Column I Percentage
schemes earlier in place, each with different III. There are total 10 EPZs in our country III. Overall it supplements domestic investment, much I. Gold a. 7.3%
conditions for eligibility and usage. Which statement is/are correct regarding export required for sustaining the high growth rate of the II. Petroleum b. 12.7%
III. Incentives (MEIS & SEIS) to be available for SEZs processing zone country. III. Electronic goods c. 30.7%
also e-Commerce of handicrafts, handlooms, books (a) Only III (b) I & II IV. Since 2000, significant changes have been made in (a) I-b, II-c, III-a (b) I-a, II-c, III-b
etc., eligible for benefits of MEIS. (c) II & III (d) All the above the FDI policy regime by the government to ensure (c) I-c, II-b, III-a (d) I-b, II-a, III-c

E-138 Foreign Trade and Investment in India Foreign Trade and Investment in India E-139

23. (d) Foreign direct investment (FDI) is a direct 39. (b) BoP compares the dollar difference of the amount of
investment into production or business in a country exports and imports, including all financial exports
by an individual or company of another country, and imports. A negative balance of payments means
either by buying a company in the target country or that more money is flowing out of the country than
by expanding operations of an existing business in coming in and vice versa. The balance of payment
EXERCISE-1 The reach of retail sales outlets of foreign multi that country. Foreign direct investment is in contrast is maintained by Central Bank of India i.e. Reserve
1. (b) brand retail trader will be limited to only those to portfolio investment. Bank of India.
2. (d) Capital receipts and payments do not form part of cities with a population of 1 million (including an 24. (a) International Monetary Fund (IMF) was initiated in 40. (a)
current account of Balance of Payment. area of 10 kilometres around the municipal/urban 1944 at the Bretton Woods Conference and formally 41. (c) On the credit side of this account receipt of foreign
3. (b) 4. (b) 5. (c) 6. (d) 7 (c) agglomeration limits of such cities). created in 1945 to foster global growth and economic exchange due to Foreign Direct Investment (FDI),
8. (c) 9. (c) 10. (a) 11. (b) 12. (b) 3. (b) 4. (a) 5. (b) 6. (c) stability. IMF grants loan to member country only. Foreign Capital Investment (FCI) and Foreign
13. (b) India has comprehensive Double Taxation 7. (a) Euro issue includes issue of ADR (American 25. (d) FIEO an apex body of Export Promotion Borrowing (FB) is recorded. On the debit side of
Avoidance Agreements (DTAA ) with 23 countries. Depositary Receipts) and GDR (Global Depositary Organisations was set up in 1965 to renders
capital account payment of foreign exchange due
This means that there are agreed rates of tax and Receipts). A scheme has been initiated during 1992 an integrated package of services to various
to Direct Investment Abroad (DIA), Portfolio
jurisdiction on specified types of income arising under which Indian companies are permitted to raise organizations connected with export promoting
Investment Abroad (PIA) and Foreign Lending (FL)
in a country to a tax resident of another country. foreign currency resources through issue of Foreign undertaken to stimulate and diversify the country’s
export trade. is recorded.
Under the Income Tax Act 1961 of India, there are Currency Convertible Bonds (FCCBs) and/or issue 42. (d) If surplus in the Capital Account is more than deficit
two specific provisions, Section 90 and Section 91, 26. (a) The basket of five international currencies includes
of ordinary equity shares through Global Depositary in the Current Account, there is net increase in the
US dollar, euro, Chinese yuan, Japanese yen and
which provide specific relief to taxpayers to save Receipts (GDRs)/American Depositary Receipts Forex Reserves of the country at the end of the year.
British pound.
them from DTAA. Section 90 is for taxpayers who (ADRs) to foreign investors i.e. institutional On the other hand if deficit in the current account is
27. (b) Foreign exchange management can be done in three
have paid the tax in a country with which India has investors or individuals (including NRIs) residing more than surplus in the Capital Account then there
possible ways: Fixed currency regime, floating
signed DTAA, while Section 91 provides relief to abroad. currency regima and managed exchange rates.The is net decrease in Foreign Reserves of the country at
taxpayers who have paid tax to a country with which 8. (d) All statements except 4th regarding F.D.I in India foreign exchange reserves of India comprise of four the end of the year.
India has not signed a DTAA. Thus, India gives are correct. elements 43. (d) If international reserves of a country are not enough
relief to both kind of taxpayers Mauritius by itself is 9. (b) 10. (d) 28. (c) SDR is an international monetary reserve currency, to balance a combined deficit in current and capital
a low tax counting. 11. (a) The World Trade Organization (WTO) is the only created by International Monetary Fund (IMF) in account on a sustained basis, then the phenomenon
14. (c) 15. (d) global international organization dealing with the 1969. It operates as a supplement to the existing is called a BoP crisis. It can be tackled by exporting
16. (b) Protectionism would reduce the level of imports into rules of trade between nations. At its heart are the reserves of member countries. It is also known as more or by limiting imports through tariffs, quotas,
an economy. WTO agreements, negotiated and signed by the “paper gold”. etc. Contractionary fiscal and monetary policies
17. (a) bulk of the world’s trading nations and ratified in 29. (d) Fixed rates are currency values which are tied to a can also tackle the crisis through lower import
18. (b) The energy company will own and control the precious metal such as gold, or anchored to another demand with fall in average income levels. Another
their parliaments. The goal is to help producers
territory and the oil reserves it contains. currency, like the US Dollar. This method was short term solution is currency devaluation which
of goods and services, exporters and importers
19. (b) 20. (b) 21. (b) 22. (b) 23. (a) 24. (a) brought by the International Monetary Fund (IMF). encourages exports and discourages costlier imports.
conduct their business. The Uruguay Round led to
25. (b) 26. (b) 27. (b) 28. (c) 29. (c) 30. (d) The system collapsed in 1971 for a variety of 44. (b) Our country has been facing BOP disequilibrium
the creation of the World Trade Organization, with
30. (c) European Central Bank European Central Bank’s reasons, including the build up of US debts abroad right since independence, culminating into a disaster
GATT remaining as an integral part of the WTO as a result of the need to fund the war in Vietnam,
(ECB’s) LTRO — Long Term Refinancing Operation in 1990-91, the year of the acute BOP crisis. India
agreements. The agreements fall into a simple inflation in the USA and growing doubts about the
is more appropriately termed the Lourdes Treatment then had foreign exchange reserve of mere 1 billion
structure with six main parts, intellectual property stability of the US$.
and Resuscitation Option. dollar, barely sufficient to finance a month’s import
31. (d) (Agreement on Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual 31. (c) 32. (b)
Property Rights (TRIPS)) was one of them. bill. The country was on the verge of defaulting.
32. (b) Different agreements of WTO are: 33. (c) There are indications that during 1990s, some of
This crisis led to the massive changes in the
1. Multi-Fiber agreement (MFA). 12. (d) 13. (d) 14. (b) 15. (d) Indian exports have moved upwards in value addition
country’s economic policy, popularly known as the
2. Agreement on agriculture (AOA). 16. (b) 17. (a) 18. (d) 19. (d) chain whereby instead of exporting raw materials,
the country has switched over to export of processed Structural Adjustment Program or New Economic
3. Trade related investment measures (TRIMS). 20. (b) The Foreign Exchange Management Act (FEMA)
goods. There were significant compositional shift Policy (NEP) regime, focusing on liberalization and
4. Trade related intellectual property right (TRIPS). has been introduced as a replacement for earlier
within the major manufactured product groups such globalization of the economy.
5. General agreement on trade and services (GATS) Foreign Exchange Regulation Act (FERA). FEMA
as engineering goods, chemicals and allied products, 45. (a) Government expenditure to be cut by 10% per
became an act on the 1st day of June, 2000. FEMA
EXERCISE-2 etc. annum, Devaluation of rupee by 22%, Excise duty
made all offenses regarding foreign exchange civil
34. (a) 35. (c) to be increased by 20% so as to neutralize the effect
1. (b) offenses, as opposed to criminal offenses as dictated of lodd of revenue dur to custom cut, Custom duty
36. (c) Balance of payments (BoP) is astatistical statement
2. (d) In respect to multi-brand retail trading, changes by FERA. to be cut drastically from the peak of 130% to 30%
of all transactions made between one particular
made in 2012 permitted up to 51 % FDI with prior 21. (a) Vijay Kelkar Committee is prepared to prepare 46. (c) The import substitution strategy was based on
country and all other countries during a specified
government approval. The foreign investor has a road map for enhancing domestic production non-price, physical- interventionist policies like
period of time. It also include export-import of
to bring in a minimum investment of USD 100 of oil and gas so as to reduce the nation’s import licensing, quotas and other physical restrictions on
visible and invisible items.
million in an entity engaged in multi brand retail dependency by 2030. 37. (b) Balance of trade takes into account only those imports.
trading. Similar to the requirement of mandatory 22. (a) The Petrapole-Benapole border checkpoint controls transactions arising out of exports and imports of 47. (d) 48. (b)
local sourcing as applicable in single brand product the foreign trade between India and Bangladesh. It only (the visible items). 49. (a) Mahalanobis strategy adopted during the Second
trading (prior to Cabinet meeting) at least 30% is in North 24 Parganas district of West Bengal. Out 38. (d) This account is the summary of all international Plan and continued with modifications till the early
of the procurement of manufactured/ processed of them, Petrapole is on Indian side and Benapole is trade transactions of the domestic country in one 1980s. It was only from 1985-86 that a genuine
products shall be sourced from `small industries`. on Bangladesh side. year attempt was made towards trade liberalisation. The
E-140 Foreign Trade and Investment in India

result was spectacular as export increased at an as to increase exports of the country. This scheme
average rate of 17 per cent per annum in dollar terms offers a wider source of raw materials, hinterland
between 1986 and 1990. A combination of factors facilities, availability of technological skills,
such as bad policy, weak government and external existence of an industrial base and the need for a
factors led to the decline of this performance to nine larger area of land for the project.
per cent in 1990-91 and 4 per cent in the subsequent 60. (d) To increases the marketable efficiency of exporters,

7
years. the Government introduced the concept of export
50. (d) The major thrust was to make exports competitive, houses, trading houses and star trading houses.
unshackle foreign trade from the clutches of a control Those registered exporters who have shown good
regime and allow import of most goods using only export performances over past few years have been

INDUSTRY AND
tariff as a restraint. given the status of export houses, and trading houses.
51. (b) Units having such classification are required to

INFRASTRUCTURE
52. (d) These schemes (MEIS and SEIS) replace multiple achieve the prescribed average export performance
schemes earlier in place, each with different level and earning of foreign exchange. These units
conditions for eligibility and usage. Incentives are provided some special facilities and benefits by
(MEIS & SEIS) to be available for SEZs also the Government.
e-Commerce of handicrafts, handlooms, books etc., 61. (a) 62. (a)
eligible for benefits of MEIS. FTP benefits from 63. (d) a non-debt capital flow, is a leading source of
both MEIS & SEIS will be extended to units located
in SEZs.
external financing, especially for the developing Introduction
economies. It not only brings in capital and technical
53. (c) Agricultural and village industry products to be Growth of industies has been always focus area of the government. The reason behind this is the important role played by
know-how but also increases the competitiveness
supported across the globe at rates of 3% and 5% the industries in Gross Domestic Product (GDP) of India. The government, therefore, has many schemes and incentives to
of the economy. Overall it supplements domestic facililate growth and development of industries.
under MEIS, Higher level of support to be provided
investment, much required for sustaining the high It has been generally noticed in the most of developing countries shift from agriculture to industries in the overall economic
to processed and packaged agricultural and food
growth rate of the country. Since 2000, significant growth of the country.
items under MEIS.
changes have been made in the FDI policy regime Indian economy, however portrays a contradictory trend. Here, the economic has by passed industries growth to rapid growth
54. (d) 55. (d)
by the government to ensure that India becomes of services sector. The rapid growth of services may be Largely attributed to reform and liberalisation of the 1990s. Indian
56. (c) Agriculture, horticulture, poultry, fisheries and
an increasingly attractive and investor-friendly industries contribute 18% of India’s GDP and employ about 19% of work force. Major industries of our country are textiles,
dairying have been included in export-oriented
destination. Chemicals, food processing, steel, cement, petroleum, pharmaceuticals etc.
units. Export processing zone units have also been
allowed to export through trading and star trading 64. (c) The third category has two subsets – one consisting
houses and can have equipments on lease. of sectors where automatic approval is granted for Indian Industries
57. (b) These zones were created to develop such an FDI (often foreign equity participation less than
environment in the economy which may provide 100 per cent) and the other consisting of sectors
capability of facing international competition. The where prior approval from the Foreign Investment
Export Processing Zone (EPZs) set up as enclaves, Approval Board (FIPB) is required. Introduction Status of Micro, Small and Major Public Sector Small Scale
separated from the Domestic Tariff Area by fiscal 65. (d) 66. (a) 67. (d) Indian Industries Medium Enterprise Industries Units Industries
barriers, were intended to provide a competitive 68. (c) The success of foreign exchange management
duty free environment for export production. by RBI can be seen in the fact that from US$ 5.8
58. (a) billion in March 1991 (enough to meet the import Before Acts and Industrial
Cottage, Small
59. (d) Since 1981, the Government introduced a requirements for three weeks) the country’s reserves Independence Regulations and Village Structure Sickness
complementary plan of EPZ (Now converted into have grown to around US $ 352 billion by December After Industries of PSES Disinvestment
SEZ) scheme for promoting export units (making 2015. It is pertinent to note here that some of the Independence Agro and Rural Role in Policy
increase in the reserve is attributed to the weakness Industrial Policy
export of their cent percent production. Under this Industries economy Approach for
of the dollar in the post-Iraq war scenario. Resolution, 1948
scheme the Government provides various incentives Cotton and Textfile Disinvestment
to increases the production capacity of these units so 69. (d) 70. (a) Industrial Industry
Development and Energy
Sugar Industry
Regulation Act 1951 Crude oil
Industrial Policy 1956 Iron and Steel Industry
Coal
MRTP Act 1969 Petroleum Industry Power
FERA 1973 Railway
Oil and Gas Production
Industrial Policy 1973
Gems and Jewellery Road
Industrialization post 1990 Transport
Industrial Policy 1991 Chemical Industry Inland waterways
Competition Act 2002 Infrastructure Shipping
Competition Civil Aviation
(Ammendment) Tele communication
Bill, 2007 Information Technology

E-142 Industry and Infrastructure Industry and Infrastructure E-143

(ii) Introduction of Industrial Entrepreneur’s Memorandum


STATUS OF INDIAN INDUSTRIES FERA 1973 (i.e. no industrial approval is required for industries
The Foreign Exchange and Regulation Act (FERA) was not requiring compulsory licensing).
Before Independence •• A group of 18 specified industries (of medium category) passed in 1973. This resulted in a tremendous shift in the (iii) Liberalisation of Locational Policy.
were in control of the state governments in liaison with foreign investment policy of the Government of India.
Status of Indian Industries : India was a manufacturing (iv) Liberalised policy for Small Scale Sectors.
Foreign Investment was allowed in only those industries that
economy before industrial revolution of England in 19th the Central government. (v) Non-Resident Indians Scheme (NRIs are allowed to
were directly into exports.
century. Its exports of cotton, silk fabrics and handicrafts were •• The remaining industrial options which were not Restrictions were placed on foreign investments. International invest upto 100% equity on non-repatriation basis in
popular in many areas. But, due to import of cheap machine- covered by either the centre or state lists, were left open companies could hold a maximum of 40% equity. But some all activities except for a small negative list).
made goods during the colonial period, Indian manufacturing to the private sector. industries in the field of advanced technology were given (vi) Electronic Hardware Technology Park (EHTP),
declined. •• This policy was to be reviewed after 10 years. permission for 51% foreign capital. This has often been Software Technology Park (STP) Scheme for building
The development thinking in the 1940s and 1950s was influenced called a draconian act which hampered the modernisation up strong electronic industry to enhance exports.
by the economic prospects of newly-independent countries Industrial Development and and growth of Indian industries. (vii) Liberalised policy for Foreign Direct Investment
like India, the experience of Latin America and writings of (FDI).
influential economists of ‘the import substitution’ school. The Regulation Act 1951 Industrial Policy 1973 (viii) Abolition of the MRTP limit.
argument was that political freedom could be sustained only The act gave complete authority to the government. This The policy listed out the various Appendix 1 industries (ix) FERA was replaced by highly liberal FEMA.
by achieving economic independence from foreign elements. resulted in the bureaucracy extending complete control over that could be started by large business houses so that small
At Independence, foreigners controlled 65% of India’s tea the industrialization of the country. industries were not driven out of business. The establishment Competition Act, 2002
plantation, more than 90% of jute manufacturing, 70% of of small and medium industries was encouraged.
•• They controlled the authorization of capability, In the present era of LPG (Liberalisation, Privatisation and
coal production and 73% of minerals. Colonial policy was
whereabouts and growth of any request for manufacture Private industries were encouraged to set up production units Globalisation), it was felt that the existing Monopolies and
export-oriented, as only exports provided a means of transfer
of new products. in rural areas and in backward areas with a vision to give thrust Restrictive Trade Practices Act, 1969 has become hurdle in
of wealth from the colonies. Therefore, after independence,
•• They controlled the authorization of foreign exchange for the economic development of those areas. certain respects and there is a need to shift our focus from
many of the former colonies, including India, chose an anti-
export and inward looking industrial regime in the 1950s. expenditure on the import of plant and machinery. Industrialization Post 1990 curbing monopolies to promoting competition. Hence a new
But the government later modified its policies with the •• They controlled the authorization for the terms of law, the Competition Act has been enacted and published in the
•• Exemption from licensing was allowed for all start ups
following points: international joint ventures. gazette of India on January 14,2003 for bringing competition
and for those with an investment worth Rs 2.5 crores in
•• Defence and strategic industries were to be the exclusive in the Indian market. The main objectives of the Act are to
Industrial Policy In 1956 fixed assets and a right to import up to 30% of the total
domain of the government. establish a commission to prevent practices having adverse
value of plant and machinery.
•• Existing units in basic and key industries could continue In 1956 a new policy for industrialization was initiated. effect on competition, to promote and sustain competition in
•• Foreign equity investment was allowed up to 40%. markets in India, to protect the interests of consumers and to
in the private sector but no fresh private investment in •• All basic and sensitive industries in India were under the
•• Geographical restrictions and investment cap for small ensure freedom of trade carried on by participants in market in
these sectors was to be allowed. purview of public sector enterprises (PSUs) and were
industries were Removed. India and for related matters.
•• Twenty important industries were allowed in private called as category A type of industries. The Centre had
complete monopoly over these industries. The then PM At the time of liberalization the Indian industries were not
sector but under strict supervision of the state. The Act mainly covers the following aspects:
Pandit Jawaharlal Nehru termed the PSUs the “temples competitive in the global scenario. They could not face the
•• All industries not covered by the above three categories
stiff competition from the foreign industries; hence many (i) Prohibition of anti competitive agreements;
were allowed in the private sector under general of modern India” in this industrial policy.
industries sold their companies to multinational corporations (ii) Prohibition of abuse of dominance;
supervision of the state. •• In category B, industries were a joint venture of both or entered into joint ventures with foreign companies or shut (iii) Regulation of combination (acquisitions, mergers and
public and private enterprises. 12 industrial areas were
Industrial Growth AfterIndependence put under this category. This category also carried the
down the business. amalgamations of certain size);
At the same time a new wave of service industries emerged, (iv) Establishment of Competition Commission of India (CCI);
Prior to independence the ownership or control of much of the provision of compulsory licensing. This provision led which positioned itself in the outsourcing segment. IT and
to the establishment of the so called ‘Licence- Quota- and
large private industries were in the hands of managing agencies, ITE’s industries flourished providing employment to millions
which grew under the British system and had access to London Permit raj’ in the economy. (v) Functions and powers of CCI.
of graduates.
money markets. Thus the owners of these managing agencies •• The remaining industries came under category C, to be The Act is expected curb those practices, which would have an
controlled a major portion of the economy, prior to independence. under the control of private initiative. Industrial Policy 1991 appreciable adverse effect on competition.
But things changed after independence. Parliament enacted a •• The policy of 1956, for the first time, recognized the (A) Objectives Competition (Amendment) Bill, 2007
legislation to curb the powers of managing agencies. By 1971 contribution of small scale industries in the growth of the • to maintain a sustained growth in productivity. On September 10, 2007 Parliament finally passed the
the government had banned the managing agencies. Indian economy. It laid stress on rational distribution of • to enhance gainful employment. long pending Competition (Amendment) Bill, 2007 that
national income and effective utilization of resources. • to achieve optimum utilisation of human resources.
The Industrial Policy Resolution,1948, clearly put forward empowers the Competition Commission of India (CCI) to
This policy is considered one of the most important • to attain international competitiveness.
the goal of the Government’s policy with respect to act as the competition regulator and to deal with a host of
industrial policies of India as it decided the nature and • to transform India into a major partner and players in
industrialization. This was the first economic policy of our contemporary economic issues including monopolies and
scope of the Indian economy till the reforms of 1991. the global arena.
country. It declared that India would be a mixed economy. take-overs of corporate firms.
Following are the major highlights of this resolution. MRTP Act -1969 (B) Main Focus on According to the Bill’s provisions, the CCA will replace
•• Those industries completely owned by the Government The Government of India appointed a Monopolies Inquiry Monopolies and Restrictive Trade Practice Commission
e.g. ordinance, atomic energy, railways and any industry • deregulating Indian industry.
Commission, under Justice K. C. Dasgupta, to study the (MRTPC). The CCA was established in 2003. Under new
of national importance were to be the exclusive domain of • allowing the industry freedom and flexibility in
presence and outcomes of concentration of economic power provisions, the MRTPC will continue till two years after the
the Central government. Certain important industries like responding to market forces, and
in private sector. The Commission observed the presence of Constitution of CCA for dealing with pending cases but after
coal, iron and steel, aircraft manufacture, ship building, • providing a policy regime which facilitates and
monopolistic and restrictive practices in certain key sectors of two years MRTPC will be dissolved.
telephone, telegraphs and communications, were given fosters growth of Indian industry.
the economy. The Commission recommended the setting up of However, MRTPC would not entertain any new cases after
the permission to operate for ten years, at the end of the Monopolies and Restrictive Trade Practices Commission (C) Policy Measures the CCI is constituted. Cases pending with MRTPC after two
which the government would nationalize them. and this eventually resulted in the MRTP Act in 1969. (i) Liberalisation of Industrial Licensing Policy. years of setting up of CCI will be transferred to the latter.
E-144 Industry and Infrastructure Industry and Infrastructure E-145

Micro, Small and Medium Enterprise The following are the investment requirements under the Sugar Industry Pradesh, Tamil Nadu, Andhra Pradesh, Rajasthan, Coastal
Service Enterprises category: area of Kerala and Andman & Nicobar Islands.
Enterprises have been categorized broadly into those Sugar industry occupies an important place among agriculture India has 21 refineries - 17 in the public sector, 3 in the
Micro Enterprises investment includes companies with based industries. Sugar industry is the second largest industry
engaged in (i) manufacturing and (ii) providing/ rendering private sector and one in joint venture. Out of 17 public sector
investment upto ` 10 lakh. Small Enterprises need an after cotton textile industry among agro based industries of
of services. Both categories have been further classified refineries, 8 are owned by Indian Oil Corporation Ltd. (IOCL),
investment above 10 lakh and upto 2 crore. Medium the country. This industry provides not only employment to a
into micro, small and medium enterprises, based on their 2 each by Chennai Petroleum Corporation Ltd. (a subsidiary
Enterprises are those enterprises which have an investment substantial number of persons but also holds the potentialities
investment in plant and machinery (for manufacturing of IOCL), Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. (HPCL),
above 2 crore and upto 5 crore. of developing other industries related to its by-products.
enterprises) or in equipment (in case of enterprises providing Bharat Petroleum Corporation Ltd. (BPCL) and Oil & Natural
Small and Medium Enterprises Development Bill 2005
or rendering services) as under: India is the largest consumer of sugar and the second largest Gas Corporation Ltd. (ONGC). Numaligarh Refinery Limited
(which was introduced in the Parliament on May 12, 2005) producer of sugar with a share of over 15% of world sugar
The following are the investment requirements under the (a subsidiary of BPCL) and Manglore Refinery and Petrol
was approved by the President and became an Act. This production. The importance of sugar industry in India can be
Manufacturing Enterprises category: Chemicals Ltd. have one refinery each. The Joint Venture
Act, named as ‘Small and Medium Enterprise Development estimated from the fact that about 45 million sugarcane growers
Micro Enterprises are those enterprises which have Refinery belongs to Bharat Petroleum Corporation Ltd.
Act, 2006’ became effective from October 2, 2006. This and a large number of rural labourers depend on sugarcane and
investment upto ` 25 lakh. Small Enterprises are those
Act makes a different category for medium level enterprises. sugar industry for their livelihood. Sugar cultivation accounts
enterprises with investment above 25 lakh and upto 5 crore.
Medium Enterprises are those enterprises which have for 3% of total cultivated area and contributes 7.5% of the
Oil and Gas Production
investment above ` 5 crore and upto `10 crore.. gross value of agricultural production. Efficient and reliable energy supply is a prerequisite for
Approximately `1,250 crore is invested in this industry and it accelerated growth of the Indian economy. While the energy
MAJOR INDUSTRIES provides livelihood for nearly 2.86 lakh workers. The industry needs of the country, especially oil and gas, are going to
also benefits the nearly 2.5 crore people who grow sugarcane increase at a rapid rate in the coming decades, the indigenous
in India. In India, the major sugar producing states are energy resources are limited. Oil and gas occupy a major
Major Cottage, Small and Village Cotton and Textiles Industry Maharashtra, Gujarat, Uttar Pradesh, Haryana, Tamil Nadu, position of total energy consumption at 45%. At the same
Industries Cotton Industry in India is the most organised industry which Punjab, Karnataka, Bihar and Andhra Pradesh. time, the dependence on imports of petroleum and petroleum
In a broad sense cottage, small and village industries are contributes to about 4% of GDP, 14% of manufacturing The Central Government fixes the Statutory Minimum Price products continues to be around 80% of total oil consumption
treated similar but they fundamentally differ from each other. value and 13.5% to total export earnings. It provides (SMP) of sugarcane for each sugar season. The SMP is fixed in the country.
employment to millions of skilled and semi-skilled workers. on the basis of the recommendations of the Commission for
Cottage industry is run by family members on full or part
time basis. It possesses negligible capital investment. The
The industry is characterised by wide diversity ranging from Agricultural Cost and Prices (CACP) and after consulting the Gems and Jewellery Industry
the organised mill sector to the decentralised power-loom State Governments and associations of sugar industry and cane
production is done by hands and no wage earning person is sector and employs millions of artisans and weavers. Gems and Jewellery industry emerged as leading export
growers.
employed in cottage industry. •• The first Indian modernised cotton mill, located in Kolkata product in India due to traditional strength in craftsmanship
Small industrial units employ wage earning labour and in 1818, was not successful. The second mill named Iron and Steel Industry and its reasonable share in global business. The gems and
production is done by the use of modern techniques. Capital ‘Bombay Spinning and Weaving Co’ was established in jewellery sector, contributing about 12% of India’s total
The advent of Iron and Steel Industry took place in India in merchandise exports continued to maintain India as the
investment is also present in small industries. A few cottage 1854 at Bombay by KGN Daber. Truly speaking, this
mill only laid the foundation stone of modern cotton the year 1870 when Bengal Iron Works Company established largest cutting and polishing centre of diamonds in the world
industries which are export-oriented have been included in the its plant at Kulti near Jharia, West Bengal. This plant
category of small sector so that facilities provided to small industry in India. both in terms of quantity and value. In terms of carat, India’s
•• Since 1854, the number of cotton mills has been rapidly produced only cast iron. Large scale iron and steel production share in this sector is about 80% of the world market. Gold
units may also be given to export-oriented cottage industries. was started in 1907 by TISCO established at Jamshedpur.
increasing. jewellery and coloured gem segments accounts for about 12%
The industries established in rural areas having population In 1919, Indian Iron and Steel Company (IISCO) was
•• Development of cotton industry had a great role in and 5%, respectively of India’s gem and jewellery export in
below 10,000 and having less than ` 15,000 as fixed capital established at Burnpur. Both TISCO and IISCO are private
Indian freedom struggle. Various movements like Non- value terms.
investment per worker will be termed as village industries. Cooperation Movement, Quit India Movement, etc. sector companies. The first public sector company was
KVIC and state village Industries Board provide economic created a wave of boycotting foreign goods and accepting ‘Vishwashwaraiya Iron and Steel Works at Bhadravati’. Chemical Industry
and technical assistance in establishing and operating these swadeshi goods, which helped a lot in developing After independence, though a thought was given to develop
Chemical industry is one of the oldest industries. It includes
industrial units. indigenous industries. Iron and Steel Industry in First Five Year Plan, but this
basic chemicals and its products, petrochemicals, fertilisers,
•• The partition of India adversely affected the Indian materialised in Second Five Year Plan. The Second Plan
paints and varnishes, gases, soap, perfumes, toiletries and
Agro and Rural Industries cotton industry. Most of the muslim weavers migrated established three steel plants in the public sector-Bhilai
pharmaceuticals. This industry is one of the most diversified of
to Pakistan and this industry got divided into two parts. (with assistance of USSR), Durgapur (with assistance of
Development of agro and rural industries based on local all industrial sectors covering more than 70,000 commercial
•• There were 394 cotton mills in India before the partition. U.K.) and Rourkela (with assistance of West Germany).
raw materials, skills and technology has been identified as Out of these, 14 mills went to Pakistan and the remaining products. It not only plays a crucial role in meeting the daily
All the three public sector plants started production between
one of the most important activities for gainful employment 380 cotton mills continued to operate in India. needs of the common man, but also contributes significantly
1956 and 1962.
in the rural non-farm sector and for overall growth of the •• On the other hand, 40% of cotton producing area became towards industrial and economic growth of the nation. It is
All the three public sector steel plants were expanded during an important constituent of the Indian economy. Its turnover
national economy. Various policies and programmes are the part of Pakistan and only 60% area was transferred Third Five Year Plan and attempts were made to establish
being implemented by the Government through Khadi and to India. size is estimated at around US $ 160 billion approx., which
one more public sector steel plant at Bokaro with the is equivalent to about 3% of India’s GDP. Major chemicals
Village Industries Commission (KVIC) and Coir Board and •• So after independence India had to import raw material to
assistance of USSR. undergo several stages of processing to be converted into
Prime Minister’s Rozgar Yojana (PMRY) with the active co- meet the input requirements of 380 cotton mills.
operation and participation by RBI, other banks and the state •• India’s Five Year Plans proved a boon to cotton industry, downstream chemicals. These processed chemicals are
as this industry not only made remarkable development but Petroleum Industry used in agriculture and industry as auxiliary materials such
governments for the promotion of agro and rural industries in
also established itself in international markets. Initially, Digboi (Assam) was the only oil producing area of the as adhesives, unprocessed plastics, dyes and fertilizers.
rural areas and small towns.
•• The Government by its Textile Development and Regulation country. But now, a number of regions having oil reserves have Chemicals are also directly used by consumers in the form of
For the development of Khadi and Village Industries (KVI)
Order 1993 has made this industry licence-free. been identified and the oil is being extracted in these regions. pharmaceuticals, cosmetics, household products, paints, etc.
Sector, the Government is implementing various programmes/
•• The textile industry is concentrated mainly in the states of Oil regions in India are Assam, Tripura, Manipur, West Alkali chemicals, inorganic chemicals and organic chemicals
schemes through KVIC. Maharashtra, Tamil Nadu and Gujarat. constitute the major segments of the chemicals industry.
Bengal, Mumbai, Gujarat, Jammu and Kashmir, Himachal

E-146 Industry and Infrastructure Industry and Infrastructure E-147

Infrastructure increasing dependence on oil in the energy sector and immediate Million tonnes railway has been contributing to the industrial and economic
steps should be taken to tackle this increasing dependence. Formation Proved Indicated Inferred Total landscape for over 150 years. Of the two main segments
Production of goods requires supporting services such as
(freight and passenger) of the Indian railways, the freight
transporting of raw materials and finished goods, institutions Crude Oil Total 125909 142506 33149 301564
for offering credit, energy sources such as coal, oil and electric segment accounts for roughly two thirds of revenues.
Our production of crude oil declined over the years. The decline Gondwana Coals 125315 142407 32350 300072
power, communication facilities and social overheads like Out of the freight and passenger traffic, the freight segment
is attributed to unexpected reservoir behaviour and lack of new Tertiary Coals 594 99 799 1493
health, education and housing. All these supporting structures accounts for about 70% of revenue. Within the freight
major discoveries. It is estimated that at the current level of
are collectively known as infrastructure. State of Coal Resources in India Last 5 years segment, bulk traffic accounts for nearly 84% of revenue-
consumption, the recoverable reserves of oil in India (approx.
Infrastructure is broadly of two types: earning freight traffic (in physical terms), of which about
550 million tonnes) would last for only 20-25 years. India’s As a result of Regional, Promotional and detailed Exploration
•• Economic infrastructure is located within the system 44% is coal.
crude oil production increased at highest pace in last four years by GSI, CMPDI, SCCL, MECL, State Govts. etc., the
of production and distribution. Some of these are the estimation of Coal resources in India reached to 301.56 billion The railway budget 2015-16 announced four major goals
of 5.6% to 3.193 million tonnes in August 2015.
transport system, banking system and power. tones. The increase/up gradation of Coal resources in the of attaining sustained improvement in customer facilities,
The oil ministry has estimated India will import 188.23 million
•• Social infrastructure contributes to the production country during last 5 years is furnished in table below: making railways safer means of travel, expanding
tonne of crude oil in FY16 at a cost of ` 4,72,932 crore,
process from outside the system. Some examples are substantially and making Indian Railways self- sustainable.
compared to 189.43 million tonnes crude worth ` 6,87,416 Million tonnes
education, training, hospitals and housing. In order to increase transportation capacity, reduce unit
crore imported in FY15, saving ` 2,14,484 crore on fuel bill. As on Geological Resources of Coal
•• Communication system is treated as both social and costs of transportation, and improve service quality, the
economic infrastructure as it has a role both within and Coal Proved Indicated Inferred Total mega rail transport projects, namely the Eastern and western
outside the production process. 1.4.2009 105820 123470 37920 267210 Dedicated Freight Corridors, are being undertaken.
Coal is the most important indigenous source of energy. The
Although there has been massive investment in infrastructure energy derived from coal in India is twice that of energy 1.4.2010 109798 130654 36358 276810 Road Transport
in successive five-year plans, India is even now far behind derived from oil, whereas on the other hand, energy derived 1.4.2011 114002 137471 34390 285862 India has one of the largest road networks in the world
global standards in the matter of infrastructure development. from coal is about 30% less than energy derived from oil the
1.4.2012 118145 142169 33183 293497 aggregating to about 3.62 million km at present. A series of
According to the Global Competitiveness Report, 2015 India’s world over.
1.4.2013 123182 142632 33101 298914 initiatives have been undertaken in recent years, to set stage
ranking in terms of Global Competitiveness Index was 55 out India is today the third largest producer of coal in the world.
for a quantum leap in India’s road system. These initiatives
of 140 countries. Million tonnes 1.4.2014 125909 142506 33149 301564
combine new institutional arrangements, highway engineering
Different methods needed to attract private investment in
infrastructure activities must include simplification and
State Proved Indicated Inferred Total Power of international standards, founded on a self-financing revenue
Total 1259029 142506 33149 301564 Power has been the most crucial problem in India’s economic model comprising tolls and a cess on fuel. Three initiatives in
transparency in clearing procedures; creating an independent
development. The share of hydro power is 26%, thermal 66%, the road sector were begun in recent years:
regulatory framework and unbundling infrastructure projects West Bengal 13403 13022 4893 31318
so that private sectors may be able to chose sub- segments in renewable energy sources 5% and nuclear 3%. The National The National Highway Development Project (NHDP),
Jharkhand 41377 32780 6559 80716 Electricity Policy, 2005 recognises electricity as a “basic human
a project. Pradhan Mantri Bharat Jodo Pariyojana (PMBJP), and
Bihar 0 0 160 160 need” and lays down per capita availability of power from the
Some ongoing government schemes to help in development of Pradhan Mantri Gram Sadak Yogana (PMGSY).
Madhya Pradesh 10411 12382 2879 25673 present 631 units to 1000 units per annum by the end of 2012. In
infrastructure are: Jawarharlal Nehru National Urban Renewal budget 2015, emphasising the need to generate more electricity NHDP dealt with building high quality highways. The PNBJP
Mission (JNNURM), National Urban Transport Policy (2006), Chhattisgarh 16052 33253 3228 52533 from clean energy sources, the government announced a massive dealt with linking up major cities to the NHDP Highways.
National Highways Development Project (NHDP), Special Uttar pradesh 884 178 0 1062 renewable power production target of 1,75,000 MW in the next The PMGSY addressed rural roads.
Accelerated Road development Programme for North East Maharashtra 5667 3186 2110 10964 seven years. Of the total 1,75,000 MW proposed to be tapped While the Central Sector Programme pertains mainly to
Region (SARDP-NE), Pradhan Mantri Gram Sadak Yojna by 2022, solar power will have the major share of 1,00,000
Odisha 27791 37873 9408 75073 National Highways, the responsibility for development of
(PMGSY), etc. MW followed by 60,000 MW from wind energy, 10,000 MW
biomass energy and 5,000 MW of small hydro projects. other categories of roads vests with the State/Union territories.
The Budget 2015 shows a significant increase of ` 70000 crore Andhra Pradesh 9729 9670 3068 22468
A major initiative to expedite power generation has been the The Indian road network, the second largest in the world
in investment in infrastructure in 2015-16 over the current Assam 465 47 3 515
development of coal-based-Ultra Mega Power Projects (UMPP) consists of 96,260 km of National Highways, 1,31,899 km of
year, with a focus on railways and roads. The money will come Sikkim 0 58 43 101 State Highways and about 27,17,763 km of Other District and
each with a capacity of 4000 MW or above. Nine sites have been
from an additional public investment outlay of ` 1.25 trillion identified including four pithead sites (Chhattisgarh, Jharkhand,
Arunachal 31 40 19 90 Rural Roads. The National Highways account for about 2% of
over that of 2014-15. The allocation for roads and railways is ` Madhya Pradesh and Odisha) and five coastal sites (Andhra
Pradesh the total road network but carry as much as 40% of the total
40,000 crore each, an increase of ` 14,031 crore and ` 10,050 Pradesh, Gujarat, Karnataka, Maharashtra and Tamil Nadu).
Meghalaya 89 17 471 576 road traffic in the country. Out of the total length of National
crore respectively over the current fiscal year. The pithead units will get coal from captive mines while the
Nagaland 9 0 307 315 Highways, 24% is single lane/intermediate lane, 52% is 2-lane
coastal plants will import coal.
Energy (Source: Geological Survey of India)
standard and balance of 24% is four-lane standard or more.
Energy is the most fundamental input into any production Railway Indian Road Network
process. Advanced countries of North America and Europe Categorization of Resources The first train in India was started on a small rail route of 34 Indian road network of 33 lakh Km. is second largest in
had developed their economies at a time when the cost of The Coal resources of India are available in older Gondwana kilometers between Bombay and Thane on April 16, 1853. the world and consists of:
energy was very low. Coal was the most important source of Formations of peninsular India and younger Tertiary formations of At present, the Indian Railway consists of an extensive
Length (In Km)
energy during the Industrial Revolution. In the 20 century, north-eastern region. Based on the results of Regional/ Promotional network spread over 63974 km comprising Broad Gauge
it was replaced by oil, which was an even cheaper source. (54257 km) , Meter Gauge (7180 km) and Narrow Gauge Expressways 200
Exploration, where the boreholes are normally placed 1-2 Km
When the oil producing countries formed a cartel (OPEC) and apart, the resources are classified into ‘Indicated‘ or ‘Inferred‘ (2537 km).With such a large rail route, the Indian Railway National Highways 96,260.72
increased the price of crude oil from $2.1 per barrel in 1973 category. Subsequent Detailed Exploration in selected blocks, network has become the biggest railway of Asia and the State Highways 1,31,899
to as much as $28 per barrel in 1980, it hit the developing where boreholes are less than 400 meter apart, upgrades the third in the world. Out of this, about 30% of the route
Major District Roads 4,67,763
countries like India the most. resources into more reliable ‘Proved‘ category. The Formation- kilometre, 41% of running track kilometre and 43% of total
track kilometre has been electrified. Railways absorb about Rural and Other Roads 26,50,000
Although India has abundant reserves of coal, our development wise and Category-wise Coal resources of India as on 1.4.2014
process has not utilised this indigenous source. There is an are given in the table below: 41% of the total central government employees. Indian Total Length 33 Lakhs Kms (Approx)
E-148 Industry and Infrastructure Industry and Infrastructure E-149

Modal Shift National Waterway 6 (NW6) Telecommunication •• This notification is a following step of the Union Cabinet’s
The last in the list, NW6, is under construction. The waterway Telecommunication has witnessed the most dramatic approval of the 74% FDI in telecom in March 2007.
• About 65% of freight and 80% passenger traffic is
carried by the roads. is proposed to cover the distance between Lakhipur and Bhanga growth since the ending of the monopoly of Department of •• As per new norms, FDI upto 49% will continue to be
• National Highways constitute only about 1.7% of the near the Bangladesh border in Assam, on the Barak River. Telecommunication, as part of the New Telecom Policy of on the automatic route.
road network but carry about 40% of the total road The first phase of the two-phase project is scheduled to be 2012 (NTP 2012) •• If the FDI limit were to cross 49% then it would require
traffic. completed by 2016-17. The waterway aims to benefit people
the approval of the Foreign Investment Promotion
• Number of vehicles has been growing at an average from the northeastern states. New Telecom Policy: Highlights
Board (FIPB).
pace of 10.16% per annum over the last five years. Plans for 106 inland waterways in India 1. Rural Tele-density – To improve rural teledensity from •• By this notification, FIPB is also empowered to note
The Union Cabinet, chaired by Prime Minister Narendra the current level of around 39 to 70 by the year 2017 and
Inland Waterways Modi, has approved to pass the official amendment of the
that the investment is not coming from countries of
100 by the year 2020. concern or unfriendly entities.
The inland waterways are another mode of transport which was National Waterways Bill, 2015. 2. Broadband – “Broadband For All” at a minimum
once important but came to be neglected after the development Here are some key points you need to know: •• The guidelines allow foreigners to hold key positions
download speed of 2 Mbps. (like Chairman, MD, CEO, etc.) of telecom companies,
of railways. It is still an important mode in the North-East • The bill seeks to add 106 inland waterways to the existing
six National Waterways on the recommendations of 3. Domestic Manufacturing – Making India a global hub. subject to clearance from the Telecom Ministry on a
where almost half of the cargo traffic between Calcutta and
the Parliamentary Standing Committee on Transport, 4. Convergence of Network, Services and Devices. yearly basis.
Assam is handled by this mode. Total navigable waterways
Tourism and Culture and comments of several state 5. Liberalization of Spectrum – any Service in any
extend to around 14,500 kms of which more than 3700 kms are governments. Technology. Information Technology
suited for mechanical crafts. The inland Waterways Authority of • The bill will also look after the renovation and The enactment of the Information Technology Act (2000)
6. Simplification of Licensing regime – Unified Licensing,
India, established in 1986, is entrusted with the responsibility maintenance of the existing waterways. was a milestone in the development of India’s IT industry.
delinking of Spectrum from License, Online real time
of developing and maintaining national waterways. • Out of the 106 new waterways, 18 have already been It provided a legal framework for e-commerce and electronic
submission and processing.
identified. These include five waterways each from transactions. It also addresses the security needs of privacy,
The six existing National Waterways in India Karnataka and Meghalaya, three each from Maharashtra 7. Consumer Focus – Achieve One Nation – Full Mobile
authenticity,integrity and non-repudiation over the Internet.
and Kerala, one each from Tamil Nadu and Rajasthan. Number Portability and work towards One Nation – Free
National Waterway 1 (NW1) A study by NASSCOM said that software exports for 2015-
• The bill also aims to help the Inland Waterways Authority Roaming.
The National Waterway No. 1 uses a 1,620-kilometre stretch 16 would grow between 12-14% to about $110-112 billion,
of India (IWAI) to develop the feasible stretches for 8. Resale of Services.
of the Ganges River. It was declared a national waterway inthe compared with the 13-15% growth estimate for the fiscal year
Shipping and Navigation. 9. VOIP – Voice over Internet Protocol.
year 1986 and runs from Allahabad in Uttar Pradesh to Haldia 2014-15. The Indian domestic market is expected to grow by
in West Bengal Shipping 10. Cloud Computing – Next Generation Network including 14% to $48 billion in the current fiscal year, mainly because of
IPV6. e-commerce growth. Domestic growth is expected to be led by
National Waterway 2 (NW2) Shipping is another important infrastructure in the country’s e-commerce, government initiatives and technology adoption
The National Waterway No. 2 consists of an 891-kilometre trade and industry. Indian overseas fleet ranks the 17 in •• The number of telephone subscribers in India increased
by industries. Investment of $26 billion by the government in
the world in terms of tonnage, with 659 ships totalling 77 to 1002.05 million in May, 2015. The overall tele-
stretch on the Brahmaputra River. The waterway was declared 2014-15 also helped domestic revenue growth.
lakh gross registered tonnage (GRT). 102 Indian shipping density in India reached 79.67%.
on September 1, 1988, and uses the stretch from Dhubri near The IT industry is the biggest private sector employer in India,
companies are in operation of which 65 are engaged only in •• Central government in its decision made on April and it added 230,000 employees in 2014-15, thus making the
the Assam-Bangladesh border and Sadiya in North-East Assam.
coastal shipping. The public sector Shipping Corporation of 19, 2007 notified the enhancement of foreign direct total number of jobs in the industry close to 3.5 million.The IT
National Waterway 3 (NW3) India (SCI) has a fleet of 112 vessels aggregating three million investment (FDI) in telecom from 49% to 74%. sector also accounted for 9.5% of the gross domestic product
Popularly known as the West Coast Canal, the National GRT. In spite of this, Indian ships carry only 29% of India’s •• As per the notification, all companies have been given (GDP). The IT industry holds the largest share of total services
Waterway No. 3 is a 168-kilometre stretch that runs from total sea borne trade. More than half of this tonnage is crude three months time to comply with the revised norms. exports at 38%.
Kollam to Kottapuram in Kerala. The waterway does not oil and its products.
follow a specific river. It consists of several canals that form There are twelve major ports under Central Government and PUBLIC SECTOR UNITS
the Kerala Backwaters. 139 minor ports under state control along the Indian coastline
National Waterway 4 (NW4) of about 5600 Kms. The major ports together handle a cargo Most countries, including India, have adopted a mixed economy shift to a more open economy with greater reliance on
The most complex inland waterway, the National Waterway of 251 million tonnes. model that encourages the role of the public as well as private market forces and a larger role of the private sector,
sector enterprises. Since Independence, the Indian government including foreign investment.
No. 4, was declared on November 24 in 2008. Civil Aviation made sustained efforts to bring about balanced development •• The PSEs were exposed to competition from domestic
The waterway consists of the Kakinada-Pondicherry stretch of by setting up public sector enterprises (PSEs). The role of the private sector companies as well as foreign MNCs.
The rapid expansion of this sector during the last five years
canals, the Kaluvelly tank, has necessitated urgent investment in infrastructure. There PSEs was earlier limited to basic, heavy and core industries, •• To sustain in a growing competitive scenario, PSEs have
Bhadrachalam-Rajahmundry stretch of River Godavari and the are 14 scheduled airline operators using 334 aircraft. It which were considered of strategic importance and vital for undertaken several steps to perform and operate on par
Wazirabad-Vijayawada stretch of River Krishna. is expected that another 250 aircraft will be added during mass consumption. Furthermore, the government had to step with their private peers such as adopting state-of-the-art
in and set up these huge PSEs because the nation was in the technology, focusing on improving productivity, giving
It traverses around 1,095 kilometre from Kakinada in Andhra the next five years. In addition, there are 65 non-scheduled
initial stages of development and private enterprises could not performance-related pay, offering additional welfare
Pradesh to the Union Territory of Pondicherry. airlines operators who have 201 aircraft. The existing
afford massive investments which the core sector called for. In facilities and other benefits to employees, establishing
National Waterway 5 (NW5) airports are unable to manage this increased volume. recent years, PSEs have penetrated into production of essential brands and increasing marketing efforts.
Another waterway with multiple riverlines and rivulets is the The numbers also demand better regulation of the operators consumer goods and have begun to spread into wide areas of the
National Waterway No. 5. The waterway was declared in in order to ensure satisfactory service. An Airport Economic economy including non-infrastructure and other non-core areas. Structure of PSEs in India
November 2008. The NW5 consists of stretches from Talcher Regulatory Authority (AERA) was set up to ensure healthy •• The public sector banks (PSBs), which have played an
competition among operators and settlement of disputes important role in shaping up the Indian economy since the The PSEs in India are basically categorised under four broad
to Dhamra on River Brahmani, the Geonkhali-Charbatia types based on their ownership structure. These include:
among operators as well as between them and passengers. pre-independence period until now, continue to dominate
stretch of the East Coast Canal, the Charbatia-Dhamra stretch (i) departmental undertakings,
Another major reform in this sector has been the merger of the Indian banking industry, accounting for more than
of River Matai and the Mangalgadi-Paradip stretch of River 70% share of total banking business in India. (ii) statutory corporations,
the Indian Airlines and Air India into a new entity called the
Mahanadi Delta. The waterway also includes a 91 kilometre National Aviation Company of India Limited (NACIL). •• With the introduction of economic reforms and (iii) government-owned companies and
stretch between Geonkhali and Nasirabad in West Bengal. liberalisation in 1991, the Government initiated a systemic (iv) autonomous bodies set up as registered societies.

E-150 Industry and Infrastructure Industry and Infrastructure E-151

(iv) Autonomous bodies •• In all other industries the contribution was less than
As per the recommendations Rangarajan Committee on
Autonomous bodies are set up whenever it is felt that certain Disinvestment of PSEs, government launched a programme of
5%.
functions need to be discharged outside the governmental set disinvestment. However, the first instalment of disinvestment
•• SSI Sector plays a major role in India’s present export of shares valued at 6480 crore fetched only 3038 crore in
up with some amount of independence and flexibility without performance. 45%-50% of the Indian Exports is
day-to-day interference from the governmental machinery. 1991-92. The process attracted a lot of criticism. Moreover,
contributed by SSI Sector. Direct exports from the SSI instead of raising resources either to strengthen the healthier
These bodies are set up by the concerned ministries or
Sector account for nearly 35% of total exports. Besides PSUs or at least to retire the national debt, the government has
their departments and are funded through grants-in-aid,
direct exports, it is estimated that small-scale industrial been looking at extra budgetary support to bridge the deficit.
either fully or partially, depending on the extent which such
units contribute around 15% to exports indirectly. This
institutes generate internal resources of their own. These In order to speed up the process of disinvestment, Government
grants are regulated by the Ministry of Finance (MOF) takes place through merchant exporters, trading houses
of India set up a separate Department of Disinvestment in
through their instructions. They are mostly registered as and export houses. They may also be in the form of
March 2000. A decision was also taken to reduce Government’s
societies under the ‘Societies Registration Act’ and in certain export orders from large units or the production of parts
equity in non-strategic PSUs to 26% or less through strategic
cases they have been set up as statutory institutions under and components for use for finished exportable goods.
sale of such shares. Only three areas-defence, atomic energy
(i) Departmental undertakings the provisions contained in various Acts. and railway-were identified as strategic and all other sectors
INDUSTRIAL SICKNESS were open to disinvestment up to 26%.
Departmental undertakings are primarily meant to provide CPSE’s Role in Economy
essential services such as railways. They function under Industrial Sickness refers to the situation where an industrial The then NDA Government pursued this policy of disinvestment
the control of the respective ministries of Government •• CPSE investments have a multiplier effect on the and several profit-making PSUs, including IPCL, VSNL and
firm performs poorly, incurs losses for many years and defaults
of India (GOI). A departmental undertaking structure is economy IBP were partially divested. Many state governments were also
in its repayment obligations.
considered suitable for activities the government aims to During the first five-year plan (1950-51 to 1955-56) there following similar disinvestment policy in respect of state PSUs.
RBI defines a sick unit as “One which has incurred a cash
keep in its control in view of the public interest. were only 5 CPSEs with a total financial investment (Including
loss for one year and likely to continue incurring losses in the
equity plus long-term loans) of Rs. 290 million, whereas at
following year. The unit which has an inbalance in its financial
Disinvestment Policy of UPA (2009-14)
(ii) Statutory corporations present, in 2015, there are as many as 290 CPSEs, wherein,
structure such as current ratio is less than 1:1 and there is The current disinvestment policy was initially decided by the
Statutory corporations are public enterprises that came 169 are Holding CPSEs and 121 are the subsidiaries.As of UPA government (2009-2014), under its Common Minimum
worse trend in debt equity ratio.
into existence by a Special Act of the Parliament. The Mar 31, 2012, the total financial investment of CPSEs was Programme. The main ideology, as listed on the site of
7,292.3 billion, showing a CAGR of around 12% during the Industrial sickness can be caused by internal and external factors.
Act defines the powers and functions, rules and regulations •• Internal factors could be mismanagement, lack of finance Ministry of Finance, says that:
governing the employees and the relationship of the same period. (i) Citizens have every right to own part of the shares of
•• CPSEs continue to dominate domestic output of key wrong dividend policy, not providing for reserves or
corporation with government departments. deliberate ‘milking’ of the unit by the owners. Public Sector Undertakings.
sectors
•• External factors could be wrong government policy, (ii) Public Sector Undertakings are the wealth of the Nation
(iii) Government-owned companies CPSEs continue to hold control across several industries, despite
and this wealth should rest in the hands of the people.
opening up of several sectors for private investment. CPSEs power shortage, non-availability of raw materials,
Government-owned or controlled companies refer to transport problem, lack of technological advancement and (iii) While pursuing disinvestment, Government has to retain
companies in which 51% or more of the paid up capital continue to have complete monopoly in nuclear power generation.
Other leading areas of dominance are coal (over 80%), crude labour disputes. majority shareholding, i.e. at least 51% and management
is held by the central or any state government (partly control of the Public Sector Undertakings.
oil (over 70%), refineries (over 55%) and wired lines (over Since 1987, the entire responsibility to tackle sickness was
or wholly by both). It is registered under the Indian
entrusted to the quasi judicial body set up for the purpose, i.e.
Companies Act and is fully governed by the provisions of 80%). However, their share has decreased considerably, with
the Board for Industrial and Financial Reconstruction (BIFR).
Approach for Disinvestment
this Act. the exception of coking coal and power generation.
The BIFR approves and sanctions rehabilitation schemes for On 5th November 2009, Government approved the following
sick companies that are referred to it. The functioning of action plan for disinvestment in profit making government
SMALL SCALE INDUSTRIES BIFR, however, has been criticised over the years because companies:
of the adoption of time consuming procedures which lead to (i) Already listed profitable CPSEs (not meeting mandatory
Small scale Industries (SSI) Employment
delays in rehabilitation. shareholding of 10%) are to be made compliant by ‘Offer
The government set up the Justice Eradi committee to for Sale’ by Government or by the CPSEs through issue
Small scale industries (SSI) are production units with a capital •• SSI Sector in India creates largest employment recommend a mechanism for revival as well as closure of a sick of fresh shares or a combination of both.
investment of up to ` one crore. opportunities for the Indian populace, next only to unit. On the recommendations of the panel, the government has (ii) Unlisted CPSEs with no accumulated losses and having
•• It plays a vital role in the growth of India. It contributes Agriculture. It has been estimated that 100,000 rupees decided to set up a National Company law Tribunal (NCLT) earned net profit in three preceding consecutive years
almost 40% of the gross industrial value added in the of investment in fixed assets in the small-scale sector whose main purpose will be to make it easier to liquidate sick are to be listed.
Indian economy, 6% of GDP and 35% of exports. generates employment for four persons. companies within a short timeframe of two years. The NCLT (iii) Follow-on public offers would be considered taking
•• It has been estimated that a million rupees of investment in •• Food products industry has ranked first in generating will act as the single forum for sick companies, replacing the into consideration the needs for capital investment of
fixed assets in the small scale sector produces 4.62 million employment, providing employment to 0.48 million existing three forums- BIFR, Company Law Board (which CPSE, on a case by case basis, and Government could
worth of goods or services. The small scale sector in India persons (13.1%). The next two industry groups were works under the Companies Act, 1956 and handles some cases simultaneously or independently offer a portion of its
is very diverse producing 8000 products from traditional Non-metallic mineral products with employment of of dispute resolution and compliance) and High Courts (which equity shareholding.
handicraft to high end technical instruments. 0.45 million persons (12.2%) and Metal products with deal with winding up of companies).
(iv) In all cases of disinvestment, the Government would
•• The small-scale sector has grown rapidly over the years. 0.37 million persons (10.2%).
retain at least 51% equity and the management control.
The growth rates during the various plan periods have •• In chemicals and chemical products, machinery parts except DISINVESTMENT POLICY (v) All cases of disinvestment are to be decided on a case
been very impressive. electrical parts, wood products, basic metal industries,
The process of selling of government equities in public sector by case basis.
•• When the performance of this sector is viewed against the paper products and printing, hosiery and garments, repair
services and rubber & plastic products, the contribution enterprises is known as disinvestment. Disinvestment in India (vi) The Department of Disinvestment is to identify CPSEs
growth in the manufacturing and the industry sector as a in consultation with respective administrative Ministries
ranged from 9% to 5%, the total contribution by these is mainly a tool for public sector reforms and was, at the
whole, it instils confidence in the resilience of the small- and submit proposal to Government in cases requiring
eight industry groups being 49%. beginning, motivated by the need for gaining resources for
scale sector. Offer for Sale of Government equity.
allocations made in the yearly budgets.
E-152 Industry and Infrastructure Industry and Infrastructure E-153

(c) Large corporations do not have the power or 27. In an oligopolistic or monopolistically competitive
resources to address society’s problems. market, firms do not raise their prices because even a
(d) Business decisions will have social and small price increase will lose many customers.
environmental consequences which will be Which among the following is the most suitable terms
1. What is a ‘limited company’? (c) Indian large scale producers cannot compete in addressed by governments. used for this concept ?
(a) In which shareholders possess the ownership limited 16. In India ‘Report on Currency and Finance’ is the annual (a) Supracompetitive pricing (b) Swing Demand
outside markets
to their paid up capital publication of (c) Kinked Demand (d) Imperfect
(d) Indian SSI units are inherently inefficient
(b) In which shares are issued (a) SEBI (b) RBI 28. Which among the following was the first deepwater
9. The Committee on Competition Policy and Law
(c) A company of Government ownership (c) Finance Commission (d) Finance Ministry block in India to start production?
(Raghavan Committee) has recommended the replacement
(d) A Registered Company 17. Which of the following is related to the EPCG Scheme (a) Krishna Godavari D-6
of which of the following institutions?
2. In India the public sector is the most dominant in of Central Government ? (b) Mahanadi deepwater block NECDWN-2002/1
(a) Securities and Exchanges Board
(a) steel production (a) Foreign Investment (b) Foreign Trade (c) SB-11
(b) Disinvestment Commission (c) Communication (d) Banking
(b) organized term-ending financial institution (d) KG-DWN- 2005/2
(c) Monopolies and Restrictive Trade Practices 18. Which of the following commissions / companies of
(c) transport 29. Who among the following heads the Genetic Engineering
Commission Indian Origin signed a pact for obtaining oil-blocks in Approvals Committee (GEAC) in India?
(d) commercial banking (d) Company Law Board
3. Tourism industry in India is quite small compared to Libya? (a) Minister of Environment & Forests
10. Which of the following can be termed an infrastructural (a) Reliance petroleum (b) Oil India Ltd. (b) Minister of Science and Technology
many other countries in terms of India’s potential and
bottleneck in the development of India’s economy? (c) ONGC (d) BPCL (c) Minister of Agriculture
size. Which one of the following statements is correct in
(a) Existence of a large variety of financial institutions 19. NASSCOM is the organisation of companies of which (d) None of them
this regard?
(b) The federal nature of Indian policy sector? 30. Bring out the incorrect statement regarding India’s textile
(a) Distances in India are too far apart and its luxury
(c) The volatility of the Indian rupee (a) Media sector:
hotels are too expensive for Western tourists.
(b) For most of the months India is too hot for Western (d) Delay in the administration of justice (b) Mobile phone service (a) India’s textile and clothing sector currently employs
tourists to feel comfortable. 11. With reference to India, which one of the following (c) Information technology 35 million people
(c) Most of the picturesque resorts in India such as statements is NOT correct? (d) Automobiles (b) After agriculture it is second largest provider of
in the northeast and Kashmir are, for all practical (a) IPCL is India’s largest petrochemical company 20. Over how many years periodic review of the “Miniratna” employment
purposes, out of bounds. (b) RIL is the largest private sector company in India & “Navratna” status of public enterprises on the basis of (c) Textile sector has a tendency to shrink as the GDP
(d) In India, the infrastructure required for attracting (c) MTNL is listed on NYSE their performance? and Economy grows
(d) BSNL is the first telecom service organization in (a) every year (b) 2 years (d) Textile sector is a major absorber of low-skilled
tourists is inadequate.
(c) 3 years (d) 4 years
4. ‘Level playing field’ argument of industries requires India to launch a nationwide cellular service at one labor
21. Which of the following funds was established in India in
(a) MNCs to be stopped from investing in India. time 31. Who among the following are the beneficiaries of the
1992 to provide assistance to cover the costs of retraining
(b) licence for MNCs to be given only in environment- 12. Which one of the following statements is not correct? MAFALDA?
and redeployment of employees arising as a result of
friendly technology. (a) Rourkela Steel Plant, the first integrated steel plant modernization, technology up gradation and industrial (a) Landless Laborers
(c) domestic industry to be given preference. in the Public Sector of India was set up with the restructuring? (b) Jobless Youth
(d) domestic industry to be treated on par with MNCs. Soviet Union collaboration. (a) National Renewal Fund (c) Small Industries
5. Which of the following is not an internal factor for (b) Salem Steel Plant is a premier producer of stainless (b) National Insurance Fund (d) Small and Marginal Farmers
industrial sickness? steel in India. (c) National Social Security Fund 32. Tourism industries India is quite a small compared to
(a) Mismanagement (c) Maharashtra Elektrosmelt Ltd. is a subsidiary of the (d) National Up-gradation Fund many other countries in term of India potentials and size.
(b) Power shortage Steel Authority of India Ltd. 22. Which among the following is the apex organization of Which one of the following statement is correct in this
(c) Wrong dividend policy (d) Visakhapatnam Steel Plant is a unit of the Rashtriya Industrial Finance in India? regard?
(d) Diversion of funds (a) IDBI (b) ICICI (a) Distances in India are too far apart and its luxury
Ispat Nigam Ltd.
6. The Eastern Dedicated Freight Corridor being built by (c) IFCI (d) RIDF hotels are too expensive for western tourists
13. Explain ‘joint sector’ in India?
Indian Railway will connect 23. Who among the following leaders announced the (b) For most of the months India is too hot for western
(a) Where the government has more than 50% share
(a) Panipat and Allahabad Industrial Policy of 1956? tourist to feel comfortable
(b) Product produced together by the public and private
(b) Rajkot and Bhubaneswar (a) Sardar Patel (b) Jawaharlal Nehru (c) Most of the picturesque resort in India such as
(c) Jawaharlal Nehru Port and Tuglakabad sectors is called the joint sector
(c) Balwant Rai mehta (d) J B Kriplani in North- East and Kashmir are, for all practical
(d) Ludhiana and Sonnagar (c) It is an enterprise owned jointly by both the sectors 24. Which among the following is the correct full form of purposes, out of bounds
7. British colonial authorities did not oppose the setting up (d) It is an enterprise owned jointly by an Indian and a SIDO? (d) In India the infrastructure required for attracting
of cotton mills in India by local capitalists during the 19th foreign enterprise (a) Small Industries Development Organization tourists is inadequate
century because 14. Which sector has maximum weightage in the index of (b) Sick Industries Development Organization 33. Which one of the following is the objective of National
(a) the coast of producing mill cloth in India was higher industrial production assigned? (c) Small Industries Development Office Renewal Fund ?
(b) the first mills set up in India were spinning mills (a) Mining and quarrying (d) State Industrial Development Organization (a) To safeguard the interest of workers who may be
which competed with indigenous hard spinning (b) Manufacturing 25. Which among the following is the most important bulk affected by technology upgradation of industry or
(c) it was too expensive to transport textiles to U.K. (c) Electricity import of India?
closer of sick units.
(d) the quality of Indian mill-made cloth was inferior (d) All equal (a) Nonelectrical machinery (b) Electric Goods
(b) To develop a core sector of economy.
8. It is argued that continuation of reservation for Small 15. The moral case for CSR, i.e. that it is the right thing to (c) Petroleum (d) Food Grains
(c) For the development of the infrastructure such as
Scale Industries after import liberalisation is anachronistic do, is justified by which of the following arguments? 26. In which among the following years, a new “ Liberalized
Industrial Policy “ in India was announced for the first energy, transport, communication and irrigation.
because (a) That the corporation is a creation of society and (d) For human resources development such as full
(a) such reservation does not exist outside India should therefore serve its needs. time?
(a) 1986 (b) 1991 literacy, employment, population control, housing
(b) Indian small scale manufacturers have to compete (b) That the corporation is a legal creation and therefore and drinking water.
with large scale manufacturers from outside cannot be a moral agent. (c) 1992 (d) 1993

E-154 Industry and Infrastructure Industry and Infrastructure E-155

34. The Council of Scientific and Industrial Research (CSIR) 38. The balance of payments of a country is a systematic 2. Most of the power plants in India are coal-based and 2. It is the first company outside Japan to get the
links 37 constituent laboratories with diverse research record of they are not able to get sufficient supplies of coal deming application prize in 2008 for excellence in
portfolios as varied as drug discovery to oceanography. (a) all import and export transactions of a country from within the country. total quality management
Recently we read in the newspapers that CSIR’s latest during a given period of time, normally a year 3. Steel companies need large quantity of coking coal 3. Immediately after the enactment of the Provident
imitative is launching of an Open Source Drug Discovery (b) good exported from a country during a year which has to be imported. Fund Law in India, Tata steel introduced provident
(c) economic transaction between the government of Which of the statements given above is/are correct? fund for its employees.
(OSDD) Programme.
one country to another (a) 1 only (b) 2 and 3 4. It is the first company in the world to get social
What is the main purpose of Open Source Drug accountability 8000 certification from the social
(d) capital movements from one country to another. (c) 1 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3
Discovery (OSDD) Programme? accountability international from the USA.
39. An increase in the Bank Rate generally indicates that the 5. With reference to the Public Sector Undertakings in
(a) To make India a hub of drug research and India, consider the following statements Which of the statements given above are correct?
(a) market rate of interest is likely to fall
development (b) Central Bank is no longer making loans to 1. Minerals and Metals Trading Corporation of India (a) 2 and 3 (b) 3 and 4
(b) To bring the scientists of the world under one roof commercial banks Limited is the largest non-oil importer of the (c) 1, 2 and 3 (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4
(c) To bring down the costs of the new drugs and make (c) Central Bank is following an easy money policy country. 10. Consider the following statements :
them affordable to all (d) Central Bank is following a tight money policy 2. Project and Equipment Corporation of India Limited 1. MMTC limited is India’s largest international
trading organisation.
(d) To make India self reliant in Drug production 40. The sales tax you pay while purchasing a toothpaste is under the Ministry of Industry.
2. Neelanchal Ispat Nigam Limited has been set up by
35. Which among the following sectors contributes maximum is a 3. One of the objectives of Export Credit Guarantee
MMTC jointly with the government of Odisha.
excise revenue to Indian exchequer? (a) tax imposed by the Central Government Corporation of India Limited is to enforce quality
Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
(a) Agriculture (b) Steel industry (b) tax imposed by the Central Government but control and compulsory pre-shipment inspection of
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(c) Oil and gas (d) Aviation collected by the State Government various exportable commodities.
(c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
36. What does PKI stands for? (c) tax imposed by the State Government but Which of these statements is/are correct? 11. Consider the following statements about the Navaratna
(a) Private Key Infrastructure collected by the Central Government (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 status industries.
(d) tax imposed and collected by the State Government (c) 2 and 3 (d) 3 only 1. Navaratna was originally assigned to nine public
(b) Primary Key Infrastructure
41. What does venture capital mean? 6. What is/are the recent policy initiative(s) of Government sector enterprises in 1997.
(c) Public Key Infrastructure
(a) A short-term capital provided to industries of India to promote the growth of manufacturing sector? 2. The number of PSEs (Public Sector Enterprises)
(d) Public Key Institute (b) A long-term start-up capital provided to new 1. Setting up of National Investment and Manufacturing having Navaratna status is now more than 15
37. Disguised unemployment generally means               entrepreneurs Zones. industries.
(a) large number of people remain unemployed (c) Funds provided to industries at times of incurring 2. Providing the benefit of ‘single window clearance’. Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
(b) alternative employment is not available losses 3. Establishing the Technology Acquisition and (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(c) marginal productivity of labour is zero (d) Funds provided for replacement and renovation of Development Fund. (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
(d) productivity of workers is low industries Select the correct answer using the codes given below: 12. Consider the following statements :
(a) 1 only (b) 2 and 3 1. The first petrochemical industry in India was started
(c) 1 and 3 (d) 1, 2 and 3 with the establishment of National organic chemical
7. SEZs were established with the objective of ____ . industry limited in sixties.
1. attracting foreign investment directly. 2. The real thrust of petrochemical industry in India
1. Consider the following statements: control and compulsory pre-shipment inspection of 2. protect domestic market from competition from came with the establishment of Indian Petrochemical
multinationals. Corporation Limited (IPCL) at Baroda.
Small-scale industries are in most cases, not as various exportable commodities.
3. providing more capital to agricultural and allied Which of the statements given above is/are
efficient and competitive as the large-scale ones. Yet Which of these statements is / are correct?
activities. (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
the government provides preferential treatment and (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
reservations in a range of products to the small firms (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
(c) 2 and 3 (d) 3 only (c) 3 only (d) All of the above 13. Consider the following statements :
because small-scale industries. 3. With reference to the National Investment Fund to which 1. Miniratna public sector enterprises can be a joint
1. provide higher employment on a per unit capital 8. Consider the following statements:
the disinvestment proceeds are routed, consider the Small-scale industries are, in most cases, not as venture, set subsidiary company or overseas office
development basis. but with certain conditions.
following statements ? efficient and competitive as the large-scale ones. Yet
2. promote a regional dispersion of industries and 2. Till now there are less than 50 public sector
1. The assets in the National Investment Fund are the Government provides preferential treatment and
economic activities. enterprises which have been given Miniratna status
managed by the Union Ministry of Finance. reservations in a range of products to the small firms
3. have performed better in export on manufactured by the Indian government.
2. The National Investment Fund is to be maintained because small-scale industries
products than the large scale ones. Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
within the Consolidated Fund of India. 1. provide higher employment on a per unit capital
4. provide jobs to low-skill workers, who otherwise (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
3. Certain Asset Management companies are appointed deployment basis.
may not find employment revenues elsewhere. (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
as the fund managers. 2. promote a regional dispersion of industries and
Which of the above statements are correct? 14. Consider the following statements :
4. A certain proportion of annual income is used for economical activities.
(a) 1 and 4 (b) 1 and 2 1. India has attained self-sufficiency in almost all
3. have performed better in export of manufactured consumer goods.
(c) 2 and 3 (d) 3 and 4 financing select social sectors.
products than the large scale ones. 2. In terms of capital goods, India still depends on the
2. With reference to the Public Sector Undertakings in Which of the statements given above is/are correct ?
4. provide jobs to low-skill workers, who otherwise import.
India, consider the following statement (a) 1 and 2 (b) 2 only
may not find employment avenues elsewhere. Which of the statements given above is/are correct?
1. Minerals and Metals Trading corporation of India (c) 3 and 4 (d) 3 only Which of the above statements are correct? (a) 1 only (b) 2 only
Limited is the largest non-oil importer of the 4. Despite having large reserves of coal, why does India (a) 1 and 4 (b) 1 and 2 (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2
country. import millions of tonnes of coal? (c) 2 and 3 (d) 3 and 4 15. Consider the following statements about Competition
2. Project and Equipment Corporation of India Limited 1. It is the policy of India to save its own coal reserves 9. Consider the following statements about Tata steel: Commission of India.
is under the Ministry of Industry. for future, and import it from other countries for the 1. It is the Asia’s first privately own integrated iron 1. Competition Commission of India (CCI) was
3. One of the objectives of Export Credit Guarantee present use. and steel plant. established with effect from 14th october 2003.
Corporation of India Limited is to enforce quality
E-156 Industry and Infrastructure Industry and Infrastructure E-157

2. The goal is to combat the monopoly tendencies government provides preferential treatment and 27. Consider the following liquid assets: II. Existing units in basic and key industries could
and faster the competition among public sector reservation in a range of product to the small firms 1. Demand deposits with the banks continue in the private sector but no fresh private
enterprises. because small industries 2. Time deposits with the banks investment in these sectors was to be allowed.
3. CCI (Competition Commission of India) consists 1. Provide higher employment on a par unit capital 3. Saving deposits with the banks III. Twenty important industries were allowed in private
of a chairperson and 6 members appointed by the development basis. 4. Currency sector but under strict supervision of the state.
central government. 2. Promote a regional dispersion of industries and The correct sequence of these assets in the decreasing IV. All industries not covered by the above three
Which of the statements given above is/are correct? economic activities. order of liquidity is categories were allowed in the private sector under
(a) 1 only (b) 2 only 3. Have promoted better in export of manufacture (a) 1-4-3-2 (b) 4-3-2-1 general supervision of the state.
(c) 1 and 2 (d) All of the above products than the large scales one. (c) 2-3-1-4 (d) 4-1-3-2 (a) Only I (b) I & II
16. Arrange the following Acts in order in which they were 4. Provides job to low skills workers, who otherwise 28. What is/are the facility/facilities the beneficiaries can (c) II & III (d) All the above
enacted. Use the codes given below. may not find employment avenues elsewhere. get from the services of Business Correspondent (Bank 33. What are the major points when India was declared as
1. The Industrial Employment (Standing orders) Act. Which of the above statement(s) are correct ? Saathi) in branchless areas? mixed economy?
2. The Indian Trade Unions Act (a) 1 and 4 (b) 1 and 2 1. It enables the beneficiaries to draw their subsidies I. Those industries completely owned by the
3. The Industrial Disputes Act (c) 2 and 3 (d) 3 and 4 and social security benefits in their villages. Government e.g. ordinance, atomic energy,
4. The Employment Exchange (Compulsory 22. Consider the following factors regarding an industry: 2. It enables the beneficiaries in the rural areas to railways and any industry of national importance
Notification) Act 1. Capital investments make deposits and withdrawals. were to be the exclusive domain of the Central
Codes: 2. Business turnover Select the correct answer using the code given below. government.
(a) 2, 1, 3, 4 (b) 3, 4, 1, 2 3. Labor forces (a) 1 only (b) 2 only II. A group of 18 specified industries (of medium
(c) 1, 2, 4, 3 (d) 4, 3, 2, 1 4. Power consumption (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 category) were in control of the state governments
17. In context of the present ceiling on investment for Which of the following factor determine the nature and 29. In the context of Indian economy, which of the following in liaison with the central government.
categorization of various enterprises as Micro, Small and size of the industry is/are the purpose/purposes of ‘Statutory Reserve III. The remaining industrial options which were not
Medium Manufacturing Enterprises (MSMEs), which of (a) 1, 3 and 4 (b) 1, 2 and 4 Requirements’? covered by either the centre or state lists, were left
the following statements are correct: (c) 2, 3 and 4 (d) 2 and 3 1. To enable the Central Bank to control the amount open to the private sector.
1. A micro enterprise is an enterprise where the 23. With the reference to the public sector undertaking in of advances the banks can create IV. This policy was to be reviewed after 5 years.
investment in equipment does not exceed `25 lakh. India, consider the following statements : 2. To make the people’s deposits with banks safe and (a) I & II (b) I, II & III
2. A small enterprise is an enterprise where the 1. Minerals and Metals Trading Corporation of liquid (c) Only III (d) All the above
investment in equipment is more than `25 lakh but India limited is the largest non-oil importer of the 3. To prevent the commercial banks from making 34. Which sentence is correct regarding Industrial
does not exceed `5 crore. country. excessive profits Development and Regulation Act 1951?
3. A medium enterprise is an enterprise where the 2. Project and Equipment Corporation of India Limited 4. To force the banks to have sufficient vault cash to I. They controlled the authorization of capability,
investment in equipment is more than `5 crore but is under the ministry of industry. meet their day-to-day requirements whereabouts and growth of any request for
does not exceed `10 crore. 3. One of the objectives of Export Credit Guarantee Select the correct answer using the code given below. manufacture of new products.
(a) Only 1 (b) Only 2 II. They controlled the authorization of foreign
Corporation of India Limited is to enforce quality (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 only
(c) Only 3 (d) All of them exchange expenditure on the import of plant and
control and compulsory pre-shipment inspection of (c) 2 and 3 only (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4
18. Consider the following factors: machinery.
1. High Investment in industries various exportable commodities. 30. List-I List-II
Which of the above statement(s) are correct ? (Industries) (Industrial Centres) III. They controlled the authorization for the terms of
2. Expanding market for product international joint ventures.
3. Dynamic entrepreneurship (a) 1 only (b) 1 and 2 (A) Pearl fishing (1) Pune
(c) 2 and 3 (d) 3 only (a) I & II (b) Only III
Which of the above are required for accelerated growth (B) Automobiles (2) Tuticorin
24. The Reserve Bank of India regulates the commercial (c) II & III (d) All the above
of an economy ? (C) Ship building (3) Pinjore 35. Match the following:
(a) Only 1 (b) 1 & 2 banks in matters of (D) Engineering (4) Marmagao
1. liquidity of assets Column I Column II
(c) 1, 2 & 3 (d) 2 & 3 goods I. PSU’s a. Category C
19. India has a high export earning from Diamonds. 2. branch expansion (a) A – 2; B – 1; C – 4; D – 3
3. merger of banks II. Joint Venture b. Category A
In this context, consider the following: (b) A – 2; B – 1; C – 3; D – 4 III. Private Sector c. Category B
1. High Diamonds Stocks 4. winding-up of banks
Select the correct answer using the codes given below. (c) A – 1; B – 2; C – 4; D – 3 (a) I – b, II – c, III – a
2. Large Production of Industrial Diamonds (b) I – a, II – c, III - b
(a) 1 and 4 only (b) 2, 3 and 4 only (d) A – 1; B – 2; C – 3; D – 4
3. Availability of experts on cutting and polishing (c) I – c, II – b, III - a
(c) 1, 2 and 3 only (d) 1, 2, 3 and 4 31. Match the following products with their percentage
Which among the above is/ are most appropriate reason/ (d) I – b, II – a, III – c
reasons behind the above fact? 25. Which of the following grants / grant direct credit part that was controlled by the foreigners at the time of
assistance to rural households? independence: 36. Which statement is correct regarding joint venture?
(a) Only 1 (b) Only 1 & 3 I. 15 industrial areas were put under this category.
(c) Only 3 (d) 1, 2 & 3 1. Regional Rural Banks Product Percentage
2. National Bank for Agriculture and Rural II. This category also carried the provision of
20. Consider the following statements: I. Tea a. 70%
Development compulsory licensing.
1. Lack of adequate entrepreneurship and leadership in II. Jute b. 73% III. This provision led to the establishment of the so-
business. 3. Land Development Banks III. Coal c. 65% called ‘Licence- Quota- Permit raj’ in the economy.
2. Lack of saving to invest. Select the correct answer using the codes given below. IV. Minerals d. 90% (a) I & II (b) II & III
3. Lack of technology, skills and infrastructure. (a) 1 and 2 only (b) 2 only (a) I – c, II – d, III – a, IV – b (c) Only I (d) All the above
4. Limited purchasing power among the larger masses. (c) 1 and 3 only (d) 1, 2 and 3 (b) I – b, II – d, III – a, IV - c 37. Which statement is correct regarding Industrial Policy
Which of the above statement(s) are correct ? 26. Consider the following statements: (c) I – c, II – b, III – a, IV - d 1956?
(a) 1, 2 and 3 (b) 1, 3 and 4 1. Inflation benefits the debtors. I. The policy of 1956, for the first time, recognized
(d) I – a, II – d, III – c, IV - b
(c) 2, 3 and 4 (d) 1, 2 and 4 2. Inflation benefits the bondholders. the contribution of small scale industries in the
32. What were the modified policies of government after
21. Consider the following statements: Which of the statements given above is/are correct? growth of the Indian economy.
1950’s?
Small-Scale industries are in most cases not as efficient (a) 1 only (b) 2 only II. It laid stress on rational distribution of national
I. Defence and strategic industries were to be the
as and competitive as the large scales one. Yet the (c) Both 1 and 2 (d) Neither 1 nor 2 income and effective utilization of resources.
exclusive domain of the government.

E-158 Industry and Infrastructure Industry and Infrastructure E-159

III. This policy is considered one of the most important II. Electronic Hardware Technology Park (EHTP), (a) I – b, II – c, III - a 55. What is government owned companies?
industrial policies of India as it decided the nature Software Technology Park (STP) Scheme for (b) I – a, II – c, III - b I. They are primarily meant to provide essential
and scope of the Indian economy till the reforms of building up strong electronic industry to enhance (c) I – b, II – a, III - c services such as railways.
1991. exports. (d) I – c, II – b, III - a II. They are public enterprises that came into existence
(a) I & II (b) II & III III. Liberalised policy for Foreign Direct Investment 50. Which statement is correct regarding cotton industry?
(c) All the above (d) Only I by a Special Act of the Parliament.
(FDI). I. The first Indian modernised cotton mill, located in
38. Which statement is correct regarding FERA 1973? Kolkata in 1818 III. They are companies in which 51% or more of the
IV. Abolition of the MRTP limit.
I. The Foreign Exchange and Regulation Act (FERA) II. The second mill named ‘Bombay Spinning and paid up capital is held by the central or any state
(a) I & III (b) III & IV
was passed in 1980. (c) Only II (d) All the above Weaving Co.’ was established in 1854 at Bombay government (partly or wholly by both).
II. This resulted in a tremendous shift in the foreign 44. Match the following investment requirements under the by KGN Daber IV. They are set up whenever it is felt that certain functions
investment policy of the Government of India. Manufacturing Enterprises category: III. There were 394 cotton mills in India before the need to be discharged outside the governmental
III. Foreign Investment was allowed in only those partition set up with some amount of independence and
Column I Column II
industries that were directly into exports. (a) I & II (b) II & III flexibility without day-to-day interference from the
I. Micro Enterprise a. 5 crores to upto 10 crores
(a) I & II (b) Only III (c) Only II (d) All the above
II. Small Enterprise b. 25 lakh to upto 5 crores governmental machinery
(c) II & III (d) All the above 51. Which statement is correct regarding iron and steel
39. Consider the following statements: III. Medium Enterprise c. Upto 25 lakh industry? (a) Only III (b) I & III
I. The policy listed out the various Appendix 1 (a) I – c, II – b, III – a I. Large scale iron and steel production was started in (c) Only II (d) None of the above
industries that could be started by large business (b) I – b, II – c, III - a 1907 by TISCO established at Jamshedpur. 56. What are autonomous bodies?
houses so that small industries were not driven out (c) I – c, II – a, III - b II. In 1919, Indian Iron and Steel Company (IISCO) I. They are primarily meant to provide essential
of business. (d) I – a, II – b, III - c was established at Burnpur. Both TISCO and IISCO services such as railways.
II. The establishment of small and medium industries 45. Match the following investment requirements under the are private sector companies. II. They are public enterprises that came into existence
was encouraged. Service Enterprises category: III. The first public sector company was ‘Vishwashwaraiya by a Special Act of the Parliament.
III. Private industries were encouraged to set up Column I Column II Iron and Steel Works at Bhadravati’. III. They are companies in which 51% or more of the
production units in rural areas and in backward I. Micro Enterprise a. 2 crores to upto 5 crores (a) I & II (b) Only II paid up capital is held by the central or any state
areas with a vision to give thrust for the economic II. Small Enterprise b. 10 lakh to upto 2 crores (c) II & III (d) All the above government (partly or wholly by both).
development of those areas. III. Medium Enterprise c. Upto 10 lakh 52. What are the categories of PSEs? IV. They are set up whenever it is felt that certain functions
Which statement is /are correct regarding Industrial (a) I – c, II – b, III – a I. Departmental undertakings need to be discharged outside the governmental
Policy 1973: (b) I – b, II – c, III – a II. Statutory corporations
(a) I & II (b) II & III set up with some amount of independence and
(c) I – c, II – a, III – b III. Government-owned companies
(c) Only III (d) All the above IV. Autonomous bodies flexibility without day-to-day interference from the
(d) I – a, II – b, III – c governmental machinery
40. Which statements are correct regarding Industrialization 46. Which statement is correct regarding cottage industries? (a) II & III (b) II & IV
post 1990? (c) All the above (d) Only I (a) Only IV (b) I & III
I. Cottage industry is run by family members on full (c) Only II (d) None of the above
I. Exemption from licensing was allowed for all start 53. What is departmental undertaking?
or part time basis. 57. Which sentence is correct regarding CPSE?
ups and for those with an investment worth `2.5 I. They are primarily meant to provide essential
crores in fixed assets and a right to import up to II. It possesses negligible capital investment.
services such as railways. I. During the first five-year plan (1950-51 to 1955-56)
30% of the total value of plant and machinery. III. The production is done by hands and no wage II. They are public enterprises that came into existence there were only five CPSEs with a total financial
II. Foreign equity investment was allowed up to 70%. earning person is employed in cottage industry. by a Special Act of the Parliament. investment (Including equity plus long-term loans)
III. Geographical restrictions and investment cap for (a) I & II (b) II & III III. They are companies in which 51% or more of the of ` 290 million
small industries were removed. (c) Only II (d) All the above paid up capital is held by the central or any state II. In 2015, there are as many as 290 CPSEs, wherein,
(a) I & II (b) Only II 47. Consider the statements: government (partly or wholly by both).
I. Small industrial units employ wage earning labour 169 are Holding CPSEs and 121 are the subsidiaries.
(c) I & III (d) All the above IV. They are set up whenever it is felt that certain
and production is done by the use of modern III. As of Mar 31, 2012, the total financial investment
41. Which among the below statements are correct regarding functions need to be discharged outside the
techniques. of CPSEs was 7,292.3 billion, showing a CAGR of
the Features of Industrial Policy 1991? governmental set up with some amount of
I. To maintain a sustained growth in productivity. II. Capital investment is also present in small industries around 12% during the same period.
independence and flexibility without day-to-day (a) I & II (b) Only I
II. To enhance gainful employment. Which among the above statement is correct regarding interference from the governmental machinery
III. Liberalisation of Industrial Licensing Policy. small industries? (c) Only III (d) All the above
(a) Only I (b) I & III 58. Match the following products with the percentage of
IV. Introduction of Industrial Entrepreneur’s Memorandum (a) Only I (b) Only II
(c) Only III (d) None of the above CPSE control over them:
(i.e., no industrial approval is required for industries (c) Both I & II (d) None of the above
not requiring compulsory licensing). 54. What is Statutory Corporation? Column I Column II
48. Which statement is correct regarding village industries?
(a) I & II (b) I & III I. The industries established in rural areas having I. They are primarily meant to provide essential I. Coal a. 70%
(c) Only IV (d) All the above population below 10,000 and having less than services such as railways. II. Crude Oil b. 55%
42. Industrial Policy 1991 mainly focuses on which points? ` 15,000 as fixed capital investment per worker will II. They are public enterprises that came into existence III. Refineries c. 80%
I. Deregulating Indian industry. be termed as village industries. by a Special Act of the Parliament. (a) I – c, II – a, III – b
II. Allowing the industry freedom & flexibility in II. KVIC and state village Industries Board provide III. They are companies in which 51% or more of the (b) I – a, II – c, III – b
responding to market forces economic and technical assistance in establishing paid up capital is held by the central or any state (c) I – c, II – b, III – a
III. Providing a policy regime which facilitates and and operating these industrial units. (d) I – b, II – a, III – c
government (partly or wholly by both).
fosters growth of Indian industry. (a) I & II (b) Only I 59. Which statement is true regarding employment in India?
(c) Only II (d) None of the above IV. They are set up whenever it is felt that certain functions
(a) I & II (b) II & III I. Food products industry has ranked first in generating
(c) Only III (d) All the above 49. Match the following according to the contribution of need to be discharged outside the governmental
employment, providing employment to 0.48 million
43. What were the policy measures taken under Industrial cotton industries in different sectors: set up with some amount of independence and
persons (13.1%).
Policy 1991? Column I Column II flexibility without day-to-day interference from the II. The next two industry groups were Non-metallic
I. Non-Resident Indians Scheme (NRIs are allowed to I. GDP a. 13.5% governmental machinery mineral products with employment of 0.45 million
invest upto 100% equity on non-repatriation basis in II. Manufacturing Value b. 4% (a) Only I (b) I & III persons (12.2%) and Metal products with 0.37
all activities except for a small negative list). III. Export earning c.14% (c) Only II (d) None of the above million persons (10.2%).
E-160 Industry and Infrastructure Industry and Infrastructure E-161

III. In chemicals & chemical products, machinery parts 65. Consider the following statements: (a) I – b, II – c, III – a II. It is expected that another 350 aircraft will be added
except electrical parts, wood products, basic metal I. Economic infrastructure is located within the system (b) I – a, II – c, III - b during the next five years.
industries, paper products & printing, hosiery of production and distribution. Some of these are (c) I – b, II – a, III – c III. An Airport Economic Regulatory Authority (AERA)
& garments, repair services and rubber & plastic the transport system, banking system and power. (d) I – c, II – b, III – a is being set up to ensure healthy competition
products, the contribution ranged from 9% to 5% II. Social infrastructure contributes to the production 71. Which statement is correct regarding road transport?
(a) I & II (b) II & III process from outside the system. Some examples among operators and settlement of disputes among
I. India has one of the largest road networks in the operators as well as between them and passengers.
(c) Only III (d) All the above are education, training, hospitals and housing.
60. Which sentences are correct regarding export in India? world aggregating to about 3.62 million km at (a) I & II (b) Only ii
Which statement is correct regarding Infrastructure?
I. 45%-50% of the Indian Exports is contributed by present.
(a) Only I (b) Only II (c) II & III (d) All the above
SSI Sector. (c) Both I & II (d) None of these II. Three initiatives in the road sector were begun in
74. What are the points covered in new telecom policy?
II. Direct exports from the SSI Sector account for 66. Which statement is correct regarding energy? recent years: The National Highway Development
I. Rural Tele-density – To improve rural teledensity
nearly 45% of total exports. I. Coal was the most important source of energy during Project (NHDP), Pradhan Mantri Bharat Jodo
III. Besides direct exports, it is estimated that small- Pariyojana (PMBJP) and Pradhan Mantri Gram from the current level of around 39 to 70 by the
the Industrial Revolution. In the 20th century, it was
scale industrial units contribute around 15% to Sadak Yogana (PMGSY) year 2017 and 100 by the year 2020.
replaced by oil, which was an even cheaper source.
exports indirectly. II. When the oil producing countries formed a cartel III. NHDP dealt with building high quality highways. II. Broadband – “Broadband For All” at a minimum
(a) I & II (b) I & III (OPEC) and increased the price of crude oil from The PNBJP dealt with linking up major cities to the download speed of 2 Mbps
(c) Only II (d) All the above $2.1 per barrel in 1973 to as much as $28 per barrel III. Domestic Manufacturing – Making India a global
NHDP Highways. The PMGSY addressed rural
61. Consider the below statements: in 1980, it hit the developing countries like India roads. hub
I. Internal factors could be mismanagement, lack of the most.
finance wrong dividend policy, not providing for (a) I & II (b) II & III IV. Convergence of Network, Services and Devices
(a) Only I (b) Only II (c) Only I (d) All the above (a) I & II (b) Only II
reserves or deliberate ‘milking’ of the unit by the (c) I & II (d) None of these
owners. 72. Which statement is correct regarding shipping? (c) II & III (d) All the above
67. Match the following power with their share of
II. External factors could be wrong government I. Indian overseas fleet ranks the 17th the world in 75. Which statement is correct regarding information
percentage:
policy, power shortage, non-availability of raw terms of tonnage, with 659 ships totalling 77 lakh technology?
Column I Column II
materials, transport problem, lack of technological gross registered tonnage (GRT). I. The IT industry is the biggest private sector
I. Thermal a. 3%
advancement and labour disputes. II. 102 Indian shipping companies are in operation of
II. Hydro b. 5% employer in India, and it added 230,000 employees
Which statement is correct regarding industrial sickness? which 65 are engaged only in coastal shipping.
(a) Only I (b) Only II III. Renewable energy c. 66% in 2014-15, thus making the total number of jobs in
IV. Nuclear d. 26% III. The public sector Shipping Corporation of India
(c) Both I & II (d) None of the above the industry close to 3.5 million.
(a) I – a, II – d, III – b, IV – c (SCI) has a fleet of 112 vessels aggregating three
62. What are the aspects of Competition Act 2002? II. The IT sector also accounted for 9.5% of the gross
I. Prohibition of anti competitive agreements (b) I – c, II – d, III – b, IV – a million GRT.
(c) I – c, II – d, III – a, IV – b (a) I & II (b) Only II domestic product. The IT industry holds the largest
II. Prohibition of abuse of dominance share of total services exports at 38%.
III. Regulation of combination (acquisitions, mergers (d) I – b, II – c, III – d, IV – a (c) II & III (d) All the above
and amalgamations of certain size 68. Which sentence is correct regarding Power? 73. Which statement is incorrect regarding civil aviation? (a) Only I (b) Only II
IV. Establishment of Competition Commission of India I. A major initiative to expedite power generation has I. There are 20 scheduled airline operators using 334 (c) Both I & II (d) None of these
(CCI) been the development of coal-based-Ultra Mega aircraft.
(a) I & II (b) II & III Power Projects (UMPP) each with a capacity of
(c) Only I (d) All the above 4000 MW or above.
63. Which statement is correct regarding disinvestment II. Nine sites have been identified including four pithead
policy? sites (Chhattisgarh, Jharkhand, Madhya Pradesh
I. Citizens have every right to own part of the shares and Odisha) and five coastal sites (Andhra Pradesh,
of Public Sector Undertakings. Gujarat, Karnataka, Maharashtra and Tamil Nadu).
II. Public Sector Undertakings are the wealth of the III. The pithead units will get coal from captive mines
Nation and this wealth should rest in the hands of while the coastal plants will import coal. EXERCISE-1 initiatives launched by the government in the early
the people. (a) I & II (b) II & III ‘90s. The basic purpose of the scheme was to allow
1. (a) 2. (c) 3. (d) 4. (d) 5. (b)
III. While pursuing disinvestment, Government has (c) Only III (d) All the above exporters to import machinery and equipment at
6. (d) 7. (b) 8. (b) 9. (c) 10. (d)
to retain majority shareholding, i.e. at least 51% 69. Which statement is correct regarding railways? affordable prices so that they can produce quality
and management control of the Public Sector 11. (a) ONGC is India’s largest petrochemical company.
I. The first train in India was started on a small rail products for the export market.
Undertakings. IPCL is the second largest petrochemical company.
route of 34 kilometers between Bombay and Thane 18. (b) Oil sector majors, ONGC Videsh (OVL) and the
(a) I & II (b) II & III 12. (a) Rourkela Steel Plant (RSP) is the first intergrated
on April 16, 1853. Oil India-IndianOil (OIL-IOC) combine have
(c) Only I (d) All the above steel plant in the public sector in India. It was set up
II. The Indian Railway network has become the biggest bagged an oil block each in Libya. This will enhance
64. What are the approaches of disinvestment? with German collaboration with an installed capacity
I. In all cases of disinvestment, the Government would railway of Asia and the third in the world exploration possibilities for the Indian companies in
of 1 million tonnes.
retain at least 31% equity and the management III. Within the freight segment, bulk traffic accounts for 13. (c) 14. (b) 15. (a) northern Africa.
control. nearly 84% of revenue-earning freight traffic (in 16. (b) In India, ‘Report on Currency and Finance’ is the 19. (c) NASSCOM is the organisation of companies of
II. All cases of disinvestment are to be decided on a physical terms), of which about 44% is coal. annual publication of Reserve Bank of India.The Information Technology.
case by case basis (a) I & II (b) Only III 20. (c) 21. (a) 22. (a) 23. (b) 24. (d) 25. (c)
III. The Department of Disinvestment is to identify report highlights the evaluation or devaluation of
(c) II & III (d) All the above rupee as a currency along with it other aspects and 26. (b) 27. (c) 28. (a) 29. (d) 30. (c) 31. (d)
CPSEs in consultation with respective administrative 70. Match the following length of various railway track: 32. (d) 33. (a) 34. (c)
Ministries and submit proposal to Government projects the financial condition of the economy.
in cases requiring Offer for Sale of Government Column I Column II 17. (b) The Export Promotion Capital Goods (EPCG) 35. (c) Oil and gas industry is the largest contributor to
equity. I. Broad Gauge a. 2537 km scheme was one of the several export-promotion excise revenues in India followed by steel industry.
(a) I & II (b) Only I II. Meter Gauge b. 54257 km
(c) II & III (d) All the above III. Narrow Gauge c. 7180 km

E-162 Industry and Infrastructure Industry and Infrastructure E-163

36. (c) PKI stands for Public Key Infrastructure. The Nigam Limited (NINL), is a company promoted by resources from rural / semi-urban areas and grant 39. (d) The policy listed out the various Appendix 1
Reserve Bank of India released a draft report on MMTC Ltd, Industrial Promotion and Investment loans and advances mostly to small and marginal industries that could be started by large business
making payment system effective to secure a safe, Corporation of Orissa limited (IPICOL). farmers, agricultural laborers and rural artisans. houses so that small industries were not driven out
secure, efficient, robust and sound payment system 11. (c) Navratna was the title given originally to 9 26. ( a) Those who benefit from higher inflation are debtors of business. The establishment of small and medium
in the country. Public Sector Enterprises (PSEs) identified by the and those who suffer from it are creditors. If one has industries was encouraged. Private industries were
37. (c) Disguised unemployment is a situation when people government in 1997 as public sector companies substantial debt, each rupee one has to repay would encouraged to set up production units in rural areas
do not have productive full-time employment, that have comparative advantages enjoying greater be worth less than when it was borrowed. In this and in backward areas with a vision to give thrust
but are not counted in the official unemployment autonomy to compete in the global market so as way, one pays back less in real terms. for the economic development of those areas.
statistics. to support in their drive to become global giants. 27. (d) Currency/cash is the most liquid ,then the demand 40. (c) Exemption from licensing was allowed for all start
38. (c) The Balance of Payments(BoPs) accounts are an However, the number of PSEs (Public Sector deposits (current accounts), then the saving deposits ups and for those with an investment worth ` 2.5
accounting record of all monetary transactions Enterprises) having Navaratna status is now more with bank and finally the least liquid is the time crores in fixed assets and a right to import up to
between country and the rest of the world. These than 15 industries.
deposits with the bank (fixed deposits). 30% of the total value of plant and machinery.
transactions include payment for the country’s 12. (c) The first petrochemical industry in India was started
28. (c) Besides giving access to banking, it also enables Foreign equity investment was allowed up to 40%.
exports and imports of goods, services, financial with the establishment of National Organic Chemical
capitals and financial transfers. government subsidies and social security benefits Geographical restrictions and investment cap for
Industry Limited in 1961. The company manufacture
39. (d) A tight monetary policy is a course of action various organic and inorganic chemicals. The real to be directly credited to the accounts of the small industries were removed.
undertaken by Central bank to constrict spending in thrust of Petrochemical industry in India came beneficiaries, enabling them to draw the money 41. (a)
an economy, or to curb inflation when it is rising too with the establishment of Indian Petrochemical from the bank saathi or business correspondents in 42. (d) Deregulating Indian industry. Allowing the industry
fast. The increased bank rate increases the cost of Corporation Limited (IPCL) at Baroda on March their village itself. freedom & flexibility in responding to market forces
borrowing and effectively reduces its attractiveness. 22, 1969, with a view to promote and encourage 29. (b) Because Reserve requirements are designed as and providing a policy regime which facilitates and
40. (d) Taxes on tooth paste come under GST which is the use of plastics in India. “precautionary measures” and not to stop banks fosters growth of Indian industry.
administered by State government.Sales tax is paid 13. (c) Miniratna public sector enterprises can be a joint from “excessive” profit. This eliminates (c) and 43. (d)
to sales tax authority in the state from where the venture, set subsidiary company or overseas office (d). 44. (a) Micro Enterprises are those enterprises which have
goods are moved. but with certain conditions i.e Miniratna-I is up to 30. (a) Industries – Industrial centres investment up to ` 25 lakh. Small Enterprises are
41. (b) Venture capital (VC) is a long term financial capital ` 500 crore or equal to their net worth, whichever (A) Pearl fishing – Tuticorin those enterprises with investment above 25 lakh
provided to early-stage, high-potential, growth start is lower. Miniratna-II: is up to ` 300 crore or up (B) Automobile industry– Pune and up to 5 crores. Medium Enterprises are those
up companies or new companies. to 50% of their net worth, whichever is lower. Till (C) Ship building – Marmagao enterprises which have investment above ` 5 crores
now less than 50 public sector enterprises have been (D) Engineering goods– Pinjore and up to ` 10 crores.
EXERCISE-2
given Miniratna status by the Indian government. 31. (a) 45. (a) Micro Enterprises investment includes companies
1. (d) 2. (a) 14. (b) In terms of capital goods, India still depends on the 32. (d) Defense and strategic industries were to be the with investment up to ` 10 lakh. Small Enterprises
3. (c) On 27 January 2005, the Government had decided to import has not attained self sufficiency in almost all exclusive domain of the government. Existing units need an investment above 10 lakh and up to 2
constitute a ‘National Investment Fund’ (NIF) into consumer goods. in basic and key industries could continue in the crore. Medium Enterprises are those enterprises
which realization from sale of minority shareholding 15. (d) Competition Commission of India is a body of private sector but no fresh private investment in which have an investment above 2 crore and up to 5
of the Government in CPSEs would be channelised. the government of India responsible for enforcing these sectors was to be allowed. Twenty important crore.
This fund is managed by professionals and a part of the Competition Act, 2002 throughout India and industries were allowed in private sector but under 46. (d) Cottage industry is run by family members on full
it is used for use in social sector – like education, to prevent activities that have an adverse effect
health care and employment. strict supervision of the state. All industries not or part time basis. It possesses negligible capital
on competition in India. It was established on 14
4. (b) covered by the above three categories were allowed investment. The production is done by hands and
October 2003.The goal is to combat the monopoly
5. (a) Minerals and Metals Trading Corporation Limited in the private sector under general supervision of the no wage earning person is employed in cottage
tendencies and faster the competition among public
(MMTC) is one of the two biggest foreign exchange state. industry.
sector enterprises. CCI (Competition Commission
earner for India. It is a leading international trading 33. (d) 34. (d) 35. (a) 47. (c) Small industrial units employ wage earning labour
of India) consists of a chairperson and 6 members
company with a turnover of over 68,885 crore appointed by the central government. 36. (b) 12 industrial areas were put under this category. This and production is done by the use of modern
rupees in 2010–11. It is the largest international 16. (a) 17. (d) 18. (c) 19. (c) category also carried the provision of compulsory techniques. Capital investment is also present in
trading company of India and the first Public Sector 20. (d) 21. (a) 22. (a) 23. (a) licensing. This provision led to the establishment of small industries.
Enterprise to be accorded the status of FIVE STAR 24. (d) The Reserve Bank of India is the main monetary the so- called ‘Licence- Quota- Permit raj’ in the 48. (a) The industries established in rural areas having
EXPORT HOUSE by Govt. of India for long authority of the country and beside that, in its economy. population below 10,000 and having less than Rs.
standing contribution to exports. MMTC is the capacity as the central bank, acts as the bank of 37. (c) The policy of 1956, for the first time, recognized 15,000 as fixed capital investment per worker will
largest non-oil importer in India. the national and state governments. Some times it the contribution of small scale industries in the be termed as village industries. KVIC and state
6. (c) 7. (d) 8. (b) growth of the Indian economy. It laid stress on village Industries Board provide economic and
happens that some of the banks close down due to
9. (c) Tata steel is the asia’s first privately owned rational distribution of national income and effective technical assistance in establishing and operating
non recovery of loans or such other issues. In such
integrated iron and steel plant. It is the first company
conditions people have to suffer as their money utilization of resources. This policy is considered these industrial units.
outside Japan to get the Doming Application Prize
is with the bank then. For this reason there is one of the most important industrial policies of 49. (a) Cotton Industry in India is the most organized
in 2008 for excellence in total quality management.
provision for winding up of the banking company India as it decided the nature and scope of the Indian industry which contributes to about 4% of GDP,
Tata Steel started provident fund for its employees
under the Banking Regulation Act, 1949. The power economy till the reforms of 1991. 14% of manufacturing value and 13.5% to total
as early as in 1920, however, it became a law for
of winding up of Bank lies in the hand of Reserve 38. (c) The Foreign Exchange and Regulation Act (FERA) export earnings.
all employers under the Provident Fund Act only in
Bank of India. was passed in 1973. This resulted in a tremendous 50. (d)
1952.
25. (c) Land development bank started financing long term shift in the foreign investment policy of the 51. (d) Large scale iron and steel production was started
10. (c) MMTC Ltd., Metals and Minerals Trading
Corporation of India, is one of the two highest loan for more significant rural development activities Government of India. Foreign Investment was in 1907 by TISCO established at Jamshedpur. In
earners of foreign exchange for India and India’s like rural and cottage industries, rural artisans etc. allowed in only those industries that were directly 1919, Indian Iron and Steel Company (IISCO) was
largest public sector trading body. Neelanchal Ispat The main purpose of RRB’s is to mobilize financial into exports. established at Burnpur. Both TISCO and IISCO are
ग्रप
ू मे उपलब्ध सामग्री निम्ि प्रका
E-164 Industry and Infrastructure News PAPER /EMPLOYMENT NEWS/Curre
news/Hindu vocabulary /All book competit
private sector companies. The first public sector 63. (d)
company was ‘Vishwashwaraiya Iron and Steel 64. (d) In all cases of disinvestment, the Government would
Works at Bhadravati’. retain at least 51% equity and the management

notes/All ncert/ignou/vardman uni/bed/engi


52. (c) The PSEs in India are basically categorized under control. All cases of disinvestment are to be
four broad types based on their ownership structure. decided on a case by case basis. The Department of
These include: departmental undertakings, statutory Disinvestment is to identify CPSEs in consultation
corporations, government-owned companies and
/computer science almost 10,000 books ava
with respective administrative Ministries and submit
autonomous bodies set up as registered societies. proposal to Government in cases requiring Offer for
53. (a) Departmental undertakings are primarily meant Sale of Government equity.
to provide essential services such as railways. 65. (c)

TE
They function under the control of the respective 66. (c) Coal was the most important source of energy during
ministries of Government of India (GoI). the Industrial Revolution. In the 20th century, it was
54. (c) Statutory corporations are public enterprises
that came into existence by a Special Act of the
Parliament. The Act defines the powers and
replaced by oil, which was an even cheaper source.
When the oil producing countries formed a cartel
(OPEC) and increased the price of crude oil from
िये TELIGRAM INSTALL करिे के ललए यहााँ जललक करें ▶️
functions, rules and regulations governing the
$2.1 per barrel in 1973 to as much as $28 per barrel
employees and the relationship of the corporation

यदि पहले से TELIGRAM है तो निचे िीली लाईि टच क


in 1980, it hit the developing countries like India the
with government departments.
most.
55. (a) Government-owned or controlled companies refer
67. (b) the share of hydro power is 26 per cent, thermal 66
to companies in which 51% or more of the paid up
capital is held by the central or any state government per cent, renewable energy sources 5 per cent and

STUDY ALL IN O
(partly or wholly by both). It is registered under the nuclear 3 per cent.
Indian Companies Act and is fully governed by the 68. (d) A major initiative to expedite power generation has
provisions of this Act. been the development of coal-based-Ultra Mega
56. (a) Autonomous bodies are set up whenever it is felt Power Projects (UMPP) each with a capacity
that certain functions need to be discharged outside of 4000 MW or above. Nine sites have been
the governmental set up with some amount of identified including four pithead sites (Chhattisgarh,
independence and flexibility without day-to-day Jharkhand, Madhya Pradesh and Odisha) and five
interference from the governmental machinery. coastal sites (Andhra Pradesh, Gujarat, Karnataka,
57. (d) During the first five-year plan (1950-51 to 1955-56) Maharashtra and Tamil Nadu). The pithead units

NEWSPAPERS
there were only five CPSEs with a total financial will get coal from captive mines while the coastal
investment (Including equity plus long-term loans) plants will import coal.
of ` 290 million, whereas at present, in 2015, 69. (d)
there are as many as 290 CPSEs, wherein, 169 are 70. (a) At present, the Indian Railway consists of an
Holding CPSEs and 121 are the subsidiaries. As extensive network spread over 63974 km comprising
of Mar 31, 2012, the total financial investment of Broad Gauge (54257 km) Meter Gauge (7180 km)
CPSEs was 7,292.3 billion, showing a CAGR of and Narrow Gauge (2537 km).
around 12% during the same period. 71. (d)
58. (a) 59. (d) 72. (d) Indian overseas fleet ranks the 17th the world in

MOVIE & NOV


60. (b) 45%-50% of the Indian Exports is contributed by SSI terms of tonnage, with 659 ships totalling 77 lakh
Sector. Direct exports from the SSI Sector account gross registered tonnage (GRT). 102 Indian shipping

फ्री study हे तू आज ही TELIGRAM APPS download करे


for nearly 35% of total exports. Besides direct companies are in operation of which 65 are engaged
exports, it is estimated that small-scale industrial only in coastal shipping. The public sector Shipping
units contribute around 15% to exports indirectly. Corporation of India (SCI) has a fleet of 112 vessels
61. (c) Internal factors could be mismanagement, lack of aggregating three million GRT.
finance wrong dividend policy, not providing for

(Google play फ्री study हे तू आज ही TELIGRAM install करे


73. (a) An Airport Economic Regulatory Authority (AERA)
reserves or deliberate ‘milking’ of the unit by the is being set up to ensure healthy competition among

EMEMPLOYMENT
owners. External factors could be wrong government operators and settlement of disputes among operators
policy, power shortage, non-availability of raw
as well as between them and passengers.
materials, transport problem, lack of technological

(google play store ) LOGIN करे & OPEN करे SEARCH


74. (d)
advancement and labour disputes.
75. (c) The IT industry is the biggest private sector
62. (d) The Act mainly covers the following aspects: (i)
employer in India, and it added 230,000 employees
Prohibition of anti competitive agreements; (ii)
in 2014-15, thus making the total number of jobs in
Prohibition of abuse of dominance; (iii) Regulation
the industry close to 3.5 million. The IT sector also

OPTIONS मे “MEENA" type करे फिर एक link show करे गा


of combination (acquisitions, mergers and
accounted for 9.5% of the gross domestic product.
amalgamations of certain size); (iv) Establishment
The IT industry holds the largest share of total
of Competition Commission of India (CCI); and (v)
services exports at 38%.
Functions and powers of CCI.

जजसे टच करे फिर join पर click करके ग्रूपमे जुड सकते है

ग्रप
ू मे उपलब्ध सामग्री निम्ि प्रकार है
News PAPER /EMPLOYMENT NEWS/Current affairs /Bbc
news/Hindu vocabulary /All book competition /Upsc ssc
notes/All ncert/ignou/vardman uni/bed/engineering/Medical
/computer science almost 10,000 books available in group

िये TELIGRAM INSTALL करिे के ललए यहााँ जललक करें ▶️ TELIGRAM


यदि पहले से TELIGRAM है तो निचे िीली लाईि टच करे ओर ग्रप
ू मे जड
ु े

STUDY ALL IN ONE


NEWSPAPERS
MOVIE & NOVEL
EMEMPLOYMENT NEWS

You might also like